Miami Criminal Lawyer Home
U.S. Code Home
U.S. Code Table of Contents
 
   
U.S. Code  
   
-CITE-
12 USC CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-MISC1-
Sec.
1811. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.
1812. Management.
1813. Definitions.
1814. Insured depository institutions.
1815. Deposit insurance.
1816. Factors to be considered.
1817. Assessments.
1818. Termination of status as insured depository
institution.
1819. Corporate powers.
1820. Administration of Corporation.
1820a. Examination of investment companies.
1821. Insurance Funds.
1821a. FSLIC Resolution Fund.
1822. Corporation as receiver.
1823. Corporation monies.
1824. Borrowing authority.
1825. Issuance of notes, debentures, bonds, and other
obligations; exemption from taxation.
1826. Forms of obligations; preparation by Secretary of the
Treasury.
1827. Reports by Corporation; audit of financial
transactions; report on audits; employment of
certified public accountants for audits.
1828. Regulations governing insured depository institutions.
1828a. Prudential safeguards.
1828b. Interagency data sharing.
1829. Penalty for unauthorized participation by convicted
individual.
1829a. Participation by State nonmember insured banks in
lotteries and related activities.
1829b. Retention of records by insured depository
institutions.
1830. Nondiscrimination.
1831. Separability of certain provisions of this chapter.
1831a. Activities of insured State banks.
1831b. Disclosures with respect to certain federally related
mortgage loans.
1831c. Assuring consistent oversight of subsidiaries of
holding companies.
1831d. State-chartered insured depository institutions and
insured branches of foreign banks.
1831e. Activities of savings associations.
1831f. Brokered deposits.
1831f-1. Repealed.
1831g. Contracts between depository institutions and persons
providing goods, products, or services.
1831h. Repealed.
1831i. Agency disapproval of directors and senior executive
officers of insured depository institutions or
depository institution holding companies.
1831j. Depository institution employee protection remedy.
1831k. Reward for information leading to recoveries or civil
penalties.
1831l. Coordination of risk analysis between SEC and Federal
banking agencies.
1831m. Early identification of needed improvements in
financial management.
1831m-1. Reports of information regarding safety and soundness
of depository institutions.
1831n. Accounting objectives, standards, and requirements.
1831o. Prompt corrective action.
1831o-1. Source of strength.
1831p. Transferred.
1831p-1. Standards for safety and soundness.
1831q. FDIC affordable housing program.
1831r. Payments on foreign deposits prohibited.
1831r-1. Notice of branch closure.
1831s. Transferred.
1831t. Depository institutions lacking Federal deposit
insurance.
1831u. Interstate bank mergers.
1831v. Authority of State insurance regulator and Securities
and Exchange Commission.
1831w. Safety and soundness firewalls applicable to financial
subsidiaries of banks.
1831x. Insurance customer protections.
1831y. CRA sunshine requirements.
1831z. Bi-annual FDIC survey and report on encouraging use of
depository institutions by the unbanked.
1831aa. Enforcement of agreements.
1832. Withdrawals by negotiable or transferable instruments
for transfers to third parties.
1833. Repealed.
1833a. Civil penalties.
1833b. Comparability in compensation schedules.
1833c. Comptroller General audit and access to records.
1833d. Repealed.
1833e. Equal opportunity.
1834. Reduced assessment rate for deposits attributable to
lifeline accounts.
1834a. Assessment credits for qualifying activities relating
to distressed communities.
1834b. Community development organizations.
1835. Insured depository institution capital requirements
for transfers of small business obligations.
1835a. Prohibition against deposit production offices.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1811 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1811. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation

-STATUTE-
(a) Establishment of Corporation
There is hereby established a Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation (hereinafter referred to as the "Corporation") which
shall insure, as hereinafter provided, the deposits of all banks
and savings associations which are entitled to the benefits of
insurance under this chapter, and which shall have the powers
hereinafter granted.
(b) Asset disposition division
(1) Establishment
The Corporation shall have a separate division of asset
disposition.
(2) Management
The division of asset disposition shall have an administrator
who shall be appointed by the Board of Directors.
(3) Responsibilities of division
The division of asset disposition shall carry out all of the
responsibilities of the Corporation under this chapter relating
to the liquidation of insured depository institutions and the
disposition of assets of such institutions.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[1], 64 Stat. 873; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Sec. 202, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 188; Pub. L. 103-204,
Sec. 22(a), Dec. 17, 1993, 107 Stat. 2407.)

-COD-
CODIFICATION
The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation was originally created
as a part of the Federal Reserve Act by act June 16, 1933, ch. 89,
Sec. 8, 48 Stat. 168, which added section 12B to the Federal
Reserve Act, act Dec. 23, 1913, ch. 6, 38 Stat. 103, and was
classified to section 264 of this title. Act Dec. 23, 1913, ch. 6,
Sec. 12B, as added June 16, 1933, ch. 89, Sec. 8, 48 Stat. 168 has
been amended by acts June 16, 1934, ch. 546, Sec. 1(1)-(10), 48
Stat. 969, 970; June 28, 1935, ch. 335, 49 Stat. 435; Aug. 23,
1935, ch. 614, Sec. 101, 49 Stat. 684; Apr. 21, 1936, ch. 244, 49
Stat. 1237; May 25, 1938, ch. 276, 52 Stat. 442; June 16, 1938, ch.
489, 52 Stat. 767; June 20, 1939, ch. 214, Sec. 2, 53 Stat. 842;
Apr. 13, 1943, ch. 62, Sec. 1, 57 Stat. 65; Aug. 5, 1947, ch. 492,
Secs. 2, 4, 61 Stat. 773; June 25, 1948, ch. 645, Sec. 21, 62 Stat.
862, eff. Sept. 1, 1948; Oct. 15, 1949, ch. 695, Sec. 4, 63 Stat.
880; Aug. 17, 1950, ch. 729, Secs. 5-7, 64 Stat. 457.
Section 12B of the Federal Reserve Act was withdrawn from the
Federal Reserve Act and made a separate Act by section 1 of act
Sept. 21, 1950, and set out as this chapter.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (a) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note above.

AMENDMENTS
1993 - Pub. L. 103-204 inserted "Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation" as section catchline, redesignated existing provisions
as subsec. (a), inserted heading, and substituted "There is hereby
established" for "There is hereby created", and added subsec. (b).
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73 inserted "and savings associations" after
"banks".

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1993 AMENDMENT
Section 22(b) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that: "The amendments
made by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall become
effective on July 1, 1995."

SHORT TITLE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 111-203, title VI, Sec. 601, July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1596, provided that: "This title [enacting sections 214d, 1467b,
1831c, 1831o-1, 1850a, 1851, and 1852 of this title and section 77z-
2a of Title 15, Commerce and Trade, amending sections 35, 36, 84,
371a, 371c, 371c-1, 375, 375b, 1462, 1464, 1467a, 1468, 1828,
1831u, 1841 to 1844, 1848a, and 3907 of this title and section 78q
of Title 15, and enacting provisions set out as notes under
sections 35, 84, 371a, 371c, 375, 375b, 1462, 1467a, 1815, 1828,
1831c, and 1831u of this title and sections 77z-2a and 78q of Title
15] may be cited as the 'Bank and Savings Association Holding
Company and Depository Institution Regulatory Improvements Act of
2010'."

SHORT TITLE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 1(a), Oct. 13, 2006, 120 Stat. 1966,
provided that: "This Act [see Tables for classification] may be
cited as the 'Financial Services Regulatory Relief Act of 2006'."
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 1, Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3601, provided
that: "This Act [see Tables for classification] may be cited as the
'Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Conforming Amendments Act of
2005'."
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2101, Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9,
provided that: "This subtitle [subtitle B (Secs. 2101-2109) of
title II of Pub. L. 109-171, amending sections 24, 338a, 347b,
1431, 1441a, 1441b, 1464, 1467a, 1723i, 1735f-14, 1813, 1815 to
1817, 1821, 1821a, 1823 to 1825, 1827, 1828, 1831a, 1831e, 1831h,
1831m, 1831o, 1833a, 1834, 1841, and 3341 of this title and section
905 of Title 2, The Congress, enacting provisions set out as notes
under sections 1817 and 1821 of this title, and repealing
provisions set out as notes under section 1821 of this title] may
be cited as the 'Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Act of 2005'."

SHORT TITLE OF 2004 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 1, Oct. 30, 2004, 118 Stat. 2228, provided
that: "This Act [amending sections 321, 1709, 1813, 1817, 1820,
1821, 1828, 1841, 1842, 1881, 3206, and 3207 of this title and
sections 78c, 78l, and 78q of Title 15, Commerce and Trade, and
enacting provisions set out as notes under section 321 of this
title] may be cited as the '2004 District of Columbia Omnibus
Authorization Act'."

SHORT TITLE OF 2000 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 106-569, title XII, Sec. 1200, Dec. 27, 2000, 114 Stat.
3032, provided that: "This title [enacting sections 215a-2, 215a-3,
and 4805a of this title, amending sections 11, 71 to 72, 83, 215b,
1426, 1464, 1467a, 1817, 1818, 1821, 1828, 1831n, and 3102 of this
title, repealing sections 51, 1465, and 1831f-1 of this title,
enacting provisions set out as a note under section 1817 of this
title, and amending provisions set out as a note under section 1828
of this title] may be cited as the 'Financial Regulatory Relief and
Economic Efficiency Act of 2000'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1999 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 1(a), Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat. 1338,
provided that: "This Act [see Tables for classification] may be
cited as the 'Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1998 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 105-277, div. H, Sec. 1, Oct. 21, 1998, 112 Stat. 2681-
854, provided that: "This Division [amending section 1828 of this
title] may be cited as the 'Depository Institution-GSE Affiliation
Act of 1998'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1997 AMENDMENTS
Pub. L. 105-24, Sec. 1, July 3, 1997, 111 Stat. 238, provided
that: "This Act [amending sections 36 and 1831a of this title and
enacting provisions set out as a note under section 1831a of this
title] may be cited as the 'Riegle-Neal Amendments Act of 1997'."
Pub. L. 105-18, title V, Sec. 50001, June 12, 1997, 111 Stat.
211, provided that: "This title [enacting provisions set out as
notes under this section and sections 1828, 1831o, and 4008 of this
title] may be cited as the 'Depository Institutions Disaster Relief
Act of 1997'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2701, Sept. 30, 1996, 110
Stat. 3009-479, provided that: "This subtitle [subtitle G (Secs.
2701-2711) of title II of div. A of Pub. L. 104-208 amending
sections 24, 338a, 347b, 1431, 1441 to 1441b, 1464, 1467a, 1723i,
1735f-14, 1813, 1815 to 1817, 1821, 1821a, 1823 to 1825, 1827,
1828, 1831a, 1831e, 1831m, 1831o, 1833a, 1834, 1841, and 3341 of
this title and section 905 of Title 2, The Congress, repealing
section 1831h of this title, and enacting provisions set out as
notes under sections 1441, 1817, and 1821 of this title and section
162 of Title 26, Internal Revenue Code] may be cited as the
'Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1994 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 103-328, Sec. 1(a), Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat. 2338,
provided that: "This Act [enacting sections 43, 215a-1, 1831u, and
1835a of this title, amending sections 30, 36, 215, 215a, 215b,
1441a, 1462a, 1820, 1821, 1828, 1831a, 1831r-1, 1841, 1842, 1846,
2906, 3103 to 3105, and 3106a of this title and section 1927 of
Title 7, Agriculture, enacting provisions set out as notes under
this section, sections 215, 1828, 3104, 3105, and 3107 of this
title, section 1927 of Title 7, and section 5112 of Title 31, Money
and Finance, and amending provisions set out as notes under this
section and sections 5111 and 5112 of Title 31] may be cited as the
'Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act of
1994'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1993 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 103-76, Sec. 1, Aug. 12, 1993, 107 Stat. 752, provided
that: "This Act [enacting provisions set out as notes under this
section and sections 1828, 1831o, and 4008 of this title] may be
cited as the 'Depository Institutions Disaster Relief Act of
1993'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Pub. L. 102-550, title XV, Sec. 1500, Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat.
4044, provided that: "This title [see Tables for classification]
may be cited as the 'Annunzio-Wylie Anti-Money Laundering Act'."
Pub. L. 102-485, Sec. 1, Oct. 23, 1992, 106 Stat. 2771, provided
that: "This Act [enacting sections 338a and 3352 of this title,
amending section 24 of this title, and enacting provisions set out
as notes under this section and sections 1811, 1828, 1831o, and
4008 of this title] may be cited as the 'Depository Institutions
Disaster Relief Act of 1992'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 1(a), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2236, as
amended by Pub. L. 102-550, title XVI, Sec. 1601, Oct. 28, 1992,
106 Stat. 4075, provided that: "This Act [see Tables for
classification] may be cited as the 'Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation Improvement Act of 1991'."
Pub. L. 102-242, title II, Sec. 231, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2308, provided that: "This subtitle [subtitle C (Secs. 231-234) of
title II of Pub. L. 102-242, enacting sections 1834, 1834a, and
1834b of this title and amending section 1817 of this title] may be
cited as the 'Bank Enterprise Act of 1991'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1990 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 101-508, title II, Sec. 2001, Nov. 5, 1990, 104 Stat.
1388-14, provided that: "This Act [probably means this subtitle,
which is subtitle A (Secs. 2001-2005) of title II of Pub. L. 101-
508, amending sections 1817 and 1824 of this title] may be cited
as the 'FDIC Assessment Rate Act of 1990'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1989 AMENDMENT
Section 1(a) of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "This Act [see
Tables for classification] may be cited as the 'Financial
Institutions Reform, Recovery, and Enforcement Act of 1989'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1987 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 100-86, title V, Sec. 501, Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 623,
provided that: "This title [enacting sections 1439-1 and 1772b of
this title, amending sections 481, 1726, 1727, 1729, 1730a, 1785,
1786, 1813, 1821, 1823, 1828, 1842, 1843, and 1849 of this title
and sections 905 and 906 of Title 2, The Congress, enacting
provisions set out as a note under section 1464 of this title,
amending provisions set out as a note under section 1729 of this
title, and repealing provisions set out as a note under section
1464 of this title] may be cited as the 'Financial Institutions
Emergency Acquisitions Amendments of 1987'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1982 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 97-320, title I, Sec. 101, Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1469,
provided that: "This title [amending sections 1431, 1436, 1437,
1462, 1464, 1725, 1726, 1727, 1728, 1729, 1730, 1730a, 1785, 1786,
1813, 1814, 1817, 1818, 1820, 1821, 1822, 1823, 1828, 1831c, 1841,
1842, and 1843 of this title and enacting provisions set out as a
note under section 1464 of this title] may be cited as the 'Deposit
Insurance Flexibility Act'."
Pub. L. 97-320, title II, Sec. 201, Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1489,
provided that: "This title [amending sections 1464, 1726, 1729, and
1823 of this title and enacting provisions set out as notes under
section 1823 of this title] may be cited as the 'Net Worth
Certificate Act'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1981 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 97-110, title I, Sec. 101, Dec. 26, 1981, 95 Stat. 1513,
provided that: "This title [amending sections 1813, 1817, and 1821
of this title] may be cited as the 'International Banking Facility
Deposit Insurance Act'."

SHORT TITLE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 95-630, title VI, Sec. 601, Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3683,
provided that: "This title [amending section 1817 of this title]
may be cited as the 'Change in Bank Control Act of 1978'."

SHORT TITLE
Section 1 of act Sept. 21, 1950, provided: "That section 12B of
the Federal Reserve Act, as amended, is hereby withdrawn as a part
of that Act and is made a separate Act [enacting this chapter] to
be known as the 'Federal Deposit Insurance Act'."

SEPARABILITY
Pub. L. 102-242, title IV, Sec. 481, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2388, provided that: "If any provision of this Act [see Short Title
of 1991 Amendment note above], or any application of any provision
of this Act to any person or circumstance, is held invalid, the
remainder of the Act, and the application of any remaining
provision of the Act to any other person or circumstance, shall not
be affected by such holding."
Section 1221 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "If any provision
of this Act [see Short Title of 1989 Amendment note above] or the
application thereof to any person or circumstance is held invalid,
the remainder of the Act and the application of the provision to
other persons not similarly situated or to other circumstances
shall not be affected thereby."

CONSTRUCTION OF 1999 AMENDMENTS
Pub. L. 106-102, title II, Sec. 210, Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat.
1396, provided that: "Nothing in this Act [see Short Title of 1999
Amendment note above] shall supersede, affect, or otherwise limit
the scope and applicability of the Commodity Exchange Act (7 U.S.C.
1 et seq.)."
Pub. L. 106-102, title VII, Sec. 714, Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat.
1470, provided that: "Nothing in this Act [see Short Title of 1999
Amendment note above] shall be construed to repeal any provision of
the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 [12 U.S.C. 2901 et seq.]."

CONSTRUCTION OF 1997 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 105-18, title V, Sec. 50006, June 12, 1997, 111 Stat.
213, provided that: "No provision of this title [see Short Title of
1997 Amendments note above] shall be construed as limiting the
authority of any department or agency under any other provision of
law."

CONSTRUCTION OF 1994 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 103-328, title I, Sec. 111, Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat.
2365, provided that: "No provision of this title [enacting sections
43, 215a-1, 1831u, and 1835a of this title, amending sections 30,
36, 215, 215a, 215b, 1462a, 1820, 1828, 1831a, 1831r-1, 1841, 1842,
1846, 2906, 3103 to 3105, and 3106a of this title and section 1927
of Title 7, Agriculture, enacting provisions set out as notes under
this section, sections 215, 1828, 3104, 3105, and 3107 of this
title and section 1927 of Title 7, and amending provisions set out
as a note under this section] and no amendment made by this title
to any other provision of law shall be construed as affecting in
any way -
"(1) the authority of any State or political subdivision of any
State to adopt, apply, or administer any tax or method of
taxation to any bank, bank holding company, or foreign bank, or
any affiliate of any such bank, bank holding company, or foreign
bank, to the extent that such tax or tax method is otherwise
permissible by or under the Constitution of the United States or
other Federal law;
"(2) the right of any State, or any political subdivision of
any State, to impose or maintain a nondiscriminatory franchise
tax or other nonproperty tax instead of a franchise tax in
accordance with section 3124 of title 31, United States Code; or
"(3) the applicability of section 5197 of the Revised Statutes
[section 85 of this title] or section 27 of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [section 1831d of this title]."

CONSTRUCTION OF 1993 AMENDMENTS
Pub. L. 103-76, Sec. 7, Aug. 12, 1993, 107 Stat. 755, provided
that: "Nothing in this Act [see Short Title of 1993 Amendment note
above] limits the authority of any department or agency under any
other provision of law."

CONSTRUCTION OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Pub. L. 102-485, Sec. 8, Oct. 23, 1992, 106 Stat. 2775, provided
that: "Nothing in this Act [see Short Title of 1992 Amendments note
above] limits the authority of any department or agency under any
other provision of law."

YEAR 2000 READINESS FOR FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS
Pub. L. 105-164, Sec. 2, Mar. 20, 1998, 112 Stat. 32, provided
that:
"(a) Findings. - The Congress finds that -
"(1) the Year 2000 computer problem poses a serious challenge
to the American economy, including the Nation's banking and
financial services industries;
"(2) thousands of banks, savings associations, and credit
unions rely heavily on internal information technology and
computer systems, as well as outside service providers, for
mission-critical functions, such as check clearing, direct
deposit, accounting, automated teller machine networks, credit
card processing, and data exchanges with domestic and
international borrowers, customers, and other financial
institutions; and
"(3) Federal financial regulatory agencies must have sufficient
examination authority to ensure that the safety and soundness of
the Nation's financial institutions will not be at risk.
"(b) Definitions. - For purposes of this section -
"(1) the terms 'depository institution' and 'Federal banking
agency' have the same meanings as in section 3 of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1813];
"(2) the term 'Federal home loan bank' has the same meaning as
in section 2 of the Federal Home Loan Bank Act [12 U.S.C. 1422];
"(3) the term 'Federal reserve bank' means a reserve bank
established under the Federal Reserve Act [12 U.S.C. 221 et
seq.];
"(4) the term 'insured credit union' has the same meaning as in
section 101 of the Federal Credit Union Act [12 U.S.C. 1752]; and
"(5) the term 'Year 2000 computer problem' means, with respect
to information technology, any problem which prevents such
technology from accurately processing, calculating, comparing, or
sequencing date or time data -
"(A) from, into, or between -
"(i) the 20th and 21st centuries; or
"(ii) the years 1999 and 2000; or
"(B) with regard to leap year calculations.
"(c) Seminars and Model Approaches to Year 2000 Computer Problem.
-
"(1) Seminars. -
"(A) In general. - Each Federal banking agency and the
National Credit Union Administration Board shall offer seminars
to all depository institutions and insured credit unions under
the jurisdiction of such agency on the implication of the Year
2000 computer problem for -
"(i) the safe and sound operations of such depository
institutions and credit unions; and
"(ii) transactions with other financial institutions,
including Federal reserve banks and Federal home loan banks.
"(B) Content and schedule. - The content and schedule of
seminars offered pursuant to subparagraph (A) shall be
determined by each Federal banking agency and the National
Credit Union Administration Board taking into account the
resources and examination priorities of such agency.
"(2) Model approaches. -
"(A) In general. - Each Federal banking agency and the
National Credit Union Administration Board shall make available
to each depository institution and insured credit union under
the jurisdiction of such agency model approaches to common Year
2000 computer problems, such as model approaches with regard to
project management, vendor contracts, testing regimes, and
business continuity planning.
"(B) Variety of approaches. - In developing model approaches
to the Year 2000 computer problem pursuant to subparagraph (A),
each Federal banking agency and the National Credit Union
Administration Board shall take into account the need to
develop a variety of approaches to correspond to the variety of
depository institutions or credit unions within the
jurisdiction of the agency.
"(3) Cooperation. - In carrying out this section, the Federal
banking agencies and the National Credit Union Administration
Board may cooperate and coordinate their activities with each
other, the Financial Institutions Examination Council, and
appropriate organizations representing depository institutions
and credit unions."

STUDY AND REPORT ON UNITED STATES FINANCIAL SERVICES SYSTEM
Pub. L. 103-328, title II, Sec. 210, Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat.
2379, provided that:
"(a) Study. -
"(1) In general. - The Secretary of the Treasury (hereafter in
this section referred to as the 'Secretary') shall, after
consultation with the Advisory Commission on Financial Services
established under subsection (b), and consultation in accordance
with paragraph (3), conduct a study of matters relating to the
strengths and weaknesses of the United States financial services
system in meeting the needs of the system's users, including the
needs of -
"(A) individual consumers and households;
"(B) communities;
"(C) agriculture;
"(D) small-, medium-, and large-sized businesses;
"(E) governmental and nonprofit entities; and
"(F) exporters and other users of international financial
services.
"(2) Matters studied. - The study required under paragraph (1)
shall include consideration of -
"(A) the changes underway in the national and international
economies and the financial services industry, and how those
changes affect the financial services system's ability to
efficiently meet the needs of the national economy and the
system's users during the next 10 years and beyond; and
"(B) the adequacy of existing statutes and regulations, and
the existing regulatory structure, to meet the needs of the
financial services system's users effectively, efficiently, and
without unfair, anticompetitive, or discriminatory practices.
"(3) Consultation. - Consultation in accordance with this
paragraph means consultation with -
"(A) the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System;
"(B) the Commodity Futures Trading Commission;
"(C) the Comptroller of the Currency;
"(D) the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision;
"(E) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation;
"(F) the Secretary of the Department of Housing and Urban
Development;
"(G) the Securities and Exchange Commission;
"(H) the Director of the Congressional Budget Office; and
"(I) the Comptroller General of the United States.
"(b) Advisory Commission on Financial Services. -
"(1) Establishment. - There is established the Advisory
Commission on Financial Services (hereafter in this section
referred to as the 'Advisory Commission').
"(2) Membership of commission. - The Advisory Commission -
"(A) shall consist of not less than 9 nor more than 14
members appointed by the Secretary from among individuals -
"(i) who are -
"(I) users of the financial services system; or
"(II) experts in finance or on the financial services system;
and
"(ii) who are not employees of the Federal Government; and
"(B) shall include representatives of business, agriculture,
and consumers.
"(3) Chairperson. - The Secretary or the Secretary's designee
shall serve as Chairperson of the Advisory Commission.
"(4) Travel expenses. - Members of the Advisory Commission
shall be allowed travel expenses, including per diem in lieu of
subsistence, at rates authorized for employees of agencies under
subchapter I of chapter 57 of title 5, United States Code, while
away from their homes or regular places of business in performing
services for the Advisory Commission.
"(5) Termination. - The Advisory Commission shall terminate 30
days after the date of submission of the report required under
subsection (d).
"(c) Recommendations. - Based on the results of the study
conducted under subsection (a), the Secretary shall develop such
recommendations as may be appropriate for changes in statutes,
regulations, and policies to improve the operation of the financial
services system, including changes to better -
"(1) meet the needs of, and assure access to the system for,
current and potential users;
"(2) promote economic growth;
"(3) protect consumers;
"(4) promote competition and efficiency;
"(5) avoid risk to the taxpayers;
"(6) control systemic risk; and
"(7) eliminate discrimination.
"(d) Report. - Not later than 15 months after the date of
enactment of this Act [Sept. 29, 1994], the Secretary shall submit
to the President pro tempore of the Senate and the Speaker of the
House of Representatives a report describing the study conducted
under subsection (a) and any recommendations developed under
subsection (c)."

STUDY AND REPORT ON DEPOSITORY INSTITUTIONS DISASTER RELIEF ACTS OF
1992 AND 1993
Pub. L. 103-76, Sec. 5, Aug. 12, 1993, 107 Stat. 754, directed
Secretary of the Treasury, after consultation with appropriate
Federal banking agencies to conduct a study that (1) examined how
agencies and entities granted authority by Depository Institutions
Disaster Relief Act of 1992 and by this Act have exercised such
authority, (2) evaluated the utility of such Acts in facilitating
recovery from disasters consistent with safety and soundness of
depository institutions, and (3) contained recommendations with
respect to whether the authority granted by this Act should be made
permanent, and, not later than 18 months after Aug. 12, 1993,
submit to Congress a report on the results of the study.

FEASIBILITY STUDY ON AUTHORIZING INSURED AND UNINSURED DEPOSIT
ACCOUNTS
Pub. L. 102-242, title III, Sec. 321, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2370, directed Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation to study the
feasibility of authorizing insured depository institutions to offer
both insured and uninsured deposit accounts to customers, specified
factors to be considered in conducting the study, and directed
Corporation, before the end of the 6-month period beginning on Dec.
19, 1991, to submit a report to Congress containing the
Corporation's findings and conclusions with respect to the study
and any recommendations for legislative or administrative action
the Corporation determined to be appropriate.

PRIVATE REINSURANCE STUDY
Pub. L. 102-242, title III, Sec. 322, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2370, directed Board of Directors of Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation, in consultation with Secretary of the Treasury and
individuals from the private sector with expertise in private
insurance, private reinsurance, depository institutions, or
economics, to conduct a study of the feasibility of establishing a
private reinsurance system, such study to include a demonstration
project consisting of a simulation, by a sample of private
reinsurers and insured depository institutions, of the activities
required for a private reinsurance system, with a report to
Congress on the study before the end of the 18-month period
beginning on Dec. 19, 1991.

PURPOSES OF 1989 AMENDMENT
Section 101 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "The purposes of
this Act [see Short Title of 1989 Amendment note above] are as
follows:
"(1) To promote, through regulatory reform, a safe and stable
system of affordable housing finance.
"(2) To improve the supervision of savings associations by
strengthening capital, accounting, and other supervisory
standards.
"(3) To curtail investments and other activities of savings
associations that pose unacceptable risks to the Federal deposit
insurance funds.
"(4) To promote the independence of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation from the institutions the deposits of which
it insures, by providing an independent board of directors,
adequate funding, and appropriate powers.
"(5) To put the Federal deposit insurance funds on a sound
financial footing.
"(6) To establish an Office of Thrift Supervision in the
Department of the Treasury, under the general oversight of the
Secretary of the Treasury.
"(7) To establish a new corporation, to be known as the
Resolution Trust Corporation, to contain, manage, and resolve
failed savings associations.
"(8) To provide funds from public and private sources to deal
expeditiously with failed depository institutions.
"(9) To strengthen the enforcement powers of Federal regulators
of depository institutions.
"(10) To strengthen the civil sanctions and criminal penalties
for defrauding or otherwise damaging depository institutions and
their depositors."

STUDIES OF FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE, BANKING SERVICES, AND SAFETY
AND SOUNDNESS OF GOVERNMENT-SPONSORED ENTERPRISES
Pub. L. 101-73, title X, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 507, as amended
by Pub. L. 103-328, title I, Sec. 108(a), Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat.
2361; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2608, Sept. 30, 1996,
110 Stat. 3009-474, provided that:

"SEC. 1001. STUDY OF FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE SYSTEM.
"(a) In General. - The Secretary of the Treasury, in consultation
with the Comptroller of the Currency, the Chairman of the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the Director of the Office
of Thrift Supervision, the Chairperson of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation, the Chairman of the National Credit Union
Administration Board, the Director of the Office of Management and
Budget, and individuals from the private sector, shall conduct a
study of the Federal deposit insurance system.
"(b) Topics. - As part of the study required under subsection
(a), the Secretary of the Treasury shall investigate, review, and
evaluate the following:
"(1) The feasibility of establishing a deposit insurance
premium rate structure which would take into account, on an
institution-by-institution basis -
"(A) asset quality risk;
"(B) interest rate risk;
"(C) quality of management; and
"(D) profitability and capital.
"(2) Incentives for market discipline, including the advantages
of -
"(A) limiting each depositor to 1 insured account per
institution;
"(B) reducing the amount insured, or providing for a
graduated decrease in the percentage of the amounts deposited
which are insured as the amounts deposited increase;
"(C) combining Federal with private insurance in order to
bring the market discipline of private insurance to bear on the
management of the depository institution; and
"(D) ensuring, by law or regulation, that on the closing of
any insured depository institution, the appropriate Federal
insurance fund will honor only its explicit liabilities, and
will never make good any losses on deposits not explicitly
covered by Federal deposit insurance.
"(3) The scope of deposit insurance coverage and its impact on
the liability of the insurance fund.
"(4) The feasibility of market value accounting, assessments on
foreign deposits, limitations on brokered deposits, the addition
of collateralized borrowings to the deposit insurance base, and
multiple insured accounts.
"(5) The impact on the deposit insurance funds of varying State
and Federal bankruptcy exemptions and the feasibility of -
"(A) uniform exemptions;
"(B) limits on exemptions when necessary to repay obligations
owed to federally insured depository institutions; and
"(C) requiring borrowers from federally insured depository
institutions to post a personal or corporate bond when
obtaining a mortgage on real property.
"(6) Policies to be followed with respect to the
recapitalization or closure of insured depository institutions
whose capital is depleted to, or near the point of, insolvency.
"(7) The efficiency of housing subsidies through the Federal
home loan bank system.
"(8) Alternatives to Federal deposit insurance.
"(9) The feasibility of developing and administering, through
the appropriate Federal banking agency, an examination of the
principles and techniques of risk management and the application
of such principles and techniques to the management of insured
institutions.
"(10) The adequacy of capital of insured credit unions and the
National Credit Union Share Insurance Fund, including whether the
supervision of such fund should be separated from the other
functions of the National Credit Union Administration.
"(11) The feasibility of requiring, by statute or other means,
that -
"(A) independent auditors and accountants of a depository
institution report the results of any audit of the institution
to the relevant regulatory agency or agencies;
"(B) a regulator share reports on a depository institution
with the institution's independent auditors and accountants;
and
"(C) independent auditors and accountants participate in
conferences between the regulator and the depository
institution.
"(12) The feasibility of adopting regulations which are the
same as or similar to the provisions of England's Banking Act,
1987, ch. 22 (4 Halsbury's Statutes of England and Wales 527-650
(1987)), enacted on May 15, 1987, relating to the Bank of
England's relationship with auditors and reporting accountants
(including sections 8, 39, 41, 45, 46, 47, 82, 83, 85, and 94 of
such Act).
"(c) Final Report. - Not later than the close of the 18-month
period beginning on the date of the enactment of this Act [Aug. 9,
1989], the Secretary of the Treasury shall submit to the Congress a
final report containing a detailed statement of findings made, and
conclusions drawn from, the study conducted under this section,
including such recommendations for administrative and legislative
action as the Secretary determines to be appropriate.

"SEC. 1002. SURVEY OF BANK FEES AND SERVICES.
"(a) Annual Survey Required. - The Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System shall obtain a sample, which is
representative by geographic location and size of the institution,
of -
"(1) certain retail banking services provided by insured
depository institutions; and
"(2) the fees, if any, which are imposed by such institutions
for providing any such service, including fees imposed for not
sufficient funds, deposit items returned, and automated teller
machine transactions.
"(b) Annual Report to Congress Required. -
"(1) Preparation. - The Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System shall prepare a report of the results of each
survey conducted pursuant to subsection (a).
"(2) Contents of the report. - Each report prepared pursuant to
paragraph (1) shall include -
"(A) a description of any discernible trend, in the Nation as
a whole, in each of the 50 States, and in each consolidated
metropolitan statistical area or primary metropolitan
statistical area (as defined by the Director of the Office of
Management and Budget), in the cost and availability of retail
banking services (including fees imposed for providing such
services), that delineates differences between insured
depository institutions on the basis of both the size of the
institution and any engagement of the institution in multistate
activity; and
"(B) a description of the correlation, if any, among the
following factors:
"(i) An increase or decrease in the amount of any deposit
insurance premium assessed by the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation against insured depository institutions.
"(ii) An increase or decrease in the amount of the fees
imposed by such institutions for providing retail banking
services.
"(iii) A decrease in the availability of such services.
"(3) Submission to congress. - The Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System shall submit an annual report to the
Congress not later than September 1, 1995, and not later than
June 1 of each subsequent year.

"SEC. 1003. GENERAL ACCOUNTING OFFICE [GOVERNMENT ACCOUNTABILITY
OFFICE] STUDY.
"(a) In General. - The Comptroller General of the United States
shall conduct a study of deposit insurance issues raised by section
1001 emphasizing in particular -
"(1) analysis of the policy considerations affecting the scope
of deposit insurance coverage;
"(2) evaluation of the risks associated with bank insurance
contracts both as to the issuing institution and the deposit
insurance funds; and
"(3) the effect of proposed changes in the definition of
'deposit' on -
"(A) market discipline; and
"(B) the ability of other participants in capital markets to
raise funds.
"(b) Report. - Not later than the close of the 18-month period
beginning on the date of the enactment of this Act [Aug. 9, 1989],
the Comptroller General shall submit to the Congress the results of
the study required by subsection (a).

"SEC. 1004. STUDY REGARDING CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS FOR GOVERNMENT-
SPONSORED ENTERPRISES.
"(a) In General. - The Comptroller General of the United States
shall conduct a study of the risks undertaken by all government-
sponsored enterprises and the appropriate level of capital for
such enterprises consistent with -
"(1) the financial soundness and stability of the government-
sponsored enterprises;
"(2) minimizing any potential financial exposure of the Federal
Government; and
"(3) minimizing any potential impact on borrowing of the
Federal Government.
"(b) Consultation and Cooperation With Other Agencies. - The
Comptroller General shall determine the structure and methodology
of the study under this section in consultation with and with the
cooperation of the Secretary of Agriculture and the Farm Credit
Administration (with respect to the Farm Credit Banks, the Banks
for Cooperatives, and the Federal Agricultural Mortgage
Corporation), the Secretary of Education (with respect to the
Student Loan Marketing Association and the College Construction
Loan Corporation), the Secretary of Housing and Urban Development
(with respect to the Federal National Mortgage Association and the
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation), and the government-
sponsored enterprises.
"(c) Access to Relevant Information. - Each government-sponsored
enterprise shall provide full and prompt access to the Comptroller
General to its books and records and shall promptly provide any
other information requested by the Comptroller General. In
conducting the study under this section, the Comptroller General
may request information from, or the assistance of, any department
or agency of the Federal Government that is authorized by law to
supervise or approve any of the activities of any government-
sponsored enterprise.
"(d) Specific Requirements. - The study shall examine and
evaluate -
"(1) the degrees and types of risks that are undertaken by the
government-sponsored enterprises in the course of their
operations, including credit risk, interest rate risk, management
and operational risk, and business risk;
"(2) the most appropriate method or methods for quantifying the
types of risks undertaken by the government-sponsored
enterprises;
"(3) the actual level of risk that exists with respect to each
government-sponsored enterprise, which shall take into account
factors including the volume and type of securities outstanding
that are issued or guaranteed by each government-sponsored
enterprise and the extent of off-balance sheet expense of each
government-sponsored enterprise;
"(4) the appropriateness of applying a risk-based capital
standard to each government-sponsored enterprise, taking into
account the nature of the business each government-sponsored
enterprise conducts;
"(5) the costs and benefits to the public from application of a
risk-based capital standard to the government-sponsored
enterprises and the impact of such a standard on the capability
of each government-sponsored enterprise to carry out its purpose
under law;
"(6) the impact, if any, of the operation of the government-
sponsored enterprises on borrowing of the Federal Government;
"(7) the overall level of capital appropriate for each of the
government-sponsored enterprises; and
"(8) the quality and timeliness of information currently
available to the public and the Federal Government concerning the
extent and nature of the activities of government-sponsored
enterprises and the financial risk associated with such
activities.
"(e) Reports to Congress. - The Comptroller General shall submit
to the Congress 2 reports regarding the study under this section.
The first report shall be submitted to the Congress not later than
9 months after the date of the enactment of this Act [Aug. 9, 1989]
and the second report shall be submitted to the Congress not later
than 21 months after the date of the enactment of this Act. Each
report shall set forth -
"(1) the results of the study under this section;
"(2) any recommendations of the Comptroller General with
respect to appropriate capital standards for each government-
sponsored enterprise;
"(3) any recommendations of the Comptroller General with
respect to information that, in the determination of the
Comptroller General, should be provided to the Congress
concerning -
"(A) the extent and nature of the activities of the
government-sponsored enterprises; and
"(B) the nature of any periodic reports that the Comptroller
General believes should be submitted to the Congress relating
to the capital condition and operations of the government-
sponsored enterprises; and
"(4) any recommendations and opinions of the Secretary of
Agriculture, the Secretary of Education, the Secretary of Housing
and Urban Development, and the Secretary of the Treasury
regarding the report, to the extent that the recommendations and
views of such officers differ from the recommendations and
opinions of the Comptroller General.
"(f) Definition. - For purposes of this section, the term
'government-sponsored enterprises' means the Federal Home Loan
Mortgage Corporation, the Federal National Mortgage Association,
the Federal Home Loan Bank System, the Farm Credit Banks, the Banks
for Cooperatives, the Federal Agricultural Mortgage Corporation,
the College Construction Loan Insurance Corporation, the Student
Loan Marketing Association."
[Pub. L. 103-328, title I, Sec. 108(b), Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat.
2362, provided that: "The requirements of subsection (a) [amending
section 1002 of Pub. L. 101-73, set out above] shall not apply
after the end of the 7-year period beginning on the date of
enactment of this Act [Sept. 29, 1994]."]

EXPANSION OF USE OF UNDERUTILIZED MINORITY BANKS, WOMEN'S BANKS,
AND LOW-INCOME CREDIT UNIONS
Section 1204 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that:
"(a) Consultation on Expanded Use. - The Secretary of the
Treasury shall consult with the appropriate Federal banking
agencies and the National Credit Union Administration Board on
methods for increasing the use of underutilized minority banks,
women's banks, and limited income credit unions as depositaries or
financial agents of Federal agencies.
"(b) Report to Congress. - The Secretary of the Treasury shall
include, in the 1st annual report submitted to the Congress under
section 331(a) of title 31, United States Code, after the
completion of the consultation required by subsection (a), a report
of the actions taken by the Secretary to increase the use of
underutilized minority banks, women's banks, and limited income
credit unions as depositaries or financial agents of Federal
agencies.
"(c) Definitions. - For purposes of this section:
"(1) Appropriate federal banking agency. - The term
'appropriate Federal banking agency' has the meaning given to
such term in section 3(q) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act
[12 U.S.C. 1813(q)].
"(2) Minority bank. - The term 'minority bank' means any
depository institution described in clause (i), (ii), or (iii) of
section 19(b)(1)(A) of the Federal Reserve Act [12 U.S.C.
461(b)(1)(A)(i), (ii), (iii)] -
"(A) more than 50 percent of the ownership or control of
which is held by 1 or more minority individuals; and
"(B) more than 50 percent of the net profit or loss of which
accrues to 1 or more minority individuals.
"(3) Minority. - The term 'minority' means any Black American,
Native American, Hispanic American, or Asian American.
"(4) Low-income credit union. - The term 'low-income credit
union' means any depository institution described in section
19(b)(1)(A)(iv) of the Federal Reserve Act which serves
predominately low-income members (as defined by the National
Credit Union Administration Board pursuant to section 101(5) of
the Federal Credit Union Act [12 U.S.C. 1752(5)]).
"(5) Women's bank. - The term 'women's bank' means any
depository institution described in clause (i), (ii), or (iii) of
section 19(b)(1)(A) of the Federal Reserve Act -
"(A) more than 50 percent of the outstanding shares of which
are held by 1 or more women;
"(B) a majority of the directors on the board of directors of
which are women; and
"(C) a significant percentage of senior management positions
of which are held by women."

SMALL INVESTOR PARTICIPATION IN UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT SECURITIES
OFFERINGS; STUDY BY SECRETARY OF THE TREASURY
Section 1207 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "Not later than the
close of the 18-month period beginning on the date of the enactment
of this Act [Aug. 9, 1989], the Secretary of the Treasury shall
conduct a study and report to the Congress on -
"(1) whether, and to what extent, the issuance of securities by
the United States Government in small denominations benefits
small investors, increases the participation of small investors
in United States Government securities offerings, and promotes
savings and thrift by the average United States taxpayer; and
"(2) additional measures the Secretary recommends be taken to
expand the availability of securities issued by the United States
Government to benefit small investors, increase their
participation in United States Government securities offerings,
and to promote savings and thrift by the average United States
taxpayer."

EXPENDITURE OF TAXPAYER MONEY ONLY FOR DEPOSIT INSURANCE PURPOSES
Section 1208 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "Funds appropriated
to the Secretary of the Treasury pursuant to an authorization
contained in this Act [see Short Title of 1989 Amendment note
above], and any amount authorized to be borrowed from the Secretary
of the Treasury by any entity pursuant to this Act, may only be
used as permitted by law, and may not otherwise be used for making
any payment to any shareholder in, or creditor to, any insured
depository institution."

STUDIES OF RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN PUBLIC DEBT AND ACTIVITIES OF
GOVERNMENT-SPONSORED ENTERPRISES
Section 1404 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that:
"(a) In General. - In order to better manage the bonded
indebtedness of the United States, the Secretary shall conduct 2
annual studies to assess the financial safety and soundness of the
activities of all Government-sponsored enterprises and the impact
of their operations on Federal borrowing.
"(b) Access to Relevant Information. -
"(1) Information from gse's. - Each Government-sponsored
enterprise shall provide full and prompt access to the Secretary
to its books and records, and shall promptly provide any other
information requested by the Secretary.
"(2) Information from supervisory agencies. - In conducting the
studies under this section, the Secretary may request information
from, or the assistance of, any Federal department or agency
authorized by law to supervise the activities of any Government-
sponsored enterprise.
"(3) Confidentiality of information. -
"(A) In general. - The Secretary shall determine and maintain
the confidentiality of any book, record, or information made
available under this subsection in a manner generally
consistent with the level of confidentiality established for
the material by the Government-sponsored enterprise involved.
"(B) Exemption from public disclosure requirements. - The
Department of the Treasury shall be exempt from section 552 of
title 5, United States Code, with respect to any book, record,
or information made available under this subsection and
determined by the Secretary to be confidential under
subparagraph (A).
"(C) Penalty for unauthorized disclosure. - Any officer or
employee of the Department of the Treasury shall be subject to
the penalties set forth in section 1906 of title 18, United
States Code, if -
"(i) by virtue of his employment or official position, he
has possession of or access to any book, record, or
information made available under this subsection and
determined by the Secretary to be confidential under
subparagraph (A); and
"(ii) he discloses the material in any manner other than -
"(I) to an officer or employee of the Department of the
Treasury; or
"(II) pursuant to the exceptions set forth in such section
1906.
"(c) Assessment of Risk. - In assessing the financial safety and
soundness of the activities of Government-sponsored enterprises,
and the impact of their activities on Federal borrowing, the
Secretary shall quantify the risks associated with each Government-
sponsored enterprise. In quantifying such risks, the Secretary
shall determine the volume and type of securities outstanding which
are issued or guaranteed by each Government-sponsored enterprise,
the capitalization of each Government-sponsored enterprise, and the
degree of risk involved in the operations of each Government-
sponsored enterprise due to factors such as credit risk, interest
rate risk, management and operations risk, and business risk. The
Secretary shall also report on the quality and timeliness of
information currently available to the public and the Federal
Government concerning the extent and nature of the activities of
Government-sponsored enterprises and the financial risk associated
with such activities.
"(d) Reports to Congress. - The Secretary shall submit to the
Congress -
"(1) by May 15, 1990, a report setting forth the results of the
1st annual study conducted under this section; and
"(2) by May 15, 1991, a report setting forth the results of the
2nd annual study conducted under this section.
"(e) Definitions. - For purposes of this section:
"(1) Government-sponsored enterprise. - The term 'Government-
sponsored enterprise' means -
"(A) the Federal National Mortgage Association, the Federal
Home Loan Mortgage Corporation, the Federal Home Loan Bank
System, the Farm Credit Banks, the Banks for Cooperatives, the
Federal Agricultural Mortgage Corporation, the Student Loan
Marketing Association, the College Construction Loan Insurance
Association, and any of their affiliated or member
institutions; and
"(B) any other Government-sponsored enterprise, as designated
by the Secretary.
"(2) Secretary. - The term 'Secretary' means the Secretary of
the Treasury or his delegate."

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1812 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1812. Management

-STATUTE-
(a) Board of Directors
(1) In general
The management of the Corporation shall be vested in a Board of
Directors consisting of 5 members -
(A) 1 of whom shall be the Comptroller of the Currency;
(B) 1 of whom shall be the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision; and
(C) 3 of whom shall be appointed by the President, by and
with the advice and consent of the Senate, from among
individuals who are citizens of the United States, 1 of whom
shall have State bank supervisory experience.
(2) Political affiliation
After February 28, 1993, not more than 3 of the members of the
Board of Directors may be members of the same political party.
(b) Chairperson and Vice Chairperson
(1) Chairperson
1 of the appointed members shall be designated by the
President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, to
serve as Chairperson of the Board of Directors for a term of 5
years.
(2) Vice Chairperson
1 of the appointed members shall be designated by the
President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, to
serve as Vice Chairperson of the Board of Directors.
(3) Acting Chairperson
In the event of a vacancy in the position of Chairperson of the
Board of Directors or during the absence or disability of the
Chairperson, the Vice Chairperson shall act as Chairperson.
(c) Terms
(1) Appointed members
Each appointed member shall be appointed for a term of 6 years.
(2) Interim appointments
Any member appointed to fill a vacancy occurring before the
expiration of the term for which such member's predecessor was
appointed shall be appointed only for the remainder of such term.
(3) Continuation of service
The Chairperson, Vice Chairperson, and each appointed member
may continue to serve after the expiration of the term of office
to which such member was appointed until a successor has been
appointed and qualified.
(d) Vacancy
(1) In general
Any vacancy on the Board of Directors shall be filled in the
manner in which the original appointment was made.
(2) Acting officials may serve
In the event of a vacancy in the office of the Comptroller of
the Currency or the office of Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision and pending the appointment of a successor, or during
the absence or disability of the Comptroller or such Director,
the acting Comptroller of the Currency or the acting Director of
the Office of Thrift Supervision, as the case may be, shall be a
member of the Board of Directors in the place of the Comptroller
or Director.
(e) Ineligibility for other offices
(1) Postservice restriction
(A) In general
No member of the Board of Directors may hold any office,
position, or employment in any insured depository institution
or any depository institution holding company during -
(i) the time such member is in office; and
(ii) the 2-year period beginning on the date such member
ceases to serve on the Board of Directors.
(B) Exception for members who serve full term
The limitation contained in subparagraph (A)(ii) shall not
apply to any member who has ceased to serve on the Board of
Directors after serving the full term for which such member was
appointed.
(2) Restriction during service
No member of the Board of Directors may -
(A) be an officer or director of any insured depository
institution, depository institution holding company, Federal
Reserve bank, or Federal home loan bank; or
(B) hold stock in any insured depository institution or
depository institution holding company.
(3) Certification
Upon taking office, each member of the Board of Directors shall
certify under oath that such member has complied with this
subsection and such certification shall be filed with the
secretary of the Board of Directors.
(f) Status of employees
(1) In general
A director, member, officer, or employee of the Corporation has
no liability under the Securities Act of 1933 [15 U.S.C. 77a et
seq.] with respect to any claim arising out of or resulting from
any act or omission by such person within the scope of such
person's employment in connection with any transaction involving
the disposition of assets (or any interests in any assets or any
obligations backed by any assets) by the Corporation. This
subsection shall not be construed to limit personal liability for
criminal acts or omissions, willful or malicious misconduct, acts
or omissions for private gain, or any other acts or omissions
outside the scope of such person's employment.
(2) "Employee of the Corporation" defined
For purposes of this subsection, the term "employee of the
Corporation" includes any employee of the Office of the
Comptroller of the Currency or of the Office of Thrift
Supervision who serves as a deputy or assistant to a member of
the Board of Directors of the Corporation in connection with
activities of the Corporation.
(3) Effect on other law
This subsection does not affect -
(A) any other immunities and protections that may be
available to such person under applicable law with respect to
such transactions, or
(B) any other right or remedy against the Corporation,
against the United States under applicable law, or against any
person other than a person described in paragraph (1)
participating in such transactions.

This subsection shall not be construed to limit or alter in any
way the immunities that are available under applicable law for
Federal officials and employees not described in this subsection.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[2], 64 Stat. 873; Pub. L. 86-230,
Sec. 19, Sept. 8, 1959, 73 Stat. 460; Pub. L. 98-181, title VII,
Sec. 702(a), Nov. 30, 1983, 97 Stat. 1267; Pub. L. 101-73, title
II, Sec. 203(a), Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 188; Pub. L. 102-18, title
I, Sec. 103(b), Mar. 23, 1991, 105 Stat. 60; Pub. L. 104-208, div.
A, title II, Sec. 2243, Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-419; Pub. L.
111-203, title III, Sec. 336(a), July 21, 2010, 124 Stat. 1540.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 336, July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1540, provided that, effect on the transfer date, this section is
amended:
(1) in subsection (a)(1)(B), by substituting "Director of the
Consumer Financial Protection Bureau" for "Director of the Office
of Thrift Supervision";
(2) by amending subsection (d)(2) to read as follows:
"(2) Acting officials may serve
"In the event of a vacancy in the office of the Comptroller of
the Currency or the office of Director of the Consumer Financial
Protection Bureau and pending the appointment of a successor, or
during the absence or disability of the Comptroller of the
Currency or the Director of the Consumer Financial Protection
Bureau, the acting Comptroller of the Currency or the acting
Director of the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, as the case
may be, shall be a member of the Board of Directors in the place
of the Comptroller or Director."; and

(3) in subsection (f)(2), by substituting "Consumer Financial
Protection Bureau" for "Office of Thrift Supervision".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
The Securities Act of 1933, referred to in subsec. (f)(1), is act
May 27, 1933, ch. 38, title I, 48 Stat. 74, as amended, which is
classified generally to subchapter I (Sec. 77a et seq.) of chapter
2A of Title 15, Commerce and Trade. For complete classification of
this Act to the Code, see section 77a of Title 15 and Tables.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (b) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
1996 - Subsec. (a)(1)(C). Pub. L. 104-208 inserted ", 1 of whom
shall have State bank supervisory experience" before period at end.
1991 - Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 102-18 added subsec. (f).
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73 amended section generally, designating
existing provisions as subsecs. (a) to (e), and making other
changes relating to the make-up and operation of the Board.
1983 - Pub. L. 98-181 inserted provision that each such
appointive member may continue to serve after the expiration of his
term until a successor has been appointed and qualified.
1959 - Pub. L. 86-230 provided for membership of Acting
Comptroller of the Currency on Board of Directors during absence or
disability of Comptroller instead of only during his absence from
Washington.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 336(b), July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1540, provided that: "This section [amending this section], and the
amendments made by this section, shall take effect on the transfer
date."
[For definition of "transfer date" as used in section 336(b) of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out above, see section 5301 of this title.]

TRANSITION PROVISION
Pub. L. 101-73, title II, Sec. 203(b), Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat.
189, provided that:
"(1) Chairperson. - Notwithstanding any provision of section 2 of
the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1812], the Chairman of
the Board of Directors of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
on the date of the enactment of the Financial Institutions Reform,
Recovery, and Enforcement Act of 1989 [Aug. 9, 1989] may continue
to serve as the Chairperson until the end of the term to which such
Chairman was appointed.
"(2) Members. - Notwithstanding any provision of section 2 of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act, the appointed member of the Board of
Directors of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation on the date
of the enactment of the Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery,
and Enforcement Act of 1989 who is not the Chairman shall continue
to serve in office until the earlier of -
"(A) the end of the term to which such member was appointed; or
"(B) February 28, 1993,
except that such member may continue to serve after the end of such
term until a successor has been appointed and qualified.
"(3) Appointments before march 1, 1993. - Notwithstanding any
provision of section 2 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, the
term of any member appointed to the Board of Directors of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation before February 28, 1993
(including the term of any Chairperson), shall end on such date."
[Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 367(1), July 21, 2010,
124 Stat. 1546, 1556, provided that, effective on the transfer date
(defined in section 5301 of this title), section 203(b) of Pub. L.
101-73, set out above, is repealed.]

COMPENSATION OF BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Compensation of Chairman and members of the Board, see sections
5314 and 5315 of Title 5, Government Organization and Employees.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1813 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1813. Definitions

-STATUTE-
As used in this chapter -
(a) Definitions of bank and related terms
(1) Bank
The term "bank" -
(A) means any national bank and State bank, and any Federal
branch and insured branch;
(B) includes any former savings association.
(2) State bank
The term "State bank" means any bank, banking association,
trust company, savings bank, industrial bank (or similar
depository institution which the Board of Directors finds to be
operating substantially in the same manner as an industrial
bank), or other banking institution which -
(A) is engaged in the business of receiving deposits, other
than trust funds (as defined in this section); and
(B) is incorporated under the laws of any State or which is
operating under the Code of Law for the District of Columbia,

including any cooperative bank or other unincorporated bank the
deposits of which were insured by the Corporation on the day
before August 9, 1989.
(3) State
The term "State" means any State of the United States, the
District of Columbia, any territory of the United States,
Puerto Rico, Guam, American Samoa, the Trust Territory of the
Pacific Islands, the Virgin Islands, and the Northern Mariana
Islands.
(b) Definition of savings associations and related terms
(1) Savings association
The term "savings association" means -
(A) any Federal savings association;
(B) any State savings association; and
(C) any corporation (other than a bank) that the Board of
Directors and the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision jointly determine to be operating in
substantially the same manner as a savings association.
(2) Federal savings association
The term "Federal savings association" means any Federal
savings association or Federal savings bank which is chartered
under section 1464 of this title.
(3) State savings association
The term "State savings association" means -
(A) any building and loan association, savings and loan
association, or homestead association; or
(B) any cooperative bank (other than a cooperative bank
which is a State bank as defined in subsection (a)(2) of this
section),

which is organized and operating according to the laws of the
State (as defined in subsection (a)(3) of this section) in
which it is chartered or organized.
(c) Definitions relating to depository institutions
(1) Depository institution
The term "depository institution" means any bank or savings
association.
(2) Insured depository institution
The term "insured depository institution" means any bank or
savings association the deposits of which are insured by the
Corporation pursuant to this chapter.
(3) Institutions included for certain purposes
The term "insured depository institution" includes any
uninsured branch or agency of a foreign bank or a commercial
lending company owned or controlled by a foreign bank for
purposes of section 1818 of this title.
(4) Federal depository institution
The term "Federal depository institution" means any national
bank, any Federal savings association, and any Federal branch.
(5) State depository institution
The term "State depository institution" means any State bank,
any State savings association, and any insured branch which is
not a Federal branch.
(d) Definitions relating to member banks
(1) National member bank
The term "national member bank" means any national bank which
is a member of the Federal Reserve System.
(2) State member bank
The term "State member bank" means any State bank which is a
member of the Federal Reserve System.
(e) Definitions relating to nonmember banks
(1) National nonmember bank
The term "national nonmember bank" means any national bank
which -
(A) is located in any territory of the United States,
Puerto Rico, Guam, American Samoa, the Virgin Islands, or the
Northern Mariana Islands; and
(B) is not a member of the Federal Reserve System.
(2) State nonmember bank
The term "State nonmember bank" means any State bank which is
not a member of the Federal Reserve System.
(f) Mutual savings bank
The term "mutual savings bank" means a bank without capital
stock transacting a savings bank business, the net earnings of
which inure wholly to the benefit of its depositors after payment
of obligations for any advances by its organizers.
(g) Savings bank
The term "savings bank" means a bank (including a mutual
savings bank) which transacts its ordinary banking business
strictly as a savings bank under State laws imposing special
requirements on such banks governing the manner of investing
their funds and of conducting their business.
(h) Insured bank
The term "insured bank" means any bank (including a foreign
bank having an insured branch) the deposits of which are insured
in accordance with the provisions of this chapter; and the term
"noninsured bank" means any bank the deposits of which are not so
insured.
(i) New depository institution and bridge depository institution
defined
(1) New depository institution
The term "new depository institution" means a new national
bank or Federal savings association, other than a bridge
depository institution, organized by the Corporation in
accordance with section 1821(m) of this title.
(2) Bridge depository institution
The term "bridge depository institution" means a new national
bank or Federal savings association organized by the
Corporation in accordance with section 1821(n) of this title.
(j) Receiver
The term "receiver" includes a receiver, liquidating agent,
conservator, commission, person, or other agency charged by law
with the duty of winding up the affairs of a bank or savings
association or of a branch of a foreign bank.
(k) Board of Directors
The term "Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of
the Corporation.
(l) Deposit
The term "deposit" means -
(1) the unpaid balance of money or its equivalent received or
held by a bank or savings association in the usual course of
business and for which it has given or is obligated to give
credit, either conditionally or unconditionally, to a
commercial, checking, savings, time, or thrift account, or
which is evidenced by its certificate of deposit, thrift
certificate, investment certificate, certificate of
indebtedness, or other similar name, or a check or draft drawn
against a deposit account and certified by the bank or savings
association, or a letter of credit or a traveler's check on
which the bank or savings association is primarily liable:
Provided, That, without limiting the generality of the term
"money or its equivalent", any such account or instrument must
be regarded as evidencing the receipt of the equivalent of
money when credited or issued in exchange for checks or drafts
or for a promissory note upon which the person obtaining any
such credit or instrument is primarily or secondarily liable,
or for a charge against a deposit account, or in settlement of
checks, drafts, or other instruments forwarded to such bank or
savings association for collection.
(2) trust funds as defined in this chapter received or held
by such bank or savings association, whether held in the trust
department or held or deposited in any other department of such
bank or savings association.
(3) money received or held by a bank or savings association,
or the credit given for money or its equivalent received or
held by a bank or savings association, in the usual course of
business for a special or specific purpose, regardless of the
legal relationship thereby established, including without being
limited to, escrow funds, funds held as security for an
obligation due to the bank or savings association or others
(including funds held as dealers reserves) or for securities
loaned by the bank or savings association, funds deposited by a
debtor to meet maturing obligations, funds deposited as advance
payment on subscriptions to United States Government
securities, funds held for distribution or purchase of
securities, funds held to meet its acceptances or letters of
credit, and withheld taxes: Provided, That there shall not be
included funds which are received by the bank or savings
association for immediate application to the reduction of an
indebtedness to the receiving bank or savings association, or
under condition that the receipt thereof immediately reduces or
extinguishes such an indebtedness.
(4) outstanding draft (including advice or authorization to
charge a bank's or a savings association's balance in another
bank or savings association), cashier's check, money order, or
other officer's check issued in the usual course of business
for any purpose, including without being limited to those
issued in payment for services, dividends, or purchases, and
(5) such other obligations of a bank or savings association
as the Board of Directors, after consultation with the
Comptroller of the Currency, Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System, shall find and prescribe by regulation to be deposit
liabilities by general usage, except that the following shall
not be a deposit for any of the purposes of this chapter or be
included as part of the total deposits or of an insured
deposit:
(A) any obligation of a depository institution which is
carried on the books and records of an office of such bank or
savings association located outside of any State, unless -
(i) such obligation would be a deposit if it were carried
on the books and records of the depository institution, and
would be payable at, an office located in any State; and
(ii) the contract evidencing the obligation provides by
express terms, and not by implication, for payment at an
office of the depository institution located in any State;

(B) any international banking facility deposit, including
an international banking facility time deposit, as such term
is from time to time defined by the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System in regulation D or any successor
regulation issued by the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System; and
(C) any liability of an insured depository institution that
arises under an annuity contract, the income of which is tax
deferred under section 72 of title 26.
(m) Insured deposit
(1) In general. - Subject to paragraph (2), the term "insured
deposit" means the net amount due to any depositor for deposits
in an insured depository institution as determined under sections
1817(i) and 1821(a) of this title.
(2) In the case of any deposit in a branch of a foreign bank,
the term "insured deposit" means an insured deposit as defined in
paragraph (1) of this subsection which -
(A) is payable in the United States to -
(i) an individual who is a citizen or resident of the
United States,
(ii) a partnership, corporation, trust, or other legally
cognizable entity created under the laws of the United States
or any State and having its principal place of business
within the United States or any State, or
(iii) an individual, partnership, corporation, trust, or
other legally cognizable entity which is determined by the
Board of Directors in accordance with its regulations to have
such business or financial relationships in the United States
as to make the insurance of such deposit consistent with the
purposes of this chapter;

and
(B) meets any other criteria prescribed by the Board of
Directors by regulation as necessary or appropriate in its
judgment to carry out the purposes of this chapter or to
facilitate the administration thereof.

(3) Uninsured deposits. - The term "uninsured deposit" means
the amount of any deposit of any depositor at any insured
depository institution in excess of the amount of the insured
deposits of such depositor (if any) at such depository
institution.
(4) Preferred deposits. - The term "preferred deposits" means
deposits of any public unit (as defined in paragraph (1)) at any
insured depository institution which are secured or
collateralized as required under State law.
(n) Transferred deposit
The term "transferred deposit" means a deposit in a new bank or
other insured depository institution made available to a
depositor by the Corporation as payment of the insured deposit of
such depositor in a closed bank, and assumed by such new bank or
other insured depository institution.
(o) Domestic branch
The term "domestic branch" includes any branch bank, branch
office, branch agency, additional office, or any branch place of
business located in any State of the United States or in any
Territory of the United States, Puerto Rico, Guam, American
Samoa, the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, or the Virgin
Islands at which deposits are received or checks paid or money
lent. The term "domestic branch" does not include an automated
teller machine or a remote service unit. The term "foreign
branch" means any office or place of business located outside the
United States, its territories, Puerto Rico, Guam, American
Samoa, the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, or the Virgin
Islands, at which banking operations are conducted.
(p) Trust funds
The term "trust funds" means funds held by an insured
depository institution in a fiduciary capacity and includes,
without being limited to, funds held as trustee, executor,
administrator, guardian, or agent.
(q) Appropriate Federal banking agency
The term "appropriate Federal banking agency" means -
(1) the Comptroller of the Currency, in the case of any
national banking association or any Federal branch or agency of
a foreign bank;
(2) the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, in
the case of -
(A) any State member insured bank,
(B) any branch or agency of a foreign bank with respect to
any provision of the Federal Reserve Act which is made
applicable under the International Banking Act of 1978,
(C) any foreign bank which does not operate an insured
branch,
(D) any agency or commercial lending company other than a
Federal agency,
(E) supervisory or regulatory proceedings arising from the
authority given to the Board of Governors under section
7(c)(1) of the International Banking Act of 1978, including
such proceedings under the Financial Institutions Supervisory
Act of 1966, and
(F) any bank holding company and any subsidiary of a bank
holding company (other than a bank);

(3) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation in the case of
a State nonmember insured bank or a foreign bank having an
insured branch; and
(4) the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision in the
case of any savings association or any savings and loan holding
company.

Under the rule set forth in this subsection, more than one agency
may be an appropriate Federal banking agency with respect to any
given institution.
(r) State bank supervisor
(1) In general
The term "State bank supervisor" means any officer, agency,
or other entity of any State which has primary regulatory
authority over State banks or State savings associations in
such State.
(2) Interstate application
The State bank supervisors of more than 1 State may be the
appropriate State bank supervisor for any insured depository
institution.
(s) Definitions relating to foreign banks and branches
(1) Foreign bank
The term "foreign bank" has the meaning given to such term by
section 1(b)(7) of the International Banking Act of 1978 [12
U.S.C. 3101(b)(7)].
(2) Federal branch
The term "Federal branch" has the meaning given to such term
by section 1(b)(6) of the International Banking Act of 1978 [12
U.S.C. 3101(b)(6)].
(3) Insured branch
The term "insured branch" means any branch (as defined in
section 1(b)(3) of the International Banking Act of 1978 [12
U.S.C. 3101(b)(3)]) of a foreign bank any deposits in which are
insured pursuant to this chapter.
(t) Includes, including
(1) In general
The terms "includes" and "including" shall not be construed
more restrictively than the ordinary usage of such terms so as
to exclude any other thing not referred to or described.
(2) Rule of construction
Paragraph (1) shall not be construed as creating any
inference that the term "includes" or "including" in any other
provision of Federal law may be deemed to exclude any other
thing not referred to or described.
(u) Institution-affiliated party
The term "institution-affiliated party" means -
(1) any director, officer, employee, or controlling
stockholder (other than a bank holding company) of, or agent
for, an insured depository institution;
(2) any other person who has filed or is required to file a
change-in-control notice with the appropriate Federal banking
agency under section 1817(j) of this title;
(3) any shareholder (other than a bank holding company),
consultant, joint venture partner, and any other person as
determined by the appropriate Federal banking agency (by
regulation or case-by-case) who participates in the conduct of
the affairs of an insured depository institution; and
(4) any independent contractor (including any attorney,
appraiser, or accountant) who knowingly or recklessly
participates in -
(A) any violation of any law or regulation;
(B) any breach of fiduciary duty; or
(C) any unsafe or unsound practice,

which caused or is likely to cause more than a minimal
financial loss to, or a significant adverse effect on, the
insured depository institution.
(v) Violation
The term "violation" includes any action (alone or with another
or others) for or toward causing, bringing about, participating
in, counseling, or aiding or abetting a violation.
(w) Definitions relating to affiliates of depository institutions
(1) Depository institution holding company
The term "depository institution holding company" means a
bank holding company or a savings and loan holding company.
(2) Bank holding company
The term "bank holding company" has the meaning given to such
term in section 1841 of this title.
(3) Savings and loan holding company
The term "savings and loan holding company" has the meaning
given to such term in section 1467a of this title.
(4) Subsidiary
The term "subsidiary" -
(A) means any company which is owned or controlled directly
or indirectly by another company; and
(B) includes any service corporation owned in whole or in
part by an insured depository institution or any subsidiary
of such a service corporation.
(5) Control
The term "control" has the meaning given to such term in
section 1841 of this title.
(6) Affiliate
The term "affiliate" has the meaning given to such term in
section 1841(k) of this title.
(7) Company
The term "company" has the same meaning as in section 1841(b)
of this title.
(x) Definitions relating to default
(1) Default
The term "default" means, with respect to an insured
depository institution, any adjudication or other official
determination by any court of competent jurisdiction, the
appropriate Federal banking agency, or other public authority
pursuant to which a conservator, receiver, or other legal
custodian is appointed for an insured depository institution
or, in the case of a foreign bank having an insured branch, for
such branch.
(2) In danger of default
The term "in danger of default" means an insured depository
institution with respect to which (or in the case of a foreign
bank having an insured branch, with respect to such insured
branch) the appropriate Federal banking agency or State
chartering authority has advised the Corporation (or, if the
appropriate Federal banking agency is the Corporation, the
Corporation has determined) that -
(A) in the opinion of such agency or authority -
(i) the depository institution or insured branch is not
likely to be able to meet the demands of the institution's
or branch's depositors or pay the institution's or branch's
obligations in the normal course of business; and
(ii) there is no reasonable prospect that the depository
institution or insured branch will be able to meet such
demands or pay such obligations without Federal assistance;
or

(B) in the opinion of such agency or authority -
(i) the depository institution or insured branch has
incurred or is likely to incur losses that will deplete all
or substantially all of its capital; and
(ii) there is no reasonable prospect that the capital of
the depository institution or insured branch will be
replenished without Federal assistance.
(y) Definitions relating to Deposit Insurance Fund
(1) Deposit Insurance Fund
The term "Deposit Insurance Fund" means the Deposit Insurance
Fund established under section 1821(a)(4) of this title.
(2) Designated reserve ratio
The term "designated reserve ratio" means the reserve ratio
designated by the Board of Directors in accordance with section
1817(b)(3) of this title.
(3) Reserve ratio
The term "reserve ratio", when used with regard to the
Deposit Insurance Fund other than in connection with a
reference to the designated reserve ratio, means the ratio of
the net worth of the Deposit Insurance Fund to the value of the
aggregate estimated insured deposits, or such comparable
percentage of the assessment base set forth in section
1817(b)(2)(C) (!1) of this title.

(z) Federal banking agency
The term "Federal banking agency" means the Comptroller of the
Currency, the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, the
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, or the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[3], 64 Stat. 873; July 14, 1952,
ch. 725, 66 Stat. 605; Aug. 1, 1956, ch. 852, Sec. 3, 70 Stat. 908;
Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 1, July 14, 1960, 74 Stat. 546; Pub. L. 89-
695, title II, Sec. 201, title III, Secs. 301(a), 303(a), Oct. 16,
1966, 80 Stat. 1046, 1055, 1056; Pub. L. 91-151, Sec. 7(a)(1), Dec.
23, 1969, 83 Stat. 375; Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 910(a)-(f),
Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811, 1812; Pub. L. 93-495, title I, Secs.
101(a)(1), 102(a)(1), Oct. 28, 1974, 88 Stat. 1500, 1502; Pub. L.
95-369, Sec. 6(c)(2)-(6), Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 614, 615; Pub.
L. 95-630, title III, Sec. 301(a), Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3675;
Pub. L. 96-221, title III, Sec. 308(a)(1)(A), Mar. 31, 1980, 94
Stat. 147; Pub. L. 97-110, title I, Secs. 102, 103(a), Dec. 26,
1981, 95 Stat. 1513; Pub. L. 97-320, title I, Sec. 113(a), (b),
title VII, Sec. 703(a), (b), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1473, 1538,
1539; Pub. L. 100-86, title I, Sec. 101(g)(1), title V, Sec.
503(b), Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 563, 632; Pub. L. 101-73, title
II, Secs. 201(a), 204, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 190; Pub. L.
102-242, title I, Secs. 111(e), 112(b), 131(c)(3), 141(f), 161(c),
title III, Secs. 305(c), 311(b)(5)(A), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2242, 2266, 2278, 2286, 2355, 2366; Pub. L. 102-550, title XVI,
Secs. 1603(b)(2)(B), (d)(5), 1606(g)(2), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat.
4079, 4080, 4089; Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 19(b), Dec. 17, 1993, 107
Stat. 2404; Pub. L. 103-325, title III, Sec. 326(b)(2), title VI,
Sec. 602(a)(1), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat. 2229, 2288; Pub. L. 104-
208, div. A, title II, Secs. 2205(b), 2614(a), 2704(d)(6)(A),
(14)(A), Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-405, 3009-478, 3009-488,
3009-490; Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1), Oct. 30, 2004, 118 Stat.
2231; Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Secs. 2102(b), 2107(b), Feb. 8,
2006, 120 Stat. 9, 19; Pub. L. 109-173, Secs. 4(a), 8(a)(1), Feb.
15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3606, 3610; Pub. L. 109-351, title VII, Sec.
725(d), Oct. 13, 2006, 120 Stat. 2002; Pub. L. 109-356, title I,
Sec. 123(d), Oct. 16, 2006, 120 Stat. 2029; Pub. L. 110-289, div.
A, title VI, Sec. 1604(b)(1)(A), July 30, 2008, 122 Stat. 2829;
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 312(c), 334(b), 363(1), July 21,
2010, 124 Stat. 1522, 1539, 1550.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(1), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1550, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (b)(1)(C), by substituting "Comptroller of the
Currency" for "Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision";
(2) in subsection (l)(5), in introductory provisions, by striking
out "Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision,"; and
(3) in subsection (z), by striking out "the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision,".
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 312(a), (c), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1521, 1522, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (q), by striking paragraphs (1) through (4) and
inserting the following:
"(1) the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, in the
case of -
"(A) any national banking association;
"(B) any Federal branch or agency of a foreign bank; and
"(C) any Federal savings association;

"(2) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, in the case
of -
"(A) any State nonmember insured bank;
"(B) any foreign bank having an insured branch; and
"(C) any State savings association;

"(3) the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, in
the case of -
"(A) any State member bank;
"(B) any branch or agency of a foreign bank with respect to
any provision of the Federal Reserve Act which is made
applicable under the International Banking Act of 1978;
"(C) any foreign bank which does not operate an insured
branch;
"(D) any agency or commercial lending company other than a
Federal agency;
"(E) supervisory or regulatory proceedings arising from the
authority given to the Board of Governors under section
7(c)(1) of the International Banking Act of 1978, including
such proceedings under the Financial Institutions Supervisory
Act of 1966;
"(F) any bank holding company and any subsidiary (other
than a depository institution) of a bank holding company; and
"(G) any savings and loan holding company and any
subsidiary (other than a depository institution) of a savings
and loan holding company."; and

(2) in paragraphs (1) and (3) of subsection (u), by striking
"(other than a bank holding company" and inserting "(other than a
bank holding company or savings and loan holding company".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment notes below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
The Federal Reserve Act, referred to in subsec. (q)(2)(B), is act
Dec. 23, 1913, ch. 6, 38 Stat. 251, as amended, which is classified
principally to chapter 3 (Sec. 221 et seq.) of this title. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see References in
Text note set out under section 226 of this title and Tables.
The International Banking Act of 1978, referred to in subsec.
(q)(2)(B), is Pub. L. 95-369, Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 607, which
enacted sections 347d, 611a, and 3101 to 3111 of this title,
amended sections 72, 378, 614, 615, 618, 619, 1813, 1815, 1817,
1818, 1820, 1821, 1822, 1823, 1828, 1829b, 1831b, and 1841 of this
title, and enacted provisions set out as notes under sections 36,
247, 601, 611a, and 3101 of this title. For complete classification
of this Act to the Code, see Short Title note set out under section
3101 of this title and Tables.
The Financial Institutions Supervisory Act of 1966, referred to
in subsec. (q)(2)(E), is Pub. L. 89-695, Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat.
1028. For complete classification of this Act to the Code, see
Short Title of 1966 Amendment note set out under section 1464 of
this title and Tables.
Section 1817(b)(2)(C) of this title, referred to in subsec.
(y)(3), was redesignated section 1817(b)(2)(D) of this title by
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 331(a)(2), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1538.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (c) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (y)(3). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 334(b), inserted ",
or such comparable percentage of the assessment base set forth in
section 1817(b)(2)(C) of this title" before the period.
2008 - Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 110-289 added subsec. (i) and struck
out former subsec. (i). Prior to amendment, text read as follows:
"(1) New bank. - The term 'new bank' means a new national bank,
other than a bridge bank, organized by the Corporation in
accordance with section 1821(m) of this title.
"(2) Bridge bank. - The term 'bridge bank' means a new national
bank organized by the Corporation in accordance with section
1821(n) of this title."
2006 - Subsec. (a)(1)(B). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(1)(A), added
subpar. (B) and struck out former subpar. (B) which read as
follows: "includes any former savings association that -
"(i) has converted from a savings association charter; and
"(ii) is a Savings Association Insurance Fund member."
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(A). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 109-351 and 109-356 amended subpar.
(B) identically, striking out "(except a national bank)" after
"District of Columbia".
Subsec. (y). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 4(a), inserted subsec. heading
and par. (1) designation and heading and added par. (2).
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(A). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (y)(1). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(1)(B), added par. (1)
and struck out heading and text of former par. (1). Text read as
follows: "The term 'deposit insurance fund' means the Bank
Insurance Fund or the Savings Association Insurance Fund, as
appropriate."
Subsec. (y)(3). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2107(b), added par. (3).
2004 - Subsec. (a)(1)(A). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1)(A),
substituted "and State bank" for ", State bank, and District bank".
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1)(B), struck out
heading and text of par. (4). Text read as follows: "The term
'District bank' means any State bank operating under the Code of
Law of the District of Columbia."
Subsec. (q)(1). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1)(C), struck out ",
any District bank," after "national banking association".
Subsec. (q)(2)(A). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1)(D), struck out
"(except a District bank)" after "State member insured bank".
Subsec. (q)(3). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(1)(E), struck out
"(except a District bank)," after "State nonmember insured bank".
1996 - Subsec. (a)(1)(B). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(A),
which directed striking out subpar. (B) and adding a new subpar.
(B), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (l)(5)(C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2614(a), added subpar.
(C).
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2205(b), substituted "lent.
The term 'domestic branch' does not include an automated teller
machine or a remote service unit. The" for "lent; and the".
Subsec. (y). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(A), which directed
the general amendment of subsec. (y), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-
171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
1994 - Subsec. (i)(1). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(1)(A),
substituted "section 1821(m) of this title" for "section 1821(h) of
this title".
Subsec. (l)(4). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(1)(B), substituted
"a bank's or a" for "bank's or" before "savings association's
balance".
Subsec. (l)(5)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 326(b)(2), amended
subpar. (A) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (A) read as
follows: "any obligation of a bank or savings association which is
payable only at an office of such bank or savings association
located outside of the States of the United States, the District of
Columbia, Puerto Rico, Guam, American Samoa, the Trust Territory of
the Pacific Islands, the Virgin Islands, and the Northern Mariana
Islands; and".
Subsec. (q)(2)(E). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(1)(C),
substituted "Financial Institutions Supervisory Act of 1966" for
"Depository Institutions Supervisory Act".
1993 - Subsec. (w)(7). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 19(b)(2), added par.
(7).
Subsec. (z). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 19(b)(1), amended subsec. (z)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (z) read as follows:
"Federal Banking Agencies. - The term 'Federal banking agencies'
means the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, the Office of
Thrift Supervision, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System, and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation."
1992 - Subsec. (i)(2). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1606(g)(2),
substituted "1821(n)" for "1821(i)".
Subsec. (r). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(2)(B), which directed
the amendment of section 112 of the "Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation Improvement Act of 1992", was executed by amending
section 112 of Pub. L. 102-242, which is the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, to reflect the
probable intent of Congress. See 1991 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (y). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(5), amended directory
language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(3). See 1991 Amendment
note below.
1991 - Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(5)(A), inserted
heading.
Subsec. (m)(1). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(5)(A), added par.
(1) and struck out former par. (1) which read as follows: "Subject
to the provisions of paragraph (2) of this subsection, the term
'insured deposit' means the net amount due to any depositor (other
than a depositor referred to in the third sentence of this
subsection) for deposits in an insured depository institution
(after deducting offsets) less any part thereof which is in excess
of $100,000. Such net amount shall be determined according to such
regulations as the Board of Directors may prescribe, and in
determining the amount due to any depositor there shall be added
together all deposits in the depository institution maintained in
the same capacity and the same right for his benefit either in his
own name or in the names of others except trust funds which shall
be insured as provided in subsection (i) of section 1817 of this
title. Each officer, employee, or agent of the United States, of
any State of the United States, of the District of Columbia, of any
Territory of the United States, of Puerto Rico, of Guam, of
American Samoa, of the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, of
the Virgin Islands, of the Northern Mariana Islands, of any county,
of any municipality, or of any political subdivision thereof,
herein called 'public unit', having official custody of public
funds and lawfully depositing the same in an insured depository
institution shall, for the purpose of determining the amount of the
insured deposits, be deemed a depositor in such custodial capacity
separate and distinct from any other officer, employee, or agent of
the same or any public unit having official custody of public funds
and lawfully depositing the same in the same insured depository
institution in custodial capacity. For the purpose of clarifying
and defining the insurance coverage under this subsection and
subsection (i) of section 1817 of this title, the Corporation is
authorized to define, with such classifications and exceptions as
it may prescribe, terms used in those subsections, in subsection
(p) of this section, and in subsections (a) and (i) of section 1821
of this title and the extent of the insurance coverage resulting
therefrom."
Subsec. (m)(3), (4). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(f), added pars.
(3) and (4).
Subsec. (r). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 112(b), as added by Pub. L.
102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(2)(B), amended subsec. (r) generally. Prior
to amendment, subsec. (r) read as follows: "The terms 'foreign
bank' and 'Federal branch' shall be construed consistently with the
usage of such terms in the International Banking Act of 1978."
Subsec. (s). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 111(e), amended subsec. (s)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (s) read as follows: "The
term 'insured branch' means a branch of a foreign bank any deposits
in which are insured in accordance with the provisions of this
chapter."
Subsec. (w). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(c), substituted
"Affiliates of Depository Institutions" for "Holding Companies" in
heading.
Subsec. (y). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(3), as amended by Pub.
L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(5), added subsec. (y).
Subsec. (z). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 305(c), added subsec. (z).
1989 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(a), amended subsec.
(a) generally, substituting provisions defining "bank", "State
bank", "State", and "District bank" for provisions defining "State
bank" and "State".
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(b), amended subsec. (b)
generally, substituting provisions defining "savings association",
"Federal savings association", and "State savings association" for
provisions defining "State member bank" and "State nonmember bank".
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(c), amended subsec. (c)
generally, substituting definitions relating to depository
institutions for definition of "District bank".
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(d), amended subsec. (d)
generally, substituting provisions defining "national member bank"
and "State member bank" for provisions defining "national member
bank".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(e), amended subsec. (e)
generally, substituting provisions defining "national nonmember
bank" and "State nonmember bank" for provisions defining "national
nonmember bank".
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(1), inserted "or savings
association" after "of a bank".
Subsec. (l)(1) to (3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(2)(A),
inserted "or savings association" after "a bank", "the bank",
"receiving bank", and "such bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (l)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(2)(A), (B), inserted
"or savings association" after "another bank", and "or savings
association's" after "bank's".
Subsec. (l)(5). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(2)(A), (C), inserted
"or savings association" after "a bank", and ", Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision," after "Comptroller of the Currency".
Subsec. (l)(5)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(2)(A), (D),
inserted "or savings association" after "a bank" and after "such
bank", and substituted "the Virgin Islands, and the Northern
Mariana Islands" for "and the Virgin Islands".
Subsec. (m)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(3)(A), substituted
"deposits in the depository institution maintained" for "deposits
in the bank maintained" and inserted reference to the Northern
Mariana Islands.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institution" for "insured bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (m)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(3)(B), substituted
"term" for "ther".
Subsec. (n). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured
depository institution" for "insured bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (p). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured
depository institution" for "insured bank".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(4), amended subsec. (q)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (q) read as follows: "The
term 'appropriate Federal banking agency' shall mean -
"(1) the Comptroller of the Currency in the case of a national
banking association, a District bank, or a Federal branch or
agency of a foreign bank;
"(2) the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System -
"(A) in the case of a State member insured bank (except a
District bank),
"(B) in the case of any branch or agency of a foreign bank
with respect to any provision of the Federal Reserve Act which
is made applicable under the International Banking Act of 1978,
"(C) in the case of any foreign bank which does not operate
an insured branch,
"(D) in the case of any agency or commercial lending company
other than a Federal agency, and
"(E) in the case of supervisory or regulatory proceedings
arising from the authority given to the Board of Governors
under section 7(c)(1) of the International Banking Act of 1978,
including such proceedings under the Financial Institutions
Supervisory Act,
"(3) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation in the case of a
State nonmember insured Bank (except a District bank) or a
foreign bank having an insured branch; and
"(4) the Federal Home Loan Bank Board in the case of an insured
Federal savings bank.
Under the rule set forth in this subsection, more than one agency
may be an appropriate Federal banking agency with respect to any
given institution. For the purposes of subsections (b) through (n)
of section 1818 of this title, the term 'insured bank' shall be
deemed to include any uninsured branch or agency of a foreign bank
or any commercial lending company owned or controlled by a foreign
bank."
Subsec. (t). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(5), amended subsec. (t)
generally, substituting provisions relating to definition and
construction of "includes" and "including" for provisions defining
"insured Federal savings bank".
Subsecs. (u) to (x). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 204(f)(6), added
subsecs. (u) to (x).
1987 - Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 101(g)(1), amended
subsec. (g) generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (g) read as
follows: "The term 'savings bank' means a bank (other than a mutual
savings bank) which transacts its ordinary banking business
strictly as a savings bank under State laws imposing special
requirements on such banks governing the manner of investing their
funds and of conducting their business: Provided, That the bank
maintains, until maturity date or until withdrawn, all deposits
made with it (other than funds held by it in a fiduciary capacity)
as time savings deposits of the specific term type or of the type
where the right is reserved to the bank to require written notice
before permitting withdrawal: Provided further, That such bank to
be considered a savings bank must elect to become subject to
regulations of the Corporation with respect to the redeposit of
maturing deposits and prohibiting withdrawal of deposits by
checking except in cases where such withdrawal was permitted by law
on August 23, 1935, from specifically designated deposit accounts
totaling not more than 15 per centum of the bank's total deposits."
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 503(b), amended subsec. (i)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (i) read as follows: "The
term 'new bank' means a new national banking association organized
by the Corporation to assume the insured deposits of an insured
bank closed on account of inability to meet the demands of its
depositors and otherwise to perform temporarily the functions
prescribed in this chapter."
1982 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 703(a), inserted
"industrial bank or similar financial institution which the Board
of Directors finds to be operating substantially in the same manner
as an industrial bank," before "or other banking institution".
Subsec. (l)(1). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 703(b), inserted "thrift
certificate, investment certificate, certificate of indebtedness,
or other similar name," before "or a check or draft drawn against a
deposit account".
Subsec. (q)(4). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(a), added par. (4).
Subsec. (t). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(b), added subsec. (t).
1981 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 103(a)(1), inserted "the
Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "American Samoa,"
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (l)(5). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 102, reenacted without
change the provisions preceding subpar. (A), redesignated remaining
existing provisions as subpar. (A), inserted reference to banks
located outside of the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands in
subpar. (A) as thus redesignated, and added subpar. (B).
Subsec. (m)(1). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 103(a)(2), inserted "of the
Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "American Samoa,".
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 103(a)(3), inserted "the Trust
Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "American Samoa," wherever
appearing.
1980 - Subsec. (m)(1). Pub. L. 96-221 substituted "$100,000" for
"$40,000".
1978 - Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(2), inserted
"(including a foreign bank having an insured branch)" after "The
term 'insured bank' means any bank".
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(3), inserted "or of a
branch of a foreign bank" after "affairs of a bank".
Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(4), designated existing
provisions as par. (1), inserted "Subject to the provisions of
paragraph (2) of this subsection", and added par. (2).
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 95-630 inserted "domestic" before "branch"
the first time it appeared, and inserted a definition of "foreign
branch" at end.
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(5), inserted reference to
a Federal branch or agency of a foreign bank in par. (1),
designated existing provisions of par. (2) as par. (2)(A) and added
subpars. (B) to (E), inserted reference to a foreign bank having an
insured branch in par. (3), and inserted closing provisions
relating to the number of agencies which may be an appropriate
Federal banking agency, and defining "insured bank" for purposes of
section 1818(b) to (n) of this title.
Subsecs. (r), (s). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(6), added subsecs.
(r) and (s).
1974 - Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 93-495 inserted "(other than a
depositor referred to in the third sentence of this subsection)"
after "net amount due to any depositor", and substituted "$40,000"
for "$20,000".
1970 - Pub. L. 91-609 inserted reference to American Samoa in
subsecs. (a), (d), (e), (l)(5), (m), and (o), respectively.
1969 - Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 91-151 substituted $20,000 for
$15,000 in first sentence.
1966 - Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 89-695, Secs. 301(a), 303(a),
substituted "$15,000" for "$10,000" in first sentence and inserted
sentence which, for purpose of clarifying and defining the
insurance coverage under subsec. (m) of this section and section
1817(i) of this title, authorized the Corporation to define terms
used in those provisions, subsec. (p) of this section, and section
1821(a) and (i) of this title and the extent of insurance coverage
resulting therefrom, respectively.
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 201, added subsec. (q).
1960 - Subsec. (l). Pub. L. 86-671 amended subsec. (l) generally,
and among other changes, inserted in par. (1) "or held", "either
conditionally or unconditionally", "or a check or draft drawn
against a deposit account and certified by the bank, or a letter of
credit or a traveler's check on which the bank is primarily
liable", and inserted the proviso, added pars. (3) and (4),
inserted provisions in par. (5) requiring the Board of Directors to
consult with the Comptroller of the Currency and the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System, and struck out provisions
which permitted mainland banks to exclude from deposit insurance
the deposits of any of its branches in the Virgin Islands.
1956 - Subsec. (a). Act Aug. 1, 1956, Sec. 3(a), inserted "Guam,"
after "Puerto Rico," and substituted a comma for the period and
inserted "and the word 'State' means any State of the United
States, the District of Columbia, any Territory of the United
States, Puerto Rico, Guam, or the Virgin Islands".
Subsecs. (d), (e). Act Aug. 1, 1956, Sec. 3(b), inserted "Guam,"
after "Puerto Rico,".
Subsec. (l). Act Aug. 1, 1956, Sec. 3(c), inserted "Guam," after
"Puerto Rico," in first proviso.
Subsec. (m). Act Aug. 1, 1956, Sec. 3(d), inserted "of Guam,"
after "of Puerto Rico,".
Subsec. (o). Act Aug. 1, 1956, Sec. 3(b), inserted "Guam," after
"Puerto Rico,".
1952 - Subsec. (l). Act July 14, 1952, made it compulsory for
banks having branches in Puerto Rico to insure their deposits.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 312(c) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 5412(a) of this title.
Amendment by section 334(b) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 1 day
after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided, see section 4 of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note under section
5301 of this title.
Amendment by section 363(1) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 4(b), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3606,
provided that: "This section [amending this section] and the
amendments made by this section shall take effect on the date that
the final regulations required under section 2109(a)(1) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Act of 2005 [Pub. L. 109-171, set
out as a Regulations note under section 1817 of this title] take
effect [Jan. 1, 2007, see 71 F.R. 69323]."
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(b), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3616,
provided that: "This section [amending this section and sections
1815 to 1818, 1821 to 1825, 1827, 1828, 1831a, 1831e, 1831m, 1831n,
and 1831o of this title and repealing section 1831h of this title]
and the amendments made by this section shall take effect on the
day of the merger of the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings
Association Insurance Fund [Mar. 31, 2006, see 71 F.R. 20524]
pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Act of 2005
[subtitle B (Secs. 2101-2109) of title II of Pub. L. 109-171, see
Short Title of 2006 Amendment note set out under section 1811 of
this title]."
Amendment by section 2102(b) of Pub. L. 109-171 effective no
later than the first day of the first calendar quarter that begins
after the end of the 90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see
section 2102(c) of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and
SAIF note under section 1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2004 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 108-386 effective Oct. 30, 2004, and, except
as otherwise provided, applicable with respect to fiscal year 2005
and each succeeding fiscal year, see sections 8(i) and 9 of Pub. L.
108-386, set out as notes under section 321 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Section 2614(b) of div. A of Pub. L. 104-208 provided that: "The
amendments made by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall
apply to any liability of an insured depository that arises under
an annuity contract issued on or after the date of enactment of
this Act [Sept. 30, 1996]."
Amendment by section 2704(d)(6)(A), (14)(A) of Pub. L. 104-208
effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no insured depository institution is a
savings association on that date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L.
104-208, formerly set out as a note under section 1821 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective as if included in the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, Pub.
L. 102-242, as of Dec. 19, 1991, except that where amendment is to
any provision of law added or amended by Pub. L. 102-242 effective
after Dec. 19, 1992, then amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective on
effective date of amendment by Pub. L. 102-242, see section 1609 of
Pub. L. 102-550, set out as a note under section 191 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 131(c)(3) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective 1
year after Dec. 19, 1991, see section 131(f) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1464 of this title.
Amendment by section 311(b)(5)(A) of Pub. L. 102-242 not
applicable to any time deposit which was made before Dec. 19, 1991,
and matures after end of 2-year period beginning Dec. 19, 1991,
with rollovers and renewals treated as new deposits, see section
311(c)(2) of Pub. L. 102-242, set out as a note under section 1821
of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1980 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 96-221 effective Mar. 31, 1980, see section
308(e) of Pub. L. 96-221, set out as a note under section 1817 of
this title.

APPLICABILITY OF 1980 AMENDMENT
Section 308(a)(2) of Pub. L. 96-221 provided that: "The
amendments made by this subsection [amending this section and
sections 1817 and 1821 of this title] are not applicable to any
claim arising out of the closing of a bank prior to the effective
date of this section [see section 308(e) of Pub. L. 96-221, set out
as a note under section 1817 of this title]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 95-630 effective on expiration of 120 days
after Nov. 10, 1978, see section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as
an Effective Date note under section 375b of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1974 AMENDMENT
Section 101(g) of Pub. L. 93-495 provided that: "This section and
the amendments made by it [amending this section and sections 1464,
1724, 1728, 1757, 1787, 1817, and 1821 of this title] shall take
effect on the thirtieth day beginning after the date of enactment
of this Act [Oct. 28, 1974]."
Section 102(b), (c) of Pub. L. 93-495 provided that:
"(b) The amendments made by this section [amending this section
and sections 1817 and 1821 of this title] are not applicable to any
claim arising out of the closing of a bank prior to the effective
date of this section.
"(c) The amendments made by this section shall take effect on the
thirtieth day beginning after the date of enactment of this Act
[Oct. 28, 1974]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1969 AMENDMENT
Section 7(b) of Pub. L. 91-151 provided that: "The amendments
made by this section [amending this section and sections 1817 and
1821 of this title] are not applicable to any claim arising out of
the closing of a bank prior to the date of enactment of this Act
[Dec. 23, 1969]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Section 301(e) of Pub. L. 89-695 provided that: "The amendments
made by this section [amending this section and sections 1817 and
1821 of this title] shall not be applicable to any claim arising
out of the closing of a bank where such closing is prior to the
date of enactment of this Act [Oct. 16, 1966]."

EXPIRATION OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 908, Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811,
repealed section 401 of Pub. L. 89-695 which had provided that:
"The provisions of titles I and II of this Act [amending this
section and sections 1464, 1730, 1817 to 1820 of this title,
repealing section 77 of this title, and enacting provisions set out
as notes under this section and sections 1464 and 1730 of this
title] and any provisions of law enacted by said titles shall be
effective only during the period ending at the close of June 30,
1972. Effective upon the expiration of such period, each provision
of law amended by either of such titles is further amended to read
as it did immediately prior to the enactment of this Act [Oct. 16,
1966] and each provision of law repealed by either of such titles
is reenacted".

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1960 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 86-671 effective Jan. 1, 1961, see section 7
of Pub. L. 86-671, set out as a note under section 1817 of this
title.


-TRANS-
TERMINATION OF TRUST TERRITORY OF THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
For termination of Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, see
note set out preceding section 1681 of Title 48, Territories and
Insular Possessions.


-MISC2-
CONDITIONS GOVERNING EMPLOYMENT OF PERSONNEL NOT REPEALED,
MODIFIED, OR AFFECTED
Section 206 of title II of Pub. L. 89-695 provided that: "Nothing
contained in this title [amending this section and sections 1817 to
1820 of this title and repealing section 77 of this title] shall be
construed to repeal, modify, or affect the provisions of section 19
of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1829)."

-FOOTNOTE-
(!1) See References in Text note below.


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1814 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1814. Insured depository institutions

-STATUTE-
(a) Continuation of insurance
(1) Banks
Each bank, which is an insured depository institution on
September 21, 1950, shall be and continue to be, without
application or approval, an insured depository institution and
shall be subject to the provisions of this chapter.
(2) Savings associations
Each savings association the accounts of which were insured by
the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation on the day
before August 9, 1989, shall be, without application or approval,
an insured depository institution.
(b) Continuation of insurance upon becoming a member bank
In the case of an insured bank which is admitted to membership in
the Federal Reserve System or an insured State bank which is
converted into a national member bank, the bank shall continue as
an insured bank.
(c) Continuation of insurance after conversion
Subject to section 1815(d) of this title and section 1464(i)(5)
of this title -
(1) any State depository institution which results from the
conversion of any insured Federal depository institution; and
(2) any Federal depository institution which results from the
conversion of any insured State or Federal depository
institution,

shall continue as an insured depository institution.
(d) Continuation of insurance after merger or consolidation
Any State depository institution or any Federal depository
institution which results from the merger or consolidation of
insured depository institutions, or from the merger or
consolidation of a noninsured depository institution with an
insured depository institution, shall continue as an insured
depository institution.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[4], 64 Stat. 875; Pub. L. 97-320,
title I, Sec. 113(c), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1473; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Secs. 201(a), 205, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 194; Pub.
L. 102-242, title I, Sec. 115(b), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2249;
Pub. L. 102-550, title XVI, Sec. 1603(b)(6), Oct. 28, 1992, 106
Stat. 4079; Pub. L. 109-351, title VI, Sec. 608(b), Oct. 13, 2006,
120 Stat. 1983.)


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (e) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2006 - Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 608(b)(1), inserted
"and section 1464(i)(5) of this title" after "section 1815(d) of
this title" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (c)(2). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 608(b)(2), which directed
insertion of "or Federal" after "insured State,", was executed by
making the insertion after "insured State", to reflect the probable
intent of Congress.
1992 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 102-550 amended directory language of
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 115(b). See 1991 Amendment note below.
1991 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 115(b), as amended by
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(6), amended subsec. (b) generally,
substituting present provisions for provisions which related to
certification by other banking agencies.
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to
insured depository institutions for references to insured banks
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 205(1), inserted heading,
designated existing provisions as par. (1), inserted par. (1)
heading, and substituted "Each bank" for "Every bank", and added
par. (2).
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 205(2)(A), (B), inserted after
first sentence "Any application or notice for membership or to
commence or resume business shall be promptly provided by the
appropriate Federal banking agency to the Corporation and the
Corporation shall have a reasonable period of time to provide
comments on such application or notice. Any comments submitted by
the Corporation to the appropriate Federal banking agency shall be
considered by such agency." and struck out at end "A State bank,
resulting from the conversion of an insured national bank, shall
continue as an insured bank. A State bank, resulting from the
merger or consolidation of insured banks, or from the merger or
consolidation of a noninsured bank or institution with an insured
State bank, shall continue as an insured bank."
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 205(2)(C), which directed the amendment of
subsec. (b) by substituting "(b) Certification by Other Banking
Agencies. - Every national bank" for "(b) Every national bank"
could not be executed literally because the original read "(b)
Every national member bank", but was executed by inserting the
heading without changing the text to reflect the probable intent of
Congress.
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 205(3), amended subsec. (c)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (c) read as follows: "Every
Federal savings bank which is chartered pursuant to section 1464(o)
of this title, and which is engaged in the business of receiving
deposits other than trust funds, shall be an insured bank from the
time it is authorized to commence business, until such time as its
accounts are insured by the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance
Corporation."
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 205(3), added subsec. (d).
1982 - Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 97-320 added subsec. (c).

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 102-558 deemed to have become effective Mar.
1, 1992, see section 304 of Pub. L. 102-558, set out as a note
under section 2062 of Title 50, Appendix, War and National Defense.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1815 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1815. Deposit insurance

-STATUTE-
(a) Application to Corporation required
(1) In general
Except as provided in paragraphs (2) and (3), any depository
institution which is engaged in the business of receiving
deposits other than trust funds (as defined in section 1813(p) of
this title), upon application to and examination by the
Corporation and approval by the Board of Directors, may become an
insured depository institution.
(2) Interim depository institutions
In the case of any interim Federal depository institution that
is chartered by the appropriate Federal banking agency and will
not open for business, the depository institution shall be an
insured depository institution upon the issuance of the
institution's charter by the agency.
(3) Application and approval not required in cases of continued
insurance
Paragraph (1) shall not apply in the case of any depository
institution whose insured status is continued pursuant to section
1814 of this title.
(4) Review requirements
In reviewing any application under this subsection, the Board
of Directors shall consider the factors described in section 1816
of this title in determining whether to approve the application
for insurance.
(5) Notice of denial of application for insurance
If the Board of Directors votes to deny any application for
insurance by any depository institution, the Board of Directors
shall promptly notify the appropriate Federal banking agency and,
in the case of any State depository institution, the appropriate
State banking supervisor of the denial of such application,
giving specific reasons in writing for the Board of Directors'
determination with reference to the factors described in section
1816 of this title.
(6) Nondelegation requirement
The authority of the Board of Directors to make any
determination to deny any application under this subsection may
not be delegated by the Board of Directors.
(b) Foreign branch nonmember banks; matters considered
Subject to the provisions of this chapter and to such terms and
conditions as the Board of Directors may impose, any branch of a
foreign bank, upon application by the bank to the Corporation, and
examination by the Corporation of the branch, and approval by the
Board of Directors, may become an insured branch. Before approving
any such application, the Board of Directors shall give
consideration to -
(1) the financial history and condition of the bank,
(2) the adequacy of its capital structure,
(3) its future earnings prospects,
(4) the general character and fitness of its management,
including but not limited to the management of the branch
proposed to be insured,
(5) the risk presented to the Deposit Insurance Fund,
(6) the convenience and needs of the community to be served by
the branch,
(7) whether or not its corporate powers, insofar as they will
be exercised through the proposed insured branch, are consistent
with the purposes of this chapter, and
(8) the probable adequacy and reliability of information
supplied and to be supplied by the bank to the Corporation to
enable it to carry out its functions under this chapter.
(c) Protection to Deposit Insurance Fund; surety bond, pledge of
assets, etc.; injunction
(1) Before any branch of a foreign bank becomes an insured
branch, the bank shall deliver to the Corporation or as the
Corporation may direct a surety bond, a pledge of assets, or both,
in such amounts and of such types as the Corporation may require or
approve, for the purpose set forth in paragraph (4) of this
subsection.
(2) After any branch of a foreign bank becomes an insured branch,
the bank shall maintain on deposit with the Corporation, or as the
Corporation may direct, surety bonds or assets or both, in such
amounts and of such types as shall be determined from time to time
in accordance with such regulations as the Board of Directors may
prescribe. Such regulations may impose differing requirements on
the basis of any factors which in the judgment of the Board of
Directors are reasonably related to the purpose set forth in
paragraph (4).
(3) The Corporation may require of any given bank larger deposits
of bonds and assets than required under paragraph (2) of this
subsection if, in the judgment of the Corporation, the situation of
that bank or any branch thereof is or becomes such that the
deposits of bonds and assets otherwise required under this section
would not adequately fulfill the purpose set forth in paragraph
(4). The imposition of any such additional requirements may be
without notice or opportunity for hearing, but the Corporation
shall afford an opportunity to any such bank to apply for a
reduction or removal of any such additional requirements so
imposed.
(4) The purpose of the surety bonds and pledges of assets
required under this subsection is to provide protection to the
Deposit Insurance Fund against the risks entailed in insuring the
domestic deposits of a foreign bank whose activities, assets, and
personnel are in large part outside the jurisdiction of the United
States. In the implementation of its authority under this
subsection, however, the Corporation shall endeavor to avoid
imposing requirements on such banks which would unnecessarily place
them at a competitive disadvantage in relation to domestically
incorporated banks.
(5) In the case of any failure or threatened failure of a foreign
bank to comply with any requirement imposed under this subsection
(c), the Corporation, in addition to all other administrative and
judicial remedies, may apply to any United States district court,
or United States court of any territory, within the jurisdiction of
which any branch of the bank is located, for an injunction to
compel such bank and any officer, employee, or agent thereof, or
any other person having custody or control of any of its assets, to
deliver to the Corporation such assets as may be necessary to meet
such requirement, and to take any other action necessary to vest
the Corporation with control of assets so delivered. If the court
shall determine that there has been any such failure or threatened
failure to comply with any such requirement, it shall be the duty
of the court to issue such injunction. The propriety of the
requirement may be litigated only as provided in chapter 7 of title
5, and may not be made an issue in an action for an injunction
under this paragraph.
(d) Insurance fees
(1) In general
Any institution that becomes insured by the Corporation, and
any noninsured branch that becomes insured by the Corporation,
shall pay the Corporation any fee which the Corporation may by
regulation prescribe, after giving due consideration to the
need to establish and maintain the reserve ratio of the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
(2) Fee credited to the Deposit Insurance Fund
The fee paid by the depository institution under paragraph (1)
shall be credited to the Deposit Insurance Fund.
(3) Exception for certain depository institutions
Any depository institution that becomes an insured depository
institution by operation of section 1814(a) of this title shall
not pay any fee.
(e) Liability of commonly controlled depository institutions
(1) In general
(A) Liability established
Any insured depository institution shall be liable for any
loss incurred by the Corporation, or any loss which the
Corporation reasonably anticipates incurring, after August 9,
1989, in connection with -
(i) the default of a commonly controlled insured depository
institution; or
(ii) any assistance provided by the Corporation to any
commonly controlled insured depository institution in danger
of default.
(B) Payment upon notice
An insured depository institution shall pay the amount of any
liability to the Corporation under subparagraph (A) upon
receipt of written notice by the Corporation in accordance with
this subsection.
(C) Notice required to be provided within 2 years of loss
No insured depository institution shall be liable to the
Corporation under subparagraph (A) if written notice with
respect to such liability is not received by such institution
before the end of the 2-year period beginning on the date the
Corporation incurred the loss.
(2) Amount of compensation; procedures
(A) Use of estimates
When an insured depository institution is in default or
requires assistance to prevent default, the Corporation shall -

(i) in good faith, estimate the amount of the loss the
Corporation will incur from such default or assistance;
(ii) if, with respect to such insured depository
institution, there is more than 1 commonly controlled insured
depository institution, estimate the amount of each such
commonly controlled depository institution's share of such
liability; and
(iii) advise each commonly controlled depository
institution of the Corporation's estimate of the amount of
such institution's liability for such losses.
(B) Procedures; immediate payment
The Corporation, after consultation with the appropriate
Federal banking agency and the appropriate State chartering
agency, shall -
(i) on a case-by-case basis, establish the procedures and
schedule under which any insured depository institution shall
reimburse the Corporation for such institution's liability
under paragraph (1) in connection with any commonly
controlled insured depository institution; or
(ii) require any insured depository institution to make
immediate payment of the amount of such institution's
liability under paragraph (1) in connection with any commonly
controlled insured depository institution.
(C) Priority
The liability of any insured depository institution under
this subsection shall have priority with respect to other
obligations and liabilities as follows:
(i) Superiority
The liability shall be superior to the following
obligations and liabilities of the depository institution:
(I) Any obligation to shareholders arising as a result of
their status as shareholders (including any depository
institution holding company or any shareholder or creditor
of such company).
(II) Any obligation or liability owed to any affiliate of
the depository institution (including any other insured
depository institution), other than any secured obligation
which was secured as of May 1, 1989.
(ii) Subordination
The liability shall be subordinate in right and payment to
the following obligations and liabilities of the depository
institution:
(I) Any deposit liability (which is not a liability
described in clause (i)(II)).
(II) Any secured obligation, other than any obligation
owed to any affiliate of the depository institution
(including any other insured depository institution) which
was secured after May 1, 1989.
(III) Any other general or senior liability (which is not
a liability described in clause (i)).
(IV) Any obligation subordinated to depositors or other
general creditors (which is not an obligation described in
clause (i)).
(D) Adjustment of estimated payment
(i) Overpayment
If the amount of compensation estimated by and paid to the
Corporation by 1 or more such commonly controlled depository
institutions is greater than the actual loss incurred by the
Corporation, the Corporation shall reimburse each such
commonly controlled depository institution its pro rata share
of any overpayment.
(ii) Underpayment
If the amount of compensation estimated by and paid to the
Corporation by 1 or more such commonly controlled depository
institutions is less than the actual loss incurred by the
Corporation, the Corporation shall redetermine in its
discretion the liability of each such commonly controlled
depository institution to the Corporation and shall require
each such commonly controlled depository institution to make
payment of any additional liability to the Corporation.
(3) Review
(A) Judicial
Actions of the Corporation shall be reviewable pursuant to
chapter 7 of title 5.
(B) Administrative
The Corporation shall prescribe regulations and establish
administrative procedures which provide for a hearing on the
record for the review of -
(i) the amount of any loss incurred by the Corporation in
connection with any insured depository institution;
(ii) the liability of individual commonly controlled
depository institutions for the amount of such loss; and
(iii) the schedule of payments to be made by such commonly
controlled depository institutions.
(4) Limitation on rights of private parties
To the extent the exercise of any right or power of any person
would impair the ability of any insured depository institution to
perform such institution's obligations under this subsection -
(A) the obligations of such insured depository institution
shall supersede such right or power; and
(B) no court may give effect to such right or power with
respect to such insured depository institution.
(5) Waiver authority
(A) In general
The Corporation, in its discretion, may exempt any insured
depository institution from the provisions of this subsection
if the Corporation determines that such exemption is in the
best interests of the Deposit Insurance Fund.
(B) Condition
During the period any exemption granted to any insured
depository institution under subparagraph (A) or (C) is in
effect, such insured depository institution and all other
insured depository institution affiliates of such depository
institution shall comply fully with the restrictions of
sections 371c and 371c-1 of this title without regard to
section 371c(d)(1) of this title.
(C) Limited partnerships
(i) In general
The Corporation may, in its discretion, exempt any limited
partnership and any affiliate of any limited partnership
(other than any insured depository institution which is a
majority owned subsidiary of such partnership) from the
provisions of this subsection if such limited partnership or
affiliate has filed a registration statement with the
Securities and Exchange Commission on or before April 10,
1989, indicating that as of the date of such filing such
partnership intended to acquire 1 or more insured depository
institutions.
(ii) Review and notice
Within 10 business days after the date of submission of any
request for an exemption under this subparagraph together
with such information as shall be reasonably requested by the
Corporation, the Corporation shall make a determination on
the request and shall so advise the applicant.
(6) Exclusion for institutions acquired in debt collections
Any depository institution shall not be treated as commonly
controlled, for purposes of this subsection, during the 5-year
period beginning on the date of an acquisition described in
subparagraph (A) or such longer period as the Corporation may
determine after written application by the acquirer, if -
(A) 1 depository institution controls another by virtue of
ownership of voting shares acquired in securing or collecting a
debt previously contracted in good faith; and
(B) during the period beginning on August 9, 1989, and ending
upon the expiration of the exclusion, the controlling bank and
all other insured depository institution affiliates of such
controlling bank comply fully with the restrictions of sections
371c and 371c-1 of this title, without regard to section
371c(d)(1) of this title, in transactions with the acquired
insured depository institution.
(7) Exception for certain FSLIC assisted institutions
No depository institution shall have any liability to the
Corporation under this subsection as the result of the default
of, or assistance provided with respect to, an insured depository
institution which is an affiliate of such depository institution
if -
(A) such affiliate was receiving cash payments from the
Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation under an
assistance agreement or note entered into before August 9,
1989;
(B) the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation, or
such other entity which has succeeded to the payment
obligations of such Corporation with respect to such assistance
agreement or note, is unable to continue such payments; and
(C) such affiliate -
(i) is in default or in need of assistance solely as a
result of the failure to meet the payment obligations
referred to in subparagraph (B); and
(ii) is not otherwise in breach of the terms of any
assistance agreement or note which would authorize the
Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation or such other
successor entity, pursuant to the terms of such assistance
agreement or note, to refuse to make such payments.
(8) Commonly controlled defined
For purposes of this subsection, depository institutions are
commonly controlled if -
(A) such institutions are controlled by the same company; or
(B) 1 depository institution is controlled by another
depository institution.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[5], 64 Stat. 876; Pub. L. 95-369,
Sec. 6(c)(7), Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 616; Pub. L. 97-320, title
VII, Sec. 703(c), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1539; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Secs. 201(a), 206(a), Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 195;
Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Sec. 115(a), title III, Sec. 302(e)(1),
(2), title V, Sec. 501(a), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2249, 2349,
2388; Pub. L. 102-550, title XVI, Secs. 1605(a)(5)(B), 1607(a),
Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4085, 4089; Pub. L. 102-558, title III,
Secs. 303(b)(6)(B), 305, Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4225, 4226; Pub.
L. 103-204, Sec. 9, Dec. 17, 1993, 107 Stat. 2388; Pub. L. 103-325,
title III, Sec. 319(b), title VI, Sec. 602(a)(2), (3), Sept. 23,
1994, 108 Stat. 2225, 2288; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II,
Secs. 2201(a), 2702(i), 2704(d)(14)(B)-(E), Sept. 30, 1996, 110
Stat. 3009-403, 3009-483, 3009-491; Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec.
2102(b), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9; Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(2)-
(6), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3610, 3611; Pub. L. 109-351, title
VII, Sec. 703, Oct. 13, 2006, 120 Stat. 1986.)


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (f)(2) of former section 264 of
this title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of
this title.

AMENDMENTS
2006 - Subsec. (b)(5). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(2), substituted
"the Deposit Insurance Fund," for "the Bank Insurance Fund or the
Savings Association Insurance Fund,".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(B).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (c)(4). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(3), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund".
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(C), (D). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (d)(1). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(5) substituted, "the
reserve ratio of the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "reserve ratios in
the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund
as required by section 1817 of this title" in subpar. (A), struck
out par. (1) designation and heading, redesignated subpar. (A) as
par. (1) and realigned margin, and struck out subpar. (B), the text
of which read as follows: "The fee paid by the depository
institution shall be credited to the Bank Insurance Fund if the
depository institution becomes a Bank Insurance Fund member, and to
the Savings Association Insurance Fund if the depository
institution becomes a Savings Association Insurance Fund member."
Former subpar. (C) redesignated par. (3).
Subsec. (d)(2). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(4), (5)(B), added par.
(2) and struck out former par. (2) which related to conversion
transactions by insured depository institutions.
Subsec. (d)(3). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(4), (5)(D),
redesignated par. (1)(C) of subsec. (d) as (3), realigned margin,
and struck out former par. (3) which related to optional
conversions by insured depository institutions subject to special
rules on deposit insurance payments.
Subsec. (e)(5)(A). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(6)(A), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank Insurance Fund or the Savings
Association Insurance Fund".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(E)(i).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (e)(6) to (9). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(6)(B), (C),
redesignated pars. (7) to (9) as (6) to (8), respectively, and
struck out heading and text of former par. (6). Text read as
follows: "During the 5-year period beginning on August 9, 1989 -
"(A) no Savings Association Insurance Fund member shall have
any liability to the Corporation under this subsection arising
out of assistance provided by the Corporation or any loss
incurred by the Corporation as a result of the default of a Bank
Insurance Fund member which was acquired by such Savings
Association Insurance Fund member or any affiliate of such member
before August 9, 1989; and
"(B) no Bank Insurance Fund member shall have such liability
with respect to assistance provided by or loss incurred by the
Corporation as a result of the default of a Savings Association
Insurance Fund member which was acquired by such Bank Insurance
Fund member or any affiliate of such member before August 9,
1989."
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(E)(ii), (iii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (e)(8)(A). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 703, which directed
general amendment of par. (9)(A) of subsec. (e), was executed by
making the amendment to par. (8)(A) to reflect the probable intent
of Congress and amendment by 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(6)(B), (C). Prior
to amendment, subpar. (A) read as follows: "such institutions are
controlled by the same depository institution holding company
(including any company required to file reports pursuant to section
1843(f)(6) of this title); or".
1996 - Subsec. (b)(5). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(B),
which directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund," for "the
Bank Insurance Fund or the Savings Association Insurance Fund;",
was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(C) and (D), which
directed the amendment of subsec. (d) by striking out par. (1)
designation and heading, redesignating subpar. (A) of par. (1) as
par. (1), realigning margin, and substituting "the reserve ratio of
the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "reserve ratios in the Bank
Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund",
striking out subpar. (B) of par. (1) and pars. (2) and (3) and
adding new par. (2), and redesignating subpar. (C) of par. (1) as
par. (3) and realigning margin, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171.
See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment
note above.
Subsec. (d)(3)(A). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2201(a)(1), substituted
"if the transaction is approved by" for "with the prior written
approval of".
Subsec. (d)(3)(C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2702(i)(1), substituted
"Except as provided in subparagraph (K), the adjusted attributable
deposit amount" for "The adjusted attributable deposit amount" in
introductory provisions.
Subsec. (d)(3)(E). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2201(a)(2), added cl.
(iii), redesignated former cls. (ii) and (iii) as (i) and (ii),
respectively, and struck out former cls. (i) and (iv), which
directed review of any application under the procedures and factors
set forth in section 1828(c) of this title and disapproval of any
application unless depository institution met all applicable
capital requirements, respectively.
Subsec. (d)(3)(G) to (J). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2201(a)(3), (4),
redesignated subpars. (H) to (J) as (G) to (I), respectively and
struck out former subpar. (G) which related to expedited approval
of acquisitions.
Subsec. (d)(3)(K). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2702(i)(2), added
subpar. (K).
Subsec. (e)(5)(A). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(E)(i), which
directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank
Insurance Fund or the Savings Association Insurance Fund", was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (e)(6) to (9). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(E)(ii),
(iii), which directed striking out par. (6) and redesignating pars.
(7) to (9) as (6) to (8), respectively, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-
171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
1994 - Subsec. (b)(5). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(2),
substituted comma for semicolon at end.
Subsec. (d)(3)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(1), redesignated
cl. (i) formerly entitled "In general" as subpar. (A), inserted
comma after "Notwithstanding paragraph (2)(A)", and struck out
heading and text of cl. (ii). Text read as follows: "If, in
connection with any transaction referred to in clause (i), the
acquiring, assuming, or resulting depository institution is a Bank
Insurance Fund member which is a subsidiary of a bank holding
company, the prior written approval of the Board shall be required
for such transaction in addition to the approval of any agency
referred to in clause (i)."
Subsec. (d)(3)(E)(i). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(2)(A), struck
out "(and, in the event the acquiring, assuming, or resulting
depository institution is a Bank Insurance Fund member which is a
subsidiary of a bank holding company, the Board)" after
"responsible agency".
Subsec. (d)(3)(E)(ii). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(2)(B), struck
out "or Board" after "responsible agency".
Subsec. (d)(3)(E)(iv). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(2)(C), struck
out ", and the appropriate Federal banking agency for any
depository institution holding company," after "responsible
agency", "each" before "such agency determines", and ", and any
depository institution holding company which controls such
institution," after "resulting depository institution".
Subsec. (d)(3)(F). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(3), substituted
"A Bank" for "The Board may not approve any transaction under
subparagraph (A) in which the acquiring, assuming, or resulting
depository institution is a Bank" and "may not be the acquiring,
assuming, or resulting depository institution in a transaction
under subparagraph (A) unless" for "unless the Board determines
that".
Subsec. (d)(3)(K). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 319(b)(4), struck out
heading and text of subpar. (K). Text read as follows: "For
purposes of this paragraph, the term 'Board' (other than when such
term appears in connection with a reference to the Board of
Directors) means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System."
Subsec. (e)(4). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(3), redesignated
cls. (i) and (ii) as subpars. (A) and (B), respectively, and
realigned margins.
1993 - Subsec. (d)(2)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 9(a),
substituted "before the later of the end" for "before the end" and
inserted before period at end "or the date on which the Savings
Association Insurance Fund first meets or exceeds the designated
reserve ratio for such fund".
Subsec. (d)(2)(B)(v). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 9(b), added cl. (v).
Subsec. (d)(2)(C)(ii), (iii), (3)(I)(i). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec.
9(c), substituted "moratorium period established by" for "5-year
period referred to in".
1992 - Subsec. (d)(3)(B). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(B),
amended directory language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e). See
1991 amendment note below. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(5)(B),
which contained an identical amendment, was repealed, effective
Oct. 28, 1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note below.
Subsec. (d)(3)(K). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1607(a), added subpar.
(K).
1991 - Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 115(a), amended section catchline.
Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 115(a), added subsec. (a)
consisting of pars. (1) to (6) and struck out former subsec. (a)
relating to application for insurance, which consisted of pars. (1)
to (7).
Subsec. (d)(3). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 501(a), amended par. (3)
generally, substituting present provisions consisting of subpars.
(A) to (J) for provisions related to optional conversion through
merger, which consisted of subpars. (A) to (G).
Subsec. (d)(3)(B)(i). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e)(1), as amended
by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(B), substituted "deposits" for
"average assessment base" and "shall be treated as deposits which
are insured by the Savings Association Insurance Fund." for "shall -

"(I) be subject to assessment at the assessment rate applicable
under section 1817 of this title for Savings Association
Insurance Fund members;
"(II) not be taken into account for purposes of any assessment
under section 1817 of this title for Bank Insurance Fund members;
and
"(III) be treated as deposits which are insured by the Savings
Association Insurance Fund."
Subsec. (d)(3)(B)(ii). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e)(2), as added
by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(B), substituted "deposits" for
"average assessment base" and "shall be treated as deposits which
are insured by the Bank Insurance Fund." for "shall -
"(I) be subject to assessment at the assessment rate applicable
under section 1817 of this title for Bank Insurance Fund members;
"(II) not be taken into account for purposes of any assessment
under section 1817 of this title for Savings Association
Insurance Fund members; and
"(III) be treated as deposits which are insured by the Bank
Insurance Fund."
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to
insured depository institutions for references to insured banks
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 206(a)(1)-(4), inserted
heading, designated existing provisions as par. (1), inserted par.
(1) heading, and substituted "Any" for "Subject to the provisions
of this chapter, any", inserted "and State savings association"
after "any State nonmember bank" and after "such State nonmember
bank", "or savings association" after "such bank", and "or savings
association, and in the case of an application by a State savings
association, the Corporation shall notify the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision of the Corporation's approval of such
application" after "books of the bank", and added pars. (2) to (7).
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 206(a)(5), inserted "and
fitness" after "character".
Subsec. (b)(5) to (8). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 206(a)(6), added par.
(5) and redesignated former pars. (5) to (7) as (6) to (8),
respectively.
Subsecs. (d), (e). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 206(a)(7), added subsecs.
(d) and (e).
1982 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 97-320 inserted provision relating to
the determination before the application of an industrial bank or
similar institution is approved that it is chartered and operating
under provisions substantially comparable to those applicable to
banks operating in the same State.
1978 - Pub. L. 95-369 designated existing provision as subsec.
(a) and added subsecs. (b) and (c).

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar. 31, 2006, see section
8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under section 1813 of
this title.
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-171 effective no later than the first
day of the first calendar quarter that begins after the end of the
90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see section 2102(c) of Pub.
L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and SAIF note under section
1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 2704(d)(14)(B)-(E) of Pub. L. 104-208
effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no insured depository institution is a
savings association on that date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L.
104-208, formerly set out as a note under section 1821 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Amendment by section 303(b)(6)(B) of Pub. L. 102-558 deemed to
have become effective Mar. 1, 1992, see section 304 of Pub. L. 102-
558, set out as a note under section 2062 of Title 50, Appendix,
War and National Defense.
Amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective as if included in the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, Pub.
L. 102-242, as of Dec. 19, 1991, except that where amendment is to
any provision of law added or amended by Pub. L. 102-242 effective
after Dec. 19, 1992, then amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective on
effective date of amendment by Pub. L. 102-242, see section 1609 of
Pub. L. 102-550, set out as a note under section 191 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 302(e)(1), (2) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective
on earlier of 180 days after date on which final regulations
promulgated in accordance with section 302(c) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title, become
effective or Jan. 1, 1994, see section 302(g) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title.
Section 501(b) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "The amendment
made by subsection (a) to section 5(d)(3)(C) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1815(d)(3)(C)] shall apply with respect to
semiannual periods beginning after the date of the enactment of
this Act [Dec. 19, 1991]."

REPEAL OF DUPLICATIVE PROVISIONS
Section 305 of Pub. L. 102-558 provided that: "In the event of
the enactment of H.R. 5334 (An Act to amend and extend certain laws
relating to housing and community development, and for other
purposes) [enacted as Pub. L. 102-550], the following provisions of
that Act, and the amendments made by such provisions, are repealed,
effective on the date of enactment of this Act [Oct. 28, 1992]:
"(1) Section 1603(a)(3) of such Act [amending section 1817 of
this title and enacting provisions set out as a note under
section 1817 of this title].
"(2) Section 1604(a)(11) of such Act [amending section 3104 of
this title].
"(3) Paragraphs (1), (2), and (3) of section 1604(b) of such
Act [amending sections 1817, 1834, and 1834a of this title].
"(3) [sic] Paragraphs (2) through (7) of section 1605(a) of
such Act [amending sections 1815, 1817, 1818, 1820, 1834, and
1834a of this title and enacting provisions set out as notes
under sections 1817, 1834, and 1834a of this title]."

MORATORIUM ON TREATMENT OF CREDIT CARD BANKS, INDUSTRIAL LOAN
COMPANIES, AND CERTAIN OTHER COMPANIES UNDER THE BANK HOLDING
COMPANY ACT OF 1956.
Pub. L. 111-203, title VI, Sec. 603(a), July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1597, provided that:
"(1) Definitions. - In this subsection -
"(A) the term 'credit card bank' means an institution described
in section 2(c)(2)(F) of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (12
U.S.C. 1841(c)(2)(F));
"(B) the term 'industrial bank' means an institution described
in section 2(c)(2)(H) of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (12
U.S.C. 1841(c)(2)(H)); and
"(C) the term 'trust bank' means an institution described in
section 2(c)(2)(D) of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (12
U.S.C. 1841(c)(2)(D)).
"(2) Moratorium on provision of deposit insurance. - The
Corporation may not approve an application for deposit insurance
under section 5 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C.
1815) that is received after November 23, 2009, for an industrial
bank, a credit card bank, or a trust bank that is directly or
indirectly owned or controlled by a commercial firm.
"(3) Change in control. -
"(A) In general. - Except as provided in subparagraph (B), the
appropriate Federal banking agency shall disapprove a change in
control, as provided in section 7(j) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1817(j)), of an industrial bank, a
credit card bank, or a trust bank if the change in control would
result in direct or indirect control of the industrial bank,
credit card bank, or trust bank by a commercial firm.
"(B) Exceptions. - Subparagraph (A) shall not apply to a change
in control of an industrial bank, credit card bank, or trust bank
-
"(i) that -
"(I) is in danger of default, as determined by the
appropriate Federal banking agency;
"(II) results from the merger or whole acquisition of a
commercial firm that directly or indirectly controls the
industrial bank, credit card bank, or trust bank in a bona
fide merger with or acquisition by another commercial firm,
as determined by the appropriate Federal banking agency; or
"(III) results from an acquisition of voting shares of a
publicly traded company that controls an industrial bank,
credit card bank, or trust bank, if, after the acquisition,
the acquiring shareholder (or group of shareholders acting in
concert) holds less than 25 percent of any class of the
voting shares of the company; and
"(ii) that has obtained all regulatory approvals otherwise
required for such change of control under any applicable
Federal or State law, including section 7(j) of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1817(j)).
"(4) Sunset. - This subsection shall cease to have effect 3 years
after the date of enactment of this Act [July 21, 2010]."
[For definitions of terms used in section 603(a) of Pub. L. 111-
203, set out above, see section 5301 of this title.]

DEPOSIT OF FUNDS INTO DEPOSIT INSURANCE FUND
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(4), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3610,
provided in part that: "any funds resulting from the application of
such paragraph (2) [of subsec. (d) of this section] prior to its
repeal [see 2006 Amendment note above] shall be deposited into the
general fund of the Deposit Insurance Fund".

NEWLY INSURED THRIFT PROVISION
Section 206(b) of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that: "Any insured
depository institution (as defined in section 3(c)(2) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1813(c)(2)], as added by
section 204(c) of this Act) -
"(1) which was an insured institution (as defined in section
401(a) of the National Housing Act [12 U.S.C. 1724(a)], as in
effect before the date of the enactment of this Act [Aug. 9,
1989]) on the day before the date of the enactment of this Act;
"(2) the board of directors of which determined, before April
1, 1987, to terminate such association's status as an insured
institution (as so defined) as evidenced in sworn minutes of the
board of directors meeting held before such date;
"(3) had insured deposits of less than $11,000,000 on April 1,
1987; and
"(4) was an insured institution (as so defined) for less than 1
year as of April 1, 1987,
may cease to be a Savings Association Insurance Fund member and
become a Bank Insurance Fund member at any time during the 2-year
period beginning on the date of the enactment of this Act without
the approval of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation under
section 5(d)(2) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1815(d)(2)] (as added by subsection (a) of this section) and
without incurring any liability for any exit or entrance fee
imposed under such section 5(d)(2)."

-CROSS-
DEFINITION OF "COMMERCIAL FIRM"
Pub. L. 111-203, title VI, Sec. 602, July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1596, provided that: "For purposes of this title [see Short Title
note set out under section 1811 of this title], a company is a
'commercial firm' if the annual gross revenues derived by the
company and all of its affiliates from activities that are
financial in nature (as defined in section 4(k) of the Bank Holding
Company Act of 1956 (12 U.S.C. 1843(k))) and, if applicable, from
the ownership or control of one or more insured depository
institutions, represent less than 15 percent of the consolidated
annual gross revenues of the company."
[For definitions of terms used in section 602 of Pub. L. 111-203,
set out above, see section 5301 of this title.]

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1816 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1816. Factors to be considered

-STATUTE-
The factors that are required, under section 1814 of this title,
to be considered in connection with, and enumerated in, any
certificate issued pursuant to section 1814 of this title and that
are required, under section 1815 of this title, to be considered by
the Board of Directors in connection with any determination by such
Board pursuant to section 1815 of this title are the following:
(1) The financial history and condition of the depository
institution.
(2) The adequacy of the depository institution's capital
structure.
(3) The future earnings prospects of the depository
institution.
(4) The general character and fitness of the management of the
depository institution.
(5) The risk presented by such depository institution to the
Deposit Insurance Fund.
(6) The convenience and needs of the community to be served by
such depository institution.
(7) Whether the depository institution's corporate powers are
consistent with the purposes of this chapter.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[6], 64 Stat. 876; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Sec. 207, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 206; Pub. L. 104-208,
div. A, title II, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(F), Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat.
3009-491; Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2102(b), Feb. 8, 2006,
120 Stat. 9; Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(7), Feb. 15, 2006, 119
Stat. 3611.)


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (g) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2006 - Par. (5). Pub. L. 109-173 substituted "Deposit Insurance
Fund" for "Bank Insurance Fund or the Savings Association Insurance
Fund".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(F).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
1996 - Par. (5). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(F), which
directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank
Insurance Fund or the Savings Association Insurance Fund", was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73 amended section generally. Prior to
amendment, section read as follows: "The factors to be enumerated
in the certificate required under section 1814 of this title and to
be considered by the Board of Directors under section 1815 of this
title shall be the following: The financial history and condition
of the bank, the adequacy of its capital structure, its future
earnings prospects, the general character of its management, the
convenience and needs of the community to be served by the bank,
and whether or not its corporate powers are consistent with the
purposes of this chapter."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar. 31, 2006, see section
8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under section 1813 of
this title.
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-171 effective no later than the first
day of the first calendar quarter that begins after the end of the
90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see section 2102(c) of Pub.
L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and SAIF note under section
1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 104-208 effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no
insured depository institution is a savings association on that
date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L. 104-208, formerly set out as a
note under section 1821 of this title.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1817 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1817. Assessments

-STATUTE-
(a) Reports of condition; access to reports
(1) Each insured State nonmember bank and each foreign bank
having an insured branch which is not a Federal branch shall make
to the Corporation reports of condition which shall be in such form
and shall contain such information as the Board of Directors may
require. Such reports shall be made to the Corporation on the dates
selected as provided in paragraph (3) of this subsection and the
deposit liabilities shall be reported therein in accordance with
and pursuant to paragraphs (4) and (5) of this subsection. The
Board of Directors may call for additional reports of condition on
dates to be fixed by it and may call for such other reports as the
Board may from time to time require. Any such bank which (A)
maintains procedures reasonably adapted to avoid any inadvertent
error and, unintentionally and as a result of such an error, fails
to make or publish any report required under this paragraph, within
the period of time specified by the Corporation, or submits or
publishes any false or misleading report or information, or (B)
inadvertently transmits or publishes any report which is minimally
late, shall be subject to a penalty of not more than $2,000 for
each day during which such failure continues or such false or
misleading information is not corrected. Such bank shall have the
burden of proving that an error was inadvertent and that a report
was inadvertently transmitted or published late. Any such bank
which fails to make or publish any report required under this
paragraph, within the period of time specified by the Corporation,
or submits or publishes any false or misleading report or
information, in a manner not described in the 2nd preceding
sentence shall be subject to a penalty of not more than $20,000 for
each day during which such failure continues or such false or
misleading information is not corrected. Notwithstanding the
preceding sentence, if any such bank knowingly or with reckless
disregard for the accuracy of any information or report described
in such sentence submits or publishes any false or misleading
report or information, the Corporation may assess a penalty of not
more than $1,000,000 or 1 percent of total assets of such bank,
whichever is less, per day for each day during which such failure
continues or such false or misleading information is not corrected.
Any penalty imposed under any of the 4 preceding sentences shall be
assessed and collected by the Corporation in the manner provided in
subparagraphs (E), (F), (G), and (I) of section 1818(i)(2) of this
title (for penalties imposed under such section) and any such
assessment (including the determination of the amount of the
penalty) shall be subject to the provisions of such section. Any
such bank against which any penalty is assessed under this
subsection shall be afforded an agency hearing if such bank submits
a request for such hearing within 20 days after the issuance of the
notice of assessment. Section 1818(h) of this title shall apply to
any proceeding under this paragraph.
(2)(A) The Corporation and, with respect to any State depository
institution, any appropriate State bank supervisor for such
institution, shall have access to reports of examination made by,
and reports of condition made to, the Comptroller of the Currency,
the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, the Federal
Housing Finance Board, any Federal home loan bank, or any Federal
Reserve bank and to all revisions of reports of condition made to
any of them, and they shall promptly advise the Corporation of any
revisions or changes in respect to deposit liabilities made or
required to be made in any report of condition. The Corporation may
accept any report made by or to any commission, board, or authority
having supervision of a depository institution, and may furnish to
the Comptroller of the Currency, the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision, the Federal Housing Finance Board, any Federal
home loan bank, to any Federal Reserve bank, and to any such
commission, board, or authority, reports of examinations made on
behalf of, and reports of condition made to, the Corporation.
(B) Additional reports. - The Board of Directors may from time to
time require any insured depository institution to file such
additional reports as the Corporation, after consultation with the
Comptroller of the Currency, the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System, and the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, as appropriate, may deem advisable for insurance
purposes.
(C) Data sharing with other agencies and persons. - In addition
to reports of examination, reports of condition, and other reports
required to be regularly provided to the Corporation (with respect
to all insured depository institutions, including a depository
institution for which the Corporation has been appointed
conservator or receiver) or an appropriate State bank supervisor
(with respect to a State depository institution) under subparagraph
(A) or (B), a Federal banking agency may, in the discretion of the
agency, furnish any report of examination or other confidential
supervisory information concerning any depository institution or
other entity examined by such agency under authority of any Federal
law, to -
(i) any other Federal or State agency or authority with
supervisory or regulatory authority over the depository
institution or other entity;
(ii) any officer, director, or receiver of such depository
institution or entity; and
(iii) any other person that the Federal banking agency
determines to be appropriate.

(3) Each insured depository institution shall make to the
appropriate Federal banking agency 4 reports of condition annually
upon dates which shall be selected by the Chairman of the Board of
Directors, the Comptroller of the Currency, and the Chairman of the
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, and the Director
of the Office of Thrift Supervision. The dates selected shall be
the same for all insured depository institutions, except that when
any of said reporting dates is a nonbusiness day for any depository
institution, the preceding business day shall be its reporting
date. Such reports of condition shall be the basis for the
certified statements to be filed pursuant to subsection (c). The
deposit liabilities shall be reported in said reports of conditions
in accordance with and pursuant to paragraphs (4) and (5) of this
subsection, and such other information shall be reported therein as
may be required by the respective agencies. Each said report of
condition shall contain a declaration by the president, a vice
president, the cashier or the treasurer, or by any other officer
designated by the board of directors or trustees of the reporting
depository institution to make such declaration, that the report is
true and correct to the best of his knowledge and belief. The
correctness of said report of condition shall be attested by the
signatures of at least two directors or trustees of the reporting
depository institution other than the officer making such
declaration, with a declaration that the report has been examined
by them and to the best of their knowledge and belief is true and
correct. At the time of making said reports of condition each
insured depository institution shall furnish to the Corporation a
copy thereof containing such signed declaration and attestations.
Nothing herein shall preclude any of the foregoing agencies from
requiring the banks or savings associations under its jurisdiction
to make additional reports of condition at any time.
(4) In the reports of condition required to be made by paragraph
(3) of this subsection, each insured depository institution shall
report the total amount of the liability of the depository
institution for deposits in the main office and in any branch
located in any State of the United States, the District of
Columbia, any Territory of the United States, Puerto Rico, Guam,
American Samoa, the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, or the
Virgin Islands, according to the definition of the term "deposit"
in and pursuant to subsection (l) of section 1813 of this title
without any deduction for indebtedness of depositors or creditors
or any deduction for cash items in the process of collection drawn
on others than the reporting depository institution: Provided, That
the depository institution in reporting such deposits may (i)
subtract from the deposit balance due to any depository institution
the deposit balance due from the same depository institution (other
than trust funds deposited by either depository institution) and
any cash items in the process of collection due from or due to such
depository institutions shall be included in determining such net
balance, except that balances of time deposits of any depository
institution and any balances standing to the credit of private
depository institutions, of depository institutions in foreign
countries, of foreign branches of other American depository
institutions, and of American branches of foreign banks shall be
reported gross without any such subtraction, and (ii) exclude any
deposits received in any office of the depository institution for
deposit in any other office of the depository institution: And
provided further, That outstanding drafts (including advices and
authorizations to charge depository institution's balance in
another depository institution) drawn in the regular course of
business by the reporting depository institution on depository
institutions need not be reported as deposit liabilities. The
amount of trust funds held in the depository institution's own
trust department, which the reporting depository institution keeps
segregated and apart from its general assets and does not use in
the conduct of its business, shall not be included in the total
deposits in such reports, but shall be separately stated in such
reports. Deposits which are accumulated for the payment of personal
loans and are assigned or pledged to assure payment of loans at
maturity shall not be included in the total deposits in such
reports, but shall be deducted from the loans for which such
deposits are assigned or pledged to assure repayment.
(5) The deposits to be reported on such reports of condition
shall be segregated between (i) time and savings deposits and (ii)
demand deposits. For this purpose, the time and savings deposits
shall consist of time certificates of deposit, time deposits-open
account, and savings deposits; and demand deposits shall consist of
all deposits other than time and savings deposits.
(6) Lifeline account deposits. - In the reports of condition
required to be reported under this subsection, the deposits in
lifeline accounts (as defined in section 1834(a)(3)(C) of this
title) shall be reported separately.
(7) The Board of Directors, after consultation with the
Comptroller of the Currency, the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System, may by regulation define the terms "cash items" and
"process of collection", and shall classify deposits as "time",
"savings", and "demand" deposits, for the purposes of this section.
(8) In respect of any report required or authorized to be
supplied or published pursuant to this subsection or any other
provision of law, the Board of Directors or the Comptroller of the
Currency, as the case may be, may differentiate between domestic
banks and foreign banks to such extent as, in their judgment, may
be reasonably required to avoid hardship and can be done without
substantial compromise of insurance risk or supervisory and
regulatory effectiveness.
(9) Data collections. - In addition to or in connection with any
other report required under this subsection, the Corporation shall
take such action as may be necessary to ensure that -
(A) each insured depository institution maintains; and
(B) the Corporation receives on a regular basis from such
institution,

information on the total amount of all insured deposits, preferred
deposits, and uninsured deposits at the institution. In prescribing
reporting and other requirements for the collection of actual and
accurate information pursuant to this paragraph, the Corporation
shall minimize the regulatory burden imposed upon insured
depository institutions that are well capitalized (as defined in
section 1831o of this title) while taking into account the benefit
of the information to the Corporation, including the use of the
information to enable the Corporation to more accurately determine
the total amount of insured deposits in each insured depository
institution for purposes of compliance with this chapter.
(10) A Federal banking agency may not, by regulation or
otherwise, designate, or require an insured institution or an
affiliate to designate, a corporation as highly leveraged or a
transaction with a corporation as a highly leveraged transaction
solely because such corporation is or has been a debtor or bankrupt
under title 11, if, after confirmation of a plan of reorganization,
such corporation would not otherwise be highly leveraged.
(11) Streamlining reports of condition. -
(A) Review of information and schedules. - Before the end of
the 1-year period beginning on October 13, 2006, and before the
end of each 5-year period thereafter, each Federal banking agency
shall, in conjunction with the other relevant Federal banking
agencies, review the information and schedules that are required
to be filed by an insured depository institution in a report of
condition required under paragraph (3).
(B) Reduction or elimination of information found to be
unnecessary. - After completing the review required by
subparagraph (A), a Federal banking agency, in conjunction with
the other relevant Federal banking agencies, shall reduce or
eliminate any requirement to file information or schedules under
paragraph (3) (other than information or schedules that are
otherwise required by law) if the agency determines that the
continued collection of such information or schedules is no
longer necessary or appropriate.
(b) Assessments
(1) Risk-based assessment system
(A) Risk-based assessment system required
The Board of Directors shall, by regulation, establish a risk-
based assessment system for insured depository institutions.
(B) Private reinsurance authorized
In carrying out this paragraph, the Corporation may -
(i) obtain private reinsurance covering not more than 10
percent of any loss the Corporation incurs with respect to an
insured depository institution; and
(ii) base that institution's assessment (in whole or in
part) on the cost of the reinsurance.
(C) "Risk-based assessment system" defined
For purposes of this paragraph, the term "risk-based
assessment system" means a system for calculating a depository
institution's assessment based on -
(i) the probability that the Deposit Insurance Fund will
incur a loss with respect to the institution, taking into
consideration the risks attributable to -
(I) different categories and concentrations of assets;
(II) different categories and concentrations of
liabilities, both insured and uninsured, contingent and
noncontingent; and
(III) any other factors the Corporation determines are
relevant to assessing such probability;

(ii) the likely amount of any such loss; and
(iii) the revenue needs of the Deposit Insurance Fund.
(D) Separate assessment systems
The Board of Directors may establish separate risk-based
assessment systems for large and small members of the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
(E) Information concerning risk of loss and economic conditions
(i) Sources of information
For purposes of determining risk of losses at insured
depository institutions and economic conditions generally
affecting depository institutions, the Corporation shall
collect information, as appropriate, from all sources the
Board of Directors considers appropriate, including reports
of condition, inspection reports, and other information from
all Federal banking agencies, any information available from
State bank supervisors, State insurance and securities
regulators, the Securities and Exchange Commission (including
information described in section 1831l of this title), the
Secretary of the Treasury, the Commodity Futures Trading
Commission, the Farm Credit Administration, the Federal Trade
Commission, any Federal reserve bank or Federal home loan
bank, and other regulators of financial institutions, and any
information available from credit rating entities, and other
private economic or business analysts.
(ii) Consultation with Federal banking agencies
(I) In general
Except as provided in subclause (II), in assessing the
risk of loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund with respect to
any insured depository institution, the Corporation shall
consult with the appropriate Federal banking agency of such
institution.
(II) Treatment on aggregate basis
In the case of insured depository institutions that are
well capitalized (as defined in section 1831o of this
title) and, in the most recent examination, were found to
be well managed, the consultation under subclause (I)
concerning the assessment of the risk of loss posed by such
institutions may be made on an aggregate basis.
(iii) Rule of construction
No provision of this paragraph shall be construed as
providing any new authority for the Corporation to require
submission of information by insured depository institutions
to the Corporation, except as provided in subsection
(a)(2)(B).
(F) Modifications to the risk-based assessment system allowed
only after notice and comment
In revising or modifying the risk-based assessment system at
any time after February 8, 2006, the Board of Directors may
implement such revisions or modification in final form only
after notice and opportunity for comment.
(2) Setting assessments
(A) In general
The Board of Directors shall set assessments for insured
depository institutions in such amounts as the Board of
Directors may determine to be necessary or appropriate, subject
to subparagraph (D).(!1)

(B) Factors to be considered
In setting assessments under subparagraph (A), the Board of
Directors shall consider the following factors:
(i) The estimated operating expenses of the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
(ii) The estimated case resolution expenses and income of
the Deposit Insurance Fund.
(iii) The projected effects of the payment of assessments
on the capital and earnings of insured depository
institutions.
(iv) The risk factors and other factors taken into account
pursuant to paragraph (1) under the risk-based assessment
system, including the requirement under such paragraph to
maintain a risk-based system.
(v) Any other factors the Board of Directors may determine
to be appropriate.
(D) (!2) Notice of assessments

The Corporation shall notify each insured depository
institution of that institution's assessment.
(E) Bank Enterprise Act requirement
The Corporation shall design the risk-based assessment system
so that, insofar as the system bases assessments, directly or
indirectly, on deposits, the portion of the deposits of any
insured depository institution which are attributable to
lifeline accounts established in accordance with the Bank
Enterprise Act of 1991 shall be subject to assessment at a rate
determined in accordance with such Act.
(3) Designated reserve ratio
(A) Establishment
(i) In general
Before the beginning of each calendar year, the Board of
Directors shall designate the reserve ratio applicable with
respect to the Deposit Insurance Fund and publish the reserve
ratio so designated.
(ii) Rulemaking requirement
Any change to the designated reserve ratio shall be made by
the Board of Directors by regulation after notice and
opportunity for comment.
(B) Minimum reserve ratio
The reserve ratio designated by the Board of Directors for
any year may not be less than 1.35 percent of estimated insured
deposits, or the comparable percentage of the assessment base
set forth in paragraph (2)(C).(!2)
(C) Factors
In designating a reserve ratio for any year, the Board of
Directors shall -
(i) take into account the risk of losses to the Deposit
Insurance Fund in such year and future years, including
historic experience and potential and estimated losses from
insured depository institutions;
(ii) take into account economic conditions generally
affecting insured depository institutions so as to allow the
designated reserve ratio to increase during more favorable
economic conditions and to decrease during less favorable
economic conditions, notwithstanding the increased risks of
loss that may exist during such less favorable conditions, as
determined to be appropriate by the Board of Directors;
(iii) seek to prevent sharp swings in the assessment rates
for insured depository institutions; and
(iv) take into account such other factors as the Board of
Directors may determine to be appropriate, consistent with
the requirements of this subparagraph.
(D) Publication of proposed change in ratio
In soliciting comment on any proposed change in the
designated reserve ratio in accordance with subparagraph (A),
the Board of Directors shall include in the published proposal
a thorough analysis of the data and projections on which the
proposal is based.
(E) DIF restoration plans
(i) In general
Whenever -
(I) the Corporation projects that the reserve ratio of
the Deposit Insurance Fund will, within 6 months of such
determination, fall below the minimum amount specified in
subparagraph (B)(ii) for the designated reserve ratio; or
(II) the reserve ratio of the Deposit Insurance Fund
actually falls below the minimum amount specified in
subparagraph (B)(ii) for the designated reserve ratio
without any determination under subclause (I) having been
made,

the Corporation shall establish and implement a Deposit
Insurance Fund restoration plan within 90 days that meets the
requirements of clause (ii) and such other conditions as the
Corporation determines to be appropriate.
(ii) Requirements of restoration plan
A Deposit Insurance Fund restoration plan meets the
requirements of this clause if the plan provides that the
reserve ratio of the Fund will meet or exceed the minimum
amount specified in subparagraph (B)(ii) for the designated
reserve ratio before the end of the 8-year period beginning
upon the implementation of the plan (or such longer period as
the Corporation may determine to be necessary due to
extraordinary circumstances).
(iii) Restriction on assessment credits
As part of any restoration plan under this subparagraph,
the Corporation may elect to restrict the application of
assessment credits provided under subsection (e)(3) for any
period that the plan is in effect.
(iv) Limitation on restriction
Notwithstanding clause (iii), while any restoration plan
under this subparagraph is in effect, the Corporation shall
apply credits provided to an insured depository institution
under subsection (e)(3) against any assessment imposed on the
institution for any assessment period in an amount equal to
the lesser of -
(I) the amount of the assessment; or
(II) the amount equal to 3 basis points of the
institution's assessment base.
(v) Transparency
Not more than 30 days after the Corporation establishes and
implements a restoration plan under clause (i), the
Corporation shall publish in the Federal Register a detailed
analysis of the factors considered and the basis for the
actions taken with regard to the plan.
(4) Depository institution required to maintain assessment-
related records
Each insured depository institution shall maintain all records
that the Corporation may require for verifying the correctness of
any assessment on the insured depository institution under this
subsection until the later of -
(A) the end of the 3-year period beginning on the due date of
the assessment; or
(B) in the case of a dispute between the insured depository
institution and the Corporation with respect to such
assessment, the date of a final determination of any such
dispute.
(5) Emergency special assessments
In addition to the other assessments imposed on insured
depository institutions under this subsection, the Corporation
may impose 1 or more special assessments on insured depository
institutions in an amount determined by the Corporation if the
amount of any such assessment is necessary -
(A) to provide sufficient assessment income to repay amounts
borrowed from the Secretary of the Treasury under section
1824(a) of this title in accordance with the repayment schedule
in effect under section 1824(c) of this title during the period
with respect to which such assessment is imposed;
(B) to provide sufficient assessment income to repay
obligations issued to and other amounts borrowed from insured
depository institutions under section 1824(d) of this title; or
(C) for any other purpose that the Corporation may deem
necessary.
(6) Community enterprise credits
The Corporation shall allow a credit against any semiannual
assessment to any insured depository institution which satisfies
the requirements of the Community Enterprise Assessment Credit
Board under section 233(a)(1) of the Bank Enterprise Act of 1991
[12 U.S.C. 1834a(a)(1)] in the amount determined by such Board by
regulation.
(c) Certified statements; payments
(1) Certified statements required
(A) In general
Each insured depository institution shall file with the
Corporation a certified statement containing such information
as the Corporation may require for determining the
institution's assessment.
(B) Form of certification
The certified statement required under subparagraph (A) shall
-
(i) be in such form and set forth such supporting
information as the Board of Directors shall prescribe; and
(ii) be certified by the president of the depository
institution or any other officer designated by its board of
directors or trustees that to the best of his or her
knowledge and belief, the statement is true, correct and
complete, and in accordance with this chapter and regulations
issued hereunder.
(2) Payments required
(A) In general
Each insured depository institution shall pay to the
Corporation the assessment imposed under subsection (b) of this
section.
(B) Form of payment
The payments required under subparagraph (A) shall be made in
such manner and at such time or times as the Board of Directors
shall prescribe by regulation.
(3) Newly insured institutions
To facilitate the administration of this section, the Board of
Directors may waive the requirements of paragraphs (1) and (2)
for the initial assessment period in which a depository
institution becomes insured.
(4) Penalty for failure to make accurate certified statement
(A) First tier
Any insured depository institution which -
(i) maintains procedures reasonably adapted to avoid any
inadvertent error and, unintentionally and as a result of
such an error, fails to submit the certified statement under
paragraph (1) within the period of time required under
paragraph (1) or submits a false or misleading certified
statement; or
(ii) submits the statement at a time which is minimally
after the time required in such paragraph,

shall be subject to a penalty of not more than $2,000 for each
day during which such failure continues or such false and
misleading information is not corrected. The institution shall
have the burden of proving that an error was inadvertent or
that a statement was inadvertently submitted late.
(B) Second tier
Any insured depository institution which fails to submit the
certified statement under paragraph (1) within the period of
time required under paragraph (1) or submits a false or
misleading certified statement in a manner not described in
subparagraph (A) shall be subject to a penalty of not more than
$20,000 for each day during which such failure continues or
such false and misleading information is not corrected.
(C) Third tier
Notwithstanding subparagraphs (A) and (B), if any insured
depository institution knowingly or with reckless disregard for
the accuracy of any certified statement described in paragraph
(1) submits a false or misleading certified statement under
paragraph (1), the Corporation may assess a penalty of not more
than $1,000,000 or not more than 1 percent of the total assets
of the institution, whichever is less, per day for each day
during which the failure continues or the false or misleading
information in such statement is not corrected.
(D) Assessment procedure
Any penalty imposed under this paragraph shall be assessed
and collected by the Corporation in the manner provided in
subparagraphs (E), (F), (G), and (I) of section 1818(i)(2) of
this title (for penalties imposed under such section) and any
such assessment (including the determination of the amount of
the penalty) shall be subject to the provisions of such
section.
(E) Hearing
Any insured depository institution against which any penalty
is assessed under this paragraph shall be afforded an agency
hearing if the institution submits a request for such hearing
within 20 days after the issuance of the notice of the
assessment. Section 1818(h) of this title shall apply to any
proceeding under this subparagraph.
(d) Corporation exempt from apportionment
Notwithstanding any other provision of law, amounts received
pursuant to any assessment under this section and any other amounts
received by the Corporation shall not be subject to apportionment
for the purposes of chapter 15 of title 31 or under any other
authority.
(e) Refunds, dividends, and credits
(1) Refunds of overpayments
In the case of any payment of an assessment by an insured
depository institution in excess of the amount due to the
Corporation, the Corporation may -
(A) refund the amount of the excess payment to the insured
depository institution; or
(B) credit such excess amount toward the payment of
subsequent assessments until such credit is exhausted.
(2) Dividends from excess amounts in Deposit Insurance Fund
(A) Reserve ratio in excess of 1.5 percent of estimated insured
deposits
If, at the end of a calendar year, the reserve ratio of the
Deposit Insurance Fund exceeds 1.5 percent of estimated insured
deposits, the Corporation shall declare the amount in the Fund
in excess of the amount required to maintain the reserve ratio
at 1.5 percent of estimated insured deposits, as dividends to
be paid to insured depository institutions.
(B) Limitation
The Board of Directors may, in its sole discretion, suspend
or limit the declaration of payment of dividends under
subparagraph (A).
(C) Notice and opportunity for comment
The Corporation shall prescribe, by regulation, after notice
and opportunity for comment, the method for the declaration,
calculation, distribution, and payment of dividends under this
paragraph (!3)

(3) One-time credit based on total assessment base at year-end
1996
(A) In general
Before the end of the 270-day period beginning on February 8,
2006, the Board of Directors shall, by regulation after notice
and opportunity for comment, provide for a credit to each
eligible insured depository institution (or a successor insured
depository institution), based on the assessment base of the
institution on December 31, 1996, as compared to the combined
aggregate assessment base of all eligible insured depository
institutions, taking into account such factors as the Board of
Directors may determine to be appropriate.
(B) Credit limit
The aggregate amount of credits available under subparagraph
(A) to all eligible insured depository institutions shall equal
the amount that the Corporation could collect if the
Corporation imposed an assessment of 10.5 basis points on the
combined assessment base of the Bank Insurance Fund and the
Savings Association Insurance Fund as of December 31, 2001.
(C) Eligible insured depository institution defined
For purposes of this paragraph, the term "eligible insured
depository institution" means any insured depository
institution that -
(i) was in existence on December 31, 1996, and paid a
deposit insurance assessment prior to that date; or
(ii) is a successor to any insured depository institution
described in clause (i).
(D) Application of credits
(i) In general
Subject to clause (ii), the amount of a credit to any
eligible insured depository institution under this paragraph
shall be applied by the Corporation, subject to subsection
(b)(3)(E), to the assessments imposed on such institution
under subsection (b) that become due for assessment periods
beginning after the effective date of regulations prescribed
under subparagraph (A).
(ii) Temporary restriction on use of credits
The amount of a credit to any eligible insured depository
institution under this paragraph may not be applied to more
than 90 percent of the assessments imposed on such
institution under subsection (b) that become due for
assessment periods beginning in fiscal years 2008, 2009, and
2010.
(iii) Regulations
The regulations prescribed under subparagraph (A) shall
establish the qualifications and procedures governing the
application of assessment credits pursuant to clause (i).
(E) Limitation on amount of credit for certain depository
institutions
In the case of an insured depository institution that
exhibits financial, operational, or compliance weaknesses
ranging from moderately severe to unsatisfactory, or is not
adequately capitalized (as defined in section 1831o of this
title) at the beginning of an assessment period, the amount of
any credit allowed under this paragraph against the assessment
on that depository institution for such period may not exceed
the amount calculated by applying to that depository
institution the average assessment rate on all insured
depository institutions for such assessment period.
(F) Successor defined
The Corporation shall define the term "successor" for
purposes of this paragraph, by regulation, and may consider any
factors as the Board may deem appropriate.
(4) Administrative review
(A) In general
The regulations prescribed under paragraphs (2) and (3) shall
include provisions allowing an insured depository institution a
reasonable opportunity to challenge administratively the amount
of the credit or dividend determined under paragraph (2) or (3)
for such institution.
(B) Administrative review
Any review under subparagraph (A) of any determination of the
Corporation under paragraph (2) or (3) shall be final and not
subject to judicial review.
(f) Action against depository institutions failing to file
certified statements
Any insured depository institution which fails to make any report
of condition under subsection (a) of this section or to file any
certified statement required to be filed by it in connection with
determining the amount of any assessment payable by the depository
institution to the Corporation may be compelled to make such report
or file such statement by mandatory injunction or other appropriate
remedy in a suit brought for such purpose by the Corporation
against the depository institution and any officer or officers
thereof in any court of the United States of competent jurisdiction
in the District or Territory in which such depository institution
is located.
(g) Assessment actions
(1) In general
The Corporation, in any court of competent jurisdiction, shall
be entitled to recover from any insured depository institution
the amount of any unpaid assessment lawfully payable by such
insured depository institution.
(2) Statute of limitations
The following provisions shall apply to actions relating to
assessments, notwithstanding any other provision in Federal law,
or the law of any State:
(A) Any action by an insured depository institution to
recover from the Corporation the overpaid amount of any
assessment shall be brought within 3 years after the date the
assessment payment was due, subject to the exception in
subparagraph (E).
(B) Any action by the Corporation to recover from an insured
depository institution the underpaid amount of any assessment
shall be brought within 3 years after the date the assessment
payment was due, subject to the exceptions in subparagraphs (C)
and (E).
(C) If an insured depository institution has made a false or
fraudulent statement with intent to evade any or all of its
assessment, the Corporation shall have until 3 years after the
date of discovery of the false or fraudulent statement in which
to bring an action to recover the underpaid amount.
(D) Except as provided in subparagraph (C), assessment
deposit information contained in records no longer required to
be maintained pursuant to subsection (b)(4) shall be considered
conclusive and not subject to change.
(E) Any action for the underpaid or overpaid amount of any
assessment that became due before January 1, 2007, shall be
subject to the statute of limitations for assessments in effect
at the time the assessment became due.
(h) Forfeiture of rights for failure to comply with law
Should any national member bank or any insured national nonmember
bank fail to make any report of condition under subsection (a) of
this section or to file any certified statement required to be
filed by such bank under any provision of this section, or fail to
pay any assessment required to be paid by such bank under any
provision of this chapter, and should the bank not correct such
failure within thirty days after written notice has been given by
the Corporation to an officer of the bank, citing this subsection,
and stating that the bank has failed to make any report of
condition under subsection (a) of this section or to file or pay as
required by law, all the rights, privileges, and franchises of the
bank granted to it under the National Bank Act, as amended [12
U.S.C. 21 et seq.], the Federal Reserve Act, as amended [12 U.S.C.
221 et seq.], or this chapter, shall be thereby forfeited. Whether
or not the penalty provided in this subsection has been incurred
shall be determined and adjudged in the manner provided in the
sixth paragraph of section 2 of the Federal Reserve Act, as amended
[12 U.S.C. 501a]. The remedies provided in this subsection and in
subsections (f) and (g) of this section shall not be construed as
limiting any other remedies against any insured depository
institution, but shall be in addition thereto.
(i) Insurance of trust funds
(1) In general
Trust funds held on deposit by an insured depository
institution in a fiduciary capacity as trustee pursuant to any
irrevocable trust established pursuant to any statute or written
trust agreement shall be insured in an amount not to exceed the
standard maximum deposit insurance amount (as determined under
section 1821(a)(1) of this title) for each trust estate.
(2) Interbank deposits
Trust funds described in paragraph (1) which are deposited by
the fiduciary depository institution in another insured
depository institution shall be similarly insured to the
fiduciary depository institution according to the trust estates
represented.
(3) Bank deposit financial assistance program
Notwithstanding paragraph (1), funds deposited by an insured
depository institution pursuant to the Bank Deposit Financial
Assistance Program of the Department of Energy shall be
separately insured in an amount not to exceed the standard
maximum deposit insurance amount (as determined under section
1821(a)(1) of this title) for each insured depository institution
depositing such funds.
(4) Regulations
The Board of Directors may prescribe such regulations as may be
necessary to clarify the insurance coverage under this subsection
and to prescribe the manner of reporting and depositing such
trust funds.
(j) Change in control of insured depository institutions
(1) No person, acting directly or indirectly or through or in
concert with one or more other persons, shall acquire control of
any insured depository institution through a purchase, assignment,
transfer, pledge, or other disposition of voting stock of such
insured depository institution unless the appropriate Federal
banking agency has been given sixty days' prior written notice of
such proposed acquisition and within that time period the agency
has not issued a notice disapproving the proposed acquisition or,
in the discretion of the agency, extending for an additional 30
days the period during which such a disapproval may issue. The
period for disapproval under the preceding sentence may be extended
not to exceed 2 additional times for not more than 45 days each
time if -
(A) the agency determines that any acquiring party has not
furnished all the information required under paragraph (6);
(B) in the agency's judgment, any material information
submitted is substantially inaccurate;
(C) the agency has been unable to complete the investigation of
an acquiring party under paragraph (2)(B) because of any delay
caused by, or the inadequate cooperation of, such acquiring
party; or
(D) the agency determines that additional time is needed -
(i) to investigate and determine that no acquiring party has
a record of failing to comply with the requirements of
subchapter II of chapter 53 of title 31; or
(ii) to analyze the safety and soundness of any plans or
proposals described in paragraph (6)(E) or the future prospects
of the institution.

An acquisition may be made prior to expiration of the disapproval
period if the agency issues written notice of its intent not to
disapprove the action.
(2)(A) Notice to State Agency. - Upon receiving any notice under
this subsection, the appropriate Federal banking agency shall
forward a copy thereof to the appropriate State depository
institution supervisory agency if the depository institution the
voting shares of which are sought to be acquired is a State
depository institution, and shall allow thirty days within which
the views and recommendations of such State depository institution
supervisory agency may be submitted. The appropriate Federal
banking agency shall give due consideration to the views and
recommendations of such State agency in determining whether to
disapprove any proposed acquisition. Notwithstanding the provisions
of this paragraph, if the appropriate Federal banking agency
determines that it must act immediately upon any notice of a
proposed acquisition in order to prevent the probable default of
the depository institution involved in the proposed acquisition,
such Federal banking agency may dispense with the requirements of
this paragraph or, if a copy of the notice is forwarded to the
State depository institution supervisory agency, such Federal
banking agency may request that the views and recommendations of
such State depository institution supervisory agency be submitted
immediately in any form or by any means acceptable to such Federal
banking agency.
(B) Investigation of Principals Required. - Upon receiving any
notice under this subsection, the appropriate Federal banking
agency shall -
(i) conduct an investigation of the competence, experience,
integrity, and financial ability of each person named in a notice
of a proposed acquisition as a person by whom or for whom such
acquisition is to be made; and
(ii) make an independent determination of the accuracy and
completeness of any information described in paragraph (6) with
respect to such person.

(C) Report. - The appropriate Federal banking agency shall
prepare a written report of any investigation under subparagraph
(B) which shall contain, at a minimum, a summary of the results of
such investigation. The agency shall retain such written report as
a record of the agency.
(D) Public Comment. - Upon receiving notice of a proposed
acquisition, the appropriate Federal banking agency shall, unless
such agency determines that an emergency exists, within a
reasonable period of time -
(i) publish the name of the insured depository institution
proposed to be acquired and the name of each person identified in
such notice as a person by whom or for whom such acquisition is
to be made; and
(ii) solicit public comment on such proposed acquisition,
particularly from persons in the geographic area where the bank
(!4) proposed to be acquired is located, before final
consideration of such notice by the agency,


unless the agency determines in writing that such disclosure or
solicitation would seriously threaten the safety or soundness of
such bank.(!4)
(3) Within three days after its decision to disapprove any
proposed acquisition, the appropriate Federal banking agency shall
notify the acquiring party in writing of the disapproval. Such
notice shall provide a statement of the basis for the disapproval.
(4) Within ten days of receipt of such notice of disapproval, the
acquiring party may request an agency hearing on the proposed
acquisition. In such hearing all issues shall be determined on the
record pursuant to section 554 of title 5. The length of the
hearing shall be determined by the appropriate Federal banking
agency. At the conclusion thereof, the appropriate Federal banking
agency shall by order approve or disapprove the proposed
acquisition on the basis of the record made at such hearing.
(5) Any person whose proposed acquisition is disapproved after
agency hearings under this subsection may obtain review by the
United States court of appeals for the circuit in which the home
office of the bank (!4) to be acquired is located, or the United
States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit, by
filing a notice of appeal in such court within ten days from the
date of such order, and simultaneously sending a copy of such
notice by registered or certified mail to the appropriate Federal
banking agency. The appropriate Federal banking agency shall
promptly certify and file in such court the record upon which the
disapproval was based. The findings of the appropriate Federal
banking agency shall be set aside if found to be arbitrary or
capricious or if found to violate procedures established by this
subsection.
(6) Except as otherwise provided by regulation of the appropriate
Federal banking agency, a notice filed pursuant to this subsection
shall contain the following information:
(A) The identity, personal history, business background and
experience of each person by whom or on whose behalf the
acquisition is to be made, including his material business
activities and affiliations during the past five years, and a
description of any material pending legal or administrative
proceedings in which he is a party and any criminal indictment or
conviction of such person by a State or Federal court.
(B) A statement of the assets and liabilities of each person by
whom or on whose behalf the acquisition is to be made, as of the
end of the fiscal year for each of the five fiscal years
immediately preceding the date of the notice, together with
related statements of income and source and application of funds
for each of the fiscal years then concluded, all prepared in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles
consistently applied, and an interim statement of the assets and
liabilities for each such person, together with related
statements of income and source and application of funds, as of a
date not more than ninety days prior to the date of the filing of
the notice.
(C) The terms and conditions of the proposed acquisition and
the manner in which the acquisition is to be made.
(D) The identity, source and amount of the funds or other
consideration used or to be used in making the acquisition, and
if any part of these funds or other consideration has been or is
to be borrowed or otherwise obtained for the purpose of making
the acquisition, a description of the transaction, the names of
the parties, and any arrangements, agreements, or understandings
with such persons.
(E) Any plans or proposals which any acquiring party making the
acquisition may have to liquidate the bank,(!4) to sell its
assets or merge it with any company or to make any other major
change in its business or corporate structure or management.
(F) The identification of any person employed, retained, or to
be compensated by the acquiring party, or by any person on his
behalf, to make solicitations or recommendations to stockholders
for the purpose of assisting in the acquisition, and a brief
description of the terms of such employment, retainer, or
arrangement for compensation.
(G) Copies of all invitations or tenders or advertisements
making a tender offer to stockholders for purchase of their stock
to be used in connection with the proposed acquisition.
(H) Any additional relevant information in such form as the
appropriate Federal banking agency may require by regulation or
by specific request in connection with any particular notice.

(7) The appropriate Federal banking agency may disapprove any
proposed acquisition if -
(A) the proposed acquisition of control would result in a
monopoly or would be in furtherance of any combination or
conspiracy to monopolize or to attempt to monopolize the business
of banking in any part of the United States;
(B) the effect of the proposed acquisition of control in any
section of the country may be substantially to lessen competition
or to tend to create a monopoly or the proposed acquisition of
control would in any other manner be in restraint of trade, and
the anticompetitive effects of the proposed acquisition of
control are not clearly outweighed in the public interest by the
probable effect of the transaction in meeting the convenience and
needs of the community to be served;
(C) either the financial condition of any acquiring person or
the future prospects of the institution is such as might
jeopardize the financial stability of the bank (!4) or prejudice
the interests of the depositors of the bank; (!4)
(D) the competence, experience, or integrity of any acquiring
person or of any of the proposed management personnel indicates
that it would not be in the interest of the depositors of the
bank, or in the interest of the public to permit such person to
control the bank; (!4)
(E) any acquiring person neglects, fails, or refuses to furnish
the appropriate Federal banking agency all the information
required by the appropriate Federal banking agency; or
(F) the appropriate Federal banking agency determines that the
proposed transaction would result in an adverse effect on the
Deposit Insurance Fund.

(8) For the purposes of this subsection, the term -
(A) "person" means an individual or a corporation, partnership,
trust, association, joint venture, pool, syndicate, sole
proprietorship, unincorporated organization, or any other form of
entity not specifically listed herein; and
(B) "control" means the power, directly or indirectly, to
direct the management or policies of an insured depository
institution or to vote 25 per centum or more of any class of
voting securities of an insured depository institution.

(9) Reporting of stock loans. -
(A) Report required. - Any foreign bank, or any affiliate
thereof, that has credit outstanding to any person or group of
persons which is secured, directly or indirectly, by shares of an
insured depository institution shall file a consolidated report
with the appropriate Federal banking agency for such insured
depository institution if the extensions of credit by the foreign
bank or any affiliate thereof, in the aggregate, are secured,
directly or indirectly, by 25 percent or more of any class of
shares of the same insured depository institution.
(B) Definitions. - For purposes of this paragraph, the
following definitions shall apply:
(i) Foreign bank. - The terms "foreign bank" and "affiliate"
have the same meanings as in section 3101 of this title.
(ii) Credit outstanding. - The term "credit outstanding"
includes -
(I) any loan or extension of credit,
(II) the issuance of a guarantee, acceptance, or letter of
credit, including an endorsement or standby letter of credit,
and
(III) any other type of transaction that extends credit or
financing to the person or group of persons.

(iii) Group of persons. - The term "group of persons"
includes any number of persons that the foreign bank or any
affiliate thereof reasonably believes -
(I) are acting together, in concert, or with one another to
acquire or control shares of the same insured depository
institution, including an acquisition of shares of the same
insured depository institution at approximately the same time
under substantially the same terms; or
(II) have made, or propose to make, a joint filing under
section 78m of title 15 regarding ownership of the shares of
the same insured depository institution.

(C) Inclusion of shares held by the financial institution. -
Any shares of the insured depository institution held by the
foreign bank or any affiliate thereof as principal shall be
included in the calculation of the number of shares in which the
foreign bank or any affiliate thereof has a security interest for
purposes of subparagraph (A).
(D) Report requirements. -
(i) Timing of report. - The report required under this
paragraph shall be a consolidated report on behalf of the
foreign bank and all affiliates thereof, and shall be filed in
writing within 30 days of the date on which the foreign bank or
affiliate thereof first believes that the security for any
outstanding credit consists of 25 percent or more of any class
of shares of an insured depository institution.
(ii) Content of report. - The report under this paragraph
shall indicate the number and percentage of shares securing
each applicable extension of credit, the identity of the
borrower, and the number of shares held as principal by the
foreign bank and any affiliate thereof.
(iii) Copy to other agencies. - A copy of any report under
this paragraph shall be filed with the appropriate Federal
banking agency for the foreign bank or any affiliate thereof
(if other than the agency receiving the report under this
paragraph).
(iv) Other information. - Each appropriate Federal banking
agency may require any additional information necessary to
carry out the agency's supervisory responsibilities.

(E) Exceptions. -
(i) Exception where information provided by borrower. -
Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), a foreign bank or any
affiliate thereof shall not be required to report a transaction
under this paragraph if the person or group of persons referred
to in such subparagraph has disclosed the amount borrowed from
such foreign bank or any affiliate thereof and the security
interest of the foreign bank or any affiliate thereof to the
appropriate Federal banking agency for the insured depository
institution in connection with a notice filed under this
subsection, an application filed under the Bank Holding Company
Act of 1956 [12 U.S.C. 1841 et seq.], section 1467a of this
title, or any other application filed with the appropriate
Federal banking agency for the insured depository institution
as a substitute for a notice under this subsection, such as an
application for deposit insurance, membership in the Federal
Reserve System, or a national bank charter.
(ii) Exception for shares owned for more than 1 year. -
Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), a foreign bank and any
affiliate thereof shall not be required to report a transaction
involving -
(I) a person or group of persons that has been the owner or
owners of record of the stock for a period of 1 year or more;
or
(II) stock issued by a newly chartered bank before the
bank's opening.

(10) The reports required by paragraph (9) of this subsection
shall contain such of the information referred to in paragraph (6)
of this subsection, and such other relevant information, as the
appropriate Federal banking agency may require by regulation or by
specific request in connection with any particular report.
(11) The Federal banking agency receiving a notice or report
filed pursuant to paragraph (1) or (9) shall immediately furnish to
the other Federal banking agencies a copy of such notice or report.
(12) Whenever such a change in control occurs, each insured
depository institution shall report promptly to the appropriate
Federal banking agency any changes or replacement of its chief
executive officer or of any director occurring in the next twelve-
month period, including in its report a statement of the past and
current business and professional affiliations of the new chief
executive officer or directors.
(13) The appropriate Federal banking agencies are authorized to
issue rules and regulations to carry out this subsection.
(14) Within two years after the effective date of the Change in
Bank Control Act of 1978, and each year thereafter in each
appropriate Federal banking agency's annual report to the Congress,
the appropriate Federal banking agency shall report to the Congress
the results of the administration of this subsection, and make any
recommendations as to changes in the law which in the opinion of
the appropriate Federal banking agency would be desirable.
(15) Investigative and Enforcement Authority. -
(A) Investigations. - The appropriate Federal banking agency
may exercise any authority vested in such agency under section
1818(n) of this title in the course of conducting any
investigation under paragraph (2)(B) or any other investigation
which the agency, in its discretion, determines is necessary to
determine whether any person has filed inaccurate, incomplete, or
misleading information under this subsection or otherwise is
violating, has violated, or is about to violate any provision of
this subsection or any regulation prescribed under this
subsection.
(B) Enforcement. - Whenever it appears to the appropriate
Federal banking agency that any person is violating, has
violated, or is about to violate any provision of this subsection
or any regulation prescribed under this subsection, the agency
may, in its discretion, apply to the appropriate district court
of the United States or the United States court of any territory
for -
(i) a temporary or permanent injunction or restraining order
enjoining such person from violating this subsection or any
regulation prescribed under this subsection; or
(ii) such other equitable relief as may be necessary to
prevent any such violation (including divestiture).

(C) Jurisdiction. -
(i) The district courts of the United States and the United
States courts in any territory shall have the same jurisdiction
and power in connection with any exercise of any authority by
the appropriate Federal banking agency under subparagraph (A)
as such courts have under section 1818(n) of this title.
(ii) The district courts of the United States and the United
States courts of any territory shall have jurisdiction and
power to issue any injunction or restraining order or grant any
equitable relief described in subparagraph (B). When
appropriate, any injunction, order, or other equitable relief
granted under this paragraph shall be granted without requiring
the posting of any bond.

The resignation, termination of employment or participation,
divestiture of control, or separation of or by an institution-
affiliated party (including a separation caused by the closing of
a depository institution) shall not affect the jurisdiction and
authority of the appropriate Federal banking agency to issue any
notice and proceed under this subsection against any such party, if
such notice is served before the end of the 6-year period beginning
on the date such party ceased to be such a party with respect to
such depository institution (whether such date occurs before, on,
or after August 9, 1989).
(16) Civil money penalty. -
(A) First tier. - Any person who violates any provision of this
subsection, or any regulation or order issued by the appropriate
Federal banking agency under this subsection, shall forfeit and
pay a civil penalty of not more than $5,000 for each day during
which such violation continues.
(B) Second tier. - Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), any person
who -
(i)(I) commits any violation described in any clause of
subparagraph (A);
(II) recklessly engages in an unsafe or unsound practice in
conducting the affairs of a depository institution; or
(III) breaches any fiduciary duty;
(ii) which violation, practice, or breach -
(I) is part of a pattern of misconduct;
(II) causes or is likely to cause more than a minimal loss
to such institution; or
(III) results in pecuniary gain or other benefit to such
person,

shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty of not more than $25,000
for each day during which such violation, practice, or breach
continues.
(C) Third tier. - Notwithstanding subparagraphs (A) and (B),
any person who -
(i) knowingly -
(I) commits any violation described in any clause of
subparagraph (A);
(II) engages in any unsafe or unsound practice in
conducting the affairs of a depository institution; or
(III) breaches any fiduciary duty; and

(ii) knowingly or recklessly causes a substantial loss to
such institution or a substantial pecuniary gain or other
benefit to such person by reason of such violation, practice,
or breach,

shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty in an amount not to exceed
the applicable maximum amount determined under subparagraph (D)
for each day during which such violation, practice, or breach
continues.
(D) Maximum amounts of penalties for any violation described in
subparagraph (c). - The maximum daily amount of any civil penalty
which may be assessed pursuant to subparagraph (C) for any
violation, practice, or breach described in such subparagraph is -

(i) in the case of any person other than a depository
institution, an amount to not exceed $1,000,000; and
(ii) in the case of a depository institution, an amount not
to exceed the lesser of -
(I) $1,000,000; or
(II) 1 percent of the total assets of such institution.

(E) Assessment; etc. - Any penalty imposed under subparagraph
(A), (B), or (C) shall be assessed and collected by the
appropriate Federal banking agency in the manner provided in
subparagraphs (E), (F), (G), and (I) of section 1818(i)(2) of
this title for penalties imposed (under such section) and any
such assessment shall be subject to the provisions of such
section.
(F) Hearing. - The depository institution or other person
against whom any penalty is assessed under this paragraph shall
be afforded an agency hearing if such institution or other person
submits a request for such hearing within 20 days after the
issuance of the notice of assessment. Section 1818(h) of this
title shall apply to any proceeding under this paragraph.
(G) Disbursement. - All penalties collected under authority of
this paragraph shall be deposited into the Treasury.

(17) Exceptions. - This subsection shall not apply with respect
to a transaction which is subject to -
(A) section 1842 of this title;
(B) section 1828(c) of this title; or
(C) section 1467a of this title.

(18) Applicability of change in control provisions to other
institutions. - For purposes of this subsection, the term "insured
depository institution" includes -
(A) any depository institution holding company; and
(B) any other company which controls an insured depository
institution and is not a depository institution holding company.
(k) Federal banking agency rules and regulations for reports and
public disclosure by banks of extension of credit to executive
officers or principal shareholders or the related interests of
such persons
The appropriate Federal banking agencies are authorized to issue
rules and regulations, including definitions of terms, to require
the reporting and public disclosure of information by a bank or any
executive officer or principal shareholder thereof concerning
extensions of credit by the bank to any of its executive officers
or principal shareholders, or the related interests of such
persons.
(l) Designation of fund membership for newly insured depository
institutions; definitions
For purposes of this section:
(1) Bank Insurance Fund
Any institution which -
(A) becomes an insured depository institution; and
(B) does not become a Savings Association Insurance Fund
member pursuant to paragraph (2),

shall be a Bank Insurance Fund member.
(2) Savings Association Insurance Fund
Any savings association, other than any Federal savings bank
chartered pursuant to section 1464(o) of this title, which
becomes an insured depository institution shall be a Savings
Association Insurance Fund member.
(3) Transition provision
(A) Bank Insurance Fund
Any depository institution the deposits of which were insured
by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation on the day before
August 9, 1989, including -
(i) any Federal savings bank chartered pursuant to section
1464(o) of this title; and
(ii) any cooperative bank,

shall be a Bank Insurance Fund member as of August 9, 1989.
(B) Savings Association Insurance Fund
Any savings association which is an insured depository
institution by operation of section 1814(a)(2) of this title
shall be a Savings Association Insurance Fund member as of
August 9, 1989.
(4) Bank Insurance Fund member
The term "Bank Insurance Fund member" means any depository
institution the deposits of which are insured by the Bank
Insurance Fund.
(5) Savings Association Insurance Fund member
The term "Savings Association Insurance Fund member" means any
depository institution the deposits of which are insured by the
Savings Association Insurance Fund.
(6) Bank Insurance Fund reserve ratio
The term "Bank Insurance Fund reserve ratio" means the ratio of
the net worth of the Bank Insurance Fund to the value of the
aggregate estimated insured deposits held in all Bank Insurance
Fund members.
(7) Savings Association Insurance Fund reserve ratio
The term "Savings Association Insurance Fund reserve ratio"
means the ratio of the net worth of the Savings Association
Insurance Fund to the value of the aggregate estimated insured
deposits held in all Savings Association Insurance Fund members.
(m) Secondary reserve offsets against premiums
(1) Offsets in calendar years beginning before 1993
Subject to the maximum amount limitation contained in paragraph
(2) and notwithstanding any other provision of law, any insured
savings association may offset such association's pro rata share
of the statutorily prescribed amount against any premium assessed
against such association under subsection (b) of this section for
any calendar year beginning before 1993.
(2) Annual maximum amount limitation
The amount of any offset allowed for any savings association
under paragraph (1) for any calendar year beginning before 1993
shall not exceed an amount which is equal to 20 percent of such
association's pro rata share of the statutorily prescribed amount
(as computed for such calendar year).
(3) Offsets in calendar years beginning after 1992
Notwithstanding any other provision of law, a savings
association may offset such association's pro rata share of the
statutorily prescribed amount against any premium assessed
against such association under subsection (b) of this section for
any calendar year beginning after 1992.
(4) Transferability
No right, title, or interest of any insured depository
institution in or with respect to its pro rata share of the
secondary reserve shall be assignable or transferable whether by
operation of law or otherwise, except to the extent that the
Corporation may provide for transfer of such pro rata share in
cases of merger or consolidation, transfer of bulk assets or
assumption of liabilities, and similar transactions, as defined
by the Corporation for purposes of this paragraph.
(5) Pro rata distribution on termination of insured status
If -
(A) the status of any savings association as an insured
depository institution is terminated pursuant to any provision
of section 1818 of this title or the insurance of accounts of
any such institution is otherwise terminated;
(B) a receiver or other legal custodian is appointed for the
purpose of liquidation or winding up the affairs of any savings
association; or
(C) the Corporation makes a determination that for the
purposes of this subsection any savings association has
otherwise gone into liquidation,

the Corporation shall pay in cash to such institution its pro
rata share of the secondary reserve, in accordance with such
terms and conditions as the Corporation may prescribe, or, at the
option of the Corporation, the Corporation may apply the whole or
any part of the amount which would otherwise be paid in cash
toward the payment of any indebtedness or obligation, whether
matured or not, of such institution to the Corporation, existing
or arising before such payment in cash. Such payment or such
application need not be made to the extent that the provisions of
the exception in paragraph (4) are applicable.
(6) "Statutorily prescribed amount" defined
For purposes of this subsection, the term "statutorily
prescribed amount" means, with respect to any calendar year which
ends after August 9, 1989 -
(A) $823,705,000, minus
(B) the sum of -
(i) the aggregate amount of offsets made before August 9,
1989, by all insured institutions under section 404(e)(2)
(!1) of the National Housing Act [12 U.S.C. 1727(e)(2)] (as
in effect before August 9, 1989); and
(ii) the aggregate amount of offsets made by all savings
associations under this subsection before the beginning of
such calendar year.
(7) Savings association's pro rata amount
For purposes of this subsection, any savings association's pro
rata share of the statutorily prescribed amount is the percentage
which is equal to such association's share of the secondary
reserve as determined under section 404(e) (!1) of the National
Housing Act on the day before the date on which the Federal
Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation ceased to recognize the
secondary reserve (as such Act [12 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.] was in
effect on the day before such date).
(8) Year of enactment rule
With respect to the calendar year in which the Financial
Institutions Reform, Recovery, and Enforcement Act of 1989 is
enacted, the Corporation shall make such adjustments as may be
necessary -
(A) in the computation of the statutorily prescribed amount
which shall be applicable for the remainder of such calendar
year after taking into account the aggregate amount of offsets
by all insured institutions under section 404(e)(2) (!1) of the
National Housing Act [12 U.S.C. 1727(e)(2)] (as in effect
before August 9, 1989) after the beginning of such calendar
year and before August 9, 1989; and
(B) in the computation of the maximum amount of any savings
association's offset for such calendar year under paragraph (1)
after taking into account -
(i) the amount of any offset by such savings association
under section 404(e)(2) (!1) of the National Housing Act (as
in effect before August 9, 1989) after the beginning of such
calendar year and before August 9, 1989; and
(ii) the change of such association's premium year from the
1-year period applicable under section 404(b) (!1) of the
National Housing Act (as in effect before August 9, 1989) to
a calendar year basis.
(n) Collections on behalf of Director of Office of Thrift
Supervision
When requested by the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, the Corporation shall collect on behalf of the
Director assessments on savings associations levied by the Director
under section 1467 of this title. The Corporation shall be
reimbursed for its actual costs for the collection of such
assessments. Any such assessments by the Director shall be in
addition to any amounts assessed by the Corporation, the Financing
Corporation, and the Resolution Funding Corporation.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[7], 64 Stat. 876; Pub. L. 86-671,
Secs. 2, 3, July 14, 1960, 74 Stat. 547-551; Pub. L. 88-593, Sept.
12, 1964, 78 Stat. 940; Pub. L. 89-695, title II, Sec. 201, title
III, Sec. 301(b), Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat. 1046, 1055; Pub. L. 91-
151, Sec. 7(a)(2), Dec. 23, 1969, 83 Stat. 375; Pub. L. 91-609,
title IX, Sec. 910(g), (h), Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1812; Pub. L.
93-495, title I, Secs. 101(a)(2), 102(a)(2), Oct. 28, 1974, 88
Stat. 1500, 1502; Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(8)-(13), Sept. 17,
1978, 92 Stat. 617, 618; Pub. L. 95-630, title III, Secs. 302, 310,
title VI, Sec. 602, title IX, Sec. 901, Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat.
3676, 3678, 3683, 3693; Pub. L. 96-221, title III, Sec.
308(a)(1)(B), (d), Mar. 31, 1980, 94 Stat. 147, 148; Pub. L. 97-
110, title I, Sec. 103(b), Dec. 26, 1981, 95 Stat. 1514; Pub. L.
97-320, title I, Secs. 113(d)-(f), (q), 117, title IV, Sec. 429,
Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1473, 1475, 1479, 1527; Pub. L. 99-570,
title I, Sec. 1360, Oct. 27, 1986, 100 Stat. 3207-29; Pub. L. 100-
86, title V, Sec. 505(a), Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 633; Pub. L.
101-73, title II, Secs. 201, 208, title IX, Secs. 905(c), 907(d),
911(c), 931(a), Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 206, 460, 468, 479,
493; Pub. L. 101-508, title II, Secs. 2002-2004, Nov. 5, 1990, 104
Stat. 1388-14 - 1388-16; Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Secs. 103(b),
104, 113(c)(1), 141(c), title II, Secs. 205, 232(b), 233(c), title
III, Secs. 302(a), (b), (e)(3), (4), formerly (e)(2), (3),
311(a)(2), (b)(3), 313(a), title IV, Sec. 474, Dec. 19, 1991, 105
Stat. 2238, 2247, 2277, 2292, 2310, 2314, 2345, 2348, 2349, 2363,
2365, 2368, 2386; Pub. L. 102-550, title IX, Sec. 931(a), (b),
title XVI, Secs. 1603(a)(1), (3), 1604(b)(1), (3), 1605(a)(2),
(5)(A), (6), (b)(1), (2), 1606(i)(1), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat.
3888, 4078, 4083, 4085-4087, 4089; Pub. L. 102-558, title III,
Secs. 303(a), (b)(1), (3), (6)(A), (7), (8), 305, Oct. 28, 1992,
106 Stat. 4224-4226; Pub. L. 103-204, Secs. 8(h), 38(a), Dec. 17,
1993, 107 Stat. 2388, 2416; Pub. L. 103-325, title III, Secs.
305(b), 308(b), 348, title VI, Sec. 602(a)(4)-(10), Sept. 23, 1994,
108 Stat. 2217, 2218, 2241, 2288; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title
II, Secs. 2226, 2703(b), 2704(d)(6)(B), (14)(G), 2706-2708, Sept.
30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-417, 3009-485, 3009-488, 3009-491, 3009-
496, 3009-497; Pub. L. 106-569, title XII, Sec. 1231(a), Dec. 27,
2000, 114 Stat. 3036; Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(2), Oct. 30, 2004,
118 Stat. 2231; Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Secs. 2102(b), 2104(a),
(b), (d), 2105(a), 2106, 2107(a), 2108, Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9,
12-16, 19; Pub. L. 109-173, Secs. 2(b), 3(a)(1)-(5), 8(a)(8), (9),
Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3602, 3605, 3611; Pub. L. 109-351, title
VI, Sec. 604, title VII, Secs. 705, 707(a), Oct. 13, 2006, 120
Stat. 1980, 1987; Pub. L. 111-22, div. A, title II, Sec. 204(b),
May 20, 2009, 123 Stat. 1649; Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs.
331(a), 332-334(a), 363(2), title IX, Sec. 939(a)(1), July 21,
2010, 124 Stat. 1538, 1539, 1550, 1885.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title IX, Sec. 939(a)(1), (g), July 21, 2010,
124 Stat. 1885, 1887, provided that, effective 2 years after July
21, 2010, subsection (b)(1)(E)(i) of this section is amended by
substituting "private economic, credit," for "credit rating
entities, and other private economic".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(2), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1550, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (a) -
(A) in paragraph (2) -
(i) in subparagraph (A) -
(I) in the first sentence, by striking out "the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision,";
(II) in the second sentence -
(aa) by substituting "to" for "the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision,"; and
(bb) by inserting "to" before "any Federal home"; and
(III) by substituting "Finance Agency" for "Finance Board"
wherever appearing; and
(ii) in subparagraph (B), by substituting "the Comptroller of the
Currency and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System,"
for "the Comptroller of the Currency, the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System, and the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision,";
(B) in paragraph (3), in the first sentence, by substituting
"Comptroller of the Currency, and the Chairman of the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System." for "Comptroller of the
Currency, the Chairman of the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System, and the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision.";
(C) in paragraph (6), by substituting "section 1834(a)(3)(D)" for
"section 1834(a)(3)(C)"; and
(D) in paragraph (7), by striking out ", the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision,"; and
(2) in subsection (n) -
(i) in the heading, by substituting "Comptroller of the Currency"
for "Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision";
(ii) in the first sentence -
(I) by substituting "the Comptroller of the Currency" for "the
Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision"; and
(II) by inserting "Federal" before "savings associations";
(iii) in the third sentence, by striking out ", the Financing
Corporation, and the Resolution Funding Corporation"; and
(iv) by substituting "the Comptroller" for "the Director"
wherever appearing.
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
Subparagraph (D), referred to in subsec. (b)(2)(A), was repealed
by Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 331(a)(1). See 2010 Amendment note below.
The Bank Enterprise Act of 1991, referred to in subsec.
(b)(2)(E), is subtitle C (Secs. 231-234) of title II of Pub. L. 102-
242, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2308-2315, which enacted sections
1834 to 1834b of this title, amended this section, and enacted
provisions set out as a note under section 1811 of this title. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see Short Title of
1991 Amendment note set out under section 1811 of this title and
Tables.
The National Bank Act, referred to in subsec. (h), is act June 3,
1864, ch. 106, 13 Stat. 99, as amended, which is classified
principally to chapter 2 (Sec. 21 et seq.) of this title. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see References in
Text note set out under section 38 of this title.
The Federal Reserve Act, referred to in subsec. (h), is act Dec.
23, 1913, ch. 6, 38 Stat. 251, as amended, which is classified
principally to chapter 3 (Sec. 221 et seq.) of this title. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see References in
Text note set out under section 226 of this title and Tables.
The Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, referred to in subsec.
(j)(9)(E)(i), is act May 9, 1956, ch. 240, 70 Stat. 133, as
amended, which is classified principally to chapter 17 (Sec. 1841
et seq.) of this title. For complete classification of this Act to
the Code, see Short Title note set out under section 1841 of this
title and Tables.
For effective date of the Change in Bank Control Act of 1978
[title VI of Pub. L. 95-630], referred to in subsec. (j)(14), see
section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as an Effective Date note
under section 375b of this title.
The National Housing Act, referred to in subsec. (m)(6) to (8),
is act June 27, 1934, ch. 847, 48 Stat. 1246, as amended, which is
classified principally to chapter 13 (Sec. 1701 et seq.) of this
title. Section 404 of the National Housing Act, is section 1727 of
this title, as such section was in effect prior to repeal by Pub.
L. 101-73, title IV, Sec. 407, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 363. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see section 1701
of this title and Tables.
The calendar year in which the Financial Institutions Reform,
Recovery, and Enforcement Act of 1989 is enacted, referred to in
subsec. (m)(8), means the calendar year in which Pub. L. 101-73 was
enacted. Such Act was approved Aug. 9, 1989.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (h) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note under section 1811 of this title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 333(a),
substituted "consultation" for "agreement".
Subsec. (b)(1)(E)(i). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 333(b)(1),
substituted "including reports" for "such as reports".
Subsec. (b)(1)(E)(iii). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 333(b)(2), which
directed substitution of "Corporation, except as provided in
subsection (a)(2)(B)" for "Corporation", was executed by making the
substitution for "Corporation" the second time appearing, to
reflect the probable intent of Congress.
Subsec. (b)(2)(C), (D). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 331(a),
redesignated subpar. (C) as (D) and struck out former subpar. (D).
Prior to amendment, text of subpar. (D) read as follows: "No
insured depository institution shall be barred from the lowest-risk
category solely because of size."
Subsec. (b)(3)(B). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 334(a), amended subpar.
(B) generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "The
reserve ratio designated by the Board of Directors for any year -
"(i) may not exceed 1.5 percent of estimated insured deposits;
and
"(ii) may not be less than 1.15 percent of estimated insured
deposits."
Subsec. (e)(2)(B). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 332(1)(A), amended
subpar. (B) generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows:
"If, at the end of a calendar year, the reserve ratio of the
Deposit Insurance Fund equals or exceeds 1.35 percent of estimated
insured deposits and is not more than 1.5 percent of such deposits,
the Corporation shall declare the amount in the Fund that is equal
to 50 percent of the amount in excess of the amount required to
maintain the reserve ratio at 1.35 percent of the estimated insured
deposits as dividends to be paid to insured depository
institutions."
Subsec. (e)(2)(C) to (G). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 332(1)(B), (C),
amended subpar. (C) generally and struck out subpars. (D) to (G).
Prior to amendment, subpars. (C) to (G) related to basis for
distribution of dividends, notice and opportunity for comment,
suspension or limitation of dividends by Board upon making certain
determination, considerations in such determination, and annual
review of such determination, respectively.
Subsec. (e)(4)(A). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 332(2), substituted
"paragraphs (2) and" for "paragraphs (2)(D) and".
2009 - Subsec. (b)(3)(E)(ii). Pub. L. 111-22 substituted "8-year
period" for "5-year period".
2006 - Subsec. (a)(2)(C). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 707(a), added
subpar. (C).
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(1), substituted "Such
reports of condition shall be the basis for the certified
statements to be filed pursuant to subsection (c)." for "Two dates
shall be selected within the semiannual period of January to June
inclusive, and the reports on such dates shall be the basis for the
certified statement to be filed in July pursuant to subsection (c)
of this section, and two dates shall be selected within the
semiannual period of July to December inclusive, and the reports on
such dates shall be the basis for the certified statement to be
filed in January pursuant to subsection (c) of this section."
Subsec. (a)(11). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 604, added par. (11).
Subsec. (b)(1)(B)(ii). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(2), struck out
"semiannual" before "assessment".
Subsec. (b)(1)(C). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(2), struck out
"semiannual" before "assessment based" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (b)(1)(C)(i), (iii). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(8)(A),
substituted "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund".
Subsec. (b)(1)(D). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(8)(B), substituted
"the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "each deposit insurance fund".
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(i). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(1)(E), (F). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2106, added
subpars. (E) and (F).
Subsec. (b)(2)(A). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2104(a)(1), added
subpar. (A) and struck out heading and text of former subpar. (A).
Text related to semiannual assessments for insured depository
institutions to achieve or maintain the reserve ratio of each
deposit insurance fund at the designated reserve ratio, the factors
to be considered by the Board of Directors, and limitations on the
assessment amount unless the insured depository institution
exhibited financial, operational, or compliance weaknesses ranging
from moderately severe to unsatisfactory or was not well
capitalized.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i)(I), (iii), (iv). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec.
2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(ii)-(iv).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(B). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2104(a)(1), added
subpar. (B) and struck out heading and text of former subpar. (B).
Text read as follows: "The Board of Directors shall -
"(i) set semiannual assessments for members of each deposit
insurance fund independently from semiannual assessments for
members of any other deposit insurance fund; and
"(ii) set the designated reserve ratio of each deposit
insurance fund independently from the designated reserve ratio of
any other deposit insurance fund."
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(B)(iii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(C). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(3)(B), struck out
"semiannual" before "assessment".
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(B)(iii), (14)(G)(v). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(D). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2104(a)(2), added
subpar. (D).
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(B)(iii), (14)(G)(vi). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(E) to (H). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(3)(A), (C),
redesignated subpar. (H) as (E) and struck out former subpars. (E)
to (G), which related to minimum assessments, the transition rule
for the Savings Association Insurance Fund, and a special rule
until insurance funds achieved the designated reserve ratio,
respectively.
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(B)(iii). See 1996 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2105(a), amended par. (3)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (3) related to a special rule
for recapitalizing undercapitalized funds.
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(vii). See 1996 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (b)(3)(E). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2108, added subpar. (E)
to par. (3), as amended by Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2105(a). See note
above.
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(4), redesignated par.
(5) as (4) and struck out heading and text of former par. (4). Text
read as follows: "For purposes of this section, the term
'semiannual period' means a period beginning on January 1 of any
calendar year and ending on June 30 of the same year, or a period
beginning on July 1 of any calendar year and ending on December 31
of the same year."
Subsec. (b)(5). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(8)(C), substituted
"any such assessment is necessary" for "any such assessment" in
introductory provisions, struck out "(A) is necessary - "
immediately following introductory provisions, redesignated cls.
(i) to (iii) of former subpar. (A) as subpars (A) to (C),
respectively, and realigned margins, substituted "insured
depository institutions" for "Bank Insurance Fund members" in
subpar. (A), inserted "that" before "the Corporation" and
substituted period for "; and" at end of subpar. (C), and struck
out former subpar. (B) which read: "is allocated between Bank
Insurance Fund members and Savings Association Insurance Fund
members in amounts which reflect the degree to which the proceeds
of the amounts borrowed are to be used for the benefit of the
respective insurance funds."
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(4), redesignated par. (6) as (5).
Former par. (5) redesignated (4).
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2104(b), amended heading and text of par.
(5) generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "Each
insured depository institution shall maintain all records that the
Corporation may require for verifying the correctness of the
institution's semiannual assessments. No insured depository
institution shall be required to retain those records for that
purpose for a period of more than 5 years from the date of the
filing of any certified statement, except that when there is a
dispute between the insured depository institution and the
Corporation over the amount of any assessment, the depository
institution shall retain the records until final determination of
the issue."
Subsec. (b)(6). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(4), redesignated par.
(7) as (6). Former par. (6) redesignated (5).
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(viii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(7). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(4), redesignated par.
(7) as (6).
Subsec. (c)(1)(A), (2)(A). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(5)(A), (B),
struck out "semiannual" before "assessment".
Subsec. (c)(3). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(5)(C), substituted
"initial assessment period" for "semiannual period".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2107(a), amended heading and
text of subsec. (e) generally. Prior to amendment, text related to
refunds of any payment of an assessment by an insured depository
institution in excess of the amount due to the Corporation and
refunds in the event of a balance in the insurance fund in excess
of the designated reserve.
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2104(d), amended subsec. (g)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (g) provided that the
Corporation was entitled to recover, by suit, any unpaid assessment
lawfully payable to it by any insured depository institution,
except that no proceeding could be brought after 5 years after the
right accrued for which the claim was made unless fraudulent
certified statements had been made by the depository institution,
with special rules with respect to a cause of action which had
expired within one year from Sept. 21, 1950, and with respect to
assessments for any year prior to 1945.
Subsec. (i)(1), (3). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 2(b), substituted "the
standard maximum deposit insurance amount (as determined under
section 1821(a)(1) of this title)" for "$100,000".
Subsec. (j)(1)(D). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 705(1), substituted "is
needed - " for "is needed" and "title 31; or" for "title 31.",
inserted cl. (i) designation before "to investigate", and added cl.
(ii).
Subsec. (j)(7)(C). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 705(2), substituted
"either the financial condition of any acquiring person or the
future prospects of the institution" for "the financial condition
of any acquiring person".
Subsec. (j)(7)(F). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(9), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank Insurance Fund or the Savings
Association Insurance Fund".
Subsecs. (l) to (n). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub.
L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(i), (ii). See 1996 Amendment note
below.
2004 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 108-386 struck out "(except a
District bank)" after "State nonmember bank" in first sentence.
2000 - Subsec. (b)(2)(E)(iii). Pub. L. 106-569 amended directory
language of Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2707. See 1996 Amendment note
below.
1996 - Subsec. (b)(1)(D). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(i), which directed substitution of "the Deposit
Insurance Fund" for "each deposit insurance fund", was repealed by
Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below
and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2708(a), inserted
"when necessary, and only to the extent necessary" after "insured
depository institutions" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i)(I). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(ii), which directed substitution of "the Deposit
Insurance Fund" for "each deposit insurance fund", was repealed by
Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(iii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2708(b), amended
heading and text of cl. (iii) generally. Prior to amendment, text
read as follows: "The semiannual assessment for each member of a
deposit insurance fund shall be not less than $1,000."
Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(iii), which directed
substitution of "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "a deposit
insurance fund", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective
Date of 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(iv). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(ii),
(iv), which directed substitution of "the Deposit Insurance Fund"
for "each deposit insurance fund" and striking out cl. (iv), was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(v). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2708(c), added cl.
(v).
Subsec. (b)(2)(B). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(iii),
which directed the striking of subpar. (B) and the redesignation of
subpar. (C) as (B), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective
Date of 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(iii),
(14)(G)(v), which directed the redesignation of subpar. (E) as (C)
and substitution of "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "any deposit
insurance fund" and "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "that fund"
wherever appearing, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective
Date of 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(2)(D). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(iii),
(14)(G)(vi), which directed the redesignation of subpar. (G) as (D)
and substitution of "fund achieves" for "funds achieve" in heading
and "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "a deposit insurance fund" in
text, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below.
Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2703(b), struck out heading and text of
subpar. (D). Text read as follows: "Notwithstanding any other
provision of this paragraph, amounts assessed by the Financing
Corporation under section 1441 of this title against Savings
Association Insurance Fund members shall be subtracted from the
amounts authorized to be assessed by the Corporation under this
paragraph."
Subsec. (b)(2)(E). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(iii),
which directed the redesignation of subpar. (H) as (E), was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(2)(E)(iii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2707, as amended by
Pub. L. 106-569, added cl. (iii).
Subsec. (b)(2)(F) to (H). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(B)(iii), which directed the striking of subpar. (F) and
the redesignation of subpars. (G) and (H) as (D) and (E),
respectively, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date
of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(vii)(I),
which directed substitution of "fund" for "funds" in heading, was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(3)(A). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(vii)(II)-
(V), which directed substitution of "If" for "Except as provided
in paragraph (2)(F), if", "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "any
deposit insurance fund", and "insured depository institutions" for
"members of that fund" in introductory provisions and directed
substitution of "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "that fund" in cl.
(i), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(3)(B). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(vii)(III), which directed substitution of "the
Deposit Insurance Fund" for "that fund", was repealed by Pub. L.
109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(3)(C), (D). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(G)(vii)(VI), which directed the striking of subpars.
(C) and (D) and the addition of a new subpar. (C), was repealed by
Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below
and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(6). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(G)(viii), which
directed the amendment of par. (6) by substituting "any such
assessment is necessary" for "any such assessment" in introductory
provisions, striking subpar. (A) designation, introductory
provisions, and subpar. (B), redesignating cls. (i) to (iii) of
subpar. (A) as subpars. (A) to (C), respectively, realigning
margins, and substituting period for "; and" at end of subpar. (C),
was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2706, inserted heading and
amended text of subsec. (e) generally. Prior to amendment, text
read as follows: "The Corporation (1) may refund to an insured
depository institution any payment of assessment in excess of the
amount due to the Corporation or (2) may credit such excess toward
the payment of the assessment next becoming due from such
depository institution and upon succeeding assessments until the
credit is exhausted."
Subsec. (j)(9)(A). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(1), substituted
"foreign bank, or any affiliate thereof," for "financial
institution and any affiliate of any financial institution" and "by
the foreign bank or any affiliate thereof" for "by the financial
institution and such institution's affiliates".
Subsec. (j)(9)(B). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(2)(A), substituted
"paragraph, the following definitions shall apply:" for "paragraph -
" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (j)(9)(B)(i). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(2)(B), added cl.
(i) and struck out heading and text of former cl. (i). Text read as
follows: "The term 'financial institution' means any insured
depository institution and any foreign bank that is subject to the
provisions of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 by virtue of
section 3106(a) of this title."
Subsec. (j)(9)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(2)(C),
substituted "foreign bank or any affiliate thereof" for "financial
institution" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (j)(9)(C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(3), substituted
"foreign bank or any affiliate thereof" for "financial institution
or any of its affiliates" before "as principal" and for "financial
institution or its affiliates" before "has a security interest".
Subsec. (j)(9)(D)(i). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(4)(A),
substituted "the foreign bank and all affiliates thereof" for "the
financial institution and all affiliates of the institution" and
"foreign bank or affiliate thereof" for "financial institution or
any such affiliate".
Subsec. (j)(9)(D)(ii), (iii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(4)(B),
(C), substituted "foreign bank and any affiliate thereof" for
"financial institution and any affiliate of such institution"
before period at end of cl. (ii) and "foreign bank or any affiliate
thereof" for "financial institution" before parenthetical at end of
cl. (iii).
Subsec. (j)(9)(E)(i). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(5)(A),
substituted "subparagraph (A), a foreign bank or any affiliate
thereof" for "subparagraph (A), a financial institution and the
affiliates of such institution" and substituted "foreign bank or
any affiliate thereof" for "institution or affiliate" in two
places.
Subsec. (j)(9)(E)(ii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2226(5)(B),
substituted "foreign bank and any affiliate thereof" for "financial
institution and any affiliate of such institution".
Subsecs. (l) to (n). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(B)(i),
(ii), which directed the striking of subsec. (l) and the
redesignation of subsecs. (m) and (n) as (l) and (m), respectively,
was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
1994 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 308(b), struck out
after third sentence "The Board of Directors may require reports of
condition to be published in such manner, not inconsistent with any
applicable law, as it may direct."
Subsec. (a)(2)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 305(b), inserted "and,
with respect to any State depository institution, any appropriate
State bank supervisor for such institution," after "The
Corporation" in first sentence.
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(4), struck out
"Chairman of the" before "Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision".
Subsec. (a)(9). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 348, inserted at end "In
prescribing reporting and other requirements for the collection of
actual and accurate information pursuant to this paragraph, the
Corporation shall minimize the regulatory burden imposed upon
insured depository institutions that are well capitalized (as
defined in section 1831o of this title) while taking into account
the benefit of the information to the Corporation, including the
use of the information to enable the Corporation to more accurately
determine the total amount of insured deposits in each insured
depository institution for purposes of compliance with this
chapter."
Subsec. (b)(3)(C). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(5), struck out
first period at end.
Subsec. (j)(2)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(6), in third
sentence substituted "this paragraph" for "this section (j)(2)" and
"this subsection (j)(2)", respectively.
Subsec. (j)(7)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(7), substituted
"monopolize" for "monoplize" after "conspiracy to".
Subsec. (l)(7). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(8), substituted "the
ratio of" for "the ratio of the value of".
Subsec. (m)(5)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(9), substituted
"such institution" for "savings association institution".
Subsec. (m)(7). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(10), inserted "the"
before "Federal".
1993 - Subsec. (b)(3)(C). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(h), substituted
"and such amendment may extend the date specified in subparagraph
(B) to such later date as the Corporation determines will, over
time, maximize the amount of semiannual assessments received by the
Savings Association Insurance Fund, net of insurance losses
incurred by the Fund." for ", but such amendments may not extend
the date specified in subparagraph (B)".
Subsec. (i)(3), (4). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 38(a), added par. (3)
and redesignated former par. (3) as (4).
1992 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(1), amended
directory language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(1). See 1991
Amendment note below. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1604(b)(1), which
contained a similar amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28,
1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), amended
directory language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e). See 1991
Amendment note below. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(5)(A), which
contained an identical amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28,
1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (a)(9), (10). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1606(i)(1),
redesignated par. (9), relating to designation of debtor or
bankrupt corporation or transaction with such a corporation as
highly leveraged, as (10).
Subsec. (b)(1)(A)(iii). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(a)(1),
substituted "assessment rate." for "assessment."
Subsec. (b)(2). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(a), struck out comma
after "members" in subpar. (D) and added subpar. (H). Pub. L. 102-
550, Sec. 1605(a)(2), which contained an identical amendment, was
repealed, effective Oct. 28, 1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305,
set out as a Repeal of Duplicative Provisions note under section
1815 of this title.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(iii)(I). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 931(b), amended
subcl. (I) generally. Prior to amendment, subcl. (I) read as
follows: " 1/2 the assessment rate applicable with respect to such
deposits pursuant to paragraph (10) during that semiannual
assessment period; and".
Subsec. (b)(6). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(7), added par. (6).
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(a)(3), which contained an identical
amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28, 1992, by Pub. L. 102-
558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of Duplicative Provisions note
under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (b)(6)(D). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(b)(1), added
subpar. (D) and struck out former subpar. (D) which read as
follows: "any liability of the insured depository institution which
is not treated as an insured deposit pursuant to section 1821(a)(8)
of this title."
Subsec. (b)(7). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(8), added par. (7).
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(6), which contained an identical
amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28, 1992, by Pub. L. 102-
558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of Duplicative Provisions note
under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (b)(10). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 931(a), substituted "at an
assessment rate to be determined by the Corporation by regulation.
Such assessment rate may not be less than 1/2 the maximum
assessment rate." for "at the assessment rate of 1/2 the maximum
rate."
Subsec. (c)(4). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(b)(2), added par. (4)
and substituted "paragraph (1)" for "paragraph (1) or (2)" wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), amended
directory language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e). See 1991
Amendment note below. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(5)(A), which
contained an identical amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28,
1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (d)(5). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(3), made technical
amendment to reference to section 1834b of this title, to correct
underlying provisions of original act. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec.
1604(b)(3), which contained an identical amendment, was repealed,
effective Oct. 28, 1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a
Repeal of Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this
title.
1991 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 474, added par. (9)
relating to designation of debtor or bankrupt corporation or
transaction with such a corporation as highly leveraged.
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(1), as amended by Pub. L. 102-558,
Sec. 303(b)(1), added par. (6) and redesignated former pars. (6) to
(8) as (7) to (9), respectively.
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(c), amended par. (8) generally,
substituting provisions relating to data collections for provisions
which required that the reports of conditions made by depository
institutions be provided to auditors which had made independent
audits of insured depository institutions within the past two years
and that such reports also include specified additional
information. Par. (8) subsequently redesignated (9), see above.
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e)(3), as renumbered by
Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), struck out "and for the
computation of assessments provided in subsection (b) of this
section" after "For this purpose".
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(a), amended subsec. (b)
generally, revising and restating as pars. (1) to (5) provisions of
former pars. (1) to (11).
Subsec. (b)(1)(A)(iii). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 104(b), added cl.
(iii) and struck out former cl. (iii) which read as follows:
"Deadline for announcing rate changes. - The Corporation shall
announce any change in assessment rates. -
"(I) for the semiannual period beginning on January 1 and
ending on June 30, not later than the preceding November 1; and
"(II) for the semiannual period beginning on July 1 and ending
on December 31, not later than the preceding May 1."
Subsec. (b)(1)(C). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 104(a), amended subpar.
(C) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (C) read as follows:
"Assessment rate for bank insurance fund members. -
"(i) In general. - The assessment rate for Bank Insurance Fund
members shall be the greater of 0.15 percent or such rate as the
Board of Directors, in its sole discretion, determines to be
appropriate -
"(I) to maintain the reserve ratio at the designated reserve
ratio; or
"(II) if the reserve ratio is less than the designated reserve
ratio, to increase the reserve ratio to the designated reserve
ratio within a reasonable period of time.
"(ii) Factors to be considered. - In making any determination
under clause (i), the Board of Directors shall consider the Bank
Insurance Fund's expected operating expenses, case resolution
expenditures, and income, the effect of the assessment rate on
members' earnings and capital, and such other factors as the Board
of Directors may deem appropriate.
"(iii) Minimum assessment. - Notwithstanding clause (i), the
assessment shall not be less than $1,000 for each member in each
year."
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i)(II). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(3)(A),
added subcl. (II) and struck out former subcl. (II) which read as
follows: "such Bank Insurance Fund member's average assessment base
for the immediately preceding semiannual period; and".
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(ii)(II). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(3)(B),
added subcl. (II) and struck out former subcl. (II) which read as
follows: "such Savings Association Insurance Fund member's average
assessment base for the immediately preceding semiannual period."
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(iii). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(3)(C), added
cl. (iii).
Subsec. (b)(6)(D). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(a)(2), added subpar.
(D).
Subsec. (b)(7) to (9). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 103(b), added par.
(7) and redesignated former pars. (7) and (8) as (8) and (9),
respectively. Former par. (9) redesignated (10).
Subsec. (b)(10). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(2), added par. (10)
and redesignated former par. (10) as (11).
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(c)(1), inserted "or section 1820(e) of
this title" after "under this section".
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 103(b)(1), redesignated par. (9) as (10).
Subsec. (b)(11). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 232(b)(2), redesignated
par. (10) as (11).
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(b), amended subsec. (c)
generally, revising and restating as pars. (1) to (3) provisions of
former pars. (1) to (5).
Subsec. (c)(5). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 313(a), added par. (5).
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e)(4), as renumbered by
Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), amended subsec. (d) generally,
substituting provisions exempting Corporation from apportionment
for purposes of chapter 15 of title 31 for provisions relating to
assessment credits.
Subsec. (d)(1)(A). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 233(c)(2)(A), inserted
"(other than credits allowed pursuant to paragraph (4))" after
"amount to be credited".
Subsec. (d)(1)(B). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 233(c)(2)(B), inserted
"(taking into account any assessment credit allowed pursuant to
paragraph (4))" after "should be reduced".
Subsec. (d)(4) to (7). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 233(c)(1), added
pars. (4) and (5) and redesignated former pars. (4) and (5) as (6)
and (7), respectively.
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(3), amended subsec. (i)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (i) read as follows: "Except
with respect to trust funds which are owned by a depositor referred
to in paragraph (2) of section 1821(a) of this title, trust funds
held by an insured depository institution in a fiduciary capacity
whether held in its trust department or held or deposited in any
other department of the fiduciary depository institution shall be
insured in an amount not to exceed $100,000 for each trust estate,
and when deposited by the fiduciary depository institution in
another insured depository institution such trust fund shall be
similarly insured to the fiduciary depository institution according
to the trust estates represented. Notwithstanding any other
provision of this chapter, such insurance shall be separate from
and additional to that covering other deposits of the owners of
such trust funds or the beneficiaries of such trust estates. The
Board of Directors shall have power by regulation to prescribe the
manner of reporting and of depositing such trust funds."
Subsec. (j)(9). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 205, amended par. (9)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (9) read as follows: "Whenever
any insured depository institution makes a loan or loans, secured,
or to be secured, by 25 per centum or more of the outstanding
voting stock of an insured depository institution, the president or
other chief executive officer of the lending bank shall promptly
report such fact to the appropriate Federal banking agency of the
bank whose stock secures the loan or loans upon obtaining knowledge
of such loan or loans, except that no report need be made in those
cases where the borrower has been the owner of record of the stock
for a period of one year or more or where the stock is that of the
newly organized bank prior to its opening."
1990 - Subsec. (b)(1)(A). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2003(a), amended
subpar. (A) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (A) read as
follows:
"(A) Annual assessment rates prescribed. -
"(i) The Corporation shall set assessment rates for insured
depository institutions annually.
"(ii) The Corporation shall fix the annual assessment rate of
Bank Insurance Fund members independently from the annual
assessment rate for Savings Association Insurance Fund members.
"(iii) The Corporation shall, by September 30 of each year,
announce the assessment rates for the succeeding calendar year."
Subsec. (b)(1)(B)(i)(II), (ii)(II). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec.
2004(1), struck out ", not exceeding 1.50 percent," after "insured
deposits".
Subsec. (b)(1)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2004(2), inserted
"and" after "Fund;" in subcl. (I), redesignated subcl. (IV) as (II)
and struck out former subcls. (II) and (III) which read as follows:
"(II) allocate each calendar quarter to an Earnings Participation
Account in the Bank Insurance Fund the investment income earned by
the Bank Insurance Fund on such Supplemental Reserves in the
preceding calendar quarter;
"(III) distribute such Earnings Participation Account at the
conclusion of each calendar year to Bank Insurance Fund members;
and".
Subsec. (b)(1)(B)(iv). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2004(3), inserted
"and" after "Fund;" in subcl. (I), redesignated subcl. (IV) as
(II), and struck out former subcls. (II) and (III) which read as
follows:
"(II) allocate each calendar quarter to an Earnings Participation
Account in the Savings Association Insurance Fund the investment
income earned by the Savings Association Insurance Fund on such
Supplemental Reserves in the preceding calendar quarter;
"(III) distribute such Earnings Participation Account at the
conclusion of each calendar year to Savings Association Insurance
Fund members; and".
Subsec. (b)(1)(C). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2002(a), amended subpar.
(C) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (C) read as follows:
"Assessment rate for bank insurance fund members. - The annual
assessment rate for Bank Insurance Fund members shall be -
"(i) until December 31, 1989, 1/12 of 1 percent;
"(ii) from January 1, 1990, through December 31, 1990, 0.12
percent;
"(iii) on and after January 1, 1991, 0.15 percent;
"(iv) on January 1 of a calendar year in which the reserve
ratio of the Bank Insurance Fund is expected to be less than the
designated reserve ratio by determination of the Board of
Directors, such rate determined by the Board of Directors to be
appropriate to restore the reserve ratio to the designated
reserve ratio within a reasonable period of time, after taking
into consideration the expected operating expenses, case
resolution expenditures, and investment income of the Bank
Insurance Fund, and the impact on insured bank earnings and
capitalization, except that -
"(I) from August 9, 1989, until the earlier of January 1,
1995, or January 1 of the calendar year in which the Bank
Insurance Fund reserve ratio is expected to first attain the
designated reserve ratio, the rate shall be as specified in
clauses (i), (ii), and (iii) of this subparagraph so long as
the Bank Insurance Fund reserve ratio is increasing on a
calendar year basis;
"(II) the rate shall not exceed 0.325 percent; and
"(III) the increase in the rate in any 1 year shall not
exceed 0.075 percent; and
"(v) sufficient to ensure that for each member in each year the
assessment shall not be less than $1,000."
Subsec. (b)(1)(D). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2002(b), amended subpar.
(D) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (D) read as follows:
"Assessment rate for savings association insurance fund members. -
The annual assessment rate for Savings Association Insurance Fund
members shall be -
"(i) until December 31, 1990, 0.208 percent;
"(ii) from January 1, 1991, through December 31, 1993, 0.23
percent;
"(iii) from January 1, 1994, through December 31, 1997, 0.18
percent;
"(iv) on and after January 1, 1998, 0.15 percent;
"(v) on January 1 of a calendar year in which the reserve ratio
of the Savings Association Insurance Fund is expected to be less
than the designated reserve ratio by determination of the Board
of Directors, such rate determined by the Board of Directors to
be appropriate to restore the reserve ratio to the designated
reserve ratio within a reasonable period of time, after taking
into consideration the expected expenses and income of the
Savings Association Insurance Fund, and the effect on insured
savings association earnings and capitalization, except that -
"(I) from August 9, 1989, through December 31, 1994, the rate
shall be as specified in clauses (i), (ii), and (iii) above;
"(II) the rate shall not exceed 0.325 percent; and
"(III) the increase in the rate in any one year shall not
exceed 0.075 percent; and
"(vi) sufficient to ensure that for each member in each year
the assessment shall not be less than $1,000."
Subsec. (b)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2002(c)(1), inserted "or
subparagraph (C)(iii) or (D)(iii) of subsection (b)(1) of this
section" after "subsection (c)(2) of this section" in introductory
provisions.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2002(c)(2), inserted
"the greater of $500 or an amount" before "equal to the product of"
in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(i)(I). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2003(b)(1), (2),
struck out "annual" before "assessment" and inserted "during that
semiannual period" after "member".
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2002(c)(2), inserted
"the greater of $500 or an amount" before "equal to the product of"
in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (b)(2)(A)(ii)(I). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2003(b)(1), (3),
struck out "annual" before "assessment" and inserted "during that
semiannual period" after "member".
Subsec. (d)(1)(A). Pub. L. 101-508, Sec. 2003(c), amended subpar.
(A) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (A) read as follows: "By
September 30 of each calendar year, the Corporation shall prescribe
and publish the aggregate amount to be credited to insured
depository institutions in the succeeding calendar year."
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201, substituted references to
insured depository institutions for references to insured banks
wherever appearing in this section and references to Director of
the Office of Thrift Supervision for references to Federal Home
Loan Bank Board wherever appearing in this section.
Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 911(c), substituted
provisions for different and increasing levels of penalties, and
provisions regarding assessment and collection of penalties and
agency hearings, for provision at end that every such bank which
failed to make or publish any such report within 10 days would be
subject to a penalty of not more than $100 for each day of such
failure recoverable by the Corporation for its use.
Subsec. (a)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(1)(A)-(C), (E),
inserted references to Director of Office of Thrift Supervision,
Federal Housing Finance Board, and any Federal home loan bank in
two places, substituted "any of them" for "either of them", and
substituted "depository institution, and may furnish" for "State
nonmember bank (except a District bank), and may furnish".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(1)(D), which directed the amendment of
last sentence of subpar. (A) by inserting "or savings associations"
after "banks" could not be executed, because "banks" does not
appear in text.
Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(1)(F), added subpar.
(B) and struck out former subpar. (B) which read as follows: "The
Corporation shall have access to reports of examination made by,
and reports of condition made to, the Federal Home Loan Bank Board
or any Federal Home Loan Bank, respecting any insured Federal
savings bank, and the Corporation shall have access to all
revisions of reports of condition made to either such agency. Such
agency shall promptly advise the Corporation of any revisions or
changes in respect to deposit liabilities made or required to be
made in any report of condition."
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(2)(A), substituted "Each
insured depository institution shall make to the appropriate
Federal banking agency 4 reports" for "Each insured State nonmember
bank (except a District bank) and each foreign bank having an
insured branch (other than a Federal branch) shall make to the
Corporation, each insured national bank, each foreign bank having
an insured branch which is a Federal branch, and each insured
District bank shall make to the Comptroller of the Currency, each
insured State member bank shall make to the Federal Reserve bank of
which it is a member, and each insured Federal savings bank shall
make to the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, four reports".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(2)(B)-(D), substituted "depository
institution, the preceding" for "bank, the preceding", "depository
institution to make such" for "bank to make such", "depository
institution other than the officer" for "bank other than the
officer", "insured depository institution shall furnish to the
Corporation" for "insured national, District and State member bank
shall furnish to the Corporation", and "banks or savings
associations under its jurisdiction" for "banks under its
jurisdiction".
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(3), which directed the
substitution of references to depository institutions for
references to banks, except where "foreign bank" appeared, was
executed as directed, except that the exception was made for
"foreign banks" rather than "foreign bank", as the probable intent
of Congress.
Subsec. (a)(8). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 931(a), added par. (8).
Subsec. (b)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(4), added par. (1) and
struck out former par. (1) which read as follows: "The annual
assessment rate shall be one-twelfth of 1 per centum. Except as
provided in subsection (c)(2) of this section, the semiannual
assessment due from any insured bank for any semiannual period
shall be equal to one-half the annual assessment rate multiplied by
such bank's average assessment base for the immediately preceding
semiannual period."
Subsec. (b)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(4), added par. (2) and
struck out former par. (2) which read as follows: "For the purposes
of this section the term 'semiannual period' means a period
beginning on January 1 of any calendar year and ending on June 30
of the same year, or a period beginning on July 1 of any calendar
year and ending on December 31 of the same year."
Subsec. (b)(3) to (8). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(6), substituted
references to depository institutions for references to banks
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (c)(1) to (3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(7), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(5), amended subpar. (d)
generally, substituting provisions relating to computation,
applicability, definitions, etc., respecting assessment credits,
for provisions relating to transfer of net assessment income of
Corporation to capital account, pro rata credit to insured banks,
and adjustment of transferred income.
Subsecs. (e) to (g), (i). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(7),
substituted "depository institution" for "bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (j)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(8), struck out at end
"For purposes of this subsection, the term 'insured bank' shall
include any 'bank holding company', as that term is defined in
section 1841 of this title, which has control of any such insured
bank, and the appropriate Federal banking agency in the case of
bank holding companies shall be the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System."
Subsec. (j)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(9), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank" wherever appearing, and
substituted "default" for "failure".
Subsec. (j)(2)(D). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(10), inserted "unless
such agency determines that an emergency exists," after "banking
agency shall,".
Subsec. (j)(7)(F). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(11), added subpar.
(F).
Subsec. (j)(15). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 905(c), inserted at end
"The resignation, termination of employment or participation,
divestiture of control, or separation of or by an institution-
affiliated party (including a separation caused by the closing of
a depository institution) shall not affect the jurisdiction and
authority of the appropriate Federal banking agency to issue any
notice and proceed under this subsection against any such party, if
such notice is served before the end of the 6-year period beginning
on the date such party ceased to be such a party with respect to
such depository institution (whether such date occurs before, on,
or after the date of the enactment of this sentence)."
Subsec. (j)(16). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 907(d), amended par. (16)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (16) read as follows: "Any
person who willfully violates any provision of this subsection, or
any regulation or order issued by the appropriate Federal banking
agency pursuant thereto, shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty of
not more than $10,000 per day for each day during which such
violation continues. The appropriate Federal banking agency shall
have authority to assess such a civil penalty, after giving notice
and an opportunity to the person to submit data, views, and
arguments, and after giving due consideration to the
appropriateness of the penalty with respect to the size of
financial resources and good faith of the person charged, the
gravity of the violation, and any data, views, and arguments
submitted. The agency may collect such civil penalty by agreement
with the person or by bringing an action in the appropriate United
States district court, except that in any such action, the person
against whom the penalty has been assessed shall have a right to
trial de novo."
Subsec. (j)(17). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(12), amended par. (17)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (17) read as follows: "This
subsection shall not apply to a transaction subject to section 1842
or section 1828 of this title. This subsection shall not apply to
an insured Federal savings bank."
Subsec. (j)(18). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(13), added par. (18).
Subsec. (l). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(14), added subsec. (l).
Subsecs. (m), (n). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 208(15), added subsecs.
(m) and (n).
1987 - Subsec. (b)(9). Pub. L. 100-86 added par. (9).
1986 - Subsec. (j)(1). Pub. L. 99-570, Sec. 1360(a), substituted
"or, in the discretion of the agency, extending for an additional
30 days" for "or extending for up to another thirty days" in first
sentence, notwithstanding directory language that new wording be
substituted for "or extending up to another thirty days", and
amended second sentence generally. Prior to amendment, second
sentence read as follows: "The period for disapproval may be
further extended only if the agency determines that any acquiring
party has not furnished all the information required under
paragraph (6) of this subsection or that in its judgment any
material information submitted is substantially inaccurate".
Subsec. (j)(2). Pub. L. 99-570, Sec. 1360(b), (c), designated
existing provisions as subpar. (A) and added subpars. (B) to (D).
Subsec. (j)(15) to (16). Pub. L. 99-570, Sec. 1360(d), added par.
(15) and redesignated former pars. (15) and (16) as (16) and (17),
respectively.
1982 - Subsec. (a)(2). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(d), designated
existing provisions as subpar. (A) and added subpar. (B).
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(e), inserted the
reporting requirement for each insured Federal savings bank, added
the Chairman of the Federal Home Loan Bank Board to the group
designated to decide upon which dates the reports will be made, and
struck out alternative provision that such decision would be made
by a majority of such group.
Subsec. (a)(6). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(f), inserted ", the
Federal Home Loan Bank Board," after "Comptroller of the Currency".
Subsec. (d)(1)(4). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 117, added cl. (4).
Subsec. (j)(16). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(q), inserted provision
that this subsection shall not apply to an insured Federal savings
bank.
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 429, substituted requirement
that Federal banking agencies issue rules and regulations for
reports and public disclosure by banks of extensions of credits to
its executive officers or principal shareholders or the relative
interests of such persons for prior provisions: covering annual
reports of insured banks to Federal banking agencies containing
information respecting preceding calendar year listing names of
stockholders of record owning, controlling, or having more than a
10 per centum voting control of any class of voting securities of
the bank and also listing names of executive officers and
controlling stockholders and aggregate amount of extensions of
credit to such persons, any company controlled by such persons, and
any political or campaign committee the funds or services of which
will benefit such persons, or which is controlled by such persons;
defining an executive officer as one meant under section 375a of
this title; authorizing Federal banking agencies to issue rules and
regulations to require filed information to be included in any
required reports to be made available to the public upon request;
and requiring copies of any reports to be made publicly available
upon request.
1981 - Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 103(b)(1), inserted
"the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "American
Samoa,".
Subsec. (b)(5)(B). Pub. L. 97-110, Sec. 103(b)(2), inserted "the
Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "American Samoa,".
1980 - Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 96-221, Sec. 308(d), designated
existing provisions as par. (1), substituted "1980" for "1961" and
"40" for "33 1/3 ", and added par. (2).
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 96-221, Sec. 308(a)(1)(B), substituted
"$100,000" for "$40,000".
1978 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(8), inserted
"and each foreign bank having an insured branch which is not a
Federal branch" after "(except a District bank)".
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 302, substituted "the
signatures of at least two directors or trustees of the reporting
bank other than the officer making such declaration" for "the
signatures of at least three of the directors or trustees of the
reporting bank other than the officer making such declaration, or
by at least two if there are not more than three directors or
trustees".
Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(9), inserted "and each foreign bank
having an insured branch (other than a Federal branch)" after
"(except a District Bank)" and "each foreign bank having an insured
branch which is a Federal branch" after "each insured national
bank".
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 310(a), inserted provision
that deposits which are accumulated for payment of personal loans
and are assigned or pledged to assure payment of loans at maturity
not be included in total deposits in such reports, but shall be
deducted from loans for which such deposits are assigned or pledged
to assure repayment.
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 310(b), struck out "deposits
accumulated for the payment of personal loans," after "deposit-open
account,".
Subsec. (a)(7). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(10), added par. (7).
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(11), designated
existing provisions as subpar. (A), substituted "Except as provided
in subparagraph (B) of this paragraph, a bank's assessment base"
for "A bank's assessment base", and added subpar. (B).
Subsec. (b)(6). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 310(c), redesignated
subpars. (C) and (D) as (B) and (C) and struck out former subpar.
(B) which related to deposits included in reported deposit
liabilities which are accumulated for the payment of personal loans
and are assigned or pledged to assure repayment of the loans at
maturity.
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 602, amended subsec. (j)
generally, substituting provisions relating to the requirement that
no person shall acquire control of any insured bank unless the
appropriate Federal agency is notified 60 days prior to such
transfer and authorizing the appropriate Federal agency to approve
or disapprove such transfer for provisions relating to the
requirement that notification of a transfer of control of an
insured bank be given to the appropriate Federal agency after such
transfer.
Subsec. (j)(1). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(12), designated
existing provisions as subpar. (A), substituted "Except as provided
in subparagraph (B) of this paragraph, whenever" for "Whenever",
and added subpar. (B).
Subsec. (j)(2). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(13), designated
existing provisions as subpar. (A), substituted "Except as provided
in subparagraph (B) of this paragraph, whenever" for "Whenever",
and added subpars. (B) and (C).
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 901, added subsec. (k).
1974 - Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 93-495 inserted exception relating to
trust funds owned by a depositor referred to par. (2) of section
1821(a) of this title, and substituted "$40,000" for "$20,000".
1970 - Pub. L. 91-609 inserted reference to American Samoa in
subsecs. (a)(4) and (b)(5)(B), respectively.
1969 - Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 91-151 substituted $20,000 for
$15,000 in first sentence.
1966 - Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 301(b), substituted
"$15,000" for "$10,000" in first sentence.
Subsec. (j)(6). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 201, repealed par. (6)
definition of "appropriate Federal banking agency", now
incorporated in section 1813(q) of this title.
1964 - Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 88-593 added subsec. (j).
1960 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 2, amended subsec. (a)
generally, and among other changes, provided for reports of
condition, the form, contents, date of making, number, and
publication of the reports of condition, declaration and
attestation of officers, penalties, access to reports, computation
of deposit liabilities, segregation and classification of deposits
and definitions. Former provisions of the subsection relating to
rate and amount of assessment, assessment base and deductions
therefrom, form and contents of certified statements, and payment
of assessments, are either covered or superseded by provisions
incorporated in subsecs. (b)(1), (3), (4), (6) including the last
paragraph, and (c)(3) of this section.
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 2, amended subsec. (b)
generally, and among other changes, provided for the computation of
assessments, the rate and amount, the base, additions and
deductions, records and definition. Former provisions of the
subsection relating to filing of certified statements of assessment
base and amounts due and payment thereof are incorporated in
subsec. (c)(1) of this section.
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 2, inserted provisions of pars.
(1) and (3), incorporated in par. (2) the provisions of former
subsec. (c) relating to exemption from payment of assessment for
semiannual period in which bank became an insured bank and amount
of first semiannual assessment due, omitted therefrom the provision
for inclusion in the assessment base of the assumed liabilities for
deposits of other banks, and required the filing of certified
statement of the assessment base or the making of a special report
of condition.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 3, substituted "December 31,
1961" and "33 1/3 " for "December 31, 1960" and "40", respectively.
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 3, substituted "fails to make
any report of condition under subsection (a) of this section or to
file" for "fails to file" and inserted "make such report or" before
"file such statement".
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 3, substituted "made any such
report of condition under subsection (a) of this section or filed"
for "filed" and "to make any such report or file" for "to file" in
first sentence.
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 3, inserted "to make any report
of condition under subsection (a) of this section or" before "to
file".
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 86-671, Sec. 3, substituted "in its trust
department or held or deposited in any other department of the
fiduciary bank" for "in its trust or deposited in any other
department or in another bank" in first sentence and deleted
proviso respecting deposit liability of insured bank in which trust
funds are deposited rather than deposit liability of depositing
fiduciary bank from second sentence.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Amendment by sections 331(a) and 332 to 334(a) of Pub. L. 111-203
effective 1 day after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided,
see section 4 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note
under section 5301 of this title.
Amendment by section 363(2) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.
Amendment by section 939(a)(1) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 2
years after July 21, 2010, see section 939(g) of Pub. L. 111-203,
set out as a note under section 24a of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 2(b) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective Apr. 1,
2006, see section 2(e) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under
section 1785 of this title.
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(b), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3606,
provided that: "This section [amending this section and sections
1818, 1823, and 1834 of this title] and the amendments made by this
section shall take effect on the date that the final regulations
required under section 2109(a)(5) of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Reform Act of 2005 [Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Regulations note
below] take effect [Jan. 1, 2007, see 71 F.R. 69282]."
Amendment by section 8(a)(8), (9) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective
Mar. 31, 2006, see section 8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a
note under section 1813 of this title.
Amendment by section 2102(b) of Pub. L. 109-171 effective no
later than the first day of the first calendar quarter that begins
after the end of the 90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see
section 2102(c) of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and
SAIF note under section 1821 of this title.
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2104(e), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat.
14, provided that: "This section [amending this section and section
1828 of this title] and the amendments made by this section shall
take effect on the date that the final regulations required under
section 9(a)(5) [probably means section 2109(a)(5) of Pub. L. 109-
171, set out as a Regulations note below] take effect [Jan. 1,
2007, see 71 F.R. 69323]."
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2105(b), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat.
15, provided that: "This section [amending this section] and the
amendments made by this section shall take effect on the date that
the final regulations required under section 9(a)(1) [probably
means section 2109(a)(1) of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a
Regulations note below] take effect [Jan. 1, 2007, see 71 F.R.
69323]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2004 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 108-386 effective Oct. 30, 2004, and, except
as otherwise provided, applicable with respect to fiscal year 2005
and each succeeding fiscal year, see sections 8(i) and 9 of Pub. L.
108-386, set out as notes under section 321 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2000 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 106-569, title XII, Sec. 1231(b), Dec. 27, 2000, 114
Stat. 3037, provided that: "The amendments made by subsection (a)
[amending this section] shall be deemed to have the same effective
date as section 2707 of the Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996
(Public Law 104-208; 110 Stat. 3009-496)."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 2703(b) of Pub. L. 104-208 applicable with
respect to semiannual periods which begin after Dec. 31, 1996, see
section 2703(c)(1) of Pub. L. 104-208, set out as an Effective and
Termination Dates of 1996 Amendment note under section 1441 of this
title.
Amendment by section 2704(d)(6)(B), (14)(G) of Pub. L. 104-208
effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no insured depository institution is a
savings association on that date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L.
104-208, formerly set out as a note under section 1821 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1993 AMENDMENT
Section 8(h) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that the amendment made
by that section is effective on the effective date of the amendment
made by section 302(a) of Pub. L. 102-242. See Effective Date of
1991 Amendment note below.
Section 38(a) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that the amendment made
by that section is effective Dec. 19, 1993.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Section 303(b)(7) of Pub. L. 102-558 provided that the amendment
made by that section is effective on the effective date of the
amendment made by section 302(a) of Pub. L. 102-242. See Effective
Date of 1991 Amendment note below.
Section 303(b)(8) of Pub. L. 102-558 provided that the amendment
made by that section is effective on the effective date of the
amendment made by section 302(e)(4) of Pub. L. 102-242. See
Effective Date of 1991 Amendment note below.
Amendment by section 303(a), (b)(1), (3), (6)(A) of Pub. L. 102-
558 deemed to have become effective Mar. 1, 1992, see section 304
of Pub. L. 102-558, set out as a note under section 2062 of Title
50, Appendix, War and National Defense.
Sections 1603(a)(3) and 1605(a)(6) of Pub. L. 102-550, which
provided effective date provisions for the amendments made by those
sections, were repealed, effective Oct. 28, 1992, by section 305 of
Pub. L. 102-558, set out as a Repeal of Duplicative Provisions note
under section 1815 of this title.
Section 1605(b)(2) of Pub. L. 102-550 provided that the amendment
made by that section is effective on the effective date of the
amendment made by section 302(b) of Pub. L. 102-242. See Effective
Date of 1991 Amendment note below.
Amendment by sections 1603(a)(1), 1604(b)(1), (3), 1605(a)(2),
(5)(A), (b)(1), 1606(i)(1) of Pub. L. 102-550 effective as if
included in the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement
Act of 1991, Pub. L. 102-242, as of Dec. 19, 1991, except that
where amendment is to any provision of law added or amended by Pub.
L. 102-242 effective after Dec. 19, 1992, then amendment by Pub. L.
102-550 effective on effective date of amendment by Pub. L. 102-
242, see section 1609 of Pub. L. 102-550, set out as a note under
section 191 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Section 302(g) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "The amendments
made by this section [amending this section and sections 1815,
1818, and 1820 of this title] shall become effective on the earlier
of -
"(1) 180 days after the date on which final regulations
promulgated in accordance with subsection (c) [set out below]
become effective [Final regulations became effective Oct. 1,
1993. See 58 F.R. 34357.]; or
"(2) January 1, 1994."
Amendment by section 311(a)(2), (b)(3) of Pub. L. 102-242
effective at end of 2-year period beginning Dec. 19, 1991, but not
applicable to any time deposit which was made before Dec. 19, 1991,
and matures after end of 2-year period beginning on Dec. 19, 1991,
with rollovers and renewals treated as new deposits, see section
311(c)(1), (2) of Pub. L. 102-242, set out as a note under section
1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1989 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 907(d) of Pub. L. 101-73 applicable to
conduct engaged in after Aug. 9, 1989, except that increased
maximum penalties of $5,000 and $25,000 may apply to conduct
engaged in before such date if such conduct is not already subject
to a notice issued by the appropriate agency and occurred after
completion of the last report of the examination of the institution
by the appropriate agency occurring before Aug. 9, 1989, see
section 907(l) of Pub. L. 101-73, set out as a note under section
93 of this title.
Amendment by section 911(c) of Pub. L. 101-73 applicable with
respect to reports filed or required to be filed after Aug. 9,
1989, see section 911(i) of Pub. L. 101-73, set out as a note under
section 161 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1986 AMENDMENT
Section 1364(f) of Pub. L. 99-570 provided that: "The amendments
made by sections 1360 and 1361 [amending this section and section
1730 of this title] shall apply with respect to notices of proposed
acquisitions filed after the date of the enactment of this Act
[Oct. 27, 1986]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1982 AMENDMENT
Section 430 of Pub. L. 97-320 provided that: "The provision of
law amended by section 428(b) [amending section 1972 of this title]
and section 429 [amending this section] shall remain in effect
until the regulations referred to in such amendments become
effective."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1980 AMENDMENT
Section 308(e) of Pub. L. 96-221 provided that: "The amendments
made by this section [amending this section and sections 1724,
1728, 1787, 1813, and 1821 of this title] shall take effect on the
date of enactment of this Act [Mar. 31, 1980]."
Amendment by section 308(a)(1)(B) of Pub. L. 96-221 not
applicable to any claim arising out of the closing of a bank prior
to the effective date of section 308 of Pub. L. 96-221, Mar. 31,
1980, see section 308(a)(2) of Pub. L. 96-221, set out as a note
under section 1813 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 95-630 effective upon expiration of 120 days
after Nov. 10, 1978, see section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as
an Effective Date note under section 375b of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1974 AMENDMENT
For effective date of amendment by section 101(a)(2) of Pub. L.
93-495, see section 101(g) of Pub. L. 93-495, set out as a note
under section 1813 of this title.
For effective date of amendment by section 102(a)(2) of Pub. L.
93-495, see section 102(b), (c) of Pub. L. 93-495, set out as a
note under section 1813 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1969 AMENDMENT
For effective date of amendment by Pub. L. 91-151, see section
7(b) of Pub. L. 91-151, set out as a note under section 1813 of
this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1966 AMENDMENT
For effective date of amendment by section 301(b) of Pub. L. 89-
695, see section 301(e) of Pub. L. 89-695, set out as a note under
section 1813 of this title.

EXPIRATION OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 908, Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811,
repealed section 401 of Pub. L. 89-695 which had provided that:
"The provisions of titles I and II of this Act [amending this
section and sections 1464, 1730, 1813, 1818 to 1820 of this title,
repealing section 77 of this title, and enacting provisions set out
as notes under sections 1464, 1730, and 1813 of this title] and any
provisions of law enacted by said titles shall be effective only
during the period ending at the close of June 30, 1972. Effective
upon the expiration of such period, each provision of law amended
by either of such titles is further amended to read as it did
immediately prior to the enactment of this Act [Oct. 16, 1966] and
each provision of law repealed by either of such titles is
reenacted."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1960 AMENDMENT
Section 7 of Pub. L. 86-671 provided that: "The amendments made
by this Act [amending this section and sections 161, 1813, 1820 and
repealing section 162 of this title] shall take effect on January
1, 1961, except that the certified statements covering the
semiannual period ending December 31, 1960, and the determination
and payment of assessments (for the semiannual period ending June
30, 1961) required to be certified in such statements, shall be
made as if such amendments were not in effect."

SHORT TITLE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
For short title of title VI of Pub. L. 95-630 as the "Change in
Bank Control Act of 1978", see section 601 of Pub. L. 95-630, set
out as a note under section 1811 of this title.

REGULATIONS
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 331(b), July 21, 2010, 124 Stat.
1538, provided that: "The Corporation shall amend the regulations
issued by the Corporation under section 7(b)(2) of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1817(b)(2)) to define the term
'assessment base' with respect to an insured depository institution
for purposes of that section 7(b)(2), as an amount equal to -
"(1) the average consolidated total assets of the insured
depository institution during the assessment period; minus
"(2) the sum of -
"(A) the average tangible equity of the insured depository
institution during the assessment period; and
"(B) in the case of an insured depository institution that is
a custodial bank (as defined by the Corporation, based on
factors including the percentage of total revenues generated by
custodial businesses and the level of assets under custody) or
a banker's bank (as that term is used in section 5136 of the
Revised Statutes (12 U.S.C. 24)), an amount that the
Corporation determines is necessary to establish assessments
consistent with the definition under section 7(b)(1) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. 1817(b)(1)) for a
custodial bank or a banker's bank."
[For definitions of terms used in section 331(b) of Pub. L. 111-
203, set out above, see section 5301 of this title.]
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2109, Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 20,
provided that:
"(a) In General. - Not later than 270 days after the date of the
enactment of this Act [Feb. 8, 2006], the Board of Directors of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation shall prescribe final
regulations, after notice and opportunity for comment -
"(1) designating the reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance
Fund in accordance with section 7(b)(3) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1817(b)(3)] (as amended by section 2105
of this subtitle);
"(2) implementing increases in deposit insurance coverage in
accordance with the amendments made by section 2103 of this
subtitle [amending 12 U.S.C. 1821];
"(3) implementing the dividend requirement under section
7(e)(2) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1817(e)(2)] (as amended by section 2107 of this subtitle);
"(4) implementing the 1-time assessment credit to certain
insured depository institutions in accordance with section
7(e)(3) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1817(e)(3)], as amended by section 2107 of this subtitle,
including the qualifications and procedures under which the
Corporation would apply assessment credits; and
"(5) providing for assessments under section 7(b) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1817(b)], as amended by
this subtitle.
"(b) Transition Provisions. -
"(1) Continuation of existing assessment regulations. - No
provision of this subtitle [subtitle B (Secs. 2101-2109) of title
II of Pub. L. 109-171, see Short Title of 2006 Amendment note set
out under section 1811 of this title] or any amendment made by
this subtitle shall be construed as affecting the authority of
the Corporation to set or collect deposit insurance assessments
pursuant to any regulations in effect before the effective date
of the final regulations prescribed under subsection (a).
"(2) Treatment of dif members under existing regulations. - As
of the date of the merger of the Bank Insurance Fund and the
Savings Association Insurance Fund pursuant to section 2102
[section 2102 of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and
SAIF note under section 1821 of this title], the assessment
regulations in effect immediately before the date of the
enactment of this Act [Feb. 8, 2006] shall continue to apply to
all members of the Deposit Insurance Fund, until such regulations
are modified by the Corporation, notwithstanding that such
regulations may refer to 'Bank Insurance Fund members' or
'Savings Association Insurance Fund members'."
Section 302(c) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "To implement
the risk-based assessment system required under section 7(b) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1817(b)] (as amended by
subsection (a)), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation shall -
"(1) provide notice of proposed regulations in the Federal
Register, not later than December 31, 1992, with an opportunity
for comment on the proposal of not less than 120 days; and
"(2) promulgate final regulations not later than July 1, 1993."
Section 302(f) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "To carry out
the amendments made by this section [amending this section and
sections 1815, 1818, and 1820 of this title], the Corporation may
promulgate regulations governing the transition from the assessment
system in effect on the date of enactment of this Act [Dec. 19,
1991] to the assessment system required under the amendments made
by this section."

TRANSITION RESERVE RATIO REQUIREMENTS TO REFLECT NEW ASSESSMENT
BASE
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 334(c)-(e), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1539, provided that:
"(c) For a period of not less than 5 years after the date of the
enactment of this title [July 21, 2010], the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation shall make available to the public the
reserve ratio and the designated reserve ratio using both estimated
insured deposits and the assessment base under [former] section
7(b)(2)(C) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1817(b)(2) does not contain a subpar. (C)].
"(d) Reserve Ratio. - Notwithstanding the timing requirements of
section 7(b)(3)(E)(ii) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12
U.S.C. 1817(b)(3)(E)(ii)], the Corporation shall take such steps as
may be necessary for the reserve ratio of the Deposit Insurance
Fund to reach 1.35 percent of estimated insured deposits by
September 30, 2020.
"(e) Offset. - In setting the assessments necessary to meet the
requirements of subsection (d), the Corporation shall offset the
effect of subsection (d) on insured depository institutions with
total consolidated assets of less than $10,000,000,000."
[For definitions of terms used in section 334(c)-(e) of Pub. L.
111-203, set out above, see section 5301 of this title.]


-TRANS-
TERMINATION OF TRUST TERRITORY OF THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
For termination of Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, see
note set out preceding section 1681 of Title 48, Territories and
Insular Possessions.


-MISC2-
REPORT TO CONGRESS ON REFUNDS, DIVIDENDS, AND CREDITS FROM DEPOSIT
INSURANCE FUND
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 5, Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3606, required
that any determination under former subsection (e)(2)(E) of this
section be submitted to the Committee on Banking, Housing, and
Urban Affairs of the Senate and the Committee on Financial Services
of the House of Representatives not later than 270 days after
making such determination and provided that the report submitted
include a detailed explanation for the determination and a
discussion of the factors required to be considered under former
subsection (e)(2)(F) of this section.

SPECIAL ASSESSMENT TO CAPITALIZE SAIF
Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2702, Sept. 30, 1996, 110
Stat. 3009-479, provided that the Board of Directors of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation was to impose a special assessment on
the SAIF-assessable deposits of each insured depository institution
in accordance with assessment regulations of the Corporation at a
rate applicable to all such institutions that the Board of
Directors determined would cause the Savings Association Insurance
Fund to achieve the designated reserve ratio on the first business
day of the 1st month beginning after Sept. 30, 1996.

SMALL BUSINESS AND SMALL FARM LOAN INFORMATION
Section 122 of Pub. L. 102-242, as amended by Pub. L. 102-550,
title XVI, Sec. 1603(c), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4079, provided
that:
"(a) In General. - Before the end of the 180-day period beginning
on the date of the enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991], the
appropriate Federal banking agency shall prescribe regulations
requiring insured depository institutions to annually submit
information on small businesses and small farm lending in their
reports of condition.
"(b) Credit Availability. - The regulations prescribed under
subsection (a) shall require insured depository institutions to
submit such information as the agency may need to assess the
availability of credit to small businesses and small farms.
"(c) Contents. - The information required under subsection (a)
may include information regarding the following:
"(1) The total number and aggregate dollar amount of commercial
loans and commercial mortgage loans to small businesses.
"(2) Charge-offs, interest, and interest fee income on
commercial loans and commercial mortgage loans to small
businesses.
"(3) Agricultural loans to small farms."

CONDITIONS GOVERNING EMPLOYMENT OF PERSONNEL NOT REPEALED,
MODIFIED, OR AFFECTED
Nothing contained in section 201 of Pub. L. 89-695, which amended
this section, to be construed as repealing, modifying, or affecting
section 1829 of this title, see section 206 of Pub. L. 89-695, set
out as a note under section 1813 of this title.

-FOOTNOTE-

(!1) See References in Text note below.

(!2) So in original. Par. (2) does not contain a subpar. (C).



(!3) So in original. Probably should be followed be a period.

(!4) So in original. Probably should be "depository
institution".


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1818 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1818. Termination of status as insured depository institution

-STATUTE-
(a) Termination of insurance
(1) Voluntary termination
Any insured depository institution which is not -
(A) a national member bank;
(B) a State member bank;
(C) a Federal branch;
(D) a Federal savings association; or
(E) an insured branch which is required to be insured under
subsection (a) or (b) (!1) of section 3104 of this title,


may terminate such depository institution's status as an insured
depository institution if such insured institution provides
written notice to the Corporation of the institution's intent to
terminate such status not less than 90 days before the effective
date of such termination.
(2) Involuntary termination
(A) Notice to primary regulator
If the Board of Directors determines that -
(i) an insured depository institution or the directors or
trustees of an insured depository institution have engaged or
are engaging in unsafe or unsound practices in conducting the
business of the depository institution;
(ii) an insured depository institution is in an unsafe or
unsound condition to continue operations as an insured
institution; or
(iii) an insured depository institution or the directors or
trustees of the insured institution have violated any
applicable law, regulation, order, condition imposed in
writing by the Corporation in connection with the approval of
any application or other request by the insured depository
institution, or written agreement entered into between the
insured depository institution and the Corporation,

the Board of Directors shall notify the appropriate Federal
banking agency with respect to such institution (if other than
the Corporation) or the State banking supervisor of such
institution (if the Corporation is the appropriate Federal
banking agency) of the Board's determination and the facts and
circumstances on which such determination is based for the
purpose of securing the correction of such practice, condition,
or violation. Such notice shall be given to the appropriate
Federal banking agency not less than 30 days before the notice
required by subparagraph (B), except that this period for
notice to the appropriate Federal banking agency may be reduced
or eliminated with the agreement of such agency.
(B) Notice of intention to terminate insurance
If, after giving the notice required under subparagraph (A)
with respect to an insured depository institution, the Board of
Directors determines that any unsafe or unsound practice or
condition or any violation specified in such notice requires
the termination of the insured status of the insured depository
institution, the Board shall -
(i) serve written notice to the insured depository
institution of the Board's intention to terminate the insured
status of the institution;
(ii) provide the insured depository institution with a
statement of the charges on the basis of which the
determination to terminate such institution's insured status
was made (or a copy of the notice under subparagraph (A));
and
(iii) notify the insured depository institution of the date
(not less than 30 days after notice under this subparagraph)
and place for a hearing before the Board of Directors (or any
person designated by the Board) with respect to the
termination of the institution's insured status.
(3) Hearing; termination
If, on the basis of the evidence presented at a hearing before
the Board of Directors (or any person designated by the Board for
such purpose), in which all issues shall be determined on the
record pursuant to section 554 of title 5 and the written
findings of the Board of Directors (or such person) with respect
to such evidence (which shall be conclusive), the Board of
Directors finds that any unsafe or unsound practice or condition
or any violation specified in the notice to an insured depository
institution under paragraph (2)(B) or subsection (w) of this
section has been established, the Board of Directors may issue an
order terminating the insured status of such depository
institution effective as of a date subsequent to such finding.
(4) Appearance; consent to termination
Unless the depository institution shall appear at the hearing
by a duly authorized representative, it shall be deemed to have
consented to the termination of its status as an insured
depository institution and termination of such status thereupon
may be ordered.
(5) Judicial review
Any insured depository institution whose insured status has
been terminated by order of the Board of Directors under this
subsection shall have the right of judicial review of such order
only to the same extent as provided for the review of orders
under subsection (h) of this section.
(6) Publication of notice of termination
The Corporation may publish notice of such termination and the
depository institution shall give notice of such termination to
each of its depositors at his last address of record on the books
of the depository institution, in such manner and at such time as
the Board of Directors may find to be necessary and may order for
the protection of depositors.
(7) Temporary insurance of deposits insured as of termination
After the termination of the insured status of any depository
institution under the provisions of this subsection, the insured
deposits of each depositor in the depository institution on the
date of such termination, less all subsequent withdrawals from
any deposits of such depositor, shall continue for a period of at
least 6 months or up to 2 years, within the discretion of the
Board of Directors, to be insured, and the depository institution
shall continue to pay to the Corporation assessments as in the
case of an insured depository institution during such period. No
additions to any such deposits and no new deposits in such
depository institution made after the date of such termination
shall be insured by the Corporation, and the depository
institution shall not advertise or hold itself out as having
insured deposits unless in the same connection it shall also
state with equal prominence that such additions to deposits and
new deposits made after such date are not so insured. Such
depository institution shall, in all other respects, be subject
to the duties and obligations of an insured depository
institution for the period referred to in the 1st sentence from
the date of such termination, and in the event that such
depository institution shall be closed on account of inability to
meet the demands of its depositors within such period, the
Corporation shall have the same powers and rights with respect to
such depository institution as in case of an insured depository
institution.
(8) Temporary suspension of insurance
(A) In general
If the Board of Directors initiates a termination proceeding
under paragraph (2), and the Board of Directors, after
consultation with the appropriate Federal banking agency, finds
that an insured depository institution (other than a savings
association to which subparagraph (B) applies) has no tangible
capital under the capital guidelines or regulations of the
appropriate Federal banking agency, the Corporation may issue a
temporary order suspending deposit insurance on all deposits
received by the institution.
(B) Special rule for certain savings institutions
(i) Certain goodwill included in tangible capital
In determining the tangible capital of a savings
association for purposes of this paragraph, the Board of
Directors shall include goodwill to the extent it is
considered a component of capital under section 1464(t) of
this title. Any savings association which would be subject to
a suspension order under subparagraph (A) but for the
operation of this subparagraph, shall be considered by the
Corporation to be a "special supervisory association".
(ii) Suspension order
The Corporation may issue a temporary order suspending
deposit insurance on all deposits received by a special
supervisory association whenever the Board of Directors
determines that -
(I) the capital of such association, as computed
utilizing applicable accounting standards, has suffered a
material decline;
(II) that such association (or its directors or officers)
is engaging in an unsafe or unsound practice in conducting
the business of the association;
(III) that such association is in an unsafe or unsound
condition to continue operating as an insured association;
or
(IV) that such association (or its directors or officers)
has violated any applicable law, rule, regulation, or
order, or any condition imposed in writing by a Federal
banking agency, or any written agreement including a
capital improvement plan entered into with any Federal
banking agency, or that the association has failed to enter
into a capital improvement plan which is acceptable to the
Corporation within the time period set forth in section
1464(t) of this title.

Nothing in this paragraph limits the right of the Corporation
or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision to
enforce a contractual provision which authorizes the
Corporation or the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, as a successor to the Federal Savings and Loan
Insurance Corporation or the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, to
require a savings association to write down or amortize
goodwill at a faster rate than otherwise required under this
chapter or under applicable accounting standards.
(C) Effective period of temporary order
Any order issued under subparagraph (A) shall become
effective not earlier than 10 days from the date of service
upon the institution and, unless set aside, limited, or
suspended by a court in proceedings authorized hereunder, such
temporary order shall remain effective and enforceable until an
order of the Board under paragraph (3) becomes final or until
the Corporation dismisses the proceedings under paragraph (3).
(D) Judicial review
Before the close of the 10-day period beginning on the date
any temporary order has been served upon an insured depository
institution under subparagraph (A), such institution may apply
to the United States District Court for the District of
Columbia, or the United States district court for the judicial
district in which the home office of the institution is
located, for an injunction setting aside, limiting, or
suspending the enforcement, operation, or effectiveness of such
order, and such court shall have jurisdiction to issue such
injunction.
(E) Continuation of insurance for prior deposits
The insured deposits of each depositor in such depository
institution on the effective date of the order issued under
this paragraph, minus all subsequent withdrawals from any
deposits of such depositor, shall continue to be insured,
subject to the administrative proceedings as provided in this
chapter.
(F) Publication of order
The depository institution shall give notice of such order to
each of its depositors in such manner and at such times as the
Board of Directors may find to be necessary and may order for
the protection of depositors.
(G) Notice by Corporation
If the Corporation determines that the depository institution
has not substantially complied with the notice to depositors
required by the Board of Directors, the Corporation may provide
such notice in such manner as the Board of Directors may find
to be necessary and appropriate.
(H) Lack of notice
Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), any deposit made after the
effective date of a suspension order issued under this
paragraph shall remain insured to the extent that the depositor
establishes that -
(i) such deposit consists of additions made by automatic
deposit the depositor was unable to prevent; or
(ii) such depositor did not have actual knowledge of the
suspension of insurance.
(9) Final decisions to terminate insurance
Any decision by the Board of Directors to -
(A) issue a temporary order terminating deposit insurance; or
(B) issue a final order terminating deposit insurance (other
than under subsection (p) or (q) of this section);

shall be made by the Board of Directors and may not be delegated.
(10) Low- to moderate-income housing lender
In making any determination regarding the termination of
insurance of a solvent savings association, the Corporation may
consider the extent of the association's low- to moderate-income
housing loans.
(b) Cease-and-desist proceedings
(1) If, in the opinion of the appropriate Federal banking agency,
any insured depository institution, depository institution which
has insured deposits, or any institution-affiliated party is
engaging or has engaged, or the agency has reasonable cause to
believe that the depository institution or any institution-
affiliated party is about to engage, in an unsafe or unsound
practice in conducting the business of such depository institution,
or is violating or has violated, or the agency has reasonable cause
to believe that the depository institution or any institution-
affiliated party is about to violate, a law, rule, or regulation,
or any condition imposed in writing by a Federal banking agency in
connection with any action on any application, notice, or other
request by the depository institution or institution-affiliated
party, or any written agreement entered into with the agency, the
appropriate Federal banking agency for the depository institution
may issue and serve upon the depository institution or such party a
notice of charges in respect thereof. The notice shall contain a
statement of the facts constituting the alleged violation or
violations or the unsafe or unsound practice or practices, and
shall fix a time and place at which a hearing will be held to
determine whether an order to cease and desist therefrom should
issue against the depository institution or the institution-
affiliated party. Such hearing shall be fixed for a date not
earlier than thirty days nor later than sixty days after service of
such notice unless an earlier or a later date is set by the agency
at the request of any party so served. Unless the party or parties
so served shall appear at the hearing personally or by a duly
authorized representative, they shall be deemed to have consented
to the issuance of the cease-and-desist order. In the event of such
consent, or if upon the record made at any such hearing, the agency
shall find that any violation or unsafe or unsound practice
specified in the notice of charges has been established, the agency
may issue and serve upon the depository institution or the
institution-affiliated party an order to cease and desist from any
such violation or practice. Such order may, by provisions which may
be mandatory or otherwise, require the depository institution or
its institution-affiliated parties to cease and desist from the
same, and, further, to take affirmative action to correct the
conditions resulting from any such violation or practice.
(2) A cease-and-desist order shall become effective at the
expiration of thirty days after the service of such order upon the
depository institution or other person concerned (except in the
case of a cease-and-desist order issued upon consent, which shall
become effective at the time specified therein), and shall remain
effective and enforceable as provided therein, except to such
extent as it is stayed, modified, terminated, or set aside by
action of the agency or a reviewing court.
(3) This subsection, subsections (c) through (s) and subsection
(u) of this section, and section 1831aa of this title shall apply
to any bank holding company, and to any subsidiary (other than a
bank) of a bank holding company, as those terms are defined in the
Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 [12 U.S.C. 1841 et seq.], and to
any organization organized and operated under section 25(a) (!2) of
the Federal Reserve Act [12 U.S.C. 611 et seq.] or operating under
section 25 of the Federal Reserve Act [12 U.S.C. 601 et seq.], in
the same manner as they apply to a State member insured bank.
Nothing in this subsection or in subsection (c) of this section
shall authorize any Federal banking agency, other than the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System, to issue a notice of
charges or cease-and-desist order against a bank holding company or
any subsidiary thereof (other than a bank or subsidiary of that
bank).

(4) This subsection, subsections (c) through (s) and subsection
(u) of this section, and section 1831aa of this title shall apply
to any foreign bank or company to which subsection (a) of section
3106 of this title applies and to any subsidiary (other than a
bank) of any such foreign bank or company in the same manner as
they apply to a bank holding company and any subsidiary thereof
(other than a bank) under paragraph (3) of this subsection. For the
purposes of this paragraph, the term "subsidiary" shall have the
meaning assigned to it in section 2 of the Bank Holding Company Act
of 1956 [12 U.S.C. 1841].
(5) This section shall apply, in the same manner as it applies to
any insured depository institution for which the appropriate
Federal banking agency is the Comptroller of the Currency, to any
national banking association chartered by the Comptroller of the
Currency, including an uninsured association.
(6) Affirmative action to correct conditions resulting from
violations or practices. - The authority to issue an order under
this subsection and subsection (c) of this section which requires
an insured depository institution or any institution-affiliated
party to take affirmative action to correct or remedy any
conditions resulting from any violation or practice with respect to
which such order is issued includes the authority to require such
depository institution or such party to -
(A) make restitution or provide reimbursement, indemnification,
or guarantee against loss if -
(i) such depository institution or such party was unjustly
enriched in connection with such violation or practice; or
(ii) the violation or practice involved a reckless disregard
for the law or any applicable regulations or prior order of the
appropriate Federal banking agency;

(B) restrict the growth of the institution;
(C) dispose of any loan or asset involved;
(D) rescind agreements or contracts; and
(E) employ qualified officers or employees (who may be subject
to approval by the appropriate Federal banking agency at the
direction of such agency); and
(F) take such other action as the banking agency determines to
be appropriate.

(7) Authority to limit activities. - The authority to issue an
order under this subsection or subsection (c) of this section
includes the authority to place limitations on the activities or
functions of an insured depository institution or any institution-
affiliated party.
(8) Unsatisfactory asset quality, management, earnings, or
liquidity as unsafe or unsound practice. - If an insured depository
institution receives, in its most recent report of examination, a
less-than-satisfactory rating for asset quality, management,
earnings, or liquidity, the appropriate Federal banking agency may
(if the deficiency is not corrected) deem the institution to be
engaging in an unsafe or unsound practice for purposes of this
subsection.
(9) Expansion of authority to savings and loan affiliates and
entities. - Subsections (a) through (s) of this section and
subsection (u) of this section shall apply to any savings and loan
holding company and to any subsidiary (other than a bank or
subsidiary of that bank) of a savings and loan holding
company,,(!3) whether wholly or partly owned, in the same manner as
such subsections apply to a savings association.

(10) Standard for certain orders. - No authority under this
subsection or subsection (c) of this section to prohibit any
institution-affiliated party from withdrawing, transferring,
removing, dissipating, or disposing of any funds, assets, or other
property may be exercised unless the appropriate Federal banking
agency meets the standards of Rule 65 of the Federal Rules of Civil
Procedure, without regard to the requirement of such rule that the
applicant show that the injury, loss, or damage is irreparable and
immediate.
(c) Temporary cease-and-desist orders
(1) Whenever the appropriate Federal banking agency shall
determine that the violation or threatened violation or the unsafe
or unsound practice or practices, specified in the notice of
charges served upon the depository institution or any institution-
affiliated party pursuant to paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of
this section, or the continuation thereof, is likely to cause
insolvency or significant dissipation of assets or earnings of the
depository institution, or is likely to weaken the condition of the
depository institution or otherwise prejudice the interests of its
depositors prior to the completion of the proceedings conducted
pursuant to paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of this section, the
agency may issue a temporary order requiring the depository
institution or such party to cease and desist from any such
violation or practice and to take affirmative action to prevent or
remedy such insolvency, dissipation, condition, or prejudice
pending completion of such proceedings. Such order may include any
requirement authorized under subsection (b)(6) of this section.
Such order shall become effective upon service upon the depository
institution or such institution-affiliated party and, unless set
aside, limited, or suspended by a court in proceedings authorized
by paragraph (2) of this subsection, shall remain effective and
enforceable pending the completion of the administrative
proceedings pursuant to such notice and until such time as the
agency shall dismiss the charges specified in such notice, or if a
cease-and-desist order is issued against the depository institution
or such party, until the effective date of such order.
(2) Within ten days after the depository institution concerned or
any institution-affiliated party has been served with a temporary
cease-and-desist order, the depository institution or such party
may apply to the United States district court for the judicial
district in which the home office of the depository institution is
located, or the United States District Court for the District of
Columbia, for an injunction setting aside, limiting, or suspending
the enforcement, operation, or effectiveness of such order pending
the completion of the administrative proceedings pursuant to the
notice of charges served upon the depository institution or such
party under paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of this section, and
such court shall have jurisdiction to issue such injunction.
(3) Incomplete or inaccurate records. -
(A) Temporary order. - If a notice of charges served under
subsection (b)(1) of this section specifies, on the basis of
particular facts and circumstances, that an insured depository
institution's books and records are so incomplete or inaccurate
that the appropriate Federal banking agency is unable, through
the normal supervisory process, to determine the financial
condition of that depository institution or the details or
purpose of any transaction or transactions that may have a
material effect on the financial condition of that depository
institution, the agency may issue a temporary order requiring -
(i) the cessation of any activity or practice which gave
rise, whether in whole or in part, to the incomplete or
inaccurate state of the books or records; or
(ii) affirmative action to restore such books or records to a
complete and accurate state, until the completion of the
proceedings under subsection (b)(1) of this section.

(B) Effective period. - Any temporary order issued under
subparagraph (A) -
(i) shall become effective upon service; and
(ii) unless set aside, limited, or suspended by a court in
proceedings under paragraph (2), shall remain in effect and
enforceable until the earlier of -
(I) the completion of the proceeding initiated under
subsection (b)(1) of this section in connection with the
notice of charges; or
(II) the date the appropriate Federal banking agency
determines, by examination or otherwise, that the insured
depository institution's books and records are accurate and
reflect the financial condition of the depository
institution.

(4) False advertising or misuse of names to indicate insured
status. -
(A) Temporary order. -
(i) In general. - If a notice of charges served under
subsection (b)(1) specifies on the basis of particular facts
that any person engaged or is engaging in conduct described in
section 1828(a)(4) of this title, the Corporation or other
appropriate Federal banking agency may issue a temporary order
requiring -
(I) the immediate cessation of any activity or practice
described, which gave rise to the notice of charges; and
(II) affirmative action to prevent any further, or to
remedy any existing, violation.

(ii) Effect of order. - Any temporary order issued under this
subparagraph shall take effect upon service.

(B) Effective period of temporary order. - A temporary order
issued under subparagraph (A) shall remain effective and
enforceable, pending the completion of an administrative
proceeding pursuant to subsection (b)(1) in connection with the
notice of charges -
(i) until such time as the Corporation or other appropriate
Federal banking agency dismisses the charges specified in such
notice; or
(ii) if a cease-and-desist order is issued against such
person, until the effective date of such order.

(C) Civil money penalties. - Any violation of section
1828(a)(4) of this title shall be subject to civil money
penalties, as set forth in subsection (i), except that for any
person other than an insured depository institution or an
institution-affiliated party that is found to have violated this
paragraph, the Corporation or other appropriate Federal banking
agency shall not be required to demonstrate any loss to an
insured depository institution.
(d) Temporary cease-and-desist orders; enforcement
In the case of violation or threatened violation of, or failure
to obey, a temporary cease-and-desist order issued pursuant to
paragraph (1) of subsection (c) of this section, the appropriate
Federal banking agency may apply to the United States district
court, or the United States court of any territory, within the
jurisdiction of which the home office of the depository institution
is located, for an injunction to enforce such order, and, if the
court shall determine that there has been such violation or
threatened violation or failure to obey, it shall be the duty of
the court to issue such injunction.
(e) Removal and prohibition authority
(1) Authority to issue order. - Whenever the appropriate Federal
banking agency determines that -
(A) any institution-affiliated party has, directly or
indirectly -
(i) violated -
(I) any law or regulation;
(II) any cease-and-desist order which has become final;
(III) any condition imposed in writing by a Federal banking
agency in connection with any action on any application,
notice, or request by such depository institution or
institution-affiliated party; or
(IV) any written agreement between such depository
institution and such agency;

(ii) engaged or participated in any unsafe or unsound
practice in connection with any insured depository institution
or business institution; or
(iii) committed or engaged in any act, omission, or practice
which constitutes a breach of such party's fiduciary duty;

(B) by reason of the violation, practice, or breach described
in any clause of subparagraph (A) -
(i) such insured depository institution or business
institution has suffered or will probably suffer financial loss
or other damage;
(ii) the interests of the insured depository institution's
depositors have been or could be prejudiced; or
(iii) such party has received financial gain or other benefit
by reason of such violation, practice, or breach; and

(C) such violation, practice, or breach -
(i) involves personal dishonesty on the part of such party;
or
(ii) demonstrates willful or continuing disregard by such
party for the safety or soundness of such insured depository
institution or business institution,

the appropriate Federal banking agency for the depository
institution may serve upon such party a written notice of the
agency's intention to remove such party from office or to prohibit
any further participation by such party, in any manner, in the
conduct of the affairs of any insured depository institution.
(2) Specific violations. -
(A) In general. - Whenever the appropriate Federal banking
agency determines that -
(i) an institution-affiliated party has committed a violation
of any provision of subchapter II of chapter 53 of title 31 and
such violation was not inadvertent or unintentional;
(ii) an officer or director of an insured depository
institution has knowledge that an institution-affiliated party
of the insured depository institution has violated any such
provision or any provision of law referred to in subsection
(g)(1)(A)(ii) of this section;
(iii) an officer or director of an insured depository
institution has committed any violation of the Depository
Institution Management Interlocks Act [12 U.S.C. 3201 et seq.];
or
(iv) an institution-affiliated party of a subsidiary (other
than a bank) of a bank holding company or of a subsidiary
(other than a savings association) of a savings and loan
holding company has been convicted of any criminal offense
involving dishonesty or a breach of trust or a criminal offense
under section 1956, 1957, or 1960 of title 18 or has agreed to
enter into a pretrial diversion or similar program in
connection with a prosecution for such an offense,

the agency may serve upon such party, officer, or director a
written notice of the agency's intention to remove such party
from office.
(B) Factors to be considered. - In determining whether an
officer or director should be removed as a result of the
application of subparagraph (A)(ii), the agency shall consider
whether the officer or director took appropriate action to stop,
or to prevent the recurrence of, a violation described in such
subparagraph.

(3) Suspension order. -
(A) Suspension or prohibition authorized. - If the appropriate
Federal banking agency serves written notice under paragraph (1)
or (2) to any institution-affiliated party of such agency's
intention to issue an order under such paragraph, the appropriate
Federal banking agency may suspend such party from office or
prohibit such party from further participation in any manner in
the conduct of the affairs of the depository institution, if the
agency -
(i) determines that such action is necessary for the
protection of the depository institution or the interests of
the depository institution's depositors; and
(ii) serves such party with written notice of the suspension
order.

(B) Effective period. - Any suspension order issued under
subparagraph (A) -
(i) shall become effective upon service; and
(ii) unless a court issues a stay of such order under
subsection (f) of this section, shall remain in effect and
enforceable until -
(I) the date the appropriate Federal banking agency
dismisses the charges contained in the notice served under
paragraph (1) or (2) with respect to such party; or
(II) the effective date of an order issued by the agency to
such party under paragraph (1) or (2).

(C) Copy of order. - If an appropriate Federal banking agency
issues a suspension order under subparagraph (A) to any
institution-affiliated party, the agency shall serve a copy of
such order on any insured depository institution with which such
party is associated at the time such order is issued.

(4) A notice of intention to remove an institution-affiliated
party from office or to prohibit such party from participating in
the conduct of the affairs of an insured depository institution,
shall contain a statement of the facts constituting grounds
therefor, and shall fix a time and place at which a hearing will be
held thereon. Such hearing shall be fixed for a date not earlier
than thirty days nor later than sixty days after the date of
service of such notice, unless an earlier or a later date is set by
the agency at the request of (A) such party, and for good cause
shown, or (B) the Attorney General of the United States. Unless
such party shall appear at the hearing in person or by a duly
authorized representative, such party shall be deemed to have
consented to the issuance of an order of such removal or
prohibition. In the event of such consent, or if upon the record
made at any such hearing the agency shall find that any of the
grounds specified in such notice have been established, the agency
may issue such orders of suspension or removal from office, or
prohibition from participation in the conduct of the affairs of the
depository institution, as it may deem appropriate. Any such order
shall become effective at the expiration of thirty days after
service upon such depository institution and such party concerned
(except in the case of an order issued upon consent, which shall
become effective at the time specified therein). Such order shall
remain effective and enforceable except to such extent as it is
stayed, modified, terminated, or set aside by action of the agency
or a reviewing court.
(5) For the purpose of enforcing any law, rule, regulation, or
cease-and-desist order in connection with an interlocking
relationship, the term "officer" within the term "institution-
affiliated party" as used in this subsection means an employee or
officer with management functions, and the term "director" within
the term "institution-affiliated party" as used in this subsection
includes an advisory or honorary director, a trustee of a
depository institution under the control of trustees, or any person
who has a representative or nominee serving in any such capacity.
(6) Prohibition of certain specific activities. - Any person
subject to an order issued under this subsection shall not -
(A) participate in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of
any institution or agency specified in paragraph (7)(A);
(B) solicit, procure, transfer, attempt to transfer, vote, or
attempt to vote any proxy, consent, or authorization with respect
to any voting rights in any institution described in subparagraph
(A);
(C) violate any voting agreement previously approved by the
appropriate Federal banking agency; or
(D) vote for a director, or serve or act as an institution-
affiliated party.

(7) Industrywide Prohibition. -
(A) In general. - Except as provided in subparagraph (B), any
person who, pursuant to an order issued under this subsection or
subsection (g) of this section, has been removed or suspended
from office in an insured depository institution or prohibited
from participating in the conduct of the affairs of an insured
depository institution may not, while such order is in effect,
continue or commence to hold any office in, or participate in any
manner in the conduct of the affairs of -
(i) any insured depository institution;
(ii) any institution treated as an insured bank under
subsection (b)(3) or (b)(4) of this section, or as a savings
association under subsection (b)(9) of this section;
(iii) any insured credit union under the Federal Credit Union
Act [12 U.S.C. 1751 et seq.];
(iv) any institution chartered under the Farm Credit Act of
1971 [12 U.S.C. 2001 et seq.];
(v) any appropriate Federal depository institution regulatory
agency;
(vi) the Federal Housing Finance Board and any Federal home
loan bank; and
(vii) the Resolution Trust Corporation.

(B) Exception if agency provides written consent. - If, on or
after the date an order is issued under this subsection which
removes or suspends from office any institution-affiliated party
or prohibits such party from participating in the conduct of the
affairs of an insured depository institution, such party receives
the written consent of -
(i) the agency that issued such order; and
(ii) the appropriate Federal financial institutions
regulatory agency of the institution described in any clause of
subparagraph (A) with respect to which such party proposes to
become an institution-affiliated party,

subparagraph (A) shall, to the extent of such consent, cease to
apply to such party with respect to the institution described in
each written consent. Any agency that grants such a written
consent shall report such action to the Corporation and publicly
disclose such consent.
(C) Violation of paragraph treated as violation of order. - Any
violation of subparagraph (A) by any person who is subject to an
order described in such subparagraph shall be treated as a
violation of the order.
(D) "Appropriate federal financial institutions regulatory
agency" defined. - For purposes of this paragraph and subsection
(j) of this section, the term "appropriate Federal financial
institutions regulatory agency" means -
(i) the appropriate Federal banking agency, in the case of an
insured depository institution;
(ii) the Farm Credit Administration, in the case of an
institution chartered under the Farm Credit Act of 1971 [12
U.S.C. 2001 et seq.];
(iii) the National Credit Union Administration Board, in the
case of an insured credit union (as defined in section 101(7)
of the Federal Credit Union Act [12 U.S.C. 1752(7)]);
(iv) the Secretary of the Treasury, in the case of the
Federal Housing Finance Board and any Federal home loan bank;
and
(v) the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board, in the
case of the Resolution Trust Corporation.

(E) Consultation between agencies. - The agencies referred to
in clauses (i) and (ii) of subparagraph (B) shall consult with
each other before providing any written consent described in
subparagraph (B).
(F) Applicability. - This paragraph shall only apply to a
person who is an individual, unless the appropriate Federal
banking agency specifically finds that it should apply to a
corporation, firm, or other business enterprise.
(f) Stay of suspension and/or prohibition of institution-affiliated
party
Within ten days after any institution-affiliated party has been
suspended from office and/or prohibited from participation in the
conduct of the affairs of an insured depository institution under
subsection (e)(3) of this section, such party may apply to the
United States district court for the judicial district in which the
home office of the depository institution is located, or the United
States District Court for the District of Columbia, for a stay of
such suspension and/or prohibition pending the completion of the
administrative proceedings pursuant to the notice served upon such
party under subsection (e)(1) or (e)(2) of this section, and such
court shall have jurisdiction to stay such suspension and/or
prohibition.
(g) Suspension, removal, and prohibition from participation orders
in the case of certain criminal offenses
(1) Suspension or prohibition. -
(A) In general. - Whenever any institution-affiliated party is
the subject of any information, indictment, or complaint,
involving the commission of or participation in -
(i) a crime involving dishonesty or breach of trust which is
punishable by imprisonment for a term exceeding one year under
State or Federal law, or
(ii) a criminal violation of section 1956, 1957, or 1960 of
title 18 or section 5322 or 5324 of title 31,

the appropriate Federal banking agency may, if continued service
or participation by such party posed, poses, or may pose a threat
to the interests of the depositors of, or threatened, threatens,
or may threaten to impair public confidence in, any relevant
depository institution (as defined in subparagraph (E)), by
written notice served upon such party, suspend such party from
office or prohibit such party from further participation in any
manner in the conduct of the affairs of any depository
institution.
(B) Provisions applicable to notice. -
(i) Copy. - A copy of any notice under subparagraph (A) shall
also be served upon any depository institution that the subject
of the notice is affiliated with at the time the notice is
issued.
(ii) Effective period. - A suspension or prohibition under
subparagraph (A) shall remain in effect until the information,
indictment, or complaint referred to in such subparagraph is
finally disposed of or until terminated by the agency.

(C) Removal or prohibition. -
(i) In general. - If a judgment of conviction or an agreement
to enter a pretrial diversion or other similar program is
entered against an institution-affiliated party in connection
with a crime described in subparagraph (A)(i), at such time as
such judgment is not subject to further appellate review, the
appropriate Federal banking agency may, if continued service or
participation by such party posed, poses, or may pose a threat
to the interests of the depositors of, or threatened,
threatens, or may threaten to impair public confidence in, any
relevant depository institution (as defined in subparagraph
(E)), issue and serve upon such party an order removing such
party from office or prohibiting such party from further
participation in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of
any depository institution without the prior written consent of
the appropriate agency.
(ii) Required for certain offenses. - In the case of a
judgment of conviction or agreement against an institution-
affiliated party in connection with a violation described in
subparagraph (A)(ii), the appropriate Federal banking agency
shall issue and serve upon such party an order removing such
party from office or prohibiting such party from further
participation in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of
any depository institution without the prior written consent of
the appropriate agency.

(D) Provisions applicable to order. -
(i) Copy. - A copy of any order under subparagraph (C) shall
also be served upon any depository institution that the subject
of the order is affiliated with at the time the order is
issued, whereupon the institution-affiliated party who is
subject to the order (if a director or an officer) shall cease
to be a director or officer of such depository institution.
(ii) Effect of acquittal. - A finding of not guilty or other
disposition of the charge shall not preclude the agency from
instituting proceedings after such finding or disposition to
remove such party from office or to prohibit further
participation in depository institution affairs, pursuant to
paragraph (1), (2), or (3) of subsection (e) of this section.
(iii) Effective period. - Any notice of suspension or order
of removal issued under this paragraph shall remain effective
and outstanding until the completion of any hearing or appeal
authorized under paragraph (3) unless terminated by the agency.

(E) Relevant depository institution. - For purposes of this
subsection, the term "relevant depository institution" means any
depository institution of which the party is or was an
institution-affiliated party at the time at which -
(i) the information, indictment, or complaint described in
subparagraph (A) was issued; or
(ii) the notice is issued under subparagraph (A) or the order
is issued under subparagraph (C)(i).

(2) If at any time, because of the suspension of one or more
directors pursuant to this section, there shall be on the board of
directors of a national bank less than a quorum of directors not so
suspended, all powers and functions vested in or exercisable by
such board shall vest in and be exercisable by the director or
directors on the board not so suspended, until such time as there
shall be a quorum of the board of directors. In the event all of
the directors of a national bank are suspended pursuant to this
section, the Comptroller of the Currency shall appoint persons to
serve temporarily as directors in their place and stead pending the
termination of such suspensions, or until such time as those who
have been suspended, cease to be directors of the bank and their
respective successors take office.
(3) Within thirty days from service of any notice of suspension
or order of removal issued pursuant to paragraph (1) of this
subsection, the institution-affiliated party concerned may request
in writing an opportunity to appear before the agency to show that
the continued service to or participation in the conduct of the
affairs of the depository institution by such party does not, or is
not likely to, pose a threat to the interests of the bank's (!4)
depositors or threaten to impair public confidence in the
depository institution. Upon receipt of any such request, the
appropriate Federal banking agency shall fix a time (not more than
thirty days after receipt of such request, unless extended at the
request of such party) and place at which such party may appear,
personally or through counsel, before one or more members of the
agency or designated employees of the agency to submit written
materials (or, at the discretion of the agency, oral testimony) and
oral argument. Within sixty days of such hearing, the agency shall
notify such party whether the suspension or prohibition from
participation in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of the
depository institution will be continued, terminated, or otherwise
modified, or whether the order removing such party from office or
prohibiting such party from further participation in any manner in
the conduct of the affairs of the depository institution will be
rescinded or otherwise modified. Such notification shall contain a
statement of the basis for the agency's decision, if adverse to
such party. The Federal banking agencies are authorized to
prescribe such rules as may be necessary to effectuate the purposes
of this subsection.

(h) Hearings and judicial review
(1) Any hearing provided for in this section (other than the
hearing provided for in subsection (g)(3) of this section) shall be
held in the Federal judicial district or in the territory in which
the home office of the depository institution is located unless the
party afforded the hearing consents to another place, and shall be
conducted in accordance with the provisions of chapter 5 of title
5. After such hearing, and within ninety days after the appropriate
Federal banking agency or Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve
System has notified the parties that the case has been submitted to
it for final decision, it shall render its decision (which shall
include findings of fact upon which its decision is predicated) and
shall issue and serve upon each party to the proceeding an order or
orders consistent with the provisions of this section. Judicial
review of any such order shall be exclusively as provided in this
subsection (h). Unless a petition for review is timely filed in a
court of appeals of the United States, as hereinafter provided in
paragraph (2) of this subsection, and thereafter until the record
in the proceeding has been filed as so provided, the issuing agency
may at any time, upon such notice and in such manner as it shall
deem proper, modify, terminate, or set aside any such order. Upon
such filing of the record, the agency may modify, terminate, or set
aside any such order with permission of the court.
(2) Any party to any proceeding under paragraph (1) may obtain a
review of any order served pursuant to paragraph (1) of this
subsection (other than an order issued with the consent of the
depository institution or the institution-affiliated party
concerned, or an order issued under paragraph (1) of subsection (g)
of this section) by the filing in the court of appeals of the
United States for the circuit in which the home office of the
depository institution is located, or in the United States Court of
Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit, within thirty days
after the date of service of such order, a written petition praying
that the order of the agency be modified, terminated, or set aside.
A copy of such petition shall be forthwith transmitted by the clerk
of the court to the agency, and thereupon the agency shall file in
the court the record in the proceeding, as provided in section 2112
of title 28. Upon the filing of such petition, such court shall
have jurisdiction, which upon the filing of the record shall except
as provided in the last sentence of said paragraph (1) be
exclusive, to affirm, modify, terminate, or set aside, in whole or
in part, the order of the agency. Review of such proceedings shall
be had as provided in chapter 7 of title 5. The judgment and decree
of the court shall be final, except that the same shall be subject
to review by the Supreme Court upon certiorari, as provided in
section 1254 of title 28.
(3) The commencement of proceedings for judicial review under
paragraph (2) of this subsection shall not, unless specifically
ordered by the court, operate as a stay of any order issued by the
agency.
(i) Jurisdiction and enforcement; penalty
(1) The appropriate Federal banking agency may in its discretion
apply to the United States district court, or the United States
court of any territory, within the jurisdiction of which the home
office of the depository institution is located, for the
enforcement of any effective and outstanding notice or order issued
under this section or under section 1831o or 1831p-1 of this title,
and such courts shall have jurisdiction and power to order and
require compliance herewith; but except as otherwise provided in
this section or under section 1831o or 1831p-1 of this title no
court shall have jurisdiction to affect by injunction or otherwise
the issuance or enforcement of any notice or order under any such
section, or to review, modify, suspend, terminate, or set aside any
such notice or order.
(2) Civil money penalty. -
(A) First tier. - Any insured depository institution which, and
any institution-affiliated party who -
(i) violates any law or regulation;
(ii) violates any final order or temporary order issued
pursuant to subsection (b), (c), (e), (g), or (s) of this
section or any final order under section 1831o or 1831p-1 of
this title;
(iii) violates any condition imposed in writing by a Federal
banking agency in connection with any action on any
application, notice, or other request by the depository
institution or institution-affiliated party; or
(iv) violates any written agreement between such depository
institution and such agency,

shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty of not more than $5,000 for
each day during which such violation continues.
(B) Second tier. - Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), any
insured depository institution which, and any institution-
affiliated party who -
(i)(I) commits any violation described in any clause of
subparagraph (A);
(II) recklessly engages in an unsafe or unsound practice in
conducting the affairs of such insured depository institution;
or
(III) breaches any fiduciary duty;
(ii) which violation, practice, or breach -
(I) is part of a pattern of misconduct;
(II) causes or is likely to cause more than a minimal loss
to such depository institution; or
(III) results in pecuniary gain or other benefit to such
party,

shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty of not more than $25,000
for each day during which such violation, practice, or breach
continues.
(C) Third tier. - Notwithstanding subparagraphs (A) and (B),
any insured depository institution which, and any institution-
affiliated party who -
(i) knowingly -
(I) commits any violation described in any clause of
subparagraph (A);
(II) engages in any unsafe or unsound practice in
conducting the affairs of such depository institution; or
(III) breaches any fiduciary duty; and

(ii) knowingly or recklessly causes a substantial loss to
such depository institution or a substantial pecuniary gain or
other benefit to such party by reason of such violation,
practice, or breach,

shall forfeit and pay a civil penalty in an amount not to exceed
the applicable maximum amount determined under subparagraph (D)
for each day during which such violation, practice, or breach
continues.
(D) Maximum amounts of penalties for any violation described in
subparagraph (c). - The maximum daily amount of any civil penalty
which may be assessed pursuant to subparagraph (C) for any
violation, practice, or breach described in such subparagraph is -

(i) in the case of any person other than an insured
depository institution, an amount to not exceed $1,000,000; and
(ii) in the case of any insured depository institution, an
amount not to exceed the lesser of -
(I) $1,000,000; or
(II) 1 percent of the total assets of such institution.

(E) Assessment. -
(i) Written notice. - Any penalty imposed under subparagraph
(A), (B), or (C) may be assessed and collected by the
appropriate Federal banking agency by written notice.
(ii) Finality of assessment. - If, with respect to any
assessment under clause (i), a hearing is not requested
pursuant to subparagraph (H) within the period of time allowed
under such subparagraph, the assessment shall constitute a
final and unappealable order.

(F) Authority to modify or remit penalty. - Any appropriate
Federal banking agency may compromise, modify, or remit any
penalty which such agency may assess or had already assessed
under subparagraph (A), (B), or (C).
(G) Mitigating factors. - In determining the amount of any
penalty imposed under subparagraph (A), (B), or (C), the
appropriate agency shall take into account the appropriateness of
the penalty with respect to -
(i) the size of financial resources and good faith of the
insured depository institution or other person charged;
(ii) the gravity of the violation;
(iii) the history of previous violations; and
(iv) such other matters as justice may require.

(H) Hearing. - The insured depository institution or other
person against whom any penalty is assessed under this paragraph
shall be afforded an agency hearing if such institution or person
submits a request for such hearing within 20 days after the
issuance of the notice of assessment.
(I) Collection. -
(i) Referral. - If any insured depository institution or
other person fails to pay an assessment after any penalty
assessed under this paragraph has become final, the agency that
imposed the penalty shall recover the amount assessed by action
in the appropriate United States district court.
(ii) Appropriateness of penalty not reviewable. - In any
civil action under clause (i), the validity and appropriateness
of the penalty shall not be subject to review.

(J) Disbursement. - All penalties collected under authority of
this paragraph shall be deposited into the Treasury.
(K) Regulations. - Each appropriate Federal banking agency
shall prescribe regulations establishing such procedures as may
be necessary to carry out this paragraph.

(3) Notice under this section after separation from service. -
The resignation, termination of employment or participation, or
separation of a institution-affiliated party (including a
separation caused by the closing of an insured depository
institution) shall not affect the jurisdiction and authority of the
appropriate Federal banking agency to issue any notice or order and
proceed under this section against any such party, if such notice
or order is served before the end of the 6-year period beginning on
the date such party ceased to be such a party with respect to such
depository institution (whether such date occurs before, on, or
after August 9, 1989).
(4) Prejudgment attachment. -
(A) In general. - In any action brought by an appropriate
Federal banking agency (excluding the Corporation when acting in
a manner described in section 1821(d)(18) of this title) pursuant
to this section, or in actions brought in aid of, or to enforce
an order in, any administrative or other civil action for money
damages, restitution, or civil money penalties brought by such
agency, the court may, upon application of the agency, issue a
restraining order that -
(i) prohibits any person subject to the proceeding from
withdrawing, transferring, removing, dissipating, or disposing
of any funds, assets or other property; and
(ii) appoints a temporary receiver to administer the
restraining order.

(B) Standard. -
(i) Showing. - Rule 65 of the Federal Rules of Civil
Procedure shall apply with respect to any proceeding under
subparagraph (A) without regard to the requirement of such rule
that the applicant show that the injury, loss, or damage is
irreparable and immediate.
(ii) State proceeding. - If, in the case of any proceeding in
a State court, the court determines that rules of civil
procedure available under the laws of such State provide
substantially similar protections to a party's right to due
process as Rule 65 (as modified with respect to such proceeding
by clause (i)), the relief sought under subparagraph (A) may be
requested under the laws of such State.
(j) Criminal penalty
Whoever, being subject to an order in effect under subsection (e)
or (g) of this section, without the prior written approval of the
appropriate Federal financial institutions regulatory agency,
knowingly participates, directly or indirectly, in any manner
(including by engaging in an activity specifically prohibited in
such an order or in subsection (e)(6) of this section) in the
conduct of the affairs of -
(1) any insured depository institution;
(2) any institution treated as an insured bank under subsection
(b)(3) or (b)(4) of this section, or as a savings association
under subsection (b)(9) of this section;
(3) any insured credit union (as defined in section 101(7) of
the Federal Credit Union Act [12 U.S.C. 1752(7)]);
(4) any institution chartered under the Farm Credit Act of 1971
[12 U.S.C. 2001 et seq.]; or
(5) the Resolution Trust Corporation,

shall be fined not more than $1,000,000, imprisoned for not more
than 5 years, or both.
(k) Repealed. Pub. L. 101-73, title IX, Sec. 920(c), Aug. 9, 1989,
103 Stat. 488
(l) Notice of service
Any service required or authorized to be made by the appropriate
Federal banking agency under this section may be made by registered
mail, or in such other manner reasonably calculated to give actual
notice as the agency may by regulation or otherwise provide. Copies
of any notice or order served by the agency upon any State
depository institution or any institution-affiliated party,
pursuant to the provisions of this section, shall also be sent to
the appropriate State supervisory authority.
(m) Notice to State authorities
In connection with any proceeding under subsection (b), (c)(1),
or (e) of this section involving an insured State bank or any
institution-affiliated party, the appropriate Federal banking
agency shall provide the appropriate State supervisory authority
with notice of the agency's intent to institute such a proceeding
and the grounds therefor. Unless within such time as the Federal
banking agency deems appropriate in the light of the circumstances
of the case (which time must be specified in the notice prescribed
in the preceding sentence) satisfactory corrective action is
effectuated by action of the State supervisory authority, the
agency may proceed as provided in this section. No bank or other
party who is the subject of any notice or order issued by the
agency under this section shall have standing to raise the
requirements of this subsection as ground for attacking the
validity of any such notice or order.
(n) Ancillary provisions; subpena power, etc.
In the course of or in connection with any proceeding under this
section, or in connection with any claim for insured deposits or
any examination or investigation under section 1820(c) of this
title, the agency conducting the proceeding, examination, or
investigation or considering the claim for insured deposits, or any
member or designated representative thereof, including any person
designated to conduct any hearing under this section, shall have
the power to administer oaths and affirmations, to take or cause to
be taken depositions, and to issue, revoke, quash, or modify
subpenas and subpenas duces tecum; and such agency is empowered to
make rules and regulations with respect to any such proceedings,
claims, examinations, or investigations. The attendance of
witnesses and the production of documents provided for in this
subsection may be required from any place in any State or in any
territory or other place subject to the jurisdiction of the United
States at any designated place where such proceeding is being
conducted. Any such agency or any party to proceedings under this
section may apply to the United States District Court for the
District of Columbia, or the United States district court for the
judicial district or the United States court in any territory in
which such proceeding is being conducted, or where the witness
resides or carries on business, for enforcement of any subpena or
subpena duces tecum issued pursuant to this subsection, and such
courts shall have jurisdiction and power to order and require
compliance therewith. Witnesses subpenaed under this subsection
shall be paid the same fees and mileage that are paid witnesses in
the district courts of the United States. Any court having
jurisdiction of any proceeding instituted under this section by an
insured depository institution or a director or officer thereof,
may allow to any such party such reasonable expenses and attorneys'
fees as it deems just and proper; and such expenses and fees shall
be paid by the depository institution or from its assets. Any
person who willfully shall fail or refuse to attend and testify or
to answer any lawful inquiry or to produce books, papers,
correspondence, memoranda, contracts, agreements, or other records,
if in such person's power so to do, in obedience to the subpoena of
the appropriate Federal banking agency, shall be guilty of a
misdemeanor and, upon conviction, shall be subject to a fine of not
more than $1,000 or to imprisonment for a term of not more than one
year or both.
(o) Termination of membership of State bank in Federal Reserve
System
Whenever the insured status of a State member bank shall be
terminated by action of the Board of Directors, the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System shall terminate its
membership in the Federal Reserve System in accordance with the
provisions of subchapter VIII of chapter 3 of this title, and
whenever the insured status of a national member bank shall be so
terminated the Comptroller of the Currency shall appoint a receiver
for the bank, which shall be the Corporation. Except as provided in
subsection (c) or (d) of section 1814 of this title, whenever a
member bank shall cease to be a member of the Federal Reserve
System, its status as an insured depository institution shall,
without notice or other action by the Board of Directors, terminate
on the date the bank shall cease to be a member of the Federal
Reserve System, with like effect as if its insured status had been
terminated on said date by the Board of Directors after proceedings
under subsection (a) of this section. Whenever the insured status
of an insured Federal savings bank shall be terminated by action of
the Board of Directors, the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision shall appoint a receiver for the bank, which shall be
the Corporation.
(p) Banks not receiving deposits
Notwithstanding any other provision of law, whenever the Board of
Directors shall determine that an insured depository institution is
not engaged in the business of receiving deposits, other than trust
funds as herein defined, the Corporation shall notify the
depository institution that its insured status will terminate at
the expiration of the first full assessment period following such
notice. A finding by the Board of Directors that a depository
institution is not engaged in the business of receiving deposits,
other than such trust funds, shall be conclusive. The Board of
Directors shall prescribe the notice to be given by the depository
institution of such termination and the Corporation may publish
notice thereof. Upon the termination of the insured status of any
such depository institution, its deposits shall thereupon cease to
be insured and the depository institution shall thereafter be
relieved of all future obligations to the Corporation, including
the obligation to pay future assessments.
(q) Assumption of liabilities
Whenever the liabilities of an insured depository institution for
deposits shall have been assumed by another insured depository
institution or depository institutions, whether by way of merger,
consolidation, or other statutory assumption, or pursuant to
contract (1) the insured status of the depository institution whose
liabilities are so assumed shall terminate on the date of receipt
by the Corporation of satisfactory evidence of such assumption; (2)
the separate insurance of all deposits so assumed shall terminate
at the end of six months from the date such assumption takes effect
or, in the case of any time deposit, the earliest maturity date
after the six-month period. Where the deposits of an insured
depository institution are assumed by a newly insured depository
institution, the depository institution whose deposits are assumed
shall not be required to pay any assessment with respect to the
deposits which have been so assumed after the assessment period in
which the assumption takes effect.
(r) Action or proceeding against foreign bank; basis; removal of
officer or other person; venue; service of process
(1) Except as otherwise specifically provided in this section,
the provisions of this section shall be applied to foreign banks in
accordance with this subsection.
(2) An act or practice outside the United States on the part of a
foreign bank or any officer, director, employee, or agent thereof
may not constitute the basis for any action by any officer or
agency of the United States under this section, unless -
(A) such officer or agency alleges a belief that such act or
practice has been, is, or is likely to be a cause of or carried
on in connection with or in furtherance of an act or practice
within any one or more States which, in and of itself, would
constitute an appropriate basis for action by a Federal officer
or agency under this section; or
(B) the alleged act or practice is one which, if proven, would,
in the judgment of the Board of Directors, adversely affect the
insurance risk assumed by the Corporation.

(3) In any case in which any action or proceeding is brought
pursuant to an allegation under paragraph (2) of this subsection
for the suspension or removal of any officer, director, or other
person associated with a foreign bank, and such person fails to
appear promptly as a party to such action or proceeding and to
comply with any effective order or judgment therein, any failure by
the foreign bank to secure his removal from any office he holds in
such bank and from any further participation in its affairs shall,
in and of itself, constitute grounds for termination of the
insurance of the deposits in any branch of the bank.
(4) Where the venue of any judicial or administrative proceeding
under this section is to be determined by reference to the location
of the home office of a bank, the venue of such a proceeding with
respect to a foreign bank having one or more branches or agencies
in not more than one judicial district or other relevant
jurisdiction shall be within such jurisdiction. Where such a bank
has branches or agencies in more than one such jurisdiction, the
venue shall be in the jurisdiction within which the branch or
branches or agency or agencies involved in the proceeding are
located, and if there is more than one such jurisdiction, the venue
shall be proper in any such jurisdiction in which the proceeding is
brought or to which it may appropriately be transferred.
(5) Any service required or authorized to be made on a foreign
bank may be made on any branch or agency located within any State,
but if such service is in connection with an action or proceeding
involving one or more branches or one or more agencies located in
any State, service shall be made on at least one branch or agency
so involved.
(s) Compliance with monetary transaction recordkeeping and report
requirements
(1) Compliance procedures required
Each appropriate Federal banking agency shall prescribe
regulations requiring insured depository institutions to
establish and maintain procedures reasonably designed to assure
and monitor the compliance of such depository institutions with
the requirements of subchapter II of chapter 53 of title 31.
(2) Examinations of depository institution to include review of
compliance procedures
(A) In general
Each examination of an insured depository institution by the
appropriate Federal banking agency shall include a review of
the procedures required to be established and maintained under
paragraph (1).
(B) Exam report requirement
The report of examination shall describe any problem with the
procedures maintained by the insured depository institution.
(3) Order to comply with requirements
If the appropriate Federal banking agency determines that an
insured depository institution -
(A) has failed to establish and maintain the procedures
described in paragraph (1); or
(B) has failed to correct any problem with the procedures
maintained by such depository institution which was previously
reported to the depository institution by such agency,

the agency shall issue an order in the manner prescribed in
subsection (b) or (c) of this section requiring such depository
institution to cease and desist from its violation of this
subsection or regulations prescribed under this subsection.
(t) Authority of FDIC to take enforcement action against insured
depository institutions and institution-affiliated parties
(1) Recommending action by appropriate Federal banking agency
The Corporation, based on an examination of an insured
depository institution by the Corporation or by the appropriate
Federal banking agency or on other information, may recommend in
writing to the appropriate Federal banking agency that the agency
take any enforcement action authorized under section 1817(j) of
this title, this section, or section 1828(j) of this title with
respect to any insured depository institution, any depository
institution holding company, or any institution-affiliated party.
The recommendation shall be accompanied by a written explanation
of the concerns giving rise to the recommendation.
(2) FDIC's authority to act if appropriate Federal banking agency
fails to follow recommendation
If the appropriate Federal banking agency does not, before the
end of the 60-day period beginning on the date on which the
agency receives the recommendation under paragraph (1), take the
enforcement action recommended by the Corporation or provide a
plan acceptable to the Corporation for responding to the
Corporation's concerns, the Corporation may take the recommended
enforcement action if the Board of Directors determines, upon a
vote of its members, that -
(A) the insured depository institution is in an unsafe or
unsound condition;
(B) the institution or institution-affiliated party is
engaging in unsafe or unsound practices, and the recommended
enforcement action will prevent the institution or institution-
affiliated party from continuing such practices;
(C) the conduct or threatened conduct (including any acts or
omissions) poses a risk to the Deposit Insurance Fund, or may
prejudice the interests of the institution's depositors or (!5)

(D) the conduct or threatened conduct (including any acts or
omissions) of the depository institution holding company poses
a risk to the Deposit Insurance Fund, provided that such
authority may not be used with respect to a depository
institution holding company that is in generally sound
condition and whose conduct does not pose a foreseeable and
material risk of loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund; (!6)

(3) Effect of exigent circumstances
(A) Authority to act
The Corporation may, upon a vote of the Board of Directors,
and after notice to the appropriate Federal banking agency,
exercise its authority under paragraph (2) in exigent
circumstances without regard to the time period set forth in
paragraph (2).
(B) Agreement on exigent circumstances
The Corporation shall, by agreement with the appropriate
Federal banking agency, set forth those exigent circumstances
in which the Corporation may act under subparagraph (A).
(4) Corporation's powers; institution's duties
For purposes of this subsection -
(A) the Corporation shall have the same powers with respect
to any insured depository institution and its affiliates as the
appropriate Federal banking agency has with respect to the
institution and its affiliates; and
(B) the institution and its affiliates shall have the same
duties and obligations with respect to the Corporation as the
institution and its affiliates have with respect to the
appropriate Federal banking agency.
(5) Requests for formal actions and investigations
(A) Submission of requests
A regional office of an appropriate Federal banking agency
(including a Federal Reserve bank) that requests a formal
investigation of or civil enforcement action against an insured
depository institution or institution-affiliated party shall
submit the request concurrently to the chief officer of the
appropriate Federal banking agency and to the Corporation.
(B) Agencies required to report on requests
Each appropriate Federal banking agency shall report
semiannually to the Corporation on the status or disposition of
all requests under subparagraph (A), including the reasons for
any decision by the agency to approve or deny such requests.
(6) Powers and duties with respect to depository institution
holding companies
For purposes of exercising the backup authority provided in
this subsection -
(A) the Corporation shall have the same powers with respect
to a depository institution holding company and its affiliates
as the appropriate Federal banking agency has with respect to
the holding company and its affiliates; and
(B) the holding company and its affiliates shall have the
same duties and obligations with respect to the Corporation as
the holding company and its affiliates have with respect to the
appropriate Federal banking agency.
(u) Public disclosures of final orders and agreements
(1) In general
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall publish and make
available to the public on a monthly basis -
(A) any written agreement or other written statement for
which a violation may be enforced by the appropriate Federal
banking agency, unless the appropriate Federal banking agency,
in its discretion, determines that publication would be
contrary to the public interest;
(B) any final order issued with respect to any administrative
enforcement proceeding initiated by such agency under this
section or any other law; and
(C) any modification to or termination of any order or
agreement made public pursuant to this paragraph.
(2) Hearings
All hearings on the record with respect to any notice of
charges issued by a Federal banking agency shall be open to the
public, unless the agency, in its discretion, determines that
holding an open hearing would be contrary to the public interest.
(3) Transcript of hearing
A transcript that includes all testimony and other documentary
evidence shall be prepared for all hearings commenced pursuant to
subsection (i) of this section. A transcript of public hearings
shall be made available to the public pursuant to section 552 of
title 5.
(4) Delay of publication under exceptional circumstances
If the appropriate Federal banking agency makes a determination
in writing that the publication of a final order pursuant to
paragraph (1)(B) would seriously threaten the safety and
soundness of an insured depository institution, the agency may
delay the publication of the document for a reasonable time.
(5) Documents filed under seal in public enforcement hearings
The appropriate Federal banking agency may file any document or
part of a document under seal in any administrative enforcement
hearing commenced by the agency if disclosure of the document
would be contrary to the public interest. A written report shall
be made part of any determination to withhold any part of a
document from the transcript of the hearing required by paragraph
(2).
(6) Retention of documents
Each Federal banking agency shall keep and maintain a record,
for a period of at least 6 years, of all documents described in
paragraph (1) and all informal enforcement agreements and other
supervisory actions and supporting documents issued with respect
to or in connection with any administrative enforcement
proceeding initiated by such agency under this section or any
other laws.
(7) Disclosures to Congress
No provision of this subsection may be construed to authorize
the withholding, or to prohibit the disclosure, of any
information to the Congress or any committee or subcommittee of
the Congress.
(v) Foreign investigations
(1) Requesting assistance from foreign banking authorities
In conducting any investigation, examination, or enforcement
action under this chapter, the appropriate Federal banking agency
may -
(A) request the assistance of any foreign banking authority;
and
(B) maintain an office outside the United States.
(2) Providing assistance to foreign banking authorities
(A) In general
Any appropriate Federal banking agency may, at the request of
any foreign banking authority, assist such authority if such
authority states that the requesting authority is conducting an
investigation to determine whether any person has violated, is
violating, or is about to violate any law or regulation
relating to banking matters or currency transactions
administered or enforced by the requesting authority.
(B) Investigation by Federal banking agency
Any appropriate Federal banking agency may, in such agency's
discretion, investigate and collect information and evidence
pertinent to a request for assistance under subparagraph (A).
Any such investigation shall comply with the laws of the United
States and the policies and procedures of the appropriate
Federal banking agency.
(C) Factors to consider
In deciding whether to provide assistance under this
paragraph, the appropriate Federal banking agency shall
consider -
(i) whether the requesting authority has agreed to provide
reciprocal assistance with respect to banking matters within
the jurisdiction of any appropriate Federal banking agency;
and
(ii) whether compliance with the request would prejudice
the public interest of the United States.
(D) Treatment of foreign banking authority
For purposes of any Federal law or appropriate Federal
banking agency regulation relating to the collection or
transfer of information by any appropriate Federal banking
agency, the foreign banking authority shall be treated as
another appropriate Federal banking agency.
(3) Rule of construction
Paragraphs (1) and (2) shall not be construed to limit the
authority of an appropriate Federal banking agency or any other
Federal agency to provide or receive assistance or information to
or from any foreign authority with respect to any matter.
(w) Termination of insurance for money laundering or cash
transaction reporting offenses
(1) In general
(A) Conviction of title 18 offenses
(i) Duty to notify
If an insured State depository institution has been
convicted of any criminal offense under section 1956 or 1957
of title 18, the Attorney General shall provide to the
Corporation a written notification of the conviction and
shall include a certified copy of the order of conviction
from the court rendering the decision.
(ii) Notice of termination; pretermination hearing
After receipt of written notification from the Attorney
General by the Corporation of such a conviction, the Board of
Directors shall issue to the insured depository institution a
notice of its intention to terminate the insured status of
the insured depository institution and schedule a hearing on
the matter, which shall be conducted in all respects as a
termination hearing pursuant to paragraphs (3) through (5) of
subsection (a) of this section.
(B) Conviction of title 31 offenses
If an insured State depository institution is convicted of
any criminal offense under section 5322 or 5324 of title 31
after receipt of written notification from the Attorney General
by the Corporation, the Board of Directors may initiate
proceedings to terminate the insured status of the insured
depository institution in the manner described in subparagraph
(A).
(C) Notice to State supervisor
The Corporation shall simultaneously transmit a copy of any
notice issued under this paragraph to the appropriate State
financial institutions supervisor.
(2) Factors to be considered
In determining whether to terminate insurance under paragraph
(1), the Board of Directors shall take into account the following
factors:
(A) The extent to which directors or senior executive
officers of the depository institution knew of, or were
involved in, the commission of the money laundering offense of
which the institution was found guilty.
(B) The extent to which the offense occurred despite the
existence of policies and procedures within the depository
institution which were designed to prevent the occurrence of
any such offense.
(C) The extent to which the depository institution has fully
cooperated with law enforcement authorities with respect to the
investigation of the money laundering offense of which the
institution was found guilty.
(D) The extent to which the depository institution has
implemented additional internal controls (since the commission
of the offense of which the depository institution was found
guilty) to prevent the occurrence of any other money laundering
offense.
(E) The extent to which the interest of the local community
in having adequate deposit and credit services available would
be threatened by the termination of insurance.
(3) Notice to State banking supervisor and public
When the order to terminate insured status initiated pursuant
to this subsection is final, the Board of Directors shall -
(A) notify the State banking supervisor of any State
depository institution described in paragraph (1) and the
Office of Thrift Supervision, where appropriate, at least 10
days prior to the effective date of the order of termination of
the insured status of such depository institution, including a
State branch of a foreign bank; and
(B) publish notice of the termination of the insured status
of the depository institution in the Federal Register.
(4) Temporary insurance of previously insured deposits
Upon termination of the insured status of any State depository
institution pursuant to paragraph (1), the deposits of such
depository institution shall be treated in accordance with
subsection (a)(7) of this section.
(5) Successor liability
This subsection shall not apply to a successor to the interests
of, or a person who acquires, an insured depository institution
that violated a provision of law described in paragraph (1), if
the successor succeeds to the interests of the violator, or the
acquisition is made, in good faith and not for purposes of
evading this subsection or regulations prescribed under this
subsection.
(6) "Senior executive officer" defined
The term "senior executive officer" has the same meaning as in
regulations prescribed under section 1831i(f) of this title.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[8], 64 Stat. 879; Pub. L. 89-695,
title II, Secs. 202, 204, Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat. 1046, 1054; Pub.
L. 93-495, title I, Sec. 110, Oct. 28, 1974, 88 Stat. 1506; Pub. L.
95-369, Secs. 6(c)(14), (15), 11, Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 618,
624; Pub. L. 95-630, title I, Secs. 107(a)(1), (b), (c)(1), (d)(1),
(e)(1), 111(a), title II, Sec. 208(a), title III, Secs. 303, 304,
Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3649, 3653, 3654, 3656, 3660, 3665, 3674,
3676; Pub. L. 97-320, title I, Sec. 113(g), (h), title IV, Secs.
404(c), 424(c), (d)(6), (e), 425(b), (c), 427(d), 433(a), Oct. 15,
1982, 96 Stat. 1473, 1474, 1512, 1523-1527; Pub. L. 99-570, title
I, Sec. 1359(a), Oct. 27, 1986, 100 Stat. 3207-27; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Sec. 201, title IX, Secs. 901(b)(1), (d), 902(a), 903(a),
904(a), 905(a), 906(a), 907(a), 908(a), 912, 913(a), 920(a), (c),
926, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 446, 450, 453, 457, 459, 462,
477, 482, 483, 488; Pub. L. 101-647, title XXV, Secs. 2521(b)(1),
2532(a), 2547(a)(1), (2), 2596(a), (b), Nov. 29, 1990, 104 Stat.
4864, 4880, 4886, 4887, 4908; Pub. L. 102-233, title III, Sec.
302(a), Dec. 12, 1991, 105 Stat. 1767; Pub. L. 102-242, title I,
Sec. 131(c)(1), (2), title III, Secs. 302(e)(5), formerly (e)(4),
307, Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2266, 2349, 2360; Pub. L. 102-550,
title XV, Secs. 1503(a), 1504(a), title XVI, Secs. 1603(d)(2)-(4),
1605(a)(5)(A), (11), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4048, 4051, 4080,
4085, 4086; Pub. L. 102-558, title III, Secs. 303(b)(6)(A), 305,
Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4225, 4226; Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 25, Dec.
17, 1993, 107 Stat. 2408; Pub. L. 103-325, title IV, Sec.
411(c)(2)(A), title VI, Sec. 602(a)(11)-(18), Sept. 23, 1994, 108
Stat. 2253, 2289; Pub. L. 105-164, Sec. 3(a)(2), Mar. 20, 1998, 112
Stat. 35; Pub. L. 105-362, title X, Sec. 1001(d), Nov. 10, 1998,
112 Stat. 3291; Pub. L. 106-569, title XII, Sec. 1232, Dec. 27,
2000, 114 Stat. 3037; Pub. L. 109-173, Secs. 3(a)(6), (7),
8(a)(10), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3605, 3611; Pub. L. 109-351,
title III, Sec. 303, title VII, Secs. 702(c), 708(a), 710(b),
715(a), 716(a), 717, Oct. 13, 2006, 120 Stat. 1970, 1985, 1988,
1991, 1995, 1996; Pub. L. 110-343, div. A, title I, Sec. 126(b),
Oct. 3, 2008, 122 Stat. 3795; Pub. L. 111-203, title I, Sec.
172(b), title III, Sec. 363(3), title X, Sec. 1090(1), July 21,
2010, 124 Stat. 1439, 1551, 2093.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title X, Secs. 1090(1), 1100H, July 21, 2010,
124 Stat. 2093, 2113, provided that, effective on the designated
transfer date, subsection (t) of this section is amended by adding
at the end the following:
"(6) Referral to Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection
"Subject to subtitle B of the Consumer Financial Protection Act
of 2010, each appropriate Federal banking agency shall make a
referral to the Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection when the
Federal banking agency has a reasonable belief that a violation
of an enumerated consumer law, as defined in the Consumer
Financial Protection Act of 2010, has been committed by any
insured depository institution or institution-affiliated party
within the jurisdiction of that appropriate Federal banking
agency."

See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(3), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1551, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (a)(8)(B)(ii), in the last sentence, by
substituting "Comptroller of the Currency" for "Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision" wherever appearing;
(2) in subsection (b) -
(A) in paragraph (3), by inserting "any savings and loan holding
company and any subsidiary (other than a depository institution) of
a savings and loan holding company (as such terms are defined in
section 1467a of this title)), any noninsured State member bank"
after "Bank Holding Company Act of 1956," and "or against a savings
and loan holding company or any subsidiary thereof (other than a
depository institution or a subsidiary of such depository
institution)" before the period at the end; and
(B) by striking out paragraph (9) and inserting the following:
"(9) [Repealed]";

(3) in subsection (e)(7) -
(A) in subparagraph (A) -
(i) in clause (v), by inserting "and" after the semicolon;
(ii) in clause (vi), by substituting "Agency" for "Board" and a
period for "; and"; and
(iii) by striking out clause (vii); and
(B) in subparagraph (D) -
(i) in clause (iii), by inserting "and" after the semicolon;
(ii) in clause (iv), by substituting "Agency" for "Board" and a
period for "; and"; and
(iii) by striking out clause (v);
(4) in subsection (j) -
(A) in paragraph (2), by striking out ", or as a savings
association under subsection (b)(9) of this section";
(B) in paragraph (3), by inserting "or" after the semicolon;
(C) in paragraph (4), by substituting a comma for "; or"; and
(D) by striking out paragraph (5);
(5) in subsection (o), by substituting "Comptroller of the
Currency" for "Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision"; and
(6) in subsection (w)(3)(A), by striking out "and the Office of
Thrift Supervision".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
Subsections (a) and (b) of section 3104 of this title, referred
to in subsec. (a)(1)(E), were redesignated subsections (b) and (c),
respectively, of section 3104 of this title by Pub. L. 103-328,
title I, Sec. 107(a)(1), Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat. 2358.
The Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, referred to in subsec.
(b)(3), is act May 9, 1956, ch. 240, 70 Stat. 133, as amended,
which is classified principally to chapter 17 (Sec. 1841 et seq.)
of this title. For complete classification of this Act to the Code,
see Short Title note set out under section 1841 of this title and
Tables.
Section 25(a) of the Federal Reserve Act, referred to in subsec.
(b)(3), which is classified to subchapter II (Sec. 611 et seq.) of
chapter 6 of this title, was renumbered section 25A of that Act by
Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Sec. 142(e)(2), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2281. Section 25 of the Federal Reserve Act is classified to
subchapter I (Sec. 601 et seq.) of chapter 6 of this title.
The Federal Rules of Civil Procedure, referred to in subsecs.
(b)(10) and (i)(4)(B), are set out in the Appendix to Title 28,
Judiciary and Judicial Procedure.
The Depository Institution Management Interlocks Act, referred to
in subsec. (e)(2)(A)(iii), is title II of Pub. L. 95-630, Nov. 10,
1978, 92 Stat. 3672, as amended, which is classified principally to
chapter 33 (Sec. 3201 et seq.) of this title. For complete
classification of this Act to the Code, see Short Title note set
out under section 3201 of this title and Tables.
The Federal Credit Union Act, referred to in subsec.
(e)(7)(A)(iii), is act June 26, 1934, ch. 750, 48 Stat. 1216, as
amended, which is classified generally to chapter 14 (Sec. 1751 et
seq.) of this title. For complete classification of this Act to the
Code, see section 1751 of this title and Tables.
The Farm Credit Act of 1971, referred to in subsecs.
(e)(7)(A)(iv), (D)(ii) and (j)(4), is Pub. L. 92-181, Dec. 10,
1971, 85 Stat. 583, as amended, which is classified generally to
chapter 23 (Sec. 2001 et seq.) of this title. For complete
classification of this Act to the Code, see Short Title note set
out under section 2001 of this title and Tables.
Subchapter VIII of chapter 3 of this title, referred to in
subsec. (o), was in the original "section 9 of the Federal Reserve
Act", meaning section 9 of act Dec. 23, 1913, ch. 6, 38 Stat. 251,
as amended, which is classified generally to subchapter VIII (Sec.
321 et seq.) of chapter 3 of this title.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (i) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (t)(1). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 172(b)(1), inserted
", any depository institution holding company," before "or any
institution-affiliated party".
Subsec. (t)(2)(D). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 172(b)(2), added subpar.
(D).
Subsec. (t)(6). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 172(b)(3), added par. (6)
relating to powers and duties with respect to depository
institution holding companies.
2008 - Subsec. (c)(4). Pub. L. 110-343 added par. (4).
2006 - Subsec. (b)(1). Pub. L. 109-351, Secs. 716(a)(1), 717(1),
in first sentence, substituted "in writing by a Federal banking
agency" for "in writing by the agency", "any action on any
application, notice, or other request by the depository institution
or institution-affiliated party," for "the granting of any
application or other request by the depository institution", and
"the appropriate Federal banking agency for the depository
institution may issue and serve" for "the agency may issue and
serve".
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 702(c)(1), substituted
"This subsection, subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u) of
this section, and section 1831aa of this title" for "This
subsection and subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u) of
this section".
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 702(c)(2), substituted
"This subsection, subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u) of
this section, and section 1831aa of this title" for "This
subsection and subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u) of
this section".
Subsec. (e)(1). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 717(2)(B), substituted "the
appropriate Federal banking agency for the depository institution
may serve upon such party" for "the agency may serve upon such
party" in concluding provisions.
Subsec. (e)(1)(A)(i)(III). Pub. L. 109-351, Secs. 716(a)(2),
717(2)(A), substituted "in writing by a Federal banking agency" for
"in writing by the appropriate Federal banking agency" and "any
action on any application, notice, or request by such depository
institution or institution-affiliated party" for "the grant of any
application or other request by such depository institution".
Subsec. (e)(2)(A)(iv). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 710(b), added cl.
(iv).
Subsec. (e)(4). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 303, struck out "In any
action brought under this section by the Comptroller of the
Currency in respect to any such party with respect to a national
banking association or a District depository institution, the
findings and conclusions of the Administrative Law Judge shall be
certified to the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
for the determination of whether any order shall issue." before
"Any such order shall become effective".
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(2), inserted heading.
Subsec. (g)(1)(A). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(A),
substituted, in introductory provisions, "is the subject of any
information, indictment, or complaint, involving the commission of
or participation in" for "is charged in any information,
indictment, or complaint, with the commission of or participation
in" and, in concluding provisions, "posed, poses, or may pose a
threat to the interests of the depositors of, or threatened,
threatens, or may threaten to impair public confidence in, any
relevant depository institution (as defined in subparagraph (E)),"
for "may pose a threat to the interests of the depository
institution's depositors or may threaten to impair public
confidence in the depository institution," and "affairs of any
depository institution" for "affairs of the depository
institution".
Subsec. (g)(1)(B)(i). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(B),
substituted "any depository institution that the subject of the
notice is affiliated with at the time the notice is issued" for
"the depository institution".
Subsec. (g)(1)(C)(i). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(C),
substituted "posed, poses, or may pose a threat to the interests of
the depositors of, or threatened, threatens, or may threaten to
impair public confidence in, any relevant depository institution
(as defined in subparagraph (E))," for "may pose a threat to the
interests of the depository institution's depositors or may
threaten to impair public confidence in the depository
institution," and "affairs of any depository institution" for
"affairs of the depository institution".
Subsec. (g)(1)(C)(ii). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(D),
substituted "affairs of any depository institution" for "affairs of
the depository institution".
Subsec. (g)(1)(D)(i). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(E),
substituted "any depository institution that the subject of the
order is affiliated with at the time the order is issued" for "the
depository institution".
Subsec. (g)(1)(E). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 708(a)(1)(F), added
subpar. (E).
Subsec. (i)(2)(A)(iii). Pub. L. 109-351, Secs. 716(a)(3), 717(3),
substituted "in writing by a Federal banking agency" for "in
writing by the appropriate Federal banking agency" and "any action
on any application, notice, or other request by the depository
institution or institution-affiliated party" for "the grant of any
application or other request by such depository institution".
Subsec. (i)(3). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 715(a), inserted "or order"
after "notice" in two places.
Subsec. (p). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(6), struck out
"semiannual" before "assessment period".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(7), substituted
"assessment period" for "semiannual period".
Subsec. (t)(2)(C). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(10), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund".
2000 - Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 106-569 substituted "subsection (c)
or (d) of section 1814" for "subsection (d) of section 1814".
1998 - Subsec. (b)(9). Pub. L. 105-164, Sec. 3(a)(2)(A), struck
out "to any service corporation of a savings association and to any
subsidiary of such service corporation" after "of a savings and
loan holding company,".
Subsec. (e)(7)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 105-164, Sec. 3(a)(2)(B),
substituted "(b)(9)" for "(b)(8)".
Subsec. (j)(2). Pub. L. 105-164, Sec. 3(a)(2)(C), substituted
"(b)(9)" for "(b)(8)".
Subsec. (u)(3) to (8). Pub. L. 105-362 redesignated pars. (4) to
(8) as (3) to (7), respectively, and struck out heading and text of
former par. (3). Text read as follows: "A written report shall be
made part of a determination not to hold a public hearing pursuant
to paragraph (2) or not to publish a document pursuant to paragraph
(1)(A). At the end of each calendar quarter, all such reports shall
be transmitted to the Congress."
1994 - Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(11),
substituted "paragraph (2)(B)" for "subparagraph (B) of this
subsection".
Subsec. (a)(7). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(12), inserted comma
after "Board of Directors" in first sentence and substituted "the
period" for "the period the period" in third sentence.
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(13), substituted
"paragraph (3)" for "subparagraph (3)".
Subsec. (c)(2). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(14), substituted
"injunction" for "injuction".
Subsec. (g)(1)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 411(c)(2)(A),
substituted "section 5322 or 5324 of title 31" for "section 5322 of
title 31".
Subsec. (g)(2). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(15), substituted
"bank" for "depository institution" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(16), in second
sentence, substituted "subsection (d)" for "subsection (b)" and
"Board of Directors" for "board of directors" in two places.
Subsec. (p). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(17), substituted
"depository" for "banking" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (r)(2). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(18), substituted
"agent thereof" for "agent therof".
Subsec. (w)(1)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 411(c)(2)(A),
substituted "section 5322 or 5324 of title 31" for "section 5322 of
title 31".
1993 - Subsec. (b)(10). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 25(2), added par.
(10).
Subsec. (i)(4)(B). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 25(1), added subpar. (B)
and struck out former subpar. (B) which read as follows: "A
permanent or temporary injunction or restraining order shall be
granted without bond upon a prima facie showing that money damages,
restitution, or civil money penalties, as sought by such agency, is
appropriate."
1992 - Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1503(a)(2), inserted
"of this subsection or subsection (w) of this section" after
"subparagraph (B)".
Subsec. (e)(2). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1504(a)(1), amended par.
(2) generally. Prior to amendment, par. (2) read as follows:
"Whenever, in the opinion of the appropriate Federal banking
agency, any director or officer of an insured depository
institution has committed any violation of the Depository
Institution Management Interlocks Act, the agency may serve upon
such director or officer a written notice of its intention to
remove him from office."
Subsec. (g)(1). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1504(a)(2), amended par.
(1) generally, subdividing existing provisions into subpars. (A) to
(D) and, in subpar. (A), including violations under section 1956,
1957, or 1960 of title 18, or section 5322 of title 31, as cause
for suspension of any institution-affiliated party.
Subsec. (i)(1). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(3), inserted
reference to section 1831p-1 of this title in two places, and
substituted "order under any such section, or to review" for "order
under this section, or to review".
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(2), amended directory language of
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(2)(A). See 1991 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (i)(2)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(4),
substituted "subsection (b), (c), (e), (g), or (s) of this section
or any final order under section 1831o or 1831p-1 of this title"
for "subsection (b), (c), (e), (g), or (s) of this section, or
final order under section 1831o of this title".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), amended
directory language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e). See 1991
amendment note below. Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(5)(A), which
contained an identical amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28,
1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out in a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this title.
Subsec. (t)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(11)(A), inserted
"or institution-affiliated party" after "institution" in two
places.
Subsec. (t)(2)(C). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(11)(B),
substituted "the conduct or threatened conduct" for "the
institution's conduct or threatened conduct".
Subsec. (t)(5)(A). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(11)(C), inserted
"or institution-affiliated party" after "depository institution".
Subsec. (w). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1503(a)(1), added subsec. (w).
1991 - Subsec. (b)(8), (9). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(1),
added par. (8) and redesignated former par. (8) as (9).
Subsec. (i)(1). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(2)(A), as amended by
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(d)(2), inserted "or under section 1831o
of this title" after first and second references to "section".
Subsec. (i)(2)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 131(c)(2)(B),
inserted ", or final order under section 1831o of this title" after
"section".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(e)(5), as renumbered by
Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(6)(A), substituted "assessment with
respect to the deposits" for "assessment upon the deposits".
Subsec. (t). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 307, amended subsec. (t)
generally, substituting present provisions for provisions relating
to authority of Board to take enforcement action against savings
associations.
1990 - Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2596(a)(2),
substituted "subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u) of this
section" for "subsections (c), (d), (h), (i), (k), (l), (m), and
(n) of this section".
Subsec. (b)(6). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2596(a)(1), inserted "or
remedy" after "to correct".
Subsec. (c)(1). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2596(b), inserted "or
remedy" after "to prevent" and substituted "(b)(6)" for
"(b)(6)(B)".
Subsec. (h)(1). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2547(a)(2), struck out
after first sentence "Such hearing shall be private, unless the
appropriate Federal banking agency, in its discretion, after fully
considering the views of the party afforded the hearing, determines
that a public hearing is necessary to protect the public interest."
Subsec. (i)(4). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2521(b)(1), added par. (4).
Subsec. (u). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2547(a)(1), amended subsec.
(u) generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (u) read as follows:
"(1) In general. - The appropriate Federal banking agency shall
publish and make available to the public -
"(A) any final order issued with respect to any administrative
enforcement proceeding initiated by such agency under this
section or any other provision of law; and
"(B) any modification to or termination of any final order
described in subparagraph (A) of this paragraph.
"(2) Delay of publication under exceptional circumstances. - If
the appropriate Federal banking agency makes a determination in
writing that the publication of any final order pursuant to
paragraph (1) would seriously threaten the safety or soundness of
an insured depository institution, such agency may delay the
publication of such order for a reasonable time."
Subsec. (v). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2532(a), added subsec. (v).
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to
insured depository institutions for references to insured banks
wherever appearing in this section.
Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(1), inserted heading.
Subsec. (a)(1) to (3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(1), added pars.
(1) to (3) and struck out first four sentences which read as
follows: "Any insured bank (except a national member bank, a
foreign bank having an insured branch which is a Federal branch, a
foreign bank having an insured branch which is required to be
insured under section 3104(a) or (b) of this title, or State member
bank) may, upon not less than ninety days' written notice to the
Corporation, terminate its status as an insured bank. Whenever the
Board of Directors shall find that an insured bank or its directors
or trustees have engaged or are engaging in unsafe or unsound
practices in conducting the business of such bank, or is in an
unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations as an insured
bank, or violated an applicable law, rule, regulation or order, or
any condition imposed in writing by the Corporation in connection
with the granting of any application or other request by the bank,
or any written agreement entered into with the Corporation the
Board of Directors shall first give to the Comptroller of the
Currency in the case of a national bank or a district bank, to the
Federal Home Loan Bank Board in the case of an insured Federal
savings bank, to the authority having supervision of the bank in
the case of a State bank, and to the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System in the case of a State member bank, a
statement with respect to such practices or violations for the
purpose of securing the correction thereof and shall give a copy
thereof to the bank. Unless such correction shall be made within
one hundred and twenty days, or such shorter period not less than
twenty days fixed by the Corporation in any case where the Board of
Directors in its discretion has determined that the insurance risk
of the Corporation is unduly jeopardized, or fixed by the
Comptroller of the Currency in the case of a national bank, or the
Federal Home Loan Bank Board in the case of an insured Federal
savings bank, or the State authority in the case of a State bank,
or Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System in the case of
a State member bank as the case may be, the Board of Directors, if
it shall determine to proceed further, shall give to the bank not
less than thirty days' written notice of intention to terminate the
status of the bank as an insured bank, and shall fix a time and
place for a hearing before the Board of Directors or before a
person designated by it to conduct such hearing, at which evidence
may be produced, and upon such evidence the Board of Directors
shall make written findings which shall be conclusive. If the Board
of Directors shall find that any unsafe or unsound practice or
condition or violation specified in such statement has been
established and has not been corrected within the time above
prescribed in which to make such corrections, the Board of
Directors may order that the insured status of the bank be
terminated on a date subsequent to such finding and to the
expiration of the time specified in such notice of intention."
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(2), designated fifth
sentence as par. (4) and inserted heading.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank".
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(3), designated sixth
sentence as par. (5), inserted heading, and substituted "Any
insured depository institution whose insured status" for "Any
insured bank whose insured status".
Subsec. (a)(6). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(4), designated seventh
sentence as par. (6) and inserted heading.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (a)(7). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(5), (6), designated last
three sentences as par. (7), inserted heading, substituted "of at
least 6 months or up to 2 years, within the discretion of the Board
of Directors" for first reference to "of two years", and "the
period referred to in the 1st sentence" for second reference to "of
two years", and struck out "of two years" after "within such
period".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (a)(8) to (10). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 926(7), added pars.
(8) to (10).
Subsec. (b)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank" wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(A)(i), (B), substituted references
to institution-affiliated parties for references to directors,
officers, employees, agents, or other persons participating in the
conduct of banks.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(A)(ii), which directed that
"institution-affiliated parties" be substituted for "directors,
officers, employees, agents, or other persons participating in the
conduct of the affairs of such bank", was executed by making the
substitution for "directors, officers, employees, agents, and other
persons participating in the conduct of the affairs of such bank",
as the probable intent of Congress.
Subsec. (b)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank".
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 902(a)(1)(A), substituted
"subsections (c) through (s) and subsection (u)" for "subsections
(c) through (f) and (h) through (n)".
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 902(a)(1)(B), which directed
the substitution of "subsections (c) through (s) and subsection
(u)" for "subsections (c) through (f) and (h) through (n)", could
not be executed because the words "subsections (c) through (f) and
(h) through (n)" did not appear. See 1990 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(6) to (8). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 902(a)(1)(C), added
pars. (6) to (8).
Subsec. (c)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 902(a)(2)(A), substituted
"insolvency or significant dissipation" for "insolvency or
substantial dissipation", struck out "seriously" before "weaken the
condition of" and before "prejudice the interests of", and inserted
after first sentence "Such order may include any requirement
authorized under subsection (b)(6)(B) of this section".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank" wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(B), substituted references to
institution-affiliated parties for references to directors,
officers, employees, agents or other persons participating in the
conduct of the affairs of banks.
Subsec. (c)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank" wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(B), substituted references to
institution-affiliated parties for references to directors,
officers, employees, agents or other persons participating in the
conduct of the affairs of banks.
Subsec. (c)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 902(a)(2)(B), added par.
(3).
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository
institution" for "bank".
Subsec. (e)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(1), amended par. (1)
generally, by, among other changes, giving existing provisions
subpar. designations, and by adding as conditions for removal of a
party a violation of any condition imposed by writing in connection
with a grant of any application or request, and violation of any
written agreement between such depository institution and agency.
Subsec. (e)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(2), redesignated par.
(3) as (2) and struck out former par. (2) which read as follows:
"Whenever, in the opinion of the appropriate Federal banking
agency, any director or officer of an insured bank, by conduct or
practice with respect to another insured bank or other business
institution which resulted in substantial financial loss or other
damage, has evidenced either his personal dishonesty or a willful
or continuing disregard for its safety and soundness, and, in
addition, has evidenced his unfitness to continue as a director or
officer and, whenever, in the opinion of the appropriate Federal
banking agency, any other person participating in the conduct of
the affairs of an insured bank, by conduct or practice with respect
to such bank or other insured bank or other business institution
which resulted in substantial financial loss or other damage, has
evidenced either his personal dishonesty or a willful or continuing
disregard for its safety and soundness, and, in addition, has
evidenced his unfitness to participate in the conduct of the
affairs of such insured bank, the agency may serve upon such
director, officer, or other person a written notice of its
intention to remove him from office or to prohibit his further
participation in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of the
bank."
Subsec. (e)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(2), added par. (3).
Former par. (3) redesignated (2).
Subsec. (e)(4). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(2), redesignated par.
(5) as (4) and struck out former par. (4) which read as follows:
"In respect to any director or officer of an insured bank or any
other person referred to in paragraph (1), (2), or (3) of this
subsection, the appropriate Federal banking agency may, if it deems
it necessary for the protection of the bank or the interests of its
depositors, by written notice to such effect served upon such
director, officer, or other person, suspend him from office or
prohibit him from further participation in any manner in the
conduct of the affairs of the bank. Such suspension or prohibition
shall become effective upon service of such notice and, unless
stayed by a court in proceedings authorized by subsection (f) of
this section, shall remain in effect pending the completion of the
administrative proceedings pursuant to the notice served under
paragraph (1), (2), or (3) of this subsection and until such time
as the agency shall dismiss the charges specified in such notice,
or, if an order of removal or prohibition is issued against the
director or officer or other person, until the effective date of
any such order. Copies of any such notice shall also be served upon
the bank of which he is a director or officer or in the conduct of
whose affairs he has participated."
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(C), substituted references to
institution-affiliated parties for references to directors,
officers, or other persons.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted reference to depository
institutions for reference to banks.
Subsec. (e)(5). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(2), redesignated par.
(6) as (5). Former par. (5) redesignated (4).
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(D), inserted "within the term
'institution-affiliated party' " after "the term 'officer' ", and
inserted "within the term 'institution-affiliated party' as used in
this subsection" after "the term 'director' ".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted reference to depository
institution for reference to bank.
Subsec. (e)(6). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(2), (3), added par.
(6) and redesignated former par. (6) as (5).
Subsec. (e)(7). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 904(a), added par. (7).
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(4)(A), substituted
"(e)(3)" for "(e)(4)" and "(e)(1) or (e)(2)" for "(e)(1), (e)(2),
or (e)(3)".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(E), substituted "any institution-
affiliated party" and "such party" for "any director, officer, or
other person" and "such director, officer, or other person",
respectively, wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank".
Subsec. (g)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 906(a), struck out
"authorized by a United States attorney" after "information,
indictment, or complaint", and substituted "or an agreement to
enter a pre-trial diversion or other similar program" for "with
respect to such crime".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 903(a)(4)(B), substituted "(1), (2), or (3)"
for "(1), (2), (3), or (4)".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted references to depository
institutions for references to banks wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(F)(i), substituted "institution-
affiliated party" for "director or officer of an insured bank, or
other person participating in the conduct of the affairs of such
bank".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(F)(v), which directed the
substitution of "party" for "director, officer or other person",
could not be executed, because the phrase did not appear.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(F)(ii)-(iv), (vi), substituted
"such party" for "the individual" wherever appearing, "such party"
for "such director, officer, or other person" wherever appearing,
"such party" for "him" wherever appearing, and "whereupon such
party (if a director or an officer)" for "whereupon such director
or officer".
Subsec. (g)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
references to depository institutions for references to banks
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (g)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
references to depository institutions for references to banks
wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(G), substituted "the institution-
affiliated party concerned" for "the director, officer, or other
person concerned" and substituted "such party" for "such
individual", for "the concerned director, officer, or other
person", and for any other reference to the director, officer or
other person.
Subsec. (h)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank".
Subsec. (h)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 920(a), substituted "Any
party to any proceeding under paragraph (1)" for "Any party to the
proceeding, or any person required by an order issued under this
section to cease and desist from any of the violations or practices
stated therein,".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository institution"
for "bank" wherever appearing.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(H), substituted "institution-
affiliated party" for "director or officer or other person".
Subsec. (i)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted
"depository institution" for "bank".
Subsec. (i)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 907(a), amended par. (2)
generally, revising and restating as subpars. (A) to (K) provisions
of former cls. (i) to (vii).
Subsec. (i)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 905(a), added par. (3).
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 908(a), amended subsec. (j)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (j) read as follows: "Any
director or officer, or former director or officer of an insured
bank, or any other person, against whom there is outstanding and
effective any notice or order (which is an order which has become
final) served upon such director, officer, or other person under
subsections (e)(4), (e)(5), or (g) of this section, and who (i)
participates in any manner in the conduct of the affairs of the
bank involved, or directly or indirectly solicits or procures, or
transfers or attempts to transfer, or votes or attempts to vote,
any proxies, consents, or authorizations in respect of any voting
rights in such bank, or (ii) without the prior written approval of
the appropriate Federal banking agency, votes for a director,
serves or acts as a director, officer, or employee of any bank,
shall upon conviction be fined not more than $5,000 or imprisoned
for not more than one year, or both."
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 920(c), struck out subsec. (k)
which defined the terms "cease-and-desist order which has become
final", "order which has become final", and "violation", as those
terms were used in this section.
Subsec. (l). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "State
depository institution" for "State bank".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(I), substituted "institution-
affiliated party" for "director or officer thereof or other person
participating in the conduct of its affairs".
Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(b)(1)(J), substituted
"institution-affiliated party" for "director or officer or other
person participating in the conduct of its affairs".
Subsec. (n). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository
institution" for "bank".
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(b), substituted "Director
of the Office of Thrift Supervision" for "Federal Home Loan Bank
Board".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted "depository
institution" for "bank" wherever appearing and "depository
institutions" for "banks".
Subsec. (s). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 901(d), substituted references
to depository institutions for references to banks wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (t). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 912, added subsec. (t).
Subsec. (u). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 913(a), added subsec. (u).
1986 - Subsec. (i)(2)(i). Pub. L. 99-570, Sec. 1359(a)(2),
inserted reference to subsec. (s) of this section.
Subsec. (s). Pub. L. 99-570, Sec. 1359(a)(1), added subsec. (s).
1982 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(g), inserted "to the
Federal Home Loan Bank Board in the case of an insured Federal
savings bank," after "national bank or a district bank," and "or
the Federal Home Loan Bank Board in the case of an insured Federal
savings bank," after "Currency in the case of a national bank,".
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 425(b), substituted "25(a)"
for "25A".
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 425(c), which directed the
amendment of subsec. (b) by adding a new par. (4) at end, was
executed (as the probable intent of Congress) as a general
amendment of existing par. (4), as added by Pub. L. 95-369, the two
pars. (4) being identical except that the new par. (4) refers to
"purposes of this paragraph" rather than "purposes of this
subparagraph".
Subsec. (b)(5). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 404(c), added par. (5).
Subsec. (e)(3). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(1)(A), added par.
(3). Former par. (3) redesignated (4).
Subsec. (e)(4). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(1)(A), (B),
redesignated former par. (3) as (4) and inserted references to par.
(3) of this subsection in two places. Former par. (4) redesignated
(5).
Subsec. (e)(5), (6). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(1)(A),
redesignated former pars. (4) and (5) as (5) and (6), respectively.
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(2), substituted
references to "subsection (e)(4)" for "subsection (e)(5) or (e)(7)"
and "subsection (e)(1), (e)(2), or (e)(3)" for "subsection (e)(1),
(e)(3), or (e)(7)".
Subsec. (g)(1). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(3), in penultimate
sentence, included reference to par. (4) of subsec. (e) of this
section.
Subsec. (i)(2)(i). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 424(c), (d)(6), inserted
proviso giving agency discretionary authority to compromise, etc.,
any civil money penalty imposed under such authority, and
substituted "may be assessed" for "shall be assessed".
Subsec. (i)(2)(iv). Pub. L. 97-424(e) substituted "twenty days
from the service" for "ten days from the date".
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 427(d)(4), struck out reference
to subsec. (e)(3) and included reference to subsec. (e)(5) of this
section.
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(h), inserted provision that
whenever the insured status of an insured Federal savings bank
shall be terminated by action of the Board of Directors, the
Federal Home Loan Bank Board shall appoint a receiver for the bank,
which shall be the Corporation.
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 433(a), struck out item (3)
provisions requiring the assuming or resulting bank to give notice
of an assumption to each of the depositors of the bank whose
liabilities are assumed within thirty days after such assumption
takes effect.
1978 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(14), inserted "a
foreign bank having an insured branch which is a Federal branch, a
foreign bank having an insured branch which is required to be
insured under section 3104(a) or (b) of this title" after "(except
a national member bank".
Subsec. (b)(1), (2). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 107(a)(1), extended
coverage of par. (1) to include directors, officers, employees,
agents, or other persons participating in the conduct of the
affairs of an insured bank or a bank which has insured deposits,
and reenacted par. (2) without change.
Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 107(b), substituted
"subsections (c) through (f) and (h) through (n) of this section"
for "subsections (c), (d), (h), (i), (k), (l), (m), and (n) of this
section" and inserted provisions relating to any organization
organized and operated under section 25A of the Federal Reserve Act
or operating under section 25 of the Federal Reserve Act and
provisions relating to the issuance of a notice of charges or cease-
and-desist order against a bank holding company or subsidiary by
any Federal banking agency other than the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System.
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 11, added par. (4).
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 107(c)(1), in pars. (1) and (2)
inserted references to any director, officer, employee, agent, or
other person participating in the conduct of the affairs of the
bank and in par. (1) inserted "prior to the completion of the
proceedings conducted pursuant to paragraph (1) of subsection (b)
of this section" after "interests of its depositors" and "and to
take affirmative action to prevent such insolvency, dissipation,
condition, or prejudice pending completion of such proceedings"
after "violation or practice".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 95-630, Secs. 107(d)(1), 208(a), generally
revised and condensed the provisions relating to the suspension and
removal of bank directors and officers, consolidated procedures
relating to the certification of facts to the Board of Governors of
the Federal Reserve System by the Comptroller of the Currency,
substituted references to insured banks for references to insured
State banks (other than a District Bank), and inserted provisions
defining "officer" and "director" for the purpose of enforcing any
law, rule, etc., in connection with an interlocking relationship.
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 111(a)(1), among other changes,
inserted in par. (1) ", if continued service or participation by
the individual may pose a threat to the interests of the bank's
depositors or may threaten to impair public confidence in the bank"
after "agency may" in two places, inserted provision that any
notice of suspension or order of removal issued under this
paragraph remain effective and outstanding until the completion of
any hearing or appeal authorized under paragraph (3) hereof unless
terminated by the agency, and added par. (3).
Subsec. (h)(1). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 111(a)(2), inserted "(other
than the hearing provided for in subsection (g)(3) of this
section)" after "provided for in this section".
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 107(e)(1), designated existing
provisions as par. (1) and added par. (2).
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 111(a)(3), substituted
"subsections (e)(3), (e)(4)" for "subsections (e)(5), (e)(7),
(e)(8)".
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 111(a)(4), substituted
"paragraph (1) or (3) of subsection (g)" for "paragraph (1) of
subsection (g)".
Subsec. (n). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 111(a)(5), inserted provision
creating a criminal penalty for a willful failure or refusal to
attend and testify or to answer any lawful inquiry or to produce
books, papers, etc. in obedience to the subpoena of the appropriate
Federal banking agency.
Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 303, inserted "or in connection with any
claim for insured deposits or any examination or investigation
under section 1820(c) of this title," after "proceeding under this
section,", "examination, or investigation or considering the claim
for insured deposits," after "conducting the proceeding,", and
"such agency or any" before "party to proceedings" and substituted
"any such proceedings, claims, examinations, or investigations" for
"any such proceedings" and "subpenaed under this subsection" for
"subpenaed under this section".
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 304, among other changes,
substituted provisions requiring the assuming or resulting bank to
give notice of an assumption to each of the depositors of the bank
whose liabilities are so assumed within thirty days after such
assumption takes effect for provisions requiring the bank whose
liabilities are being assumed to give notice of such assumption to
its depositors within thirty days after such assumption takes
effect, by publication or by any reasonable means, in accordance
with regulations to be prescribed by the Board of Directors.
Subsec. (r). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(15), added subsec. (r).
1974 - Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 93-495 added par. (3).
1966 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 204, enlarged the
authority of the Corporation to institute involuntary termination
proceedings against an insured bank which had engaged in or whose
directors or trustees had engaged in, rather than merely continued
unsafe or unsound practices, or was in an unsafe or unsound
condition to continue operations as an insured bank, or had
violated any law, rule, regulation or order, or any condition
imposed in writing by the Corporation or any written agreement
entered into with the Corporation; made it clear that the
Corporation would be required to give the State authority a copy of
the statement dealing the practices or violations where the State
bank involved was a State member bank; provided for an alternative
and shortened correction period of not less than twenty days in
those cases where the Board of Directors of the Corporation on its
discretion determined that the insurance risk of the Corporation
was unduly jeopardized; provided the State authority with power to
shorten the correction period in those cases involving State banks
whether member or nonmember banks; transposed the position of the
fourth and fifth sentences; and provided a bank whose insured
status had been terminated with right of judicial review to the
extent provided in subsec. (h) of this section.
Subsecs. (b) to (q). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 202, added subsecs. (b)
to (n) and redesignated former subsecs. (b) to (d) as (o) to (q),
respectively.

-CHANGE-
CHANGE OF NAME
Oversight Board redesignated Thrift Depositor Protection
Oversight Board, effective Feb. 1, 1992, see section 302(a) of Pub.
L. 102-233, set out as a note under section 1441a of this title.
Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board abolished, see section
14(a)-(d) of Pub. L. 105-216, set out as a note under section 1441a
of this title.


-MISC2-
EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 172(b) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 1 day
after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided, see section 4 of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note under section
5301 of this title.
Amendment by section 363(3) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.
Amendment by section 1090(1) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
designated transfer date, see section 1100H of Pub. L. 111-203, set
out as a note under section 552a of Title 5, Government
Organization and Employees.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 3(a)(6), (7) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective
Jan. 1, 2007, see section 3(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a
note under section 1817 of this title.
Amendment by section 8(a)(10) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar.
31, 2006, see section 8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note
under section 1813 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Amendment by section 303(b)(6)(A) of Pub. L. 102-558 deemed to
have become effective Mar. 1, 1992, see section 304 of Pub. L. 102-
558, set out as a note under section 2062 of Title 50, Appendix,
War and National Defense.
Amendment by sections 1603(d)(2)-(4) and 1605(a)(5)(A), (11) of
Pub. L. 102-550 effective as if included in the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, Pub. L. 102-242, as
of Dec. 19, 1991, except that where amendment is to any provision
of law added or amended by Pub. L. 102-242 effective after Dec. 19,
1992, then amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective on effective date
of amendment by Pub. L. 102-242, see section 1609 of Pub. L. 102-
550, set out as a note under section 191 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 131(c)(1), (2) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective
1 year after Dec. 19, 1991, see section 131(f) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1464 of this title.
Amendment by section 302(e)(4) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective on
earlier of 180 days after date on which final regulations
promulgated in accordance with section 302(c) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title, become
effective or Jan. 1, 1994, see section 302(g) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1990 AMENDMENT
Section 2547(a)(3) of Pub. L. 101-647 provided that: "The
amendment made by paragraph (1) [amending this section] shall apply
with respect to all written agreements which are entered into and
all written statements which become effective after the date of the
enactment of this Act [Nov. 29, 1990]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1989 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 903(a) of Pub. L. 101-73 applicable with
respect to violations committed and activities engaged in after
Aug. 9, 1989, see section 903(e) of Pub. L. 101-73, set out as a
note under section 1786 of this title.
Amendment by section 907(a) of Pub. L. 101-73 applicable to
conduct engaged in after Aug. 9, 1989, except that increased
maximum penalties of $5,000 and $25,000 may apply to conduct
engaged in before such date if such conduct is not already subject
to a notice issued by the appropriate agency and occurred after
completion of the last report of the examination of the institution
by the appropriate agency occurring before Aug. 9, 1989, see
section 907(l) of Pub. L. 101-73, set out as a note under section
93 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF REGULATIONS PRESCRIBED UNDER 1986 AMENDMENT
The regulations required to be prescribed under amendment by Pub.
L. 99-570 effective at end of 3-month period beginning on Oct. 27,
1986, see section 1364(e) of Pub. L. 99-570, set out as a note
under section 1464 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 95-630, except for amendment by section
107(e)(1), effective upon expiration of 120 days after Nov. 10,
1978, see section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as an Effective
Date note under section 375b of this title.
Amendment by section 107(e)(1) of Pub. L. 95-630, relating to
imposition of civil penalties, applicable to violations occurring
or continuing after Nov. 10, 1978, see section 109 of Pub. L. 95-
630, set out as a note under section 93 of this title.

EXPIRATION OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 908, Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811,
repealed section 401 of Pub. L. 89-695 which had provided that:
"The provisions of titles I and II of this Act [amending sections
1464, 1730, 1813, 1817 to 1820 and repealing section 77 of this
title and enacting provisions set out as notes under sections 1464,
1730, and 1813 of this title] and any provisions of law enacted by
said titles shall be effective only during the period ending at the
close of June 30, 1972. Effective upon the expiration of such
period, each provision of law amended by either of such titles is
further amended to read as it did immediately prior to the
enactment of this Act [Oct. 16, 1966] and each provision of law
repealed by either of such titles is reenacted."

IMPROVED ADMINISTRATIVE HEARINGS AND PROCEDURES FOR FEDERAL BANKING
AGENCIES AND NATIONAL CREDIT UNION ADMINISTRATION BOARD
Section 916 of Pub. L. 101-73 provided that before close of 24-
month period beginning on Aug. 9, 1989, appropriate Federal
banking agencies (as defined in section 3(q) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1813(q)]) and National Credit Union
Administration Board jointly establish their own pool of
administrative law judges and develop a set of uniform rules and
procedures for administrative hearings, including provisions for
summary judgment rulings where there are no disputes as to material
facts of the case.

TASK FORCE STUDY OF DELEGATION OF ENFORCEMENT ACTIONS
Section 917 of Pub. L. 101-73 directed appropriate Federal
banking agencies (as defined in section 1813(q) of this title and
National Credit Union Administration Board to create a joint task
force to study desirability and feasibility of delegating
investigation and enforcement authority to their regional or
district offices or banks, provided for composition of task force,
and required that not later than Sept. 30, 1990, task force report
to Congress its findings and recommendations, together with
responses of Comptroller of the Currency, Director of Office of
Thrift Supervision, Chairperson of Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation, Chairman of Board of Governors of Federal Reserve
System, and Chairman of National Credit Union Administration.

CREDIT STANDARDS ADVISORY COMMITTEE
Pub. L. 101-73, title XII, Sec. 1205, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat.
521, as amended by Pub. L. 102-242, title IV, Sec. 422, Dec. 19,
1991, 105 Stat. 2377; Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 367(7), July
21, 2010, 124 Stat. 1557, provided that:
"(a) Establishment. - There is hereby established the Credit
Standards Advisory Committee (in this section referred to as the
'Committee').
"(b) Membership. -
"(1) Appointment. - The Committee shall consist of 11 members,
as follows:
"(A) The Chairman of the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System, or the Chairman's designee.
"(B) The Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, or the
Director's designee.
"(C) The Chairperson of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation, or the Chairperson's designee.
"(D) The Comptroller of the Currency, or the Comptroller's
designee.
"(E) The Chairman of the National Credit Union
Administration, or the Chairman's designee.
"(F) 6 members of the public appointed by the President who
are knowledgeable with the credit standards and lending
practices of insured depository institutions, no more than 3 of
whom shall be from the same political party.
"(2) Terms. - Each member appointed under paragraph (1)(F)
shall serve for the life of the Committee.
"(3) Chairperson. - The Chairperson of the Committee shall be
designated by the President from among the members appointed
under paragraph (1)(F).
"(4) Vacancies. - Any vacancy on the Committee shall be filled
in the manner in which the original appointment was made.
"(5) Pay and expenses. - Members of the Committee shall serve
without pay but each member of the Committee shall be reimbursed
for expenses incurred in connection with attendance of such
members at meetings of the Committee. All expenses of the
Committee shall be shared on a pro rata basis, based upon each
agency's total budget for the preceding year by the Federal
financial regulators specified in subparagraphs (A) through (E)
of paragraph (1).
"(6) Meetings. - The Committee shall meet, not less frequently
than quarterly, at the call of the chairperson or a majority of
the members.
"(c) Duties of the Committee. - The Committee shall do the
following:
"(1) Review credit standards, lending practices, and
supervision by federal regulators. - Review the credit standards
and lending practices of insured depository institutions and the
supervision of such standards and practices by the Federal
financial regulators.
"(2) Prepare recommendations. - Prepare written comments and
recommendations for the Federal financial regulators to ensure
that insured depository institutions adhere to prudential credit
standards and lending practices that are consistent for all
insured depository institutions, to the maximum extent possible.
"(3) Monitor credit standards, lending practices, and
supervision by federal regulators. - Monitor the credit standards
and lending practices of insured depository institutions, and the
supervision of such standards and practices by the Federal
financial regulators, to ensure that insured depository
institutions can meet the demands of a modern and globally
competitive financial world.
"(d) Annual Report. -
"(1) Required. - Not later than January 30 of each year, the
Committee shall submit a report to the Committee on Banking,
Finance and Urban Affairs [now Committee on Financial Services]
of the House of Representatives and the Committee on Banking,
Housing, and Urban Affairs of the Senate.
"(2) Contents. - The report required by paragraph (1) shall
describe the activities of the Committee during the preceding
year and the reports and recommendations made by the Committee to
the Federal financial regulators.
"(e) Conflict of Interest Guidelines. - The Committee shall
prescribe such guidelines as the Committee determines to be
appropriate to avoid conflicts of interest with respect to the
disclosure to and use by members of the Committee of information
relating to insured depository institutions and the Federal
financial regulators.
"(f) Federal Advisory Committee Act Does not Apply. - The Federal
Advisory Committee Act [5 U.S.C. App.] shall not apply with respect
to the Committee."
[Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 367(7), July 21, 2010,
124 Stat. 1546, 1557, provided that, effective on the transfer date
(defined in section 5301 of this title), section 1205(b) of Pub. L.
101-73, set out above, is amended, in paragraph (1), by striking
subparagraph (B) and by redesignating subparagraphs (C) through (F)
as subparagraphs (B) through (E), respectively, and, in paragraph
(2), by striking "paragraph (1)(F)" and inserting "paragraph
(1)(E)".]
[For termination, effective May 15, 2000, of reporting provisions
under 1205(d) of Pub. L. 101-73, set out above, see section 3003 of
Pub. L. 104-66, as amended, set out as a note under section 1113 of
Title 31, Money and Finance, and page 159 of House Document No. 103-
7.]

CONDITIONS GOVERNING EMPLOYMENT OF PERSONNEL NOT REPEALED,
MODIFIED, OR AFFECTED
Nothing contained in sections 202 and 204 of Pub. L. 89-695
amending this section to be construed as repealing, modifying, or
affecting section 1829 of this title, see section 206 of Pub. L. 89-
695, set out as a note under section 1813 of this title.

-FOOTNOTE-
(!1) See References in Text note below.

(!2) See References in Text note below.

(!3) So in original.

(!4) So in original. Probably should be "depository
institution's".



(!5) So in original. Probably should be "; or".



(!6) So in original. The semicolon probably should be a period.


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1819 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1819. Corporate powers

-STATUTE-
(a) In general
Upon June 16, 1933, the Corporation shall become a body corporate
and as such shall have power -
First. To adopt and use a corporate seal.
Second. To have succession until dissolved by an Act of Congress.
Third. To make contracts.
Fourth. To sue and be sued, and complain and defend, by and
through its own attorneys, in any court of law or equity, State or
Federal.
Fifth. To appoint by its Board of Directors such officers and
employees as are not otherwise provided for in this chapter, to
define their duties, fix their compensation, require bonds of them
and fix the penalty thereof, and to dismiss at pleasure such
officers or employees. Nothing in this chapter or any other Act
shall be construed to prevent the appointment and compensation as
an officer or employee of the Corporation of any officer or
employee of the United States in any board, commission, independent
establishment, or executive department thereof.
Sixth. To prescribe, by its Board of Directors, bylaws not
inconsistent with law, regulating the manner in which its general
business may be conducted, and the privileges granted to it by law
may be exercised and enjoyed.
Seventh. To exercise by its Board of Directors, or duly
authorized officers or agents, all powers specifically granted by
the provisions of this chapter, and such incidental powers as shall
be necessary to carry out the powers so granted.
Eighth. To make examinations of and to require information and
reports from depository institutions, as provided in this chapter.
Ninth. To act as receiver.
Tenth. To prescribe by its Board of Directors such rules and
regulations as it may deem necessary to carry out the provisions of
this chapter or of any other law which it has the responsibility of
administering or enforcing (except to the extent that authority to
issue such rules and regulations has been expressly and exclusively
granted to any other regulatory agency).
(b) Agency authority
(1) Status
The Corporation, in any capacity, shall be an agency of the
United States for purposes of section 1345 of title 28 without
regard to whether the Corporation commenced the action.
(2) Federal court jurisdiction
(A) In general
Except as provided in subparagraph (D), all suits of a civil
nature at common law or in equity to which the Corporation, in
any capacity, is a party shall be deemed to arise under the
laws of the United States.
(B) Removal
Except as provided in subparagraph (D), the Corporation may,
without bond or security, remove any action, suit, or
proceeding from a State court to the appropriate United States
district court before the end of the 90-day period beginning on
the date the action, suit, or proceeding is filed against the
Corporation or the Corporation is substituted as a party.
(C) Appeal of remand
The Corporation may appeal any order of remand entered by any
United States district court.
(D) State actions
Except as provided in subparagraph (E), any action -
(i) to which the Corporation, in the Corporation's capacity
as receiver of a State insured depository institution by the
exclusive appointment by State authorities, is a party other
than as a plaintiff;
(ii) which involves only the preclosing rights against the
State insured depository institution, or obligations owing
to, depositors, creditors, or stockholders by the State
insured depository institution; and
(iii) in which only the interpretation of the law of such
State is necessary,

shall not be deemed to arise under the laws of the United
States.
(E) Rule of construction
Subparagraph (D) shall not be construed as limiting the right
of the Corporation to invoke the jurisdiction of any United
States district court in any action described in such
subparagraph if the institution of which the Corporation has
been appointed receiver could have invoked the jurisdiction of
such court.
(3) Service of process
The Board of Directors shall designate agents upon whom service
of process may be made in any State, territory, or jurisdiction
in which any insured depository institution is located.
(4) Bonds or fees
The Corporation shall not be required to post any bond to
pursue any appeal and shall not be subject to payments of any
filing fees in United States district courts or courts of appeal.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[9], 64 Stat. 881; Pub. L. 89-695,
title II, Sec. 205, Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat. 1055; Pub. L. 95-630,
title III, Sec. 309, Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3677; Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Sec. 209, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 216; Pub. L. 102-242,
title I, Sec. 161(d), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2286; Pub. L. 103-
325, title III, Sec. 331(e), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat. 2232.)


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (j) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
1994 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 103-325 in par. Fourth inserted "by
and through its own attorneys," after "complain and defend,".
1991 - Subsec. (b)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-242 inserted before period
at end "before the end of the 90-day period beginning on the date
the action, suit, or proceeding is filed against the Corporation or
the Corporation is substituted as a party".
1989 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 209(2), designated
existing provisions as subsec. (a) and inserted heading.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 209(3), amended par. Fourth generally. Prior
to amendment, par. Fourth read as follows: "Fourth. To sue and be
sued, complain and defend, in any court of law or equity, State or
Federal. All suits of a civil nature at common law or in equity to
which the Corporation shall be a party shall be deemed to arise
under the laws of the United States, and the United States district
courts shall have original jurisdiction thereof, without regard to
the amount in controversy; and the Corporation may, without bond or
security, remove any such action, suit, or proceeding from a State
court to the United States district court for the district or
division embracing the place where the same is pending by following
any procedure for removal now or hereafter in effect, except that
any such suit to which the Corporation is a party in its capacity
as receiver of a State bank and which involves only the rights or
obligations of depositors, creditors, stockholders, and such State
bank under State law shall not be deemed to arise under the laws of
the United States. No attachment or execution shall be issued
against the Corporation or its property before final judgment in
any suit, action, or proceeding in any State, county, municipal, or
United States court. The Board of Directors shall designate an
agent upon whom service of process may be made in any State,
Territory, or jurisdiction in which any insured bank is located."
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 209(1), in par. Eighth, substituted
reference to depository institutions for reference to banks.
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 209(4), added subsec. (b).
1978 - Pub. L. 95-630 in par. Tenth inserted "or of any other law
which it has the responsibility of administering or enforcing
(except to the extent that authority to issue such rules and
regulations has been expressly and exclusively granted to any other
regulatory agency)" after "provisions of this chapter".
1966 - Pub. L. 89-695 in par. Fourth vested United States
district courts, without regard to the amount in controversy, with
original jurisdiction over any action to which the Corporation is a
party and authorized the removal of such actions to the Federal
courts.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment effective upon expiration of 120 days after Nov. 10,
1978, see section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as an Effective
Date note under section 375b of this title.

EXPIRATION OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 908, Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811,
repealed section 401 of Pub. L. 89-695 which provided that: "The
provisions of titles I and II of this Act [amending sections 1464,
1730, 1813, 1817 to 1820 and repealing section 77 of this title and
enacting provisions set out as notes under sections 1464, 1730, and
1813 of this title] and any provisions of law enacted by said
titles shall be effective only during the period ending at the
close of June 30, 1972. Effective upon the expiration of such
period, each provision of law amended by either of such titles is
further amended to read as it did immediately prior to the
enactment of this Act [Oct. 16, 1966] and each provision of law
repealed by either of such titles is reenacted."

CONDITIONS GOVERNING EMPLOYMENT OF PERSONNEL NOT REPEALED,
MODIFIED, OR AFFECTED
Nothing contained in section 205 of Pub. L. 89-695 amending
subsec. Fourth of this section to be construed as repealing,
modifying, or affecting section 1829 of this title, see section 206
of Pub. L. 89-695, set out as a note under section 1813 of this
title.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1820 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1820. Administration of Corporation

-STATUTE-
(a) Board of Directors; use of mails; cooperation with other
Federal agencies
The Board of Directors shall administer the affairs of the
Corporation fairly and impartially and without discrimination. The
Board of Directors of the Corporation shall determine and prescribe
the manner in which its obligations shall be incurred and its
expenses allowed and paid. The Corporation shall be entitled to the
free use of the United States mails in the same manner as the
executive departments of the Government. The Corporation with the
consent of any Federal Reserve bank or of any board, commission,
independent establishment, or executive department of the
Government, including any field service thereof, may avail itself
of the use of information, services, and facilities thereof in
carrying out the provisions of this chapter.
(b) Examinations
(1) Appointment of examiners and claims agents
The Board of Directors shall appoint examiners and claims
agents.
(2) Regular examinations
Any examiner appointed under paragraph (1) shall have power, on
behalf of the Corporation, to examine -
(A) any insured State nonmember bank or insured State branch
of any foreign bank;
(B) any depository institution which files an application
with the Corporation to become an insured depository
institution; and
(C) any insured depository institution in default,

whenever the Board of Directors determines an examination of any
such depository institution is necessary.
(3) Special examination of any insured depository institution
(A) In general
In addition to the examinations authorized under paragraph
(2), any examiner appointed under paragraph (1) shall have
power, on behalf of the Corporation, to make any special
examination of any insured depository institution or nonbank
financial company supervised by the Board of Governors or a
bank holding company described in section 165(a) of the
Financial Stability Act of 2010 [12 U.S.C. 5365(a)], whenever
the Board of Directors determines that a special examination of
any such depository institution is necessary to determine the
condition of such depository institution for insurance
purposes, or of such nonbank financial company supervised by
the Board of Governors or bank holding company described in
section 165(a) of the Financial Stability Act of 2010 [12
U.S.C. 5365(a)], for the purpose of implementing its authority
to provide for orderly liquidation of any such company under
title II (!1) of that Act, provided that such authority may not
be used with respect to any such company that is in a generally
sound condition.

(B) Limitation
Before conducting a special examination of a nonbank
financial company supervised by the Board of Governors or a
bank holding company described in section 165(a) of the
Financial Stability Act of 2010 [12 U.S.C. 5365(a)], the
Corporation shall review any available and acceptable
resolution plan that the company has submitted in accordance
with section 165(d) of that Act [12 U.S.C. 5365(d)], consistent
with the nonbinding effect of such plan, and available reports
of examination, and shall coordinate to the maximum extent
practicable with the Board of Governors, in order to minimize
duplicative or conflicting examinations.
(4) Examination of affiliates
(A) In general
In making any examination under paragraph (2) or (3), any
examiner appointed under paragraph (1) shall have power, on
behalf of the Corporation, to make such examinations of the
affairs of any affiliate of any depository institution as may
be necessary to disclose fully -
(i) the relationship between such depository institution
and any such affiliate; and
(ii) the effect of such relationship on the depository
institution.
(B) Commitment by foreign banks to allow examinations of
affiliates
No branch or depository institution subsidiary of a foreign
bank may become an insured depository institution unless such
foreign bank submits a written binding commitment to the Board
of Directors to permit any examination of any affiliate of such
branch or depository institution subsidiary pursuant to
subparagraph (A) to the extent determined by the Board of
Directors to be necessary to carry out the purposes of this
chapter.
(5) Examination of insured State branches
The Board of Directors shall -
(A) coordinate examinations of insured State branches of
foreign banks with examinations conducted by the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System under section
3105(c)(1) of this title; and
(B) to the extent possible, participate in any simultaneous
examination of the United States operations of a foreign bank
requested by the Board under such section.
(6) Power and duty of examiners
Each examiner appointed under paragraph (1) shall -
(A) have power to make a thorough examination of any insured
depository institution or affiliate under paragraph (2), (3),
(4), or (5); and
(B) shall make a full and detailed report of condition of any
insured depository institution or affiliate examined to the
Corporation.
(7) Power of claim agents
Each claim agent appointed under paragraph (1) shall have power
to investigate and examine all claims for insured deposits.
(c) Administration of oaths and affirmations; evidence; subpena
powers
In connection with examinations of insured depository
institutions and any State nonmember bank, savings association, or
other institution making application to become insured depository
institutions, and affiliates thereof, or with other types of
investigations to determine compliance with applicable law and
regulations, the appropriate Federal banking agency, or its
designated representatives, are authorized to administer oaths and
affirmations, and to examine and to take and preserve testimony
under oath as to any matter in respect to the affairs or ownership
of any such bank or institution or affiliate thereof, and to
exercise such other powers as are set forth in section 1818(n) of
this title.
(d) Annual on-site examinations of all insured depository
institutions required
(1) In general
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall, not less than
once during each 12-month period, conduct a full-scope, on-site
examination of each insured depository institution.
(2) Examinations by Corporation
Paragraph (1) shall not apply during any 12-month period in
which the Corporation has conducted a full-scope, on-site
examination of the insured depository institution.
(3) State examinations acceptable
The examinations required by paragraph (1) may be conducted in
alternate 12-month periods, as appropriate, if the appropriate
Federal banking agency determines that an examination of the
insured depository institution conducted by the State during the
intervening 12-month period carries out the purpose of this
subsection.
(4) 18-month rule for certain small institutions
Paragraphs (1), (2), and (3) shall apply with "18-month"
substituted for "12-month" if -
(A) the insured depository institution has total assets of
less than $500,000,000;
(B) the institution is well capitalized, as defined in
section 1831o of this title;
(C) when the institution was most recently examined, it was
found to be well managed, and its composite condition -
(i) was found to be outstanding; or
(ii) was found to be outstanding or good, in the case of an
insured depository institution that has total assets of not
more than $100,000,000;

(D) the insured institution is not currently subject to a
formal enforcement proceeding or order by the Corporation or
the appropriate Federal banking agency; and
(E) no person acquired control of the institution during the
12-month period in which a full-scope, on-site examination
would be required but for this paragraph.
(5) Certain Government-controlled institutions exempted
Paragraph (1) does not apply to -
(A) any institution for which the Corporation or the
Resolution Trust Corporation is conservator; or
(B) any bridge depository institution, none of the voting
securities of which are owned by a person or agency other than
the Corporation or the Resolution Trust Corporation.
(6) Coordinated examinations
To minimize the disruptive effects of examinations on the
operations of insured depository institutions -
(A) each appropriate Federal banking agency shall, to the
extent practicable and consistent with principles of safety and
soundness and the public interest -
(i) coordinate examinations to be conducted by that agency
at an insured depository institution and its affiliates;
(ii) coordinate with the other appropriate Federal banking
agencies in the conduct of such examinations;
(iii) work to coordinate with the appropriate State bank
supervisor -
(I) the conduct of all examinations made pursuant to this
subsection; and
(II) the number, types, and frequency of reports required
to be submitted to such agencies and supervisors by insured
depository institutions, and the type and amount of
information required to be included in such reports; and

(iv) use copies of reports of examinations of insured
depository institutions made by any other Federal banking
agency or appropriate State bank supervisor to eliminate
duplicative requests for information; and

(B) not later than 2 years after September 23, 1994, the
Federal banking agencies shall jointly establish and implement
a system for determining which one of the Federal banking
agencies or State bank supervisors shall be the lead agency
responsible for managing a unified examination of each insured
depository institution and its affiliates, as required by this
subsection.
(7) Separate examinations permitted
Notwithstanding paragraph (6), each appropriate Federal banking
agency may conduct a separate examination in an emergency or
under other exigent circumstances, or when the agency believes
that a violation of law may have occurred.
(8) Report
At the time the system provided for in paragraph (6) is
established, the Federal banking agencies shall submit a joint
report describing the system to the Committee on Banking,
Housing, and Urban Affairs of the Senate and the Committee on
Banking, Finance and Urban Affairs of the House of
Representatives. Thereafter, the Federal banking agencies shall
annually submit a joint report to the Committee on Banking,
Housing, and Urban Affairs of the Senate and the Committee on
Banking, Finance and Urban Affairs of the House of
Representatives regarding the progress of the agencies in
implementing the system and indicating areas in which
enhancements to the system, including legislature improvements,
would be appropriate.
(9) Standards for determining adequacy of State examinations
The Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council shall
issue guidelines establishing standards to be used at the
discretion of the appropriate Federal banking agency for purposes
of making a determination under paragraph (3).
(10) Agencies authorized to increase maximum asset amount of
institutions for certain purposes
At any time after the end of the 2-year period beginning on
September 23, 1994, the appropriate Federal banking agency, in
the agency's discretion, may increase the maximum amount
limitation contained in paragraph (4)(C)(ii), by regulation, from
$100,000,000 to an amount not to exceed $500,000,000 for purposes
of such paragraph, if the agency determines that the greater
amount would be consistent with the principles of safety and
soundness for insured depository institutions.
(e) Examination fees
(1) Regular and special examinations of depository institutions
The cost of conducting any regular examination or special
examination of any depository institution under subsection
(b)(2), (b)(3), or (d) of this section may be assessed by the
Corporation against the institution to meet the Corporation's
expenses in carrying out such examinations.
(2) Examination of affiliates
The cost of conducting any examination of any affiliate of any
insured depository institution under subsection (b)(4) of this
section may be assessed by the Corporation against each affiliate
which is examined to meet the Corporation's expenses in carrying
out such examination.
(3) Assessment against depository institution in case of
affiliate's refusal to pay
(A) In general
Subject to subparagraph (B), if any affiliate of any insured
depository institution -
(i) refuses to pay any assessment under paragraph (2); or
(ii) fails to pay any such assessment before the end of the
60-day period beginning on the date the affiliate receives
notice of the assessment,

the Corporation may assess such cost against, and collect such
cost from, the depository institution.
(B) Affiliate of more than 1 depository institution
If any affiliate referred to in subparagraph (A) is an
affiliate of more than 1 insured depository institution, the
assessment under subparagraph (A) may be assessed against the
depository institutions in such proportions as the Corporation
determines to be appropriate.
(4) Civil money penalty for affiliate's refusal to cooperate
(A) Penalty imposed
If any affiliate of any insured depository institution -
(i) refuses to permit an examiner appointed by the Board of
Directors under subsection (b)(1) of this section to conduct
an examination; or
(ii) refuses to provide any information required to be
disclosed in the course of any examination,

the depository institution shall forfeit and pay a penalty of
not more than $5,000 for each day that any such refusal
continues.
(B) Assessment and collection
Any penalty imposed under subparagraph (A) shall be assessed
and collected by the Corporation in the manner provided in
section 1818(i)(2) of this title.
(5) Deposits of examination assessment
Amounts received by the Corporation under this subsection
(other than paragraph (4)) may be deposited in the manner
provided in section 1823 of this title.
(f) Preservation of agency records
(1) In general
A Federal banking agency may cause any and all records, papers,
or documents kept by the agency or in the possession or custody
of the agency to be -
(A) photographed or microphotographed or otherwise reproduced
upon film; or
(B) preserved in any electronic medium or format which is
capable of -
(i) being read or scanned by computer; and
(ii) being reproduced from such electronic medium or format
by printing any other form of reproduction of electronically
stored data.
(2) Treatment as original records
Any photographs, microphotographs, or photographic film or
copies thereof described in paragraph (1)(A) or reproduction of
electronically stored data described in paragraph (1)(B) shall be
deemed to be an original record for all purposes, including
introduction in evidence in all State and Federal courts or
administrative agencies, and shall be admissible to prove any
act, transaction, occurrence, or event therein recorded.
(3) Authority of the Federal banking agencies
Any photographs, microphotographs, or photographic film or
copies thereof described in paragraph (1)(A) or reproduction of
electronically stored data described in paragraph (1)(B) shall be
preserved in such manner as the Federal banking agency shall
prescribe, and the original records, papers, or documents may be
destroyed or otherwise disposed of as the Federal banking agency
may direct.
(g) Authority to prescribe regulations and definitions
Except to the extent that authority under this chapter is
conferred on any of the Federal banking agencies other than the
Corporation, the Corporation may -
(1) prescribe regulations to carry out this chapter; and
(2) by regulation define terms as necessary to carry out this
chapter.
(h) Coordination of examination authority
(1) State bank supervisors of home and host States
(A) Home State of bank
The appropriate State bank supervisor of the home State of an
insured State bank has authority to examine and supervise the
bank.
(B) Host State branches
The State bank supervisor of the home State of an insured
State bank and any State bank supervisor of an appropriate host
State shall exercise its respective authority to supervise and
examine the branches of the bank in a host State in accordance
with the terms of any applicable cooperative agreement between
the home State bank supervisor and the State bank supervisor of
the relevant host State.
(C) Supervisory fees
Except as expressly provided in a cooperative agreement
between the State bank supervisors of the home State and any
host State of an insured State bank, only the State bank
supervisor of the home State of an insured State bank may levy
or charge State supervisory fees on the bank.
(2) Host State examination
(A) In general
With respect to a branch operated in a host State by an out-
of-State insured State bank that resulted from an interstate
merger transaction approved under section 1831u of this title,
or that was established in such State pursuant to section 36(g)
of this title, the third undesignated paragraph of section 321
of this title or section 1828(d)(4) of this title, the
appropriate State bank supervisor of such host State may -
(i) with written notice to the State bank supervisor of the
bank's home State and subject to the terms of any applicable
cooperative agreement with the State bank supervisor of such
home State, examine such branch for the purpose of
determining compliance with host State laws that are
applicable pursuant to section 1831a(j) of this title,
including those that govern community reinvestment, fair
lending, and consumer protection; and
(ii) if expressly permitted under and subject to the terms
of a cooperative agreement with the State bank supervisor of
the bank's home State or if such out-of-State insured State
bank has been determined to be in a troubled condition by
either the State bank supervisor of the bank's home State or
the bank's appropriate Federal banking agency, participate in
the examination of the bank by the State bank supervisor of
the bank's home State to ascertain that the activities of the
branch in such host State are not conducted in an unsafe or
unsound manner.
(B) Notice of determination
(i) In general
The State bank supervisor of the home State of an insured
State bank shall notify the State bank supervisor of each
host State of the bank if there has been a final
determination that the bank is in a troubled condition.
(ii) Timing of notice
The State bank supervisor of the home State of an insured
State bank shall provide notice under clause (i) as soon as
is reasonably possible, but in all cases not later than 15
business days after the date on which the State bank
supervisor has made such final determination or has received
written notification of such final determination.
(3) Host State enforcement
If the State bank supervisor of a host State determines that a
branch of an out-of-State insured State bank is violating any law
of the host State that is applicable to such branch pursuant to
section 1831a(j) of this title, including a law that governs
community reinvestment, fair lending, or consumer protection, the
State bank supervisor of the host State or, to the extent
authorized by the law of the host State, a host State law
enforcement officer may, with written notice to the State bank
supervisor of the bank's home State and subject to the terms of
any applicable cooperative agreement with the State bank
supervisor of the bank's home State, undertake such enforcement
actions and proceedings as would be permitted under the law of
the host State as if the branch were a bank chartered by that
host State.
(4) Cooperative agreement
(A) In general
The State bank supervisors from 2 or more States may enter
into cooperative agreements to facilitate State regulatory
supervision of State banks, including cooperative agreements
relating to the coordination of examinations and joint
participation in examinations.
(B) Definition
For purposes of this subsection, the term "cooperative
agreement" means a written agreement that is signed by the home
State bank supervisor and the host State bank supervisor to
facilitate State regulatory supervision of State banks, and
includes nationwide or multi-State cooperative agreements and
cooperative agreements solely between the home State and host
State.
(C) Rule of construction
Except for State bank supervisors, no provision of this
subsection relating to such cooperative agreements shall be
construed as limiting in any way the authority of home State
and host State law enforcement officers, regulatory
supervisors, or other officials that have not signed such
cooperative agreements to enforce host State laws that are
applicable to a branch of an out-of-State insured State bank
located in the host State pursuant to section 1831a(j) of this
title.
(5) Federal regulatory authority
No provision of this subsection shall be construed as limiting
in any way the authority of any Federal banking agency.
(6) State taxation authority not affected
No provision of this subsection shall be construed as affecting
the authority of any State or political subdivision of any State
to adopt, apply, or administer any tax or method of taxation to
any bank, bank holding company, or foreign bank, or any affiliate
of any bank, bank holding company, or foreign bank, to the extent
that such tax or tax method is otherwise permissible by or under
the Constitution of the United States or other Federal law.
(7) Definitions
For purpose of this section, the following definitions shall
apply:
(A) Host State, home State, out-of-State bank
The terms "host State", "home State", and "out-of-State bank"
have the same meanings as in section 1831u(g) of this title.
(B) State supervisory fees
The term "State supervisory fees" means assessments,
examination fees, branch fees, license fees, and all other fees
that are levied or charged by a State bank supervisor directly
upon an insured State bank or upon branches of an insured State
bank.
(C) Troubled condition
Solely for purposes of paragraph (2)(B), an insured State
bank has been determined to be in "troubled condition" if the
bank -
(i) has a composite rating, as determined in its most
recent report of examination, of 4 or 5 under the Uniform
Financial Institutions Ratings System;
(ii) is subject to a proceeding initiated by the
Corporation for termination or suspension of deposit
insurance; or
(iii) is subject to a proceeding initiated by the State
bank supervisor of the bank's home State to vacate, revoke,
or terminate the charter of the bank, or to liquidate the
bank, or to appoint a receiver for the bank.
(D) Final determination
For purposes of paragraph (2)(B), the term "final
determination" means the transmittal of a report of examination
to the bank or transmittal of official notice of proceedings to
the bank.
(i) Flood insurance compliance by insured depository institutions
(1) Examinations
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall, during each
scheduled on-site examination required by this section, determine
whether the insured depository institution is complying with the
requirements of the national flood insurance program.
(2) Report
(A) Requirement
Not later than 1 year after September 23, 1994, and
biennially thereafter for the next 4 years, each appropriate
Federal banking agency shall submit a report to the Congress on
compliance by insured depository institutions with the
requirements of the national flood insurance program.
(B) Contents
Each report submitted under this paragraph shall include a
description of the methods used to determine compliance, the
number of institutions examined during the reporting year, a
listing and total number of institutions found not to be in
compliance, actions taken to correct incidents of
noncompliance, and an analysis of compliance, including a
discussion of any trends, patterns, and problems, and
recommendations regarding reasonable actions to improve the
efficiency of the examinations processes.
(j) Consultation among examiners
(1) In general
Each appropriate Federal banking agency shall take such action
as may be necessary to ensure that examiners employed by the
agency -
(A) consult on examination activities with respect to any
depository institution; and
(B) achieve an agreement and resolve any inconsistencies in
the recommendations to be given to such institution as a
consequence of any examinations.
(2) Examiner-in-charge
Each appropriate Federal banking agency shall consider
appointing an examiner-in-charge with respect to a depository
institution to ensure consultation on examination activities
among all of the examiners of that agency involved in
examinations of the institution.
(k) One-year restrictions on Federal examiners of financial
institutions
(1) In general
In addition to other applicable restrictions set forth in title
18, the penalties set forth in paragraph (6) of this subsection
shall apply to any person who -
(A) was an officer or employee (including any special
Government employee) of a Federal banking agency or a Federal
reserve bank;
(B) served 2 or more months during the final 12 months of his
or her employment with such agency or entity as the senior
examiner (or a functionally equivalent position) of a
depository institution or depository institution holding
company with continuing, broad responsibility for the
examination (or inspection) of that depository institution or
depository institution holding company on behalf of the
relevant agency or Federal reserve bank; and
(C) within 1 year after the termination date of his or her
service or employment with such agency or entity, knowingly
accepts compensation as an employee, officer, director, or
consultant from -
(i) such depository institution, any depository institution
holding company that controls such depository institution, or
any other company that controls such depository institution;
or
(ii) such depository institution holding company or any
depository institution that is controlled by such depository
institution holding company.
(2) Definitions
For purposes of this subsection -
(A) the term "depository institution" includes an uninsured
branch or agency of a foreign bank, if such branch or agency is
located in any State; and
(B) the term "depository institution holding company"
includes any foreign bank or company described in section
3106(a) of this title.
(3) Rules of construction
For purposes of this subsection, a foreign bank shall be deemed
to control any branch or agency of the foreign bank, and a person
shall be deemed to act as a consultant for a depository
institution, depository institution holding company, or other
company, only if such person directly works on matters for, or on
behalf of, such depository institution, depository institution
holding company, or other company.
(4) Regulations
(A) In general
Each Federal banking agency shall prescribe rules or
regulations to administer and carry out this subsection,
including rules, regulations, or guidelines to define the scope
of persons referred to in paragraph (1)(B).
(B) Consultation required
The Federal banking agencies shall consult with each other
for the purpose of assuring that the rules and regulations
issued by the agencies under subparagraph (A) are, to the
extent possible, consistent, comparable, and practicable,
taking into account any differences in the supervisory programs
utilized by the agencies for the supervision of depository
institutions and depository institution holding companies.
(5) Waiver
(A) Agency authority
A Federal banking agency may grant a waiver, on a case by
case basis, of the restriction imposed by this subsection to
any officer or employee (including any special Government
employee) of that agency, and the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System may grant a waiver of the restriction
imposed by this subsection to any officer or employee of a
Federal reserve bank, if the head of such agency certifies in
writing that granting the waiver would not affect the integrity
of the supervisory program of the relevant Federal banking
agency.
(B) Definition
For purposes of this paragraph, the head of an agency is -
(i) the Comptroller of the Currency, in the case of the
Office of the Comptroller of the Currency;
(ii) the Chairman of the Board of Governors of the Federal
Reserve System, in the case of the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System;
(iii) the Chairperson of the Board of Directors, in the
case of the Corporation; and
(iv) the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, in
the case of the Office of Thrift Supervision.
(6) Penalties
(A) In general
In addition to any other administrative, civil, or criminal
remedy or penalty that may otherwise apply, whenever a Federal
banking agency determines that a person subject to paragraph
(1) has become associated, in the manner described in paragraph
(1)(C), with a depository institution, depository institution
holding company, or other company for which such agency serves
as the appropriate Federal banking agency, the agency shall
impose upon such person one or more of the following penalties:
(i) Industry-wide prohibition order
The Federal banking agency shall serve a written notice or
order in accordance with and subject to the provisions of
section 1818(e)(4) of this title for written notices or
orders under paragraph (1) or (2) of section 1818(e) of this
title, upon such person of the intention of the agency -
(I) to remove such person from office or to prohibit such
person from further participation in the conduct of the
affairs of the depository institution, depository
institution holding company, or other company for a period
of up to 5 years; and
(II) to prohibit any further participation by such
person, in any manner, in the conduct of the affairs of any
insured depository institution for a period of up to 5
years.
(ii) Civil monetary penalty
The Federal banking agency may, in an administrative
proceeding or civil action in an appropriate United States
district court, impose on such person a civil monetary
penalty of not more than $250,000. Any administrative
proceeding under this clause shall be conducted in accordance
with section 1818(i) of this title. In lieu of an action by
the Federal banking agency under this clause, the Attorney
General of the United States may bring a civil action under
this clause in the appropriate United States district court.
(B) Scope of prohibition order
Any person subject to an order issued under subparagraph
(A)(i) shall be subject to paragraphs (6) and (7) of section
1818(e) of this title in the same manner and to the same extent
as a person subject to an order issued under such section.
(C) Definitions
Solely for purposes of this paragraph, the "appropriate
Federal banking agency" for a company that is not a depository
institution or depository institution holding company shall be
the Federal banking agency on whose behalf the person described
in paragraph (1) performed the functions described in paragraph
(1)(B).

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[10], 64 Stat. 882; Pub. L. 86-671,
Sec. 4, July 14, 1960, 74 Stat. 551; Pub. L. 89-695, title II, Sec.
203, Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat. 1053; Pub. L. 91-452, title II, Sec.
208, Oct. 15, 1970, 84 Stat. 929; Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(16),
Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 619; Pub. L. 95-630, title III, Sec. 305,
Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3677; Pub. L. 97-320, title I, Sec. 113(i),
title IV, Sec. 410(g), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1474, 1520; Pub. L.
100-418, title V, Sec. 5115(c), Aug. 23, 1988, 102 Stat. 1433; Pub.
L. 101-73, title II, Secs. 201(a), 210, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat.
187, 217; Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Secs. 111(a), 113(a), (b),
(c)(2), title II, Sec. 203(c), title III, Sec. 302(d), Dec. 19,
1991, 105 Stat. 2240, 2246-2248, 2292, 2349; Pub. L. 102-550, title
XVI, Secs. 1603(b)(1), (4), 1604(a)(3), 1605(a)(4), Oct. 28, 1992,
106 Stat. 4078, 4079, 4082, 4085; Pub. L. 102-558, title III, Secs.
303(b)(5), 305, Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4225, 4226; Pub. L. 103-
325, title III, Secs. 305(a), 306, 349(a), title V, Sec. 529(a),
title VI, Sec. 602(a)(19), (20), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat. 2216,
2217, 2242, 2266, 2289; Pub. L. 103-328, title I, Sec. 105, Sept.
29, 1994, 108 Stat. 2357; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Secs.
2221, 2244, Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-414, 3009-419; Pub. L.
108-386, Sec. 8(a)(3), Oct. 30, 2004, 118 Stat. 2231; Pub. L. 108-
458, title VI, Sec. 6303(b), Dec. 17, 2004, 118 Stat. 3751; Pub.
L. 109-351, title VI, Sec. 605, title VII, Secs. 711, 723(a), Oct.
13, 2006, 120 Stat. 1981, 1991, 2000; Pub. L. 109-473, Sec. 1, Jan.
11, 2007, 120 Stat. 3561; Pub. L. 110-289, div. A, title VI, Sec.
1604(b)(1)(B), July 30, 2008, 122 Stat. 2829; Pub. L. 111-203,
title I, Sec. 172(a), title III, Secs. 318(d), 363(4), July 21,
2010, 124 Stat. 1438, 1527, 1552.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(4), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1552, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (d)(5), by striking out "or the Resolution
Trust Corporation" wherever appearing; and
(2) in subsection (k)(5)(B) -
(A) in clause (ii), by inserting "and" after the semicolon;
(B) in clause (iii), by substituting a period for "; and"; and
(C) by striking out clause (iv).
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 318(d), (e), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1527, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
subsection (e) of this section is amended by striking out paragraph
(1) and inserting the following:
"(1) Regular and special examinations of depository institutions
"The cost of conducting any regular examination or special
examination of any depository institution under subsection
(b)(2), (b)(3), or (d) or of any entity described in section
1813(q)(2) of this title may be assessed by the Corporation
against the institution or entity to meet the expenses of the
Corporation in carrying out such examinations."

See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
Title II of that Act, referred to in subsec. (b)(3)(A), probably
means title II of Pub. L. 111-203, known as the Dodd-Frank Wall
Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, which is classified
principally to subchapter II (Sec. 5381 et seq.) of chapter 53 of
this title. The Financial Stability Act of 2010, which is title I
of Pub. L. 111-203, does not contain titles. For complete
classification of title II to the Code, see Tables.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Subsecs. (a), (b), [former] (e), and [former] (f) are derived
from subsec. (k) of former section 264 of this title. See
Codification note set out under section 1811 of this title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (b)(3). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 172(a)(2), which
directed substitution of "or nonbank financial company supervised
by the Board of Governors or a bank holding company described in
section 165(a) of the Financial Stability Act of 2010, whenever the
Board of Directors determines that a special examination of any
such depository institution is necessary to determine the condition
of such depository institution for insurance purposes, or of such
nonbank financial company supervised by the Board of Governors or
bank holding company described in section 165(a) of the Financial
Stability Act of 2010, for the purpose of implementing its
authority to provide for orderly liquidation of any such company
under title II of that Act, provided that such authority may not be
used with respect to any such company that is in a generally sound
condition.
"(B) Limitation. - Before conducting a special examination of a
nonbank financial company supervised by the Board of Governors or
a bank holding company described in section 165(a) of the
Financial Stability Act of 2010, the Corporation shall review any
available and acceptable resolution plan that the company has
submitted in accordance with section 165(d) of that Act,
consistent with the nonbinding effect of such plan, and available
reports of examination, and shall coordinate to the maximum
extent practicable with the Board of Governors, in order to
minimize duplicative or conflicting examinations."
for " 'whenever the board of directors determines' and all that
follows through the period", was executed by making the
substitution for "whenever the Board of Directors determines" and
all that followed through the period, to reflect the probable
intent of Congress.
Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 172(a)(1), designated existing provisions
as subpar. (A) and inserted heading.
2008 - Subsec. (d)(5)(B). Pub. L. 110-289 substituted "bridge
depository institution" for "bridge bank".
2007 - Subsec. (d)(10). Pub. L. 109-473 substituted
"$500,000,000" for "$250,000,000".
2006 - Subsec. (d)(4)(A). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 605, substituted
"$500,000,000" for "$250,000,000".
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 723(a), amended subsec. (f)
generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "The
Corporation may cause any and all records, papers, or documents
kept by it or in its possession or custody to be photographed or
microphotographed or otherwise reproduced upon film, which
photographic film shall comply with the minimum standards of
quality approved for permanent photographic records by the National
Institute of Standards and Technology. Such photographs,
microphotographs, or photographic film or copies thereof shall be
deemed to be an original record for all purposes, including
introduction in evidence in all State and Federal courts or
administrative agencies and shall be admissible to prove any act,
transaction, occurrence, or event therein recorded. Such
photographs, microphotographs, or reproduction shall be preserved
in such manner as the Board of Directors of the Corporation shall
prescribe and the original records, papers, or documents may be
destroyed or otherwise disposed of as the Board shall direct."
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 711, amended subsec. (h)
generally. Prior to amendment, subsec. (h) related to coordination
of examination authority.
2004 - Subsec. (b)(2)(A). Pub. L. 108-386 struck out "(except a
District bank)" after "State nonmember bank".
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 108-458 added subsec. (k).
1996 - Subsec. (d)(6)(B). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2244(b), which
directed insertion of "or State bank supervisors" after "one of the
Federal agencies", was executed by making the insertion after "one
of the Federal banking agencies" to reflect the probable intent of
Congress.
Subsec. (d)(8). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2221(1), redesignated par.
(8), relating to agencies authorized to increase maximum asset
amount of institutions for certain purposes, as (10).
Subsec. (d)(10). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2221(2), substituted
"$250,000,000" for "$175,000,000".
Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2221(1), redesignated par. (8), relating to
agencies authorized to increase maximum asset amount of
institutions for certain purposes, as (10).
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2244(a), added subsec. (j).
1994 - Subsec. (b)(1). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(19),
substituted "claims" for "claim".
Subsec. (b)(2)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(20), inserted
"and" at end.
Subsec. (d)(4)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 306(a)(1), substituted
"$250,000,000" for "$100,000,000".
Subsec. (d)(4)(C). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 306(a)(2), substituted
"and its composite condition -
"(i) was found to be outstanding; or
"(ii) was found to be outstanding or good, in the case of an
insured depository institution that has total assets of not more
than $100,000,000;"
for "and its composite condition was found to be outstanding; and".
Subsec. (d)(4)(D), (E). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 306(a)(3), (4),
added subpar. (D) and redesignated former subpar. (D) as (E).
Subsec. (d)(6), (7). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 305(a), added pars.
(6) and (7).
Subsec. (d)(8). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 306(b), added par. (8)
relating to agencies authorized to increase maximum asset amount of
institutions for certain purposes.
Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 305(a), added par. (8) relating to report
requirements.
Subsec. (d)(9). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 349(a), added par. (9).
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 103-328 added subsec. (h).
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 529(a), added subsec. (i).
1992 - Subsec. (b)(6)(A). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1604(a)(3),
substituted "paragraph (2), (3), (4), or (5);" for " 'paragraph
(2)' and all that follows through the semicolon" resulting in no
change in text.
Subsec. (d)(5). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(1)(A), (B),
inserted "or the Resolution Trust Corporation" in subpars. (A) and
(B) and inserted a comma after "bank" in subpar. (B).
Subsec. (d)(6). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(1)(C), struck out
par. (6) which read as follows: "(6) Consumer compliance
examinations excluded. - For purposes of this subsection, the term
'full-scope, on-site examination' does not include a consumer
compliance examination, as defined in section 41(b)."
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(4), amended directory
language of Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(a)(2). See 1991 Amendment
note below.
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 303(b)(5), redesignated
subsec. (f), relating to authority to prescribe regulations and
definitions, as (g). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1605(a)(4), which
contained an identical amendment, was repealed, effective Oct. 28,
1992, by Pub. L. 102-558, Sec. 305, set out as a Repeal of
Duplicative Provisions note under section 1815 of this title.
1991 - Subsec. (b)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(b), amended
subpar. (B) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (B) read as
follows: "any savings association, State nonmember bank, or State
branch of a foreign bank, or other depository institution which
files an application with the Corporation to become an insured
depository institution; and".
Subsec. (b)(4)(A). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(c)(2), struck out
"insured" before "depository institution" in three places.
Subsec. (b)(5) to (7). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 203(c), added par.
(5), redesignated former par. (5) as (6) and substituted "(4), or
(5)" for "or (4)", and redesignated former par. (6) as (7).
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 111(a), added subsec. (d).
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(a)(2), as amended by Pub.
L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(b)(4), added subsec. (e). Former subsec. (e)
redesignated (f).
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 302(d), added subsec. (f)
relating to authority to prescribe regulations and definitions.
Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 113(a)(1), redesignated subsec. (e),
relating to preservation of records by photography, as (f).
1989 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 210(a), amended subsec.
(b) generally, revising and restating as pars. (1) to (6)
provisions formerly contained in a single unnumbered paragraph.
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 210(b)(1), substituted "and any
State nonmember bank, savings association, or other institution"
for ", State nonmember banks or other institutions".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institutions" for "insured banks" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 210(b)(2), struck out subsec.
(d) which defined "affiliate" and "member bank" for purposes of
this section.
1988 - Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 100-418 substituted "National
Institute of Standards and Technology" for "National Bureau of
Standards".
1982 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(i), inserted "or any
insured Federal savings bank," after "foreign bank, or District
bank,".
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 410(g), inserted "as in section
221a(b) of this title and".
1978 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 305(a), inserted "or
other institution" after "any State nonmember bank" and struck out
provisions that each claim agent have power to administer oaths and
affirmations and to examine and to take and preserve testimony
under oath as to any matter in respect to claims for insured
deposits, and to issue subpenas and subpenas duces tecum, and, for
the enforcement thereof, to apply to the United States district
court for the judicial district or the United States court in any
territory in which the main office of the bank or affiliate thereof
is located, or in which the witness resides or carriers on business
and that such courts have jurisdiction and power to order and
require compliance with any such subpena.
Pub. L. 95-369 inserted "any insured State branch of a foreign
bank, any State branch of a foreign bank making application to
become an insured bank" after "(except a District bank)", inserted
"or branch" after "and any closed insured bank", substituted "any
national bank, insured Federal branch of a foreign bank, or
District bank" for "any national bank or District bank" and
inserted "and in the case of a foreign bank, a binding commitment
by such bank to permit such examination to the extent determined by
the Board of Directors to be necessary to carry out the purposes of
this chapter shall be required as a condition to the insurance of
any deposits" after "effect of such relations upon such banks".
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 305(b), among other changes,
inserted references to State nonmember banks, other institutions
making application to become insured banks, and investigations to
determine compliance with applicable law and regulations and struck
out provisions defining "affiliate" and "member bank".
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 95-630, Sec. 305(b), substituted provisions
defining the terms "affiliate" and "member bank" for provisions
relating to the enforcement of subpenas and orders.
1970 - Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 91-452 struck out provisions which
granted immunity from prosecution for any individual compelled to
testify or produce evidence, documentary or otherwise, after
claiming his privilege against self-incrimination.
1966 - Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 89-695 empowered Corporation
examiners making examinations of insured banks to make such
examinations of the affairs of all affiliates of such banks as
shall be necessary to disclose fully the relations between such
banks and their affiliates and the effect of such relations upon
such banks, authorized Corporation claim agents to issue subpenas
and subpenas duces tecum in connection with investigation and
examination of claims for insured deposits and to apply to the
proper United States district court for the enforcement of such
subpenas and provided such courts with jurisdiction and power to
order and require compliance with any such subpena.
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 89-695 provided that in connection with
examinations of insured banks and affiliates thereof, the
appropriate Federal banking agency, or its designated
representatives, could administer oaths and affirmations, take and
preserve testimony under oath as to any matter in respect of the
affairs or ownership of such bank or affiliate thereof, issue
subpenas and subpenas duces tecum, and apply to the proper United
States district court for the enforcement of such subpenas,
provided such courts with jurisdiction and power to order and
require compliance with any such subpena, and defined "affiliate"
and "member bank".
1960 - Subsecs. (e) to (g). Pub. L. 86-671 struck out subsecs.
(e) and (f) which related to reports of condition by insured
nonmember State banks and access by Corporation to information of
other bank supervisory authorities, and redesignated subsec. (g) as
(e). See section 1817(a)(1) and (2) of this title.

-CHANGE-
CHANGE OF NAME
Committee on Banking, Finance and Urban Affairs of House of
Representatives treated as referring to Committee on Banking and
Financial Services of House of Representatives by section 1(a) of
Pub. L. 104-14, set out as a note preceding section 21 of Title 2,
The Congress. Committee on Banking and Financial Services of House
of Representatives abolished and replaced by Committee on Financial
Services of House of Representatives, and jurisdiction over matters
relating to securities and exchanges and insurance generally
transferred from Committee on Energy and Commerce of House of
Representatives by House Resolution No. 5, One Hundred Seventh
Congress, Jan. 3, 2001.


-MISC2-
EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 172(a) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 1 day
after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided, see section 4 of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note under section
5301 of this title.
Amendment by section 318(d) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 318(e) of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an
Effective Date note under section 16 of this title.
Amendment by section 363(4) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2004 AMENDMENTS
Amendment by Pub. L. 108-458 effective at the end of the 12-month
period beginning on Dec. 17, 2004, whether or not final regulations
are issued as of Dec. 17, 2004, in accordance with the amendments
made by section 6303 of Pub. L. 108-458, amending this section and
section 1786 of this title, see section 6303(d) of Pub. L. 108-458,
set out as a note under section 1786 of this title.
Amendment by Pub. L. 108-386 effective Oct. 30, 2004, and, except
as otherwise provided, applicable with respect to fiscal year 2005
and each succeeding fiscal year, see sections 8(i) and 9 of Pub. L.
108-386, set out as notes under section 321 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENTS
Amendment by section 303(b)(5) of Pub. L. 102-558 deemed to have
become effective Mar. 1, 1992, see section 304 of Pub. L. 102-558,
set out as a note under section 2062 of Title 50, Appendix, War and
National Defense.
Amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective as if included in the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, Pub.
L. 102-242, as of Dec. 19, 1991, except that where amendment is to
any provision of law added or amended by Pub. L. 102-242 effective
after Dec. 19, 1992, then amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective on
effective date of amendment by Pub. L. 102-242, see section 1609 of
Pub. L. 102-550, set out as a note under section 191 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Section 111(b) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "The amendment
made by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall become
effective 1 year after the date of enactment of this Act [Dec. 19,
1991]."
Amendment by section 302(d) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective on
earlier of 180 days after date on which final regulations
promulgated in accordance with section 302(c) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title, become
effective or Jan. 1, 1994, see section 302(g) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 1817 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 95-630 effective upon expiration of 120 days
after Nov. 10, 1978, see section 2101 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as
an Effective Date note under section 375b of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1970 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 91-452 effective on sixtieth day following
Oct. 15, 1970, not to affect any immunity to which any individual
is entitled under this section by reason of any testimony given
before sixtieth day following Oct. 15, 1970, see section 260 of
Pub. L. 91-452, set out as an Effective Date; Savings Provision
note under section 6001 of Title 18, Crimes and Criminal Procedure.

EXPIRATION OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 91-609, title IX, Sec. 908, Dec. 31, 1970, 84 Stat. 1811,
repealed section 401 of Pub. L. 89-695 which had provided that:
"The provisions of titles I and II of this Act [amending sections
1464, 1730, 1813, 1817 to 1820 and repealing section 77 of this
title and enacting provisions set out as notes under sections 1464,
1730, and 1813 of this title] and any provisions of law enacted by
said titles shall be effective only during the period ending at the
close of June 30, 1972. Effective upon the expiration of such
period, each provision of law amended by either of such titles is
further amended to read as it did immediately prior to the
enactment of this Act [Oct. 16, 1966] and each provision of law
repealed by either of such titles is reenacted."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1960 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 86-671 effective Jan. 1, 1961, see section 7
of Pub. L. 86-671, set out as a note under section 1817 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF INITIAL GUIDELINES
Section 349(b) of Pub. L. 103-325 provided that: "The initial
guidelines required to be issued pursuant to the amendment made by
subsection (a) [amending this section] shall become effective not
later than 1 year after the date of enactment of this Act [Sept.
23, 1994]."

TRANSITION RULE
Section 111(c) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that: "Notwithstanding
section 10(d) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1820(d)] (as added by subsection (a)), during the period beginning
on the date of enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991] and ending on
December 31, 1993, a full-scope, on-site examination of an insured
depository institution is not required more often than once during
every 18-month period, unless -
"(1) the institution, when most recently examined, was found to
be in a less than satisfactory condition; or
"(2) 1 or more persons acquired control of the institution."

CONDITIONS GOVERNING EMPLOYMENT OF PERSONNEL NOT REPEALED,
MODIFIED, OR AFFECTED
Nothing contained in section 203 of Pub. L. 89-695 amending
subsecs. (b) and (c) of this section to be construed as repealing,
modifying, or affecting section 1829 of this title, see section 206
of Pub. L. 89-695, set out as a note under section 1813 of this
title.

-FOOTNOTE-
(!1) See References in Text note below.


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1820a 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1820a. Examination of investment companies

-STATUTE-
(a) Exclusive Commission authority
Except as provided in subsection (c) of this section, a Federal
banking agency may not inspect or examine any registered investment
company that is not a bank holding company or a savings and loan
holding company.
(b) Examination results and other information
The Commission shall provide to any Federal banking agency, upon
request, the results of any examination, reports, records, or other
information with respect to any registered investment company to
the extent necessary for the agency to carry out its statutory
responsibilities.
(c) Certain examinations authorized
Nothing in this section shall prevent the Corporation, if the
Corporation finds it necessary to determine the condition of an
insured depository institution for insurance purposes, from
examining an affiliate of any insured depository institution,
pursuant to its authority under section 1820(b)(4) of this title,
as may be necessary to disclose fully the relationship between the
insured depository institution and the affiliate, and the effect of
such relationship on the insured depository institution.
(d) Definitions
For purposes of this section, the following definitions shall
apply:
(1) Bank holding company
The term "bank holding company" has the meaning given the term
in section 1841 of this title.
(2) Commission
The term "Commission" means the Securities and Exchange
Commission.
(3) Corporation
The term "Corporation" means the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation.
(4) Federal banking agency
The term "Federal banking agency" has the meaning given the
term in section 1813(z) of this title.
(5) Insured depository institution
The term "insured depository institution" has the meaning given
the term in section 1813(c) of this title.
(6) Registered investment company
The term "registered investment company" means an investment
company that is registered with the Commission under the
Investment Company Act of 1940 [15 U.S.C. 80a-1 et seq.].
(7) Savings and loan holding company
The term "savings and loan holding company" has the meaning
given the term in section 1467a(a)(1)(D) of this title.

-SOURCE-
(Pub. L. 106-102, title I, Sec. 115, Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat.
1371.)

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
The Investment Company Act of 1940, referred to in subsec.
(d)(6), is title I of act Aug. 22, 1940, ch. 686, 54 Stat. 789, as
amended, which is classified generally to subchapter I (Sec. 80a-1
et seq.) of chapter 2D of Title 15, Commerce and Trade. For
complete classification of this Act to the Code, see section 80a-51
of Title 15 and Tables.

-COD-
CODIFICATION
Section was enacted as part of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, and
not as part of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act which comprises
this chapter.


-MISC1-
EFFECTIVE DATE
Section effective 120 days after Nov. 12, 1999, see section 161
of Pub. L. 106-102, set out as an Effective Date of 1999 Amendment
note under section 24 of this title.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1821 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1821. Insurance Funds

-STATUTE-
(a) Deposit insurance
(1) Insured amounts payable
(A) In general
The Corporation shall insure the deposits of all insured
depository institutions as provided in this chapter.
(B) Net amount of insured deposit
(i) In general
Subject to clause (ii), the net amount due to any depositor
at an insured depository institution shall not exceed the
standard maximum deposit insurance amount as determined in
accordance with subparagraphs (C), (D), (E) and (F) and
paragraph (3).
(ii) Insurance for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts
Notwithstanding clause (i), the Corporation shall fully
insure the net amount that any depositor at an insured
depository institution maintains in a noninterest-bearing
transaction account. Such amount shall not be taken into
account when computing the net amount due to such depositor
under clause (i).
(iii) Noninterest-bearing transaction account defined
For purposes of this subparagraph, the term "noninterest-
bearing transaction account" means -
(I) a deposit or account maintained at an insured
depository institution -
(aa) with respect to which interest is neither accrued
nor paid;
(bb) on which the depositor or account holder is
permitted to make withdrawals by negotiable or
transferable instrument, payment orders of withdrawal,
telephone or other electronic media transfers, or other
similar items for the purpose of making payments or
transfers to third parties or others; and
(cc) on which the insured depository institution does
not reserve the right to require advance notice of an
intended withdrawal; and

(II) a trust account established by an attorney or law
firm on behalf of a client, commonly known as an "Interest
on Lawyers Trust Account", or a functionally equivalent
account, as determined by the Corporation.
(C) Aggregation of deposits
For the purpose of determining the net amount due to any
depositor under subparagraph (B)(i), the Corporation shall
aggregate the amounts of all deposits in the insured depository
institution which are maintained by a depositor in the same
capacity and the same right for the benefit of the depositor
either in the name of the depositor or in the name of any other
person, other than any amount in a trust fund described in
paragraph (1) or (2) of section 1817(i) of this title or any
funds described in section 1817(i)(3) of this title.
(D) Coverage for certain employee benefit plan deposits
(i) Pass-through insurance
The Corporation shall provide pass-through deposit
insurance for the deposits of any employee benefit plan.
(ii) Prohibition on acceptance of benefit plan deposits
An insured depository institution that is not well
capitalized or adequately capitalized may not accept employee
benefit plan deposits.
(iii) Definitions
For purposes of this subparagraph, the following
definitions shall apply:
(I) Capital standards
The terms "well capitalized" and "adequately capitalized"
have the same meanings as in section 1831o of this title.
(II) Employee benefit plan
The term "employee benefit plan" has the same meaning as
in paragraph (5)(B)(ii), and includes any eligible deferred
compensation plan described in section 457 of title 26.
(III) Pass-through deposit insurance
The term "pass-through deposit insurance" means, with
respect to an employee benefit plan, deposit insurance
coverage based on the interest of each participant, in
accordance with regulations issued by the Corporation.
(E) Standard maximum deposit insurance amount defined
For purposes of this chapter, the term "standard maximum
deposit insurance amount" means $250,000, adjusted as provided
under subparagraph (F) after March 31, 2010. Notwithstanding
any other provision of law, the increase in the standard
maximum deposit insurance amount to $250,000 shall apply to
depositors in any institution for which the Corporation was
appointed as receiver or conservator on or after January 1,
2008, and before October 3, 2008. The Corporation shall take
such actions as are necessary to carry out the requirements of
this section with respect to such depositors, without regard to
any time limitations under this chapter. In implementing this
and the preceding 2 sentences, any payment on a deposit claim
made by the Corporation as receiver or conservator to a
depositor above the standard maximum deposit insurance amount
in effect at the time of the appointment of the Corporation as
receiver or conservator shall be deemed to be part of the net
amount due to the depositor under subparagraph (B).
(F) Inflation adjustment
(i) In general
By April 1 of 2010, and the 1st day of each subsequent 5-
year period, the Board of Directors and the National Credit
Union Administration Board shall jointly consider the factors
set forth under clause (v), and, upon determining that an
inflation adjustment is appropriate, shall jointly prescribe
the amount by which the standard maximum deposit insurance
amount and the standard maximum share insurance amount (as
defined in section 1787(k) of this title) applicable to any
depositor at an insured depository institution shall be
increased by calculating the product of -
(I) $100,000; and
(II) the ratio of the published annual value of the
Personal Consumption Expenditures Chain-Type Price Index
(or any successor index thereto), published by the
Department of Commerce, for the calendar year preceding the
year in which the adjustment is calculated under this
clause, to the published annual value of such index for the
calendar year preceding April 1, 2006.

The values used in the calculation under subclause (II) shall
be, as of the date of the calculation, the values most
recently published by the Department of Commerce.
(ii) Rounding
If the amount determined under clause (ii) for any period
is not a multiple of $10,000, the amount so determined shall
be rounded down to the nearest $10,000.
(iii) Publication and report to the Congress
Not later than April 5 of any calendar year in which an
adjustment is required to be calculated under clause (i) to
the standard maximum deposit insurance amount and the
standard maximum share insurance amount under such clause,
the Board of Directors and the National Credit Union
Administration Board shall -
(I) publish in the Federal Register the standard maximum
deposit insurance amount, the standard maximum share
insurance amount, and the amount of coverage under
paragraph (3)(A) and section 1787(k)(3) of this title, as
so calculated; and
(II) jointly submit a report to the Congress containing
the amounts described in subclause (I).
(iv) 6-month implementation period
Unless an Act of Congress enacted before July 1 of the
calendar year in which an adjustment is required to be
calculated under clause (i) provides otherwise, the increase
in the standard maximum deposit insurance amount and the
standard maximum share insurance amount shall take effect on
January 1 of the year immediately succeeding such calendar
year.
(v) Inflation adjustment consideration
In making any determination under clause (i) to increase
the standard maximum deposit insurance amount and the
standard maximum share insurance amount, the Board of
Directors and the National Credit Union Administration Board
shall jointly consider -
(I) the overall state of the Deposit Insurance Fund and
the economic conditions affecting insured depository
institutions;
(II) potential problems affecting insured depository
institutions; or
(III) whether the increase will cause the reserve ratio
of the fund to fall below 1.15 percent of estimated insured
deposits.
(2) Government depositors
(A) In general
Notwithstanding any limitation in this chapter or in any
other provision of law relating to the amount of deposit
insurance available to any 1 depositor -
(i) a government depositor shall, for the purpose of
determining the amount of insured deposits under this
subsection, be deemed to be a depositor separate and distinct
from any other officer, employee, or agent of the United
States or any public unit referred to in subparagraph (B);
and
(ii) except as provided in subparagraph (C), the deposits
of a government depositor shall be insured in an amount equal
to the standard maximum deposit insurance amount (as
determined under paragraph (1)).
(B) Government depositor
In this paragraph, the term "government depositor" means a
depositor that is -
(i) an officer, employee, or agent of the United States
having official custody of public funds and lawfully
investing or depositing the same in time and savings deposits
in an insured depository institution;
(ii) an officer, employee, or agent of any State of the
United States, or of any county, municipality, or political
subdivision thereof having official custody of public funds
and lawfully investing or depositing the same in time and
savings deposits in an insured depository institution in such
State;
(iii) an officer, employee, or agent of the District of
Columbia having official custody of public funds and lawfully
investing or depositing the same in time and savings deposits
in an insured depository institution in the District of
Columbia;
(iv) an officer, employee, or agent of the Commonwealth of
Puerto Rico, of the Virgin Islands, of American Samoa, of the
Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, or of Guam, or of any
county, municipality, or political subdivision thereof having
official custody of public funds and lawfully investing or
depositing the same in time and savings deposits in an
insured depository institution in the Commonwealth of Puerto
Rico, the Virgin Islands, American Samoa, the Trust Territory
of the Pacific Islands, or Guam, respectively; or
(v) an officer, employee, or agent of any Indian tribe (as
defined in section 1452(c) of title 25) or agency thereof
having official custody of tribal funds and lawfully
investing or depositing the same in time and savings deposits
in an insured depository institution.
(C) Authority to limit deposits
The Corporation may limit the aggregate amount of funds that
may be invested or deposited in deposits in any insured
depository institution by any government depositor on the basis
of the size of any such bank (!1) in terms of its assets:
Provided, however, such limitation may be exceeded by the
pledging of acceptable securities to the government depositor
when and where required.

(3) Certain retirement accounts
(A) In general
Notwithstanding any limitation in this chapter relating to
the amount of deposit insurance available for the account of
any 1 depositor, deposits in an insured depository institution
made in connection with -
(i) any individual retirement account described in section
408(a) of title 26;
(ii) subject to the exception contained in paragraph
(1)(D)(ii), any eligible deferred compensation plan described
in section 457 of title 26; and
(iii) any individual account plan defined in section
1002(34) of title 29, and any plan described in section
401(d) of title 26, to the extent that participants and
beneficiaries under such plan have the right to direct the
investment of assets held in individual accounts maintained
on their behalf by the plan,

shall be aggregated and insured in an amount not to exceed
$250,000 (which amount shall be subject to inflation
adjustments as provided in paragraph (1)(F), except that
$250,000 shall be substituted for $100,000 wherever such term
appears in such paragraph) per participant per insured
depository institution.
(B) Amounts taken into account
For purposes of subparagraph (A), the amount aggregated for
insurance coverage under this paragraph shall consist of the
present vested and ascertainable interest of each participant
under the plan, excluding any remainder interest created by, or
as a result of, the plan.
(4) Deposit Insurance Fund
(A) Establishment
There is established the Deposit Insurance Fund, which the
Corporation shall -
(i) maintain and administer;
(ii) use to carry out its insurance purposes, in the manner
provided by this subsection; and
(iii) invest in accordance with section 1823(a) of this
title.
(B) Uses
The Deposit Insurance Fund shall be available to the
Corporation for use with respect to insured depository
institutions the deposits of which are insured by the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
(C) Limitation on use
Notwithstanding any provision of law other than section
1823(c)(4)(G) of this title, the Deposit Insurance Fund shall
not be used in any manner to benefit any shareholder or
affiliate (other than an insured depository institution that
receives assistance in accordance with the provisions of this
chapter) of -
(i) any insured depository institution for which the
Corporation has been appointed conservator or receiver, in
connection with any type of resolution by the Corporation;
(ii) any other insured depository institution in default or
in danger of default, in connection with any type of
resolution by the Corporation; or
(iii) any insured depository institution, in connection
with the provision of assistance under this section or
section 1823 of this title with respect to such institution,
except that this clause shall not prohibit any assistance to
any insured depository institution that is not in default, or
that is not in danger of default, that is acquiring (as
defined in section 1823(f)(8)(B) of this title) another
insured depository institution.
(D) Deposits
All amounts assessed against insured depository institutions
by the Corporation shall be deposited into the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
(5) Certain investment contracts not treated as insured deposits
(A) In general
A liability of an insured depository institution shall not be
treated as an insured deposit if the liability arises under any
insured depository institution investment contract between any
insured depository institution and any employee benefit plan
which expressly permits benefit-responsive withdrawals or
transfers.
(B) Definitions
For purposes of subparagraph (A) -
(i) Benefit-responsive withdrawals or transfers
The term "benefit-responsive withdrawals or transfers"
means any withdrawal or transfer of funds (consisting of any
portion of the principal and any interest credited at a rate
guaranteed by the insured depository institution investment
contract) during the period in which any guaranteed rate is
in effect, without substantial penalty or adjustment, to pay
benefits provided by the employee benefit plan or to permit a
plan participant or beneficiary to redirect the investment of
his or her account balance.
(ii) Employee benefit plan
The term "employee benefit plan" -
(I) has the meaning given to such term in section 1002(3)
of title 29; and
(II) includes any plan described in section 401(d) of
title 26.
(b) Liquidation as closing of depository institution
For the purposes of this chapter an insured depository
institution shall be deemed to have been closed on account of
inability to meet the demands of its depositors in any case in
which it has been closed for the purpose of liquidation without
adequate provision being made for payment of its depositors.
(c) Appointment of Corporation as conservator or receiver
(1) In general
Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal law, the law of
any State, or the constitution of any State, the Corporation may
accept appointment and act as conservator or receiver for any
insured depository institution upon appointment in the manner
provided in paragraph (2) or (3).
(2) Federal depository institutions
(A) Appointment
(i) Conservator
The Corporation may, at the discretion of the supervisory
authority, be appointed conservator of any insured Federal
depository institution and the Corporation may accept such
appointment.
(ii) Receiver
The Corporation shall be appointed receiver, and shall
accept such appointment, whenever a receiver is appointed for
the purpose of liquidation or winding up the affairs of an
insured Federal depository institution by the appropriate
Federal banking agency, notwithstanding any other provision
of Federal law (other than section 1441a of this title).
(B) Additional powers
In addition to and not in derogation of the powers conferred
and the duties imposed by this section on the Corporation as
conservator or receiver, the Corporation, to the extent not
inconsistent with such powers and duties, shall have any other
power conferred on or any duty (which is related to the
exercise of such power) imposed on a conservator or receiver
for any Federal depository institution under any other
provision of law.
(C) Corporation not subject to any other agency
When acting as conservator or receiver pursuant to an
appointment described in subparagraph (A), the Corporation
shall not be subject to the direction or supervision of any
other agency or department of the United States or any State in
the exercise of the Corporation's rights, powers, and
privileges.
(D) Depository institution in conservatorship subject to
banking agency supervision
Notwithstanding subparagraph (C), any Federal depository
institution for which the Corporation has been appointed
conservator shall remain subject to the supervision of the
appropriate Federal banking agency.
(3) Insured State depository institutions
(A) Appointment by appropriate State supervisor
Whenever the authority having supervision of any insured
State depository institution appoints a conservator or receiver
for such institution and tenders appointment to the
Corporation, the Corporation may accept such appointment.
(B) Additional powers
In addition to the powers conferred and the duties related to
the exercise of such powers imposed by State law on any
conservator or receiver appointed under the law of such State
for an insured State depository institution, the Corporation,
as conservator or receiver pursuant to an appointment described
in subparagraph (A), shall have the powers conferred and the
duties imposed by this section on the Corporation as
conservator or receiver.
(C) Corporation not subject to any other agency
When acting as conservator or receiver pursuant to an
appointment described in subparagraph (A), the Corporation
shall not be subject to the direction or supervision of any
other agency or department of the United States or any State in
the exercise of its rights, powers, and privileges.
(D) Depository institution in conservatorship subject to
banking agency supervision
Notwithstanding subparagraph (C), any insured State
depository institution for which the Corporation has been
appointed conservator shall remain subject to the supervision
of the appropriate State bank or savings association
supervisor.
(4) Appointment of Corporation by the Corporation
Except as otherwise provided in section 1441a of this title and
notwithstanding any other provision of Federal law, the law of
any State, or the constitution of any State, the Corporation may
appoint itself as sole conservator or receiver of any insured
State depository institution if -
(A) the Corporation determines -
(i) that -
(I) a conservator, receiver, or other legal custodian has
been appointed for such institution;
(II) such institution has been subject to the appointment
of any such conservator, receiver, or custodian for a
period of at least 15 consecutive days; and
(III) 1 or more of the depositors in such institution is
unable to withdraw any amount of any insured deposit; or

(ii) that such institution has been closed by or under the
laws of any State; and

(B) the Corporation determines that 1 or more of the grounds
specified in paragraph (5) -
(i) existed with respect to such institution at the time -
(I) the conservator, receiver, or other legal custodian
was appointed; or
(II) such institution was closed; or

(ii) exist at any time -
(I) during the appointment of the conservator, receiver,
or other legal custodian; or
(II) while such institution is closed.
(5) Grounds for appointing conservator or receiver
The grounds for appointing a conservator or receiver (which may
be the Corporation) for any insured depository institution are as
follows:
(A) Assets insufficient for obligations. - The institution's
assets are less than the institution's obligations to its
creditors and others, including members of the institution.
(B) Substantial dissipation. - Substantial dissipation of
assets or earnings due to -
(i) any violation of any statute or regulation; or
(ii) any unsafe or unsound practice.

(C) Unsafe or unsound condition. - An unsafe or unsound
condition to transact business.
(D) Cease and desist orders. - Any willful violation of a
cease-and-desist order which has become final.
(E) Concealment. - Any concealment of the institution's
books, papers, records, or assets, or any refusal to submit the
institution's books, papers, records, or affairs for inspection
to any examiner or to any lawful agent of the appropriate
Federal banking agency or State bank or savings association
supervisor.
(F) Inability to meet obligations. - The institution is
likely to be unable to pay its obligations or meet its
depositors' demands in the normal course of business.
(G) Losses. - The institution has incurred or is likely to
incur losses that will deplete all or substantially all of its
capital, and there is no reasonable prospect for the
institution to become adequately capitalized (as defined in
section 1831o(b) of this title) without Federal assistance.
(H) Violations of law. - Any violation of any law or
regulation, or any unsafe or unsound practice or condition that
is likely to -
(i) cause insolvency or substantial dissipation of assets
or earnings;
(ii) weaken the institution's condition; or
(iii) otherwise seriously prejudice the interests of the
institution's depositors or the Deposit Insurance Fund.

(I) Consent. - The institution, by resolution of its board of
directors or its shareholders or members, consents to the
appointment.
(J) Cessation of insured status. - The institution ceases to
be an insured institution.
(K) Undercapitalization. - The institution is
undercapitalized (as defined in section 1831o(b) of this
title), and -
(i) has no reasonable prospect of becoming adequately
capitalized (as defined in that section);
(ii) fails to become adequately capitalized when required
to do so under section 1831o(f)(2)(A) of this title;
(iii) fails to submit a capital restoration plan acceptable
to that agency within the time prescribed under section
1831o(e)(2)(D) of this title; or
(iv) materially fails to implement a capital restoration
plan submitted and accepted under section 1831o(e)(2) of this
title.

(L) The institution -
(i) is critically undercapitalized, as defined in section
1831o(b) of this title; or
(ii) otherwise has substantially insufficient capital.

(M) Money laundering offense. - The Attorney General notifies
the appropriate Federal banking agency or the Corporation in
writing that the insured depository institution has been found
guilty of a criminal offense under section 1956 or 1957 of
title 18 or section 5322 or 5324 of title 31.
(6) Appointment by Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision
(A) Conservator
The Corporation or the Resolution Trust Corporation may, at
the discretion of the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, be appointed conservator and the Corporation may
accept any such appointment.
(B) Receiver
Whenever the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision
appoints a receiver under the provisions of subparagraph (A) or
(C) of section 1464(d)(2) of this title for the purpose of
liquidation or winding up any savings association's affairs -
(i) before such date as is determined by the Chairperson of
the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title, the Resolution Trust
Corporation shall be appointed;
(ii) on or after the date determined by the Chairperson of
the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title, the Resolution Trust
Corporation shall be appointed if the Resolution Trust
Corporation had been placed in control of the depository
institution at any time before such date; and
(iii) on or after the date determined by the Chairperson of
the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title, the Corporation shall be
appointed unless the Resolution Trust Corporation is required
to be appointed under clause (ii).
(7) Judicial review
If the Corporation is appointed (including the appointment of
the Corporation as receiver by the Board of Directors) as
conservator or receiver of a depository institution under
paragraph (4), (9), or (10), the depository institution may, not
later than 30 days thereafter, bring an action in the United
States district court for the judicial district in which the home
office of such depository institution is located, or in the
United States District Court for the District of Columbia, for an
order requiring the Corporation to be removed as the conservator
or receiver (regardless of how such appointment was made), and
the court shall, upon the merits, dismiss such action or direct
the Corporation to be removed as the conservator or receiver.
(8) Replacement of conservator of State depository institution
(A) In general
In the case of any insured State depository institution for
which the Corporation appointed itself as conservator pursuant
to paragraph (4), the Corporation may, without any requirement
of notice, hearing, or other action, replace itself as
conservator with itself as receiver of such institution.
(B) Replacement treated as removal of incumbent
The replacement of a conservator with a receiver under
subparagraph (A) shall be treated as the removal of the
Corporation as conservator.
(C) Right of review of original appointment not affected
The replacement of a conservator with a receiver under
subparagraph (A) shall not affect any right of the insured
State depository institution to obtain review, pursuant to
paragraph (7), of the original appointment of the conservator.
(9) Appropriate Federal banking agency may appoint Corporation as
conservator or receiver for insured State depository
institution to carry out section 1831o
(A) In general
The appropriate Federal banking agency may appoint the
Corporation as sole receiver (or, subject to paragraph (11),
sole conservator) of any insured State depository institution,
after consultation with the appropriate State supervisor, if
the appropriate Federal banking agency determines that -
(i) 1 or more of the grounds specified in subparagraphs (K)
and (L) of paragraph (5) exist with respect to that
institution; and
(ii) the appointment is necessary to carry out the purpose
of section 1831o of this title.
(B) Nondelegation
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall not delegate any
action under subparagraph (A).
(10) Corporation may appoint itself as conservator or receiver
for insured depository institution to prevent loss to Deposit
Insurance Fund
The Board of Directors may appoint the Corporation as sole
conservator or receiver of an insured depository institution,
after consultation with the appropriate Federal banking agency
and the appropriate State supervisor (if any), if the Board of
Directors determines that -
(A) 1 or more of the grounds specified in any subparagraph of
paragraph (5) exist with respect to the institution; and
(B) the appointment is necessary to reduce -
(i) the risk that the Deposit Insurance Fund would incur a
loss with respect to the insured depository institution, or
(ii) any loss that the Deposit Insurance Fund is expected
to incur with respect to that institution.
(11) Appropriate Federal banking agency shall not appoint
conservator under certain provisions without giving Corporation
opportunity to appoint receiver
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall not appoint a
conservator for an insured depository institution under
subparagraph (K) or (L) of paragraph (5) without the
Corporation's consent unless the agency has given the Corporation
48 hours notice of the agency's intention to appoint the
conservator and the grounds for the appointment.
(12) Directors not liable for acquiescing in appointment of
conservator or receiver
The members of the board of directors of an insured depository
institution shall not be liable to the institution's shareholders
or creditors for acquiescing in or consenting in good faith to -
(A) the appointment of the Corporation or the Resolution
Trust Corporation as conservator or receiver for that
institution; or
(B) an acquisition or combination under section
1831o(f)(2)(A)(iii) of this title.
(13) Additional powers
In any case in which the Corporation is appointed conservator
or receiver under paragraph (4), (6), (9), or (10) for any
insured State depository institution -
(A) this section shall apply to the Corporation as
conservator or receiver in the same manner and to the same
extent as if that institution were a Federal depository
institution for which the Corporation had been appointed
conservator or receiver; and
(B) the Corporation as receiver of the institution may -
(i) liquidate the institution in an orderly manner; and
(ii) make any other disposition of any matter concerning
the institution, as the Corporation determines is in the best
interests of the institution, the depositors of the
institution, and the Corporation.
(d) Powers and duties of Corporation as conservator or receiver
(1) Rulemaking authority of Corporation
The Corporation may prescribe such regulations as the
Corporation determines to be appropriate regarding the conduct of
conservatorships or receiverships.
(2) General powers
(A) Successor to institution
The Corporation shall, as conservator or receiver, and by
operation of law, succeed to -
(i) all rights, titles, powers, and privileges of the
insured depository institution, and of any stockholder,
member, accountholder, depositor, officer, or director of
such institution with respect to the institution and the
assets of the institution; and
(ii) title to the books, records, and assets of any
previous conservator or other legal custodian of such
institution.
(B) Operate the institution
The Corporation may (subject to the provisions of section
1831q of this title), as conservator or receiver -
(i) take over the assets of and operate the insured
depository institution with all the powers of the members or
shareholders, the directors, and the officers of the
institution and conduct all business of the institution;
(ii) collect all obligations and money due the institution;
(iii) perform all functions of the institution in the name
of the institution which are consistent with the appointment
as conservator or receiver; and
(iv) preserve and conserve the assets and property of such
institution.
(C) Functions of institution's officers, directors, and
shareholders
The Corporation may, by regulation or order, provide for the
exercise of any function by any member or stockholder,
director, or officer of any insured depository institution for
which the Corporation has been appointed conservator or
receiver.
(D) Powers as conservator
The Corporation may, as conservator, take such action as may
be -
(i) necessary to put the insured depository institution in
a sound and solvent condition; and
(ii) appropriate to carry on the business of the
institution and preserve and conserve the assets and property
of the institution.
(E) Additional powers as receiver
The Corporation may (subject to the provisions of section
1831q of this title), as receiver, place the insured depository
institution in liquidation and proceed to realize upon the
assets of the institution, having due regard to the conditions
of credit in the locality.
(F) Organization of new institutions
The Corporation may, as receiver, with respect to any insured
depository institution, organize a new depository institution
under subsection (m) or a bridge depository institution under
subsection (n).
(G) Merger; transfer of assets and liabilities
(i) In general
The Corporation may, as conservator or receiver -
(I) merge the insured depository institution with another
insured depository institution; or
(II) subject to clause (ii), transfer any asset or
liability of the institution in default (including assets
and liabilities associated with any trust business) without
any approval, assignment, or consent with respect to such
transfer.
(ii) Approval by appropriate Federal banking agency
No transfer described in clause (i)(II) may be made to
another depository institution (other than a new depository
institution or a bridge depository institution established
pursuant to subsection (m) or (n) of this section) without
the approval of the appropriate Federal banking agency for
such institution.
(H) Payment of valid obligations
The Corporation, as conservator or receiver, shall pay all
valid obligations of the insured depository institution in
accordance with the prescriptions and limitations of this
chapter.
(I) Subpoena authority
(i) In general
The Corporation may, as conservator, receiver, or exclusive
manager and for purposes of carrying out any power,
authority, or duty with respect to an insured depository
institution (including determining any claim against the
institution and determining and realizing upon any asset of
any person in the course of collecting money due the
institution), exercise any power established under section
1818(n) of this title, and the provisions of such section
shall apply with respect to the exercise of any such power
under this subparagraph in the same manner as such provisions
apply under such section.
(ii) Authority of Board of Directors
A subpoena or subpoena duces tecum may be issued under
clause (i) only by, or with the written approval of, the
Board of Directors or their designees (or, in the case of a
subpoena or subpoena duces tecum issued by the Resolution
Trust Corporation under this subparagraph and section
1441a(b)(4) (!2) of this title, only by, or with the written
approval of, the Board of Directors of such Corporation or
their designees).

(iii) Rule of construction
This subsection shall not be construed as limiting any
rights that the Corporation, in any capacity, might otherwise
have under section 1820(c) of this title.
(J) Incidental powers
The Corporation may, as conservator or receiver -
(i) exercise all powers and authorities specifically
granted to conservators or receivers, respectively, under
this chapter and such incidental powers as shall be necessary
to carry out such powers; and
(ii) take any action authorized by this chapter,

which the Corporation determines is in the best interests of
the depository institution, its depositors, or the Corporation.
(K) Utilization of private sector
In carrying out its responsibilities in the management and
disposition of assets from insured depository institutions, as
conservator, receiver, or in its corporate capacity, the
Corporation shall utilize the services of private persons,
including real estate and loan portfolio asset management,
property management, auction marketing, legal, and brokerage
services, only if such services are available in the private
sector and the Corporation determines utilization of such
services is the most practicable, efficient, and cost
effective.
(3) Authority of receiver to determine claims
(A) In general
The Corporation may, as receiver, determine claims in
accordance with the requirements of this subsection and
regulations prescribed under paragraph (4).
(B) Notice requirements
The receiver, in any case involving the liquidation or
winding up of the affairs of a closed depository institution,
shall -
(i) promptly publish a notice to the depository
institution's creditors to present their claims, together
with proof, to the receiver by a date specified in the notice
which shall be not less than 90 days after the publication of
such notice; and
(ii) republish such notice approximately 1 month and 2
months, respectively, after the publication under clause (i).
(C) Mailing required
The receiver shall mail a notice similar to the notice
published under subparagraph (B)(i) at the time of such
publication to any creditor shown on the institution's books -
(i) at the creditor's last address appearing in such books;
or
(ii) upon discovery of the name and address of a claimant
not appearing on the institution's books within 30 days after
the discovery of such name and address.
(4) Rulemaking authority relating to determination of claims
(A) In general
The Corporation may prescribe regulations regarding the
allowance or disallowance of claims by the receiver and
providing for administrative determination of claims and review
of such determination.
(B) Final settlement payment procedure
(i) In general
In the handling of receiverships of insured depository
institutions, to maintain essential liquidity and to prevent
financial disruption, the Corporation may, after the
declaration of an institution's insolvency, settle all
uninsured and unsecured claims on the receivership with a
final settlement payment which shall constitute full payment
and disposition of the Corporation's obligations to such
claimants.
(ii) Final settlement payment
For purposes of clause (i), a final settlement payment
shall be payment of an amount equal to the product of the
final settlement payment rate and the amount of the uninsured
and unsecured claim on the receivership; and
(iii) Final settlement payment rate
For purposes of clause (ii), the final settlement payment
rate shall be a percentage rate reflecting an average of the
Corporation's receivership recovery experience, determined by
the Corporation in such a way that over such time period as
the Corporation may deem appropriate, the Corporation in
total will receive no more or less than it would have
received in total as a general creditor standing in the place
of insured depositors in each specific receivership.
(iv) Corporation authority
The Corporation may undertake such supervisory actions and
promulgate such regulations as may be necessary to assure
that the requirements of this section can be implemented with
respect to each insured depository institution in the event
of its insolvency.
(5) Procedures for determination of claims
(A) Determination period
(i) In general
Before the end of the 180-day period beginning on the date
any claim against a depository institution is filed with the
Corporation as receiver, the Corporation shall determine
whether to allow or disallow the claim and shall notify the
claimant of any determination with respect to such claim.
(ii) Extension of time
The period described in clause (i) may be extended by a
written agreement between the claimant and the Corporation.
(iii) Mailing of notice sufficient
The requirements of clause (i) shall be deemed to be
satisfied if the notice of any determination with respect to
any claim is mailed to the last address of the claimant which
appears -
(I) on the depository institution's books;
(II) in the claim filed by the claimant; or
(III) in documents submitted in proof of the claim.
(iv) Contents of notice of disallowance
If any claim filed under clause (i) is disallowed, the
notice to the claimant shall contain -
(I) a statement of each reason for the disallowance; and
(II) the procedures available for obtaining agency review
of the determination to disallow the claim or judicial
determination of the claim.
(B) Allowance of proven claims
The receiver shall allow any claim received on or before the
date specified in the notice published under paragraph
(3)(B)(i) by the receiver from any claimant which is proved to
the satisfaction of the receiver.
(C) Disallowance of claims filed after end of filing period
(i) In general
Except as provided in clause (ii), claims filed after the
date specified in the notice published under paragraph
(3)(B)(i) shall be disallowed and such disallowance shall be
final.
(ii) Certain exceptions
Clause (i) shall not apply with respect to any claim filed
by any claimant after the date specified in the notice
published under paragraph (3)(B)(i) and such claim may be
considered by the receiver if -
(I) the claimant did not receive notice of the
appointment of the receiver in time to file such claim
before such date; and
(II) such claim is filed in time to permit payment of
such claim.
(D) Authority to disallow claims
(i) In general
The receiver may disallow any portion of any claim by a
creditor or claim of security, preference, or priority which
is not proved to the satisfaction of the receiver.
(ii) Payments to less than fully secured creditors
In the case of a claim of a creditor against an insured
depository institution which is secured by any property or
other asset of such institution, any receiver appointed for
any insured depository institution -
(I) may treat the portion of such claim which exceeds an
amount equal to the fair market value of such property or
other asset as an unsecured claim against the institution;
and
(II) may not make any payment with respect to such
unsecured portion of the claim other than in connection
with the disposition of all claims of unsecured creditors
of the institution.
(iii) Exceptions
No provision of this paragraph shall apply with respect to -

(I) any extension of credit from any Federal home loan
bank or Federal Reserve bank to any insured depository
institution; or
(II) any security interest in the assets of the
institution securing any such extension of credit.
(E) No judicial review of determination pursuant to
subparagraph (D)
No court may review the Corporation's determination pursuant
to subparagraph (D) to disallow a claim.
(F) Legal effect of filing
(i) Statute of limitation tolled
For purposes of any applicable statute of limitations, the
filing of a claim with the receiver shall constitute a
commencement of an action.
(ii) No prejudice to other actions
Subject to paragraph (12), the filing of a claim with the
receiver shall not prejudice any right of the claimant to
continue any action which was filed before the appointment of
the receiver.
(6) Provision for agency review or judicial determination of
claims
(A) In general
Before the end of the 60-day period beginning on the earlier
of -
(i) the end of the period described in paragraph (5)(A)(i)
with respect to any claim against a depository institution
for which the Corporation is receiver; or
(ii) the date of any notice of disallowance of such claim
pursuant to paragraph (5)(A)(i),

the claimant may request administrative review of the claim in
accordance with subparagraph (A) or (B) of paragraph (7) or
file suit on such claim (or continue an action commenced before
the appointment of the receiver) in the district or territorial
court of the United States for the district within which the
depository institution's principal place of business is located
or the United States District Court for the District of
Columbia (and such court shall have jurisdiction to hear such
claim).
(B) Statute of limitations
If any claimant fails to -
(i) request administrative review of any claim in
accordance with subparagraph (A) or (B) of paragraph (7); or
(ii) file suit on such claim (or continue an action
commenced before the appointment of the receiver),

before the end of the 60-day period described in subparagraph
(A), the claim shall be deemed to be disallowed (other than any
portion of such claim which was allowed by the receiver) as of
the end of such period, such disallowance shall be final, and
the claimant shall have no further rights or remedies with
respect to such claim.
(7) Review of claims
(A) Administrative hearing
If any claimant requests review under this subparagraph in
lieu of filing or continuing any action under paragraph (6) and
the Corporation agrees to such request, the Corporation shall
consider the claim after opportunity for a hearing on the
record. The final determination of the Corporation with respect
to such claim shall be subject to judicial review under chapter
7 of title 5.
(B) Other review procedures
(i) In general
The Corporation shall also establish such alternative
dispute resolution processes as may be appropriate for the
resolution of claims filed under paragraph (5)(A)(i).
(ii) Criteria
In establishing alternative dispute resolution processes,
the Corporation shall strive for procedures which are
expeditious, fair, independent, and low cost.
(iii) Voluntary binding or nonbinding procedures
The Corporation may establish both binding and nonbinding
processes, which may be conducted by any government or
private party, but all parties, including the claimant and
the Corporation, must agree to the use of the process in a
particular case.
(iv) Consideration of incentives
The Corporation shall seek to develop incentives for
claimants to participate in the alternative dispute
resolution process.
(8) Expedited determination of claims
(A) Establishment required
The Corporation shall establish a procedure for expedited
relief outside of the routine claims process established under
paragraph (5) for claimants who -
(i) allege the existence of legally valid and enforceable
or perfected security interests in assets of any depository
institution for which the Corporation has been appointed
receiver; and
(ii) allege that irreparable injury will occur if the
routine claims procedure is followed.
(B) Determination period
Before the end of the 90-day period beginning on the date any
claim is filed in accordance with the procedures established
pursuant to subparagraph (A), the Corporation shall -
(i) determine -
(I) whether to allow or disallow such claim; or
(II) whether such claim should be determined pursuant to
the procedures established pursuant to paragraph (5); and

(ii) notify the claimant of the determination, and if the
claim is disallowed, provide a statement of each reason for
the disallowance and the procedure for obtaining agency
review or judicial determination.
(C) Period for filing or renewing suit
Any claimant who files a request for expedited relief shall
be permitted to file a suit, or to continue a suit filed before
the appointment of the receiver, seeking a determination of the
claimant's rights with respect to such security interest after
the earlier of -
(i) the end of the 90-day period beginning on the date of
the filing of a request for expedited relief; or
(ii) the date the Corporation denies the claim.
(D) Statute of limitations
If an action described in subparagraph (C) is not filed, or
the motion to renew a previously filed suit is not made, before
the end of the 30-day period beginning on the date on which
such action or motion may be filed in accordance with
subparagraph (B), the claim shall be deemed to be disallowed as
of the end of such period (other than any portion of such claim
which was allowed by the receiver), such disallowance shall be
final, and the claimant shall have no further rights or
remedies with respect to such claim.
(E) Legal effect of filing
(i) Statute of limitation tolled
For purposes of any applicable statute of limitations, the
filing of a claim with the receiver shall constitute a
commencement of an action.
(ii) No prejudice to other actions
Subject to paragraph (12), the filing of a claim with the
receiver shall not prejudice any right of the claimant to
continue any action which was filed before the appointment of
the receiver.
(9) Agreement as basis of claim
(A) Requirements
Except as provided in subparagraph (B), any agreement which
does not meet the requirements set forth in section 1823(e) of
this title shall not form the basis of, or substantially
comprise, a claim against the receiver or the Corporation.
(B) Exception to contemporaneous execution requirement
Notwithstanding section 1823(e)(2) (!2) of this title, any
agreement relating to an extension of credit between a Federal
home loan bank or Federal Reserve bank and any insured
depository institution which was executed before the extension
of credit by such bank to such institution shall be treated as
having been executed contemporaneously with such extension of
credit for purposes of subparagraph (A).
(10) Payment of claims
(A) In general
The receiver may, in the receiver's discretion and to the
extent funds are available, pay creditor claims which are
allowed by the receiver, approved by the Corporation pursuant
to a final determination pursuant to paragraph (7) or (8), or
determined by the final judgment of any court of competent
jurisdiction in such manner and amounts as are authorized under
this chapter.
(B) Payment of dividends on claims
The receiver may, in the receiver's sole discretion, pay
dividends on proved claims at any time, and no liability shall
attach to the Corporation (in such Corporation's corporate
capacity or as receiver), by reason of any such payment, for
failure to pay dividends to a claimant whose claim is not
proved at the time of any such payment.
(C) Rulemaking authority of Corporation
The Corporation may prescribe such rules, including
definitions of terms, as it deems appropriate to establish a
single uniform interest rate for or to make payments of post
insolvency interest to creditors holding proven claims against
the receivership estates of insured Federal or State depository
institutions following satisfaction by the receiver of the
principal amount of all creditor claims.
(11) Depositor preference
(A) In general
Subject to section 1815(e)(2)(C) of this title, amounts
realized from the liquidation or other resolution of any
insured depository institution by any receiver appointed for
such institution shall be distributed to pay claims (other than
secured claims to the extent of any such security) in the
following order of priority:
(i) Administrative expenses of the receiver.
(ii) Any deposit liability of the institution.
(iii) Any other general or senior liability of the
institution (which is not a liability described in clause
(iv) or (v)).
(iv) Any obligation subordinated to depositors or general
creditors (which is not an obligation described in clause
(v)).
(v) Any obligation to shareholders or members arising as a
result of their status as shareholders or members (including
any depository institution holding company or any shareholder
or creditor of such company).
(B) Effect on State law
(i) In general
The provisions of subparagraph (A) shall not supersede the
law of any State except to the extent such law is
inconsistent with the provisions of such subparagraph, and
then only to the extent of the inconsistency.
(ii) Procedure for determination of inconsistency
Upon the Corporation's own motion or upon the request of
any person with a claim described in subparagraph (A) or any
State which is submitted to the Corporation in accordance
with procedures which the Corporation shall prescribe, the
Corporation shall determine whether any provision of the law
of any State is inconsistent with any provision of
subparagraph (A) and the extent of any such inconsistency.
(iii) Judicial review
The final determination of the Corporation under clause
(ii) shall be subject to judicial review under chapter 7 of
title 5.
(C) Accounting report
Any distribution by the Corporation in connection with any
claim described in subparagraph (A)(v) shall be accompanied by
the accounting report required under paragraph (15)(B).
(12) Suspension of legal actions
(A) In general
After the appointment of a conservator or receiver for an
insured depository institution, the conservator or receiver may
request a stay for a period not to exceed -
(i) 45 days, in the case of any conservator; and
(ii) 90 days, in the case of any receiver,

in any judicial action or proceeding to which such institution
is or becomes a party.
(B) Grant of stay by all courts required
Upon receipt of a request by any conservator or receiver
pursuant to subparagraph (A) for a stay of any judicial action
or proceeding in any court with jurisdiction of such action or
proceeding, the court shall grant such stay as to all parties.
(13) Additional rights and duties
(A) Prior final adjudication
The Corporation shall abide by any final unappealable
judgment of any court of competent jurisdiction which was
rendered before the appointment of the Corporation as
conservator or receiver.
(B) Rights and remedies of conservator or receiver
In the event of any appealable judgment, the Corporation as
conservator or receiver shall -
(i) have all the rights and remedies available to the
insured depository institution (before the appointment of
such conservator or receiver) and the Corporation in its
corporate capacity, including removal to Federal court and
all appellate rights; and
(ii) not be required to post any bond in order to pursue
such remedies.
(C) No attachment or execution
No attachment or execution may issue by any court upon assets
in the possession of the receiver.
(D) Limitation on judicial review
Except as otherwise provided in this subsection, no court
shall have jurisdiction over -
(i) any claim or action for payment from, or any action
seeking a determination of rights with respect to, the assets
of any depository institution for which the Corporation has
been appointed receiver, including assets which the
Corporation may acquire from itself as such receiver; or
(ii) any claim relating to any act or omission of such
institution or the Corporation as receiver.
(E) Disposition of assets
In exercising any right, power, privilege, or authority as
conservator or receiver in connection with any sale or
disposition of assets of any insured depository institution for
which the Corporation has been appointed conservator or
receiver, including any sale or disposition of assets acquired
by the Corporation under section 1823(d)(1) of this title, the
Corporation shall conduct its operations in a manner which -
(i) maximizes the net present value return from the sale or
disposition of such assets;
(ii) minimizes the amount of any loss realized in the
resolution of cases;
(iii) ensures adequate competition and fair and consistent
treatment of offerors;
(iv) prohibits discrimination on the basis of race, sex, or
ethnic groups in the solicitation and consideration of
offers; and
(v) maximizes the preservation of the availability and
affordability of residential real property for low- and
moderate-income individuals.
(14) Statute of limitations for actions brought by conservator or
receiver
(A) In general
Notwithstanding any provision of any contract, the applicable
statute of limitations with regard to any action brought by the
Corporation as conservator or receiver shall be -
(i) in the case of any contract claim, the longer of -
(I) the 6-year period beginning on the date the claim
accrues; or
(II) the period applicable under State law; and

(ii) in the case of any tort claim (other than a claim
which is subject to section 1441a(b)(14) of this title), the
longer of -
(I) the 3-year period beginning on the date the claim
accrues; or
(II) the period applicable under State law.
(B) Determination of the date on which a claim accrues
For purposes of subparagraph (A), the date on which the
statute of limitations begins to run on any claim described in
such subparagraph shall be the later of -
(i) the date of the appointment of the Corporation as
conservator or receiver; or
(ii) the date on which the cause of action accrues.
(C) Revival of expired State causes of action
(i) In general
In the case of any tort claim described in clause (ii) for
which the statute of limitation applicable under State law
with respect to such claim has expired not more than 5 years
before the appointment of the Corporation as conservator or
receiver, the Corporation may bring an action as conservator
or receiver on such claim without regard to the expiration of
the statute of limitation applicable under State law.
(ii) Claims described
A tort claim referred to in clause (i) is a claim arising
from fraud, intentional misconduct resulting in unjust
enrichment, or intentional misconduct resulting in
substantial loss to the institution.
(15) Accounting and recordkeeping requirements
(A) In general
The Corporation as conservator or receiver shall, consistent
with the accounting and reporting practices and procedures
established by the Corporation, maintain a full accounting of
each conservatorship and receivership or other disposition of
institutions in default.
(B) Annual accounting or report
With respect to each conservatorship or receivership to which
the Corporation was appointed, the Corporation shall make an
annual accounting or report, as appropriate, available to the
Secretary of the Treasury, the Comptroller General of the
United States, and the authority which appointed the
Corporation as conservator or receiver.
(C) Availability of reports
Any report prepared pursuant to subparagraph (B) shall be
made available by the Corporation upon request to any
shareholder of the depository institution for which the
Corporation was appointed conservator or receiver or any other
member of the public.
(D) Recordkeeping requirement
(i) In general
Except as provided in clause (ii), after the end of the 6-
year period beginning on the date the Corporation is
appointed as receiver of an insured depository institution,
the Corporation may destroy any records of such institution
which the Corporation, in the Corporation's discretion,
determines to be unnecessary unless directed not to do so by
a court of competent jurisdiction or governmental agency, or
prohibited by law.
(ii) Old records
Notwithstanding clause (i), the Corporation may destroy
records of an insured depository institution which are at
least 10 years old as of the date on which the Corporation is
appointed as the receiver of such depository institution in
accordance with clause (i) at any time after such appointment
is final, without regard to the 6-year period of limitation
contained in clause (i).
(16) Contracts with State housing finance authorities
(A) In general
The Corporation may enter into contracts with any State
housing finance authority for the sale of mortgage-related
assets (as such terms are defined in section 1441a-1 of this
title) of any depository institution in default (including
assets and liabilities associated with any trust business),
such contracts to be effective in accordance with their terms
without any further approval, assignment, or consent with
respect thereto.
(B) Factors to consider
In evaluating the disposition of mortgage related assets to
any State housing finance authority the Corporation shall
consider -
(i) the State housing finance authority's ability to
acquire and service current, delinquent, and defaulted
mortgage related assets;
(ii) the State housing finance authority's ability to
further national housing policies;
(iii) the State housing finance authority's sensitivity to
the impact of the sale of mortgage related assets upon the
State and local communities;
(iv) the costs to the Federal Government associated with
alternative ownership or disposition of the mortgage related
assets;
(v) the minimization of future guaranties which may be
required of the Federal Government;
(vi) the maximization of mortgage related asset values; and
(vii) the utilization of institutions currently established
in mortgage related asset market activities.
(17) Fraudulent transfers
(A) In general
The Corporation, as conservator or receiver for any insured
depository institution, and any conservator appointed by the
Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision may avoid a transfer of any interest of an
institution-affiliated party, or any person who the Corporation
or conservator determines is a debtor of the institution, in
property, or any obligation incurred by such party or person,
that was made within 5 years of the date on which the
Corporation or conservator was appointed conservator or
receiver if such party or person voluntarily or involuntarily
made such transfer or incurred such liability with the intent
to hinder, delay, or defraud the insured depository
institution, the Corporation or other conservator, or any other
appropriate Federal banking agency.
(B) Right of recovery
To the extent a transfer is avoided under subparagraph (A),
the Corporation or any conservator described in such
subparagraph may recover, for the benefit of the insured
depository institution, the property transferred, or, if a
court so orders, the value of such property (at the time of
such transfer) from -
(i) the initial transferee of such transfer or the
institution-affiliated party or person for whose benefit such
transfer was made; or
(ii) any immediate or mediate transferee of any such
initial transferee.
(C) Rights of transferee or obligee
The Corporation or any conservator described in subparagraph
(A) may not recover under subparagraph (B) from -
(i) any transferee that takes for value, including
satisfaction or securing of a present or antecedent debt, in
good faith; or
(ii) any immediate or mediate good faith transferee of such
transferee.
(D) Rights under this paragraph
The rights under this paragraph of the Corporation and any
conservator described in subparagraph (A) shall be superior to
any rights of a trustee or any other party (other than any
party which is a Federal agency) under title 11.
(18) Attachment of assets and other injunctive relief
Subject to paragraph (19), any court of competent jurisdiction
may, at the request of -
(A) the Corporation (in the Corporation's capacity as
conservator or receiver for any insured depository institution
or in the Corporation's corporate capacity with respect to any
asset acquired or liability assumed by the Corporation under
this section or section 1822 or 1823 of this title); or
(B) any conservator appointed by the Comptroller of the
Currency or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision,

issue an order in accordance with Rule 65 of the Federal Rules of
Civil Procedure, including an order placing the assets of any
person designated by the Corporation or such conservator under
the control of the court and appointing a trustee to hold such
assets.
(19) Standards
(A) Showing
Rule 65 of the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure shall apply
with respect to any proceeding under paragraph (18) without
regard to the requirement of such rule that the applicant show
that the injury, loss, or damage is irreparable and immediate.
(B) State proceeding
If, in the case of any proceeding in a State court, the court
determines that rules of civil procedure available under the
laws of such State provide substantially similar protections to
such party's right to due process as Rule 65 (as modified with
respect to such proceeding by subparagraph (A)), the relief
sought by the Corporation or a conservator pursuant to
paragraph (18) may be requested under the laws of such State.
(20) Treatment of claims arising from breach of contracts
executed by the receiver or conservator
Notwithstanding any other provision of this subsection, any
final and unappealable judgment for monetary damages entered
against a receiver or conservator for an insured depository
institution for the breach of an agreement executed or approved
by such receiver or conservator after the date of its appointment
shall be paid as an administrative expense of the receiver or
conservator. Nothing in this paragraph shall be construed to
limit the power of a receiver or conservator to exercise any
rights under contract or law, including to terminate, breach,
cancel, or otherwise discontinue such agreement.
(e) Provisions relating to contracts entered into before
appointment of conservator or receiver
(1) Authority to repudiate contracts
In addition to any other rights a conservator or receiver may
have, the conservator or receiver for any insured depository
institution may disaffirm or repudiate any contract or lease -
(A) to which such institution is a party;
(B) the performance of which the conservator or receiver, in
the conservator's or receiver's discretion, determines to be
burdensome; and
(C) the disaffirmance or repudiation of which the conservator
or receiver determines, in the conservator's or receiver's
discretion, will promote the orderly administration of the
institution's affairs.
(2) Timing of repudiation
The conservator or receiver appointed for any insured
depository institution in accordance with subsection (c) of this
section shall determine whether or not to exercise the rights of
repudiation under this subsection within a reasonable period
following such appointment.
(3) Claims for damages for repudiation
(A) In general
Except as otherwise provided in subparagraph (C) and
paragraphs (4), (5), and (6), the liability of the conservator
or receiver for the disaffirmance or repudiation of any
contract pursuant to paragraph (1) shall be -
(i) limited to actual direct compensatory damages; and
(ii) determined as of -
(I) the date of the appointment of the conservator or
receiver; or
(II) in the case of any contract or agreement referred to
in paragraph (8), the date of the disaffirmance or
repudiation of such contract or agreement.
(B) No liability for other damages
For purposes of subparagraph (A), the term "actual direct
compensatory damages" does not include -
(i) punitive or exemplary damages;
(ii) damages for lost profits or opportunity; or
(iii) damages for pain and suffering.
(C) Measure of damages for repudiation of financial contracts
In the case of any qualified financial contract or agreement
to which paragraph (8) applies, compensatory damages shall be -

(i) deemed to include normal and reasonable costs of cover
or other reasonable measures of damages utilized in the
industries for such contract and agreement claims; and
(ii) paid in accordance with this subsection and subsection
(i) of this section except as otherwise specifically provided
in this section.
(4) Leases under which the institution is the lessee
(A) In general
If the conservator or receiver disaffirms or repudiates a
lease under which the insured depository institution was the
lessee, the conservator or receiver shall not be liable for any
damages (other than damages determined pursuant to subparagraph
(B)) for the disaffirmance or repudiation of such lease.
(B) Payments of rent
Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), the lessor under a lease to
which such subparagraph applies shall -
(i) be entitled to the contractual rent accruing before the
later of the date -
(I) the notice of disaffirmance or repudiation is mailed;
or
(II) the disaffirmance or repudiation becomes effective,

unless the lessor is in default or breach of the terms of the
lease;
(ii) have no claim for damages under any acceleration
clause or other penalty provision in the lease; and
(iii) have a claim for any unpaid rent, subject to all
appropriate offsets and defenses, due as of the date of the
appointment which shall be paid in accordance with this
subsection and subsection (i) of this section.
(5) Leases under which the institution is the lessor
(A) In general
If the conservator or receiver repudiates an unexpired
written lease of real property of the insured depository
institution under which the institution is the lessor and the
lessee is not, as of the date of such repudiation, in default,
the lessee under such lease may either -
(i) treat the lease as terminated by such repudiation; or
(ii) remain in possession of the leasehold interest for the
balance of the term of the lease unless the lessee defaults
under the terms of the lease after the date of such
repudiation.
(B) Provisions applicable to lessee remaining in possession
If any lessee under a lease described in subparagraph (A)
remains in possession of a leasehold interest pursuant to
clause (ii) of such subparagraph -
(i) the lessee -
(I) shall continue to pay the contractual rent pursuant
to the terms of the lease after the date of the repudiation
of such lease;
(II) may offset against any rent payment which accrues
after the date of the repudiation of the lease, any damages
which accrue after such date due to the nonperformance of
any obligation of the insured depository institution under
the lease after such date; and

(ii) the conservator or receiver shall not be liable to the
lessee for any damages arising after such date as a result of
the repudiation other than the amount of any offset allowed
under clause (i)(II).
(6) Contracts for the sale of real property
(A) In general
If the conservator or receiver repudiates any contract (which
meets the requirements of each paragraph of section 1823(e) of
this title) for the sale of real property and the purchaser of
such real property under such contract is in possession and is
not, as of the date of such repudiation, in default, such
purchaser may either -
(i) treat the contract as terminated by such repudiation;
or
(ii) remain in possession of such real property.
(B) Provisions applicable to purchaser remaining in possession
If any purchaser of real property under any contract
described in subparagraph (A) remains in possession of such
property pursuant to clause (ii) of such subparagraph -
(i) the purchaser -
(I) shall continue to make all payments due under the
contract after the date of the repudiation of the contract;
and
(II) may offset against any such payments any damages
which accrue after such date due to the nonperformance
(after such date) of any obligation of the depository
institution under the contract; and

(ii) the conservator or receiver shall -
(I) not be liable to the purchaser for any damages
arising after such date as a result of the repudiation
other than the amount of any offset allowed under clause
(i)(II);
(II) deliver title to the purchaser in accordance with
the provisions of the contract; and
(III) have no obligation under the contract other than
the performance required under subclause (II).
(C) Assignment and sale allowed
(i) In general
No provision of this paragraph shall be construed as
limiting the right of the conservator or receiver to assign
the contract described in subparagraph (A) and sell the
property subject to the contract and the provisions of this
paragraph.
(ii) No liability after assignment and sale
If an assignment and sale described in clause (i) is
consummated, the conservator or receiver shall have no
further liability under the contract described in
subparagraph (A) or with respect to the real property which
was the subject of such contract.
(7) Provisions applicable to service contracts
(A) Services performed before appointment
In the case of any contract for services between any person
and any insured depository institution for which the
Corporation has been appointed conservator or receiver, any
claim of such person for services performed before the
appointment of the conservator or the receiver shall be -
(i) a claim to be paid in accordance with subsections (d)
and (i) of this section; and
(ii) deemed to have arisen as of the date the conservator
or receiver was appointed.
(B) Services performed after appointment and prior to
repudiation
If, in the case of any contract for services described in
subparagraph (A), the conservator or receiver accepts
performance by the other person before the conservator or
receiver makes any determination to exercise the right of
repudiation of such contract under this section -
(i) the other party shall be paid under the terms of the
contract for the services performed; and
(ii) the amount of such payment shall be treated as an
administrative expense of the conservatorship or
receivership.
(C) Acceptance of performance no bar to subsequent repudiation
The acceptance by any conservator or receiver of services
referred to in subparagraph (B) in connection with a contract
described in such subparagraph shall not affect the right of
the conservator or receiver to repudiate such contract under
this section at any time after such performance.
(8) Certain qualified financial contracts
(A) Rights of parties to contracts
Subject to paragraphs (9) and (10) of this subsection and
notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter (other than
subsection (d)(9) of this section and section 1823(e) of this
title), any other Federal law, or the law of any State, no
person shall be stayed or prohibited from exercising -
(i) any right such person has to cause the termination,
liquidation, or acceleration of any qualified financial
contract with an insured depository institution which arises
upon the appointment of the Corporation as receiver for such
institution at any time after such appointment;
(ii) any right under any security agreement or arrangement
or other credit enhancement related to one or more qualified
financial contracts described in clause (i); (!3)

(iii) any right to offset or net out any termination value,
payment amount, or other transfer obligation arising under or
in connection with 1 or more contracts and agreements
described in clause (i), including any master agreement for
such contracts or agreements.
(B) Applicability of other provisions
Subsection (d)(12) of this section shall apply in the case of
any judicial action or proceeding brought against any receiver
referred to in subparagraph (A), or the insured depository
institution for which such receiver was appointed, by any party
to a contract or agreement described in subparagraph (A)(i)
with such institution.
(C) Certain transfers not avoidable
(i) In general
Notwithstanding paragraph (11), section 91 of this title or
any other Federal or State law relating to the avoidance of
preferential or fraudulent transfers, the Corporation,
whether acting as such or as conservator or receiver of an
insured depository institution, may not avoid any transfer of
money or other property in connection with any qualified
financial contract with an insured depository institution.
(ii) Exception for certain transfers
Clause (i) shall not apply to any transfer of money or
other property in connection with any qualified financial
contract with an insured depository institution if the
Corporation determines that the transferee had actual intent
to hinder, delay, or defraud such institution, the creditors
of such institution, or any conservator or receiver appointed
for such institution.
(D) Certain contracts and agreements defined
For purposes of this subsection, the following definitions
shall apply:
(i) Qualified financial contract
The term "qualified financial contract" means any
securities contract, commodity contract, forward contract,
repurchase agreement, swap agreement, and any similar
agreement that the Corporation determines by regulation,
resolution, or order to be a qualified financial contract for
purposes of this paragraph.
(ii) Securities contract
The term "securities contract" -
(I) means a contract for the purchase, sale, or loan of a
security, a certificate of deposit, a mortgage loan, any
interest in a mortgage loan, a group or index of
securities, certificates of deposit, or mortgage loans or
interests therein (including any interest therein or based
on the value thereof) or any option on any of the
foregoing, including any option to purchase or sell any
such security, certificate of deposit, mortgage loan,
interest, group or index, or option, and including any
repurchase or reverse repurchase transaction on any such
security, certificate of deposit, mortgage loan, interest,
group or index, or option (whether or not such repurchase
or reverse repurchase transaction is a "repurchase
agreement", as defined in clause (v));
(II) does not include any purchase, sale, or repurchase
obligation under a participation in a commercial mortgage
loan unless the Corporation determines by regulation,
resolution, or order to include any such agreement within
the meaning of such term;
(III) means any option entered into on a national
securities exchange relating to foreign currencies;
(IV) means the guarantee (including by novation) by or to
any securities clearing agency of any settlement of cash,
securities, certificates of deposit, mortgage loans or
interests therein, group or index of securities,
certificates of deposit, or mortgage loans or interests
therein (including any interest therein or based on the
value thereof) or option on any of the foregoing, including
any option to purchase or sell any such security,
certificate of deposit, mortgage loan, interest, group or
index, or option (whether or not such settlement is in
connection with any agreement or transaction referred to in
subclauses (I) through (XII) (other than subclause (II));
(!4)

(V) means any margin loan;
(VI) means any extension of credit for the clearance or
settlement of securities transactions;
(VII) means any loan transaction coupled with a
securities collar transaction, any prepaid securities
forward transaction, or any total return swap transaction
coupled with a securities sale transaction;
(VIII) means any other agreement or transaction that is
similar to any agreement or transaction referred to in this
clause;
(IX) means any combination of the agreements or
transactions referred to in this clause;
(X) means any option to enter into any agreement or
transaction referred to in this clause;
(XI) means a master agreement that provides for an
agreement or transaction referred to in subclause (I),
(III), (IV), (V), (VI), (VII), (VIII), (IX), or (X),
together with all supplements to any such master agreement,
without regard to whether the master agreement provides for
an agreement or transaction that is not a securities
contract under this clause, except that the master
agreement shall be considered to be a securities contract
under this clause only with respect to each agreement or
transaction under the master agreement that is referred to
in subclause (I), (III), (IV), (V), (VI), (VII), (VIII),
(IX), or (X); and
(XII) means any security agreement or arrangement or
other credit enhancement related to any agreement or
transaction referred to in this clause, including any
guarantee or reimbursement obligation in connection with
any agreement or transaction referred to in this clause.
(iii) Commodity contract
The term "commodity contract" means -
(I) with respect to a futures commission merchant, a
contract for the purchase or sale of a commodity for future
delivery on, or subject to the rules of, a contract market
or board of trade;
(II) with respect to a foreign futures commission
merchant, a foreign future;
(III) with respect to a leverage transaction merchant, a
leverage transaction;
(IV) with respect to a clearing organization, a contract
for the purchase or sale of a commodity for future delivery
on, or subject to the rules of, a contract market or board
of trade that is cleared by such clearing organization, or
commodity option traded on, or subject to the rules of, a
contract market or board of trade that is cleared by such
clearing organization;
(V) with respect to a commodity options dealer, a
commodity option;
(VI) any other agreement or transaction that is similar
to any agreement or transaction referred to in this clause;
(VII) any combination of the agreements or transactions
referred to in this clause;
(VIII) any option to enter into any agreement or
transaction referred to in this clause;
(IX) a master agreement that provides for an agreement or
transaction referred to in subclause (I), (II), (III),
(IV), (V), (VI), (VII), or (VIII), together with all
supplements to any such master agreement, without regard to
whether the master agreement provides for an agreement or
transaction that is not a commodity contract under this
clause, except that the master agreement shall be
considered to be a commodity contract under this clause
only with respect to each agreement or transaction under
the master agreement that is referred to in subclause (I),
(II), (III), (IV), (V), (VI), (VII), or (VIII); or
(X) any security agreement or arrangement or other credit
enhancement related to any agreement or transaction
referred to in this clause, including any guarantee or
reimbursement obligation in connection with any agreement
or transaction referred to in this clause.
(iv) Forward contract
The term "forward contract" means -
(I) a contract (other than a commodity contract) for the
purchase, sale, or transfer of a commodity or any similar
good, article, service, right, or interest which is
presently or in the future becomes the subject of dealing
in the forward contract trade, or product or byproduct
thereof, with a maturity date more than 2 days after the
date the contract is entered into, including,(!5) a
repurchase or reverse repurchase transaction (whether or
not such repurchase or reverse repurchase transaction is a
"repurchase agreement", as defined in clause (v)),
consignment, lease, swap, hedge transaction, deposit, loan,
option, allocated transaction, unallocated transaction, or
any other similar agreement;

(II) any combination of agreements or transactions
referred to in subclauses (I) and (III);
(III) any option to enter into any agreement or
transaction referred to in subclause (I) or (II);
(IV) a master agreement that provides for an agreement or
transaction referred to in subclauses (I), (II), or (III),
together with all supplements to any such master agreement,
without regard to whether the master agreement provides for
an agreement or transaction that is not a forward contract
under this clause, except that the master agreement shall
be considered to be a forward contract under this clause
only with respect to each agreement or transaction under
the master agreement that is referred to in subclause (I),
(II), or (III); or
(V) any security agreement or arrangement or other credit
enhancement related to any agreement or transaction
referred to in subclause (I), (II), (III), or (IV),
including any guarantee or reimbursement obligation in
connection with any agreement or transaction referred to in
any such subclause.
(v) Repurchase agreement
The term "repurchase agreement" (which definition also
applies to a reverse repurchase agreement) -
(I) means an agreement, including related terms, which
provides for the transfer of one or more certificates of
deposit, mortgage-related securities (as such term is
defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 [15 U.S.C.
78a et seq.]), mortgage loans, interests in mortgage-
related securities or mortgage loans, eligible bankers'
acceptances, qualified foreign government securities or
securities that are direct obligations of, or that are
fully guaranteed by, the United States or any agency of the
United States against the transfer of funds by the
transferee of such certificates of deposit, eligible
bankers' acceptances, securities, mortgage loans, or
interests with a simultaneous agreement by such transferee
to transfer to the transferor thereof certificates of
deposit, eligible bankers' acceptances, securities,
mortgage loans, or interests as described above, at a date
certain not later than 1 year after such transfers or on
demand, against the transfer of funds, or any other similar
agreement;
(II) does not include any repurchase obligation under a
participation in a commercial mortgage loan unless the
Corporation determines by regulation, resolution, or order
to include any such participation within the meaning of
such term;
(III) means any combination of agreements or transactions
referred to in subclauses (I) and (IV);
(IV) means any option to enter into any agreement or
transaction referred to in subclause (I) or (III);
(V) means a master agreement that provides for an
agreement or transaction referred to in subclause (I),
(III), or (IV), together with all supplements to any such
master agreement, without regard to whether the master
agreement provides for an agreement or transaction that is
not a repurchase agreement under this clause, except that
the master agreement shall be considered to be a repurchase
agreement under this subclause only with respect to each
agreement or transaction under the master agreement that is
referred to in subclause (I), (III), or (IV); and
(VI) means any security agreement or arrangement or other
credit enhancement related to any agreement or transaction
referred to in subclause (I), (III), (IV), or (V),
including any guarantee or reimbursement obligation in
connection with any agreement or transaction referred to in
any such subclause.

For purposes of this clause, the term "qualified foreign
government security" means a security that is a direct
obligation of, or that is fully guaranteed by, the central
government of a member of the Organization for Economic
Cooperation and Development (as determined by regulation or
order adopted by the appropriate Federal banking authority).
(vi) Swap agreement
The term "swap agreement" means -
(I) any agreement, including the terms and conditions
incorporated by reference in any such agreement, which is
an interest rate swap, option, future, or forward
agreement, including a rate floor, rate cap, rate collar,
cross-currency rate swap, and basis swap; a spot, same day-
tomorrow, tomorrow-next, forward, or other foreign
exchange, precious metals, or other commodity agreement; a
currency swap, option, future, or forward agreement; an
equity index or equity swap, option, future, or forward
agreement; a debt index or debt swap, option, future, or
forward agreement; a total return, credit spread or credit
swap, option, future, or forward agreement; a commodity
index or commodity swap, option, future, or forward
agreement; weather swap, option, future, or forward
agreement; an emissions swap, option, future, or forward
agreement; or an inflation swap, option, future, or forward
agreement;
(II) any agreement or transaction that is similar to any
other agreement or transaction referred to in this clause
and that is of a type that has been, is presently, or in
the future becomes, the subject of recurrent dealings in
the swap or other derivatives markets (including terms and
conditions incorporated by reference in such agreement) and
that is a forward, swap, future, option, or spot
transaction on one or more rates, currencies, commodities,
equity securities or other equity instruments, debt
securities or other debt instruments, quantitative measures
associated with an occurrence, extent of an occurrence, or
contingency associated with a financial, commercial, or
economic consequence, or economic or financial indices or
measures of economic or financial risk or value;
(III) any combination of agreements or transactions
referred to in this clause;
(IV) any option to enter into any agreement or
transaction referred to in this clause;
(V) a master agreement that provides for an agreement or
transaction referred to in subclause (I), (II), (III), or
(IV), together with all supplements to any such master
agreement, without regard to whether the master agreement
contains an agreement or transaction that is not a swap
agreement under this clause, except that the master
agreement shall be considered to be a swap agreement under
this clause only with respect to each agreement or
transaction under the master agreement that is referred to
in subclause (I), (II), (III), or (IV); and
(VI) any security agreement or arrangement or other
credit enhancement related to any agreements or
transactions referred to in subclause (I), (II), (III),
(IV), or (V), including any guarantee or reimbursement
obligation in connection with any agreement or transaction
referred to in any such subclause.

Such term is applicable for purposes of this subsection only
and shall not be construed or applied so as to challenge or
affect the characterization, definition, or treatment of any
swap agreement under any other statute, regulation, or rule,
including the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, the Legal Certainty for
Bank Products Act of 2000 [7 U.S.C. 27 to 27f], the
securities laws (as such term is defined in section 3(a)(47)
of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 [15 U.S.C.
78c(a)(47)]) and the Commodity Exchange Act [7 U.S.C. 1 et
seq.].
(vii) Treatment of master agreement as one agreement
Any master agreement for any contract or agreement
described in any preceding clause of this subparagraph (or
any master agreement for such master agreement or
agreements), together with all supplements to such master
agreement, shall be treated as a single agreement and a
single qualified financial contract. If a master agreement
contains provisions relating to agreements or transactions
that are not themselves qualified financial contracts, the
master agreement shall be deemed to be a qualified financial
contract only with respect to those transactions that are
themselves qualified financial contracts.
(viii) Transfer
The term "transfer" means every mode, direct or indirect,
absolute or conditional, voluntary or involuntary, of
disposing of or parting with property or with an interest in
property, including retention of title as a security interest
and foreclosure of the depository institution's equity of
redemption.
(ix) Person
The term "person" includes any governmental entity in
addition to any entity included in the definition of such
term in section 1 of title 1.
(E) Certain protections in event of appointment of conservator
Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter (other
than subsections (d)(9) and (e)(10) of this section, and
section 1823(e) of this title), any other Federal law, or the
law of any State, no person shall be stayed or prohibited from
exercising -
(i) any right such person has to cause the termination,
liquidation, or acceleration of any qualified financial
contract with a depository institution in a conservatorship
based upon a default under such financial contract which is
enforceable under applicable noninsolvency law;
(ii) any right under any security agreement or arrangement
or other credit enhancement related to one or more qualified
financial contracts described in clause (i); (!3)
(iii) any right to offset or net out any termination
values, payment amounts, or other transfer obligations
arising under or in connection with such qualified financial
contracts.
(F) Clarification
No provision of law shall be construed as limiting the right
or power of the Corporation, or authorizing any court or agency
to limit or delay, in any manner, the right or power of the
Corporation to transfer any qualified financial contract in
accordance with paragraphs (9) and (10) of this subsection or
to disaffirm or repudiate any such contract in accordance with
subsection (e)(1) of this section.
(G) Walkaway clauses not effective
(i) In general
Notwithstanding the provisions of subparagraphs (A) and
(E), and sections 4403 and 4404 of this title, no walkaway
clause shall be enforceable in a qualified financial contract
of an insured depository institution in default.
(ii) Limited suspension of certain obligations
In the case of a qualified financial contract referred to
in clause (i), any payment or delivery obligations otherwise
due from a party pursuant to the qualified financial contract
shall be suspended from the time the receiver is appointed
until the earlier of -
(I) the time such party receives notice that such
contract has been transferred pursuant to subparagraph (A);
or
(II) 5:00 p.m. (eastern time) on the business day
following the date of the appointment of the receiver.
(iii) Walkaway clause defined
For purposes of this subparagraph, the term "walkaway
clause" means any provision in a qualified financial contract
that suspends, conditions, or extinguishes a payment
obligation of a party, in whole or in part, or does not
create a payment obligation of a party that would otherwise
exist, solely because of such party's status as a
nondefaulting party in connection with the insolvency of an
insured depository institution that is a party to the
contract or the appointment of or the exercise of rights or
powers by a conservator or receiver of such depository
institution, and not as a result of a party's exercise of any
right to offset, setoff, or net obligations that exist under
the contract, any other contract between those parties, or
applicable law.
(H) Recordkeeping requirements
The Corporation, in consultation with the appropriate Federal
banking agencies, may prescribe regulations requiring more
detailed recordkeeping by any insured depository institution
with respect to qualified financial contracts (including market
valuations) only if such insured depository institution is in a
troubled condition (as such term is defined by the Corporation
pursuant to section 1831i of this title).
(9) Transfer of qualified financial contracts
(A) In general
In making any transfer of assets or liabilities of a
depository institution in default which includes any qualified
financial contract, the conservator or receiver for such
depository institution shall either -
(i) transfer to one financial institution, other than a
financial institution for which a conservator, receiver,
trustee in bankruptcy, or other legal custodian has been
appointed or which is otherwise the subject of a bankruptcy
or insolvency proceeding -
(I) all qualified financial contracts between any person
or any affiliate of such person and the depository
institution in default;
(II) all claims of such person or any affiliate of such
person against such depository institution under any such
contract (other than any claim which, under the terms of
any such contract, is subordinated to the claims of general
unsecured creditors of such institution);
(III) all claims of such depository institution against
such person or any affiliate of such person under any such
contract; and
(IV) all property securing or any other credit
enhancement for any contract described in subclause (I) or
any claim described in subclause (II) or (III) under any
such contract; or

(ii) transfer none of the qualified financial contracts,
claims, property or other credit enhancement referred to in
clause (i) (with respect to such person and any affiliate of
such person).
(B) Transfer to foreign bank, foreign financial institution, or
branch or agency of a foreign bank or financial institution
In transferring any qualified financial contracts and related
claims and property under subparagraph (A)(i), the conservator
or receiver for the depository institution shall not make such
transfer to a foreign bank, financial institution organized
under the laws of a foreign country, or a branch or agency of a
foreign bank or financial institution unless, under the law
applicable to such bank, financial institution, branch or
agency, to the qualified financial contracts, and to any
netting contract, any security agreement or arrangement or
other credit enhancement related to one or more qualified
financial contracts, the contractual rights of the parties to
such qualified financial contracts, netting contracts, security
agreements or arrangements, or other credit enhancements are
enforceable substantially to the same extent as permitted under
this section.
(C) Transfer of contracts subject to the rules of a clearing
organization
In the event that a conservator or receiver transfers any
qualified financial contract and related claims, property, and
credit enhancements pursuant to subparagraph (A)(i) and such
contract is cleared by or subject to the rules of a clearing
organization, the clearing organization shall not be required
to accept the transferee as a member by virtue of the transfer.
(D) Definitions
For purposes of this paragraph, the term "financial
institution" means a broker or dealer, a depository
institution, a futures commission merchant, or any other
institution, as determined by the Corporation by regulation to
be a financial institution, and the term "clearing
organization" has the same meaning as in section 4402 of this
title.
(10) Notification of transfer
(A) In general
If -
(i) the conservator or receiver for an insured depository
institution in default makes any transfer of the assets and
liabilities of such institution; and
(ii) the transfer includes any qualified financial
contract,

the conservator or receiver shall notify any person who is a
party to any such contract of such transfer by 5:00 p.m.
(eastern time) on the business day following the date of the
appointment of the receiver in the case of a receivership, or
the business day following such transfer in the case of a
conservatorship.
(B) Certain rights not enforceable
(i) Receivership
A person who is a party to a qualified financial contract
with an insured depository institution may not exercise any
right that such person has to terminate, liquidate, or net
such contract under paragraph (8)(A) of this subsection or
section 4403 or 4404 of this title, solely by reason of or
incidental to the appointment of a receiver for the
depository institution (or the insolvency or financial
condition of the depository institution for which the
receiver has been appointed) -
(I) until 5:00 p.m. (eastern time) on the business day
following the date of the appointment of the receiver; or
(II) after the person has received notice that the
contract has been transferred pursuant to paragraph (9)(A).
(ii) Conservatorship
A person who is a party to a qualified financial contract
with an insured depository institution may not exercise any
right that such person has to terminate, liquidate, or net
such contract under paragraph (8)(E) of this subsection or
section 4403 or 4404 of this title, solely by reason of or
incidental to the appointment of a conservator for the
depository institution (or the insolvency or financial
condition of the depository institution for which the
conservator has been appointed).
(iii) Notice
For purposes of this paragraph, the Corporation as receiver
or conservator of an insured depository institution shall be
deemed to have notified a person who is a party to a
qualified financial contract with such depository institution
if the Corporation has taken steps reasonably calculated to
provide notice to such person by the time specified in
subparagraph (A).
(C) Treatment of bridge depository institutions
The following institutions shall not be considered to be a
financial institution for which a conservator, receiver,
trustee in bankruptcy, or other legal custodian has been
appointed or which is otherwise the subject of a bankruptcy or
insolvency proceeding for purposes of paragraph (9):
(i) A bridge depository institution.
(ii) A depository institution organized by the Corporation,
for which a conservator is appointed either -
(I) immediately upon the organization of the institution;
or
(II) at the time of a purchase and assumption transaction
between the depository institution and the Corporation as
receiver for a depository institution in default.
(D) "Business day" defined
For purposes of this paragraph, the term "business day" means
any day other than any Saturday, Sunday, or any day on which
either the New York Stock Exchange or the Federal Reserve Bank
of New York is closed.
(11) Disaffirmance or repudiation of qualified financial
contracts
In exercising the rights of disaffirmance or repudiation of a
conservator or receiver with respect to any qualified financial
contract to which an insured depository institution is a party,
the conservator or receiver for such institution shall either -
(A) disaffirm or repudiate all qualified financial contracts
between -
(i) any person or any affiliate of such person; and
(ii) the depository institution in default; or

(B) disaffirm or repudiate none of the qualified financial
contracts referred to in subparagraph (A) (with respect to such
person or any affiliate of such person).
(12) Certain security interests not avoidable
No provision of this subsection shall be construed as
permitting the avoidance of any legally enforceable or perfected
security interest in any of the assets of any depository
institution except where such an interest is taken in
contemplation of the institution's insolvency or with the intent
to hinder, delay, or defraud the institution or the creditors of
such institution.
(13) Authority to enforce contracts
(A) In general
The conservator or receiver may enforce any contract, other
than a director's or officer's liability insurance contract or
a depository institution bond, entered into by the depository
institution notwithstanding any provision of the contract
providing for termination, default, acceleration, or exercise
of rights upon, or solely by reason of, insolvency or the
appointment of or the exercise of rights or powers by a
conservator or receiver.
(B) Certain rights not affected
No provision of this paragraph may be construed as impairing
or affecting any right of the conservator or receiver to
enforce or recover under a director's or officer's liability
insurance contract or depository institution bond under other
applicable law.
(C) Consent requirement
(i) In general
Except as otherwise provided by this section or section
1825 of this title, no person may exercise any right or power
to terminate, accelerate, or declare a default under any
contract to which the depository institution is a party, or
to obtain possession of or exercise control over any property
of the institution or affect any contractual rights of the
institution, without the consent of the conservator or
receiver, as appropriate, during the 45-day period beginning
on the date of the appointment of the conservator, or during
the 90-day period beginning on the date of the appointment of
the receiver, as applicable.
(ii) Certain exceptions
No provision of this subparagraph shall apply to a director
or officer liability insurance contract or a depository
institution bond, to the rights of parties to certain
qualified financial contracts pursuant to paragraph (8), or
to the rights of parties to netting contracts pursuant to
subtitle A of title IV of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (12 U.S.C. 4401 et seq.),
or shall be construed as permitting the conservator or
receiver to fail to comply with otherwise enforceable
provisions of such contract.
(iii) Rule of construction
Nothing in this subparagraph shall be construed to limit or
otherwise affect the applicability of title 11.
(14) Exception for Federal Reserve and Federal home loan banks
No provision of this subsection shall apply with respect to -
(A) any extension of credit from any Federal home loan bank
or Federal Reserve bank to any insured depository institution;
or
(B) any security interest in the assets of the institution
securing any such extension of credit.
(15) Selling credit card accounts receivable
(A) Notification required
An undercapitalized insured depository institution (as
defined in section 1831o of this title) shall notify the
Corporation in writing before entering into an agreement to
sell credit card accounts receivable.
(B) Waiver by Corporation
The Corporation may at any time, in its sole discretion and
upon such terms as it may prescribe, waive its right to
repudiate an agreement to sell credit card accounts receivable
if the Corporation -
(i) determines that the waiver is in the best interests of
the Deposit Insurance Fund; and
(ii) provides a written waiver to the selling institution.
(C) Effect of waiver on successors
(i) In general
If, under subparagraph (B), the Corporation has waived its
right to repudiate an agreement to sell credit card accounts
receivable -
(I) any provision of the agreement that restricts
solicitation of a credit card customer of the selling
institution, or the use of a credit card customer list of
the institution, shall bind any receiver or conservator of
the institution; and
(II) the Corporation shall require any acquirer of the
selling institution, or of substantially all of the selling
institution's assets or liabilities, to agree to be bound
by a provision described in subclause (I) as if the
acquirer were the selling institution.
(ii) Exception
Clause (i)(II) does not -
(I) restrict the acquirer's authority to offer any
product or service to any person identified without using a
list of the selling institution's customers in violation of
the agreement;
(II) require the acquirer to restrict any preexisting
relationship between the acquirer and a customer; or
(III) apply to any transaction in which the acquirer
acquires only insured deposits.
(D) Waiver not actionable
The Corporation shall not, in any capacity, be liable to any
person for damages resulting from the waiver of or failure to
waive the Corporation's right under this section to repudiate
any contract or lease, including an agreement to sell credit
card accounts receivable. No court shall issue any order
affecting any such waiver or failure to waive.
(E) Other authority not affected
This paragraph does not limit any other authority of the
Corporation to waive the Corporation's right to repudiate an
agreement or lease under this section.
(16) Certain credit card customer lists protected
(A) In general
If any insured depository institution sells credit card
accounts receivable under an agreement negotiated at arm's
length that provides for the sale of the institution's credit
card customer list, the Corporation shall prohibit any party to
a transaction with respect to the institution under this
section or section 1823 of this title from using the list,
except as permitted under the agreement.
(B) Fraudulent transactions excluded
Subparagraph (A) does not limit the Corporation's authority
to repudiate any agreement entered into with the intent to
hinder, delay, or defraud the institution, the institution's
creditors, or the Corporation.
(17) Savings clause
The meanings of terms used in this subsection are applicable
for purposes of this subsection only, and shall not be construed
or applied so as to challenge or affect the characterization,
definition, or treatment of any similar terms under any other
statute, regulation, or rule, including the Gramm-Leach-Bliley
Act, the Legal Certainty for Bank Products Act of 2000 [7 U.S.C.
27 to 27f], the securities laws (as that term is defined in
section 3(a)(47) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 [15
U.S.C. 78c(a)(47)]), and the Commodity Exchange Act [7 U.S.C. 1
et seq.].
(f) Payment of insured deposits
(1) In general
In case of the liquidation of, or other closing or winding up
of the affairs of, any insured depository institution, payment of
the insured deposits in such institution shall be made by the
Corporation as soon as possible, subject to the provisions of
subsection (g) of this section, either by cash or by making
available to each depositor a transferred deposit in a new
insured depository institution in the same community or in
another insured depository institution in an amount equal to the
insured deposit of such depositor.
(2) Proof of claims
The Corporation, in its discretion, may require proof of claims
to be filed and may approve or reject such claims for insured
deposits.
(3) Resolution of disputes
A determination by the Corporation regarding any claim for
insurance coverage shall be treated as a final determination for
purposes of this section. In its discretion, the Corporation may
promulgate regulations prescribing procedures for resolving any
disputed claim relating to any insured deposit or any
determination of insurance coverage with respect to any deposit.
(4) Review of Corporation determination
A final determination made by the Corporation regarding any
claim for insurance coverage shall be a final agency action
reviewable in accordance with chapter 7 of title 5 by the United
States district court for the Federal judicial district where the
principal place of business of the depository institution is
located.
(5) Statute of limitations
Any request for review of a final determination by the
Corporation regarding any claim for insurance coverage shall be
filed with the appropriate United States district court not later
than 60 days after the date on which such determination is
issued.
(g) Subrogation of Corporation
(1) In general
Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal law, the law of
any State, or the constitution of any State, the Corporation,
upon the payment to any depositor as provided in subsection (f)
of this section in connection with any insured depository
institution or insured branch described in such subsection or the
assumption of any deposit in such institution or branch by
another insured depository institution pursuant to this section
or section 1823 of this title, shall be subrogated to all rights
of the depositor against such institution or branch to the extent
of such payment or assumption.
(2) Dividends on subrogated amounts
The subrogation of the Corporation under paragraph (1) with
respect to any insured depository institution shall include the
right on the part of the Corporation to receive the same
dividends from the proceeds of the assets of such institution and
recoveries on account of stockholders' liability as would have
been payable to the depositor on a claim for the insured deposit,
but such depositor shall retain such claim for any uninsured or
unassumed portion of the deposit.
(3) Waiver of certain claims
With respect to any bank which closes after May 25, 1938, the
Corporation shall waive, in favor only of any person against whom
stockholders' individual liability may be asserted, any claim on
account of such liability in excess of the liability, if any, to
the bank or its creditors, for the amount unpaid upon such stock
in such bank; but any such waiver shall be effected in such
manner and on such terms and conditions as will not increase
recoveries or dividends on account of claims to which the
Corporation is not subrogated.
(4) Applicability of State law
Subject to subsection (d)(11) of this section, if the
Corporation is appointed pursuant to subsection (c)(3) of this
section, or determines not to invoke the authority conferred in
subsection (c)(4) of this section, the rights of depositors and
other creditors of any State depository institution shall be
determined in accordance with the applicable provisions of State
law.
(h) Conditions applicable to resolution proceedings
(1) Consideration of local economic impact required
The Corporation shall fully consider the adverse economic
impact on local communities, including businesses and farms, of
actions to be taken by it during the administration and
liquidation of loans of a depository institution in default.
(2) Actions to alleviate adverse economic impact to be considered
The actions which the Corporation shall consider include the
release of proceeds from the sale of products and services for
family living and business expenses and shortening the undue
length of the decisionmaking process for the acceptance of offers
of settlement contingent upon third party financing.
(3) Guidelines required
The Corporation shall adopt and publish procedures and
guidelines to minimize adverse economic effects caused by its
actions on individual debtors in the community.
(4) Financial services industry impact analysis
After the appointment of the Corporation as conservator or
receiver for any insured depository institution and before taking
any action under this section or section 1823 of this title in
connection with the resolution of such institution, the
Corporation shall -
(A) evaluate the likely impact of the means of resolution,
and any action which the Corporation may take in connection
with such resolution, on the viability of other insured
depository institutions in the same community; and
(B) take such evaluation into account in determining the
means for resolving the institution and establishing the terms
and conditions for any such action.
(i) Valuation of claims in default
(1) In general
Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal law or the law
of any State and regardless of the method which the Corporation
determines to utilize with respect to an insured depository
institution in default or in danger of default, including
transactions authorized under subsection (n) of this section and
section 1823(c) of this title, this subsection shall govern the
rights of the creditors (other than insured depositors) of such
institution.
(2) Maximum liability
The maximum liability of the Corporation, acting as receiver or
in any other capacity, to any person having a claim against the
receiver or the insured depository institution for which such
receiver is appointed shall equal the amount such claimant would
have received if the Corporation had liquidated the assets and
liabilities of such institution without exercising the
Corporation's authority under subsection (n) of this section or
section 1823 of this title.
(3) Additional payments authorized
(A) In general
The Corporation may, in its discretion and in the interests
of minimizing its losses, use its own resources to make
additional payments or credit additional amounts to or with
respect to or for the account of any claimant or category of
claimants. Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal or
State law, or the constitution of any State, the Corporation
shall not be obligated, as a result of having made any such
payment or credited any such amount to or with respect to or
for the account of any claimant or category of claimants, to
make payments to any other claimant or category of claimants.
(B) Manner of payment
The Corporation may make the payments or credit the amounts
specified in subparagraph (A) directly to the claimants or may
make such payments or credit such amounts to an open insured
depository institution to induce such institution to accept
liability for such claims.
(j) Limitation on court action
Except as provided in this section, no court may take any action,
except at the request of the Board of Directors by regulation or
order, to restrain or affect the exercise of powers or functions of
the Corporation as a conservator or a receiver.
(k) Liability of directors and officers
A director or officer of an insured depository institution may be
held personally liable for monetary damages in any civil action by,
on behalf of, or at the request or direction of the Corporation,
which action is prosecuted wholly or partially for the benefit of
the Corporation -
(1) acting as conservator or receiver of such institution,
(2) acting based upon a suit, claim, or cause of action
purchased from, assigned by, or otherwise conveyed by such
receiver or conservator, or
(3) acting based upon a suit, claim, or cause of action
purchased from, assigned by, or otherwise conveyed in whole or in
part by an insured depository institution or its affiliate in
connection with assistance provided under section 1823 of this
title,

for gross negligence, including any similar conduct or conduct that
demonstrates a greater disregard of a duty of care (than gross
negligence) including intentional tortious conduct, as such terms
are defined and determined under applicable State law. Nothing in
this paragraph shall impair or affect any right of the Corporation
under other applicable law.
(l) Damages
In any proceeding related to any claim against an insured
depository institution's director, officer, employee, agent,
attorney, accountant, appraiser, or any other party employed by or
providing services to an insured depository institution,
recoverable damages determined to result from the improvident or
otherwise improper use or investment of any insured depository
institution's assets shall include principal losses and appropriate
interest.
(m) New depository institutions
(1) Organization authorized
As soon as possible after the default of an insured depository
institution, the Corporation, if it finds that it is advisable
and in the interest of the depositors of the insured depository
institution in default or the public shall organize a new
national bank or Federal savings association in the same
community as the insured depository institution in default to
assume the insured deposits of such depository institution in
default and otherwise to perform temporarily the functions
hereinafter provided for.
(2) Articles of association
The articles of association and the organization certificate of
the new depository institution shall be executed by
representatives designated by the Corporation.
(3) Capital stock
No capital stock need be paid in by the Corporation.
(4) Executive officer
The new depository institution shall not have a board of
directors, but shall be managed by an executive officer appointed
by the Board of Directors of the Corporation who shall be subject
to its directions.
(5) Subject to laws relating to national banks
In all other respects the new depository institution shall be
organized in accordance with the then existing provisions of law
relating to the organization of national banking associations.
(6) New deposits
The new depository institution may, with the approval of the
Corporation, accept new deposits which shall be subject to
withdrawal on demand and which, except where the new depository
institution is the only depository institution in the community,
shall not exceed an amount equal to the standard maximum deposit
insurance amount from any depositor.
(7) Insured status
The new depository institution, without application to or
approval by the Corporation, shall be an insured depository
institution and shall maintain on deposit with the Federal
Reserve bank of its district reserves in the amount required by
law for member banks, but it shall not be required to subscribe
for stock of the Federal Reserve bank.
(8) Investments
Funds of the new depository institution shall be kept on hand
in cash, invested in obligations of the United States or
obligations guaranteed as to principal and interest by the United
States, or deposited with the Corporation, any Federal Reserve
bank, or, to the extent of the insurance coverage on any such
deposit, an insured depository institution.
(9) Conduct of business
The new depository institution, unless otherwise authorized by
the Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, shall transact business only
as authorized by this chapter and as may be incidental to its
organization.
(10) Exempt status
Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal or State law,
the new depository institution, its franchise, property, and
income shall be exempt from all taxation now or hereafter imposed
by the United States, by any territory, dependency, or possession
thereof, or by any State, county, municipality, or local taxing
authority.
(11) Transfer of deposits
(A) Upon the organization of a new depository institution, the
Corporation shall promptly make available to it an amount equal
to the estimated insured deposits of such depository institution
in default plus the estimated amount of the expenses of operating
the new depository institution, and shall determine as soon as
possible the amount due each depositor for the depositor's
insured deposit in the insured depository institution in default,
and the total expenses of operation of the new depository
institution.
(B) Upon such determination, the amounts so estimated and made
available shall be adjusted to conform to the amounts so
determined.
(12) Earnings
Earnings of the new depository institution shall be paid over
or credited to the Corporation in such adjustment.
(13) Losses
If any new depository institution, during the period it
continues its status as such, sustains any losses with respect to
which it is not effectively protected except by reason of being
an insured depository institution, the Corporation shall furnish
to it additional funds in the amount of such losses.
(14) Payment of insured deposits
(A) The new depository institution shall assume as transferred
deposits the payment of the insured deposits of such depository
institution in default to each of its depositors.
(B) Of the amounts so made available, the Corporation shall
transfer to the new depository institution, in cash, such sums as
may be necessary to enable it to meet its expenses of operation
and immediate cash demands on such transferred deposits, and the
remainder of such amounts shall be subject to withdrawal by the
new depository institution on demand.
(15) Issuance of stock
(A) Whenever in the judgment of the Board of Directors it is
desirable to do so, the Corporation shall cause capital stock of
the new depository institution to be offered for sale on such
terms and conditions as the Board of Directors shall deem
advisable in an amount sufficient, in the opinion of the Board of
Directors, to make possible the conduct of the business of the
new depository institution on a sound basis.
(B) The stockholders of the insured depository institution in
default shall be given the first opportunity to purchase any
shares of common stock so offered.
(16) Issuance of certificate
Upon proof that an adequate amount of capital stock in the new
depository institution has been subscribed and paid for in cash,
the Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, shall require the articles of
association and the organization certificate to be amended to
conform to the requirements for the organization of a national
bank or Federal savings association, and thereafter, when the
requirements of law with respect to the organization of a
national bank or Federal savings association have been complied
with, the Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, shall issue to the
depository institution a certificate of authority to commence
business, and thereupon the depository institution shall cease to
have the status of a new depository institution, shall be managed
by directors elected by its own shareholders, may exercise all
the powers granted by law, and shall be subject to all provisions
of law relating to national banks or Federal savings
associations. Such depository institution shall thereafter be an
insured national bank or Federal savings association, without
certification to or approval by the Corporation.
(17) Transfer to other institution
If the capital stock of the new depository institution is not
offered for sale, or if an adequate amount of capital for such
new depository institution is not subscribed and paid for, the
Board of Directors may offer to transfer its business to any
insured depository institution in the same community which will
take over its assets, assume its liabilities, and pay to the
Corporation for such business such amount as the Board of
Directors may deem adequate; or the Board of Directors in its
discretion may change the location of the new depository
institution to the office of the Corporation or to some other
place or may at any time wind up its affairs as herein provided.
(18) Winding up
Unless the capital stock of the new depository institution is
sold or its assets are taken over and its liabilities are assumed
by an insured depository institution as above provided within 2
years after the date of its organization, the Corporation shall
wind up the affairs of such depository institution, after giving
such notice, if any, as the Comptroller of the Currency or the
Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, may
require, and shall certify to the Comptroller of the Currency or
the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate,
the termination of the new depository institution. Thereafter the
Corporation shall be liable for the obligations of such
depository institution and shall be the owner of its assets.
(19) Applicability of certain laws
The provisions of sections 181 and 182 of this title shall not
apply to a new depository institution under this subsection.
(n) Bridge depository institutions
(1) Organization
(A) Purpose
When 1 or more insured depository institutions are in
default, or when the Corporation anticipates that 1 or more
insured depository institutions may become in default, the
Corporation may, in its discretion, organize, and the Office of
the Comptroller of the Currency, with respect to 1 or more
insured banks, or the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, with respect to 1 or more insured savings
associations, shall charter, 1 or more national banks or
Federal savings associations, as appropriate, with respect
thereto with the powers and attributes of national banking
associations or Federal savings associations, as
applicable,,(!6) subject to the provisions of this subsection,
to be referred to as "bridge depository institutions".

(B) Authorities
Upon the granting of a charter to a bridge depository
institution, the bridge depository institution may -
(i) assume such deposits of such insured depository
institution or institutions that is or are in default or in
danger of default as the Corporation may, in its discretion,
determine to be appropriate;
(ii) assume such other liabilities (including liabilities
associated with any trust business) of such insured
depository institution or institutions that is or are in
default or in danger of default as the Corporation may, in
its discretion, determine to be appropriate;
(iii) purchase such assets (including assets associated
with any trust business) of such insured depository
institution or institutions that is or are in default or in
danger of default as the Corporation may, in its discretion,
determine to be appropriate; and
(iv) perform any other temporary function which the
Corporation may, in its discretion, prescribe in accordance
with this chapter.
(C) Articles of association
The articles of association and organization certificate of a
bridge depository institution as approved by the Corporation
shall be executed by 3 representatives designated by the
Corporation.
(D) Interim directors
A bridge depository institution shall have an interim board
of directors consisting of not fewer than 5 nor more than 10
members appointed by the Corporation.
(E) National bank or Federal savings association
A bridge depository institution shall be organized as a
national bank, in the case of 1 or more insured banks, and as a
Federal savings association, in the case of 1 or more insured
savings associations.
(2) Chartering
(A) Conditions
A national bank or Federal savings association may be
chartered by the Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of
the Office of Thrift Supervision as a bridge depository
institution only if the Board of Directors determines that -
(i) the amount which is reasonably necessary to operate
such bridge depository institution will not exceed the amount
which is reasonably necessary to save the cost of
liquidating, including paying the insured accounts of, 1 or
more insured depository institutions in default or in danger
of default with respect to which the bridge depository
institution is chartered;
(ii) the continued operation of such insured depository
institution or institutions in default or in danger of
default with respect to which the bridge depository
institution is chartered is essential to provide adequate
banking services in the community where each such depository
institution in default or in danger of default is located; or
(iii) the continued operation of such insured depository
institution or institutions in default or in danger of
default with respect to which the bridge depository
institution is chartered is in the best interest of the
depositors of such depository institution or institutions in
default or in danger of default or the public.
(B) Insured national bank or Federal savings association
A bridge depository institution shall be an insured
depository institution from the time it is chartered as a
national bank or Federal savings association.
(C) Bridge bank (!7) treated as being in default for certain
purposes

A bridge depository institution shall be treated as an
insured depository institution in default at such times and for
such purposes as the Corporation may, in its discretion,
determine.
(D) Management
A bridge depository institution, upon the granting of its
charter, shall be under the management of a board of directors
consisting of not fewer than 5 nor more than 10 members
appointed by the Corporation.
(E) Bylaws
The board of directors of a bridge depository institution
shall adopt such bylaws as may be approved by the Corporation.
(3) Transfer of assets and liabilities
(A) In general
(i) Transfer upon grant of charter
Upon the granting of a charter to a bridge depository
institution pursuant to this subsection, the Corporation, as
receiver, or any other receiver appointed with respect to any
insured depository institution in default with respect to
which the bridge depository institution is chartered may
transfer any assets and liabilities of such depository
institution in default to the bridge depository institution
in accordance with paragraph (1).
(ii) Subsequent transfers
At any time after a charter is granted to a bridge
depository institution, the Corporation, as receiver, or any
other receiver appointed with respect to an insured
depository institution in default may transfer any assets and
liabilities of such insured depository institution in default
as the Corporation may, in its discretion, determine to be
appropriate in accordance with paragraph (1).
(iii) Treatment of trust business
For purposes of this paragraph, the trust business,
including fiduciary appointments, of any insured depository
institution in default is included among its assets and
liabilities.
(iv) Effective without approval
The transfer of any assets or liabilities, including those
associated with any trust business, of an insured depository
institution in default transferred to a bridge depository
institution shall be effective without any further approval
under Federal or State law, assignment, or consent with
respect thereto.
(B) Intent of Congress regarding continuing operations
It is the intent of the Congress that, in order to prevent
unnecessary hardship or losses to the customers of any insured
depository institution in default with respect to which a
bridge depository institution is chartered, especially
creditworthy farmers, small businesses, and households, the
Corporation should -
(i) continue to honor commitments made by the depository
institution in default to creditworthy customers, and
(ii) not interrupt or terminate adequately secured loans
which are transferred under subparagraph (A) and are being
repaid by the debtor in accordance with the terms of the loan
instrument.
(4) Powers of bridge banks (!8)

Each bridge depository institution chartered under this
subsection shall have all corporate powers of, and be subject to
the same provisions of law as, a national bank or Federal savings
association, as appropriate, except that -
(A) the Corporation may -
(i) remove the interim directors and directors of a bridge
depository institution;
(ii) fix the compensation of members of the interim board
of directors and the board of directors and senior
management, as determined by the Corporation in its
discretion, of a bridge depository institution; and
(iii) waive any requirement established under section 71,
72, 73, 74, or 75 of this title (relating to directors of
national banks) or section 71a of this title which would
otherwise be applicable with respect to directors of a bridge
depository institution by operation of paragraph (2)(B);

(B) the Corporation may indemnify the representatives for
purposes of paragraph (1)(B) and the interim directors,
directors, officers, employees, and agents of a bridge
depository institution on such terms as the Corporation
determines to be appropriate;
(C) no requirement under any provision of law relating to the
capital of a national bank shall apply with respect to a bridge
depository institution;
(D) the Comptroller of the Currency and the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, may establish a
limitation on the extent to which any person may become
indebted to a bridge depository institution without regard to
the amount of the bridge depository institution's capital or
surplus;
(E)(i) the board of directors of a bridge depository
institution shall elect a chairperson who may also serve in the
position of chief executive officer, except that such person
shall not serve either as chairperson or as chief executive
officer without the prior approval of the Corporation; and
(ii) the board of directors of a bridge depository
institution may appoint a chief executive officer who is not
also the chairperson, except that such person shall not serve
as chief executive officer without the prior approval of the
Corporation;
(F) a bridge depository institution shall not be required to
purchase stock of any Federal Reserve bank;
(G) the Comptroller of the Currency and the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, shall waive any
requirement for a fidelity bond with respect to a bridge
depository institution at the request of the Corporation;
(H) any judicial action to which a bridge depository
institution becomes a party by virtue of its acquisition of any
assets or assumption of any liabilities of a depository
institution in default shall be stayed from further proceedings
for a period of up to 45 days at the request of the bridge
depository institution;
(I) no agreement which tends to diminish or defeat the right,
title or interest of a bridge depository institution in any
asset of an insured depository institution in default acquired
by it shall be valid against the bridge depository institution
unless such agreement -
(i) is in writing,
(ii) was executed by such insured depository institution in
default and the person or persons claiming an adverse
interest thereunder, including the obligor, contemporaneously
with the acquisition of the asset by such insured depository
institution in default,
(iii) was approved by the board of directors of such
insured depository institution in default or its loan
committee, which approval shall be reflected in the minutes
of said board or committee, and
(iv) has been, continuously from the time of its execution,
an official record of such insured depository institution in
default;

(J) notwithstanding section 1823(e)(2) of this title, any
agreement relating to an extension of credit between a Federal
home loan bank or Federal Reserve bank and any insured
depository institution which was executed before the extension
of credit by such bank to such depository institution shall be
treated as having been executed contemporaneously with such
extension of credit for purposes of subparagraph (I); and
(K) except with the prior approval of the Corporation, a
bridge depository institution may not, in any transaction or
series of transactions, issue capital stock or be a party to
any merger, consolidation, disposition of assets or
liabilities, sale or exchange of capital stock, or similar
transaction, or change its charter.
(5) Capital
(A) No capital required
The Corporation shall not be required to -
(i) issue any capital stock on behalf of a bridge
depository institution chartered under this subsection; or
(ii) purchase any capital stock of a bridge depository
institution, except that notwithstanding any other provision
of Federal or State law, the Corporation may purchase and
retain capital stock of a bridge depository institution in
such amounts and on such terms as the Corporation, in its
discretion, determines to be appropriate.
(B) Operating funds in lieu of capital
Upon the organization of a bridge depository institution, and
thereafter, as the Board of Directors may, in its discretion,
determine to be necessary or advisable, the Corporation may
make available to the bridge depository institution, upon such
terms and conditions and in such form and amounts as the
Corporation may in its discretion determine, funds for the
operation of the bridge depository institution in lieu of
capital.
(C) Authority to issue capital stock
Whenever the Board of Directors determines it is advisable to
do so, the Corporation shall cause capital stock of a bridge
depository institution to be issued and offered for sale in
such amounts and on such terms and conditions as the
Corporation may, in its discretion, determine.
(D) Capital levels
A bridge depository institution shall not be considered an
undercapitalized depository institution or a critically
undercapitalized depository institution for purposes of section
347b(b) of this title.
(6) No Federal status
(A) Agency status
A bridge depository institution is not an agency,
establishment, or instrumentality of the United States.
(B) Employee status
Representatives for purposes of paragraph (1)(B), interim
directors, directors, officers, employees, or agents of a
bridge depository institution are not, solely by virtue of
service in any such capacity, officers or employees of the
United States. Any employee of the Corporation or of any
Federal instrumentality who serves at the request of the
Corporation as a representative for purposes of paragraph
(1)(B), interim director, director, officer, employee, or agent
of a bridge depository institution shall not -
(i) solely by virtue of service in any such capacity lose
any existing status as an officer or employee of the United
States for purposes of title 5 or any other provision of law,
or
(ii) receive any salary or benefits for service in any such
capacity with respect to a bridge depository institution in
addition to such salary or benefits as are obtained through
employment with the Corporation or such Federal
instrumentality.
(7) Assistance authorized
The Corporation may, in its discretion, provide assistance
under section 1823(c) of this title to facilitate any transaction
described in clause (i), (ii), or (iii) of paragraph (10)(A) with
respect to any bridge depository institution in the same manner
and to the same extent as such assistance may be provided under
such section with respect to an insured depository institution in
default, or to facilitate a bridge depository institution's
acquisition of any assets or the assumption of any liabilities of
an insured depository institution in default.
(8) Acquisition
(A) In general
The responsible agency shall notify the Attorney General of
any transaction involving the merger or sale of a bridge
depository institution requiring approval under section 1828(c)
of this title and if a report on competitive factors is
requested within 10 days, such transaction may not be
consummated before the 5th calendar day after the date of
approval by the responsible agency with respect thereto. If the
responsible agency has found that it must act immediately to
prevent the probable failure of 1 of the depository
institutions involved, the preceding sentence does not apply
and the transaction may be consummated immediately upon
approval by the agency.
(B) By out-of-State holding company
Any depository institution, including an out-of-State
depository institution, or any out-of-State depository
institution holding company may acquire and retain the capital
stock or assets of, or otherwise acquire and retain a bridge
depository institution if the bridge depository institution at
any time had assets aggregating $500,000,000 or more, as
determined by the Corporation on the basis of the bridge
depository institution's reports of condition or on the basis
of the last available reports of condition of any insured
depository institution in default, which institution has been
acquired, or whose assets have been acquired, by the bridge
depository institution. The acquiring entity may acquire the
bridge depository institution only in the same manner and to
the same extent as such entity may acquire an insured
depository institution in default under section 1823(f)(2) of
this title.
(9) Duration of bridge depository institution
Subject to paragraphs (11) and (12), the status of a bridge
depository institution as such shall terminate at the end of the
2-year period following the date it was granted a charter. The
Board of Directors may, in its discretion, extend the status of
the bridge depository institution as such for 3 additional 1-year
periods.
(10) Termination of bridge depository institution status
The status of any bridge depository institution as such shall
terminate upon the earliest of -
(A) the merger or consolidation of the bridge depository
institution with a depository institution that is not a bridge
depository institution;
(B) at the election of the Corporation, the sale of a
majority of the capital stock of the bridge depository
institution to an entity other than the Corporation and other
than another bridge depository institution;
(C) the sale of 80 percent, or more, of the capital stock of
the bridge depository institution to an entity other than the
Corporation and other than another bridge depository
institution;
(D) at the election of the Corporation, either the assumption
of all or substantially all of the deposits and other
liabilities of the bridge depository institution by a
depository institution holding company or a depository
institution that is not a bridge depository institution, or the
acquisition of all or substantially all of the assets of the
bridge depository institution by a depository institution
holding company, a depository institution that is not a bridge
depository institution, or other entity as permitted under
applicable law; and
(E) the expiration of the period provided in paragraph (9),
or the earlier dissolution of the bridge depository institution
as provided in paragraph (12).
(11) Effect of termination events
(A) Merger or consolidation
A bridge depository institution that participates in a merger
or consolidation as provided in paragraph (10)(A) shall be for
all purposes a national bank or a Federal savings association,
as the case may be, with all the rights, powers, and privileges
thereof, and such merger or consolidation shall be conducted in
accordance with, and shall have the effect provided in, the
provisions of applicable law.
(B) Charter conversion
Following the sale of a majority of the capital stock of the
bridge depository institution as provided in paragraph (10)(B),
the Corporation may amend the charter of the bridge depository
institution to reflect the termination of the status of the
bridge depository institution as such, whereupon the depository
institution shall remain a national bank or a Federal savings
association, as the case may be,,(!6) with all of the rights,
powers, and privileges thereof, subject to all laws and
regulations applicable thereto.
(C) Sale of stock
Following the sale of 80 percent or more of the capital stock
of a bridge depository institution as provided in paragraph
(10)(C), the depository institution shall remain a national
bank or a Federal savings association, as the case may be,,(!6)
with all of the rights, powers, and privileges thereof, subject
to all laws and regulations applicable thereto.
(D) Assumption of liabilities and sale of assets
Following the assumption of all or substantially all of the
liabilities of the bridge depository institution, or the sale
of all or substantially all of the assets of the bridge
depository institution, as provided in paragraph (10)(D), at
the election of the Corporation the bridge depository
institution may retain its status as such for the period
provided in paragraph (9).
(E) Effect on holding companies
A depository institution holding company acquiring a bridge
depository institution under section 1823(f) of this title,
paragraph (8)(B) (or any predecessor provision), or both
provisions, shall not be impaired or adversely affected by the
termination of the status of a bridge depository institution as
a result of subparagraph (A), (B), (C), or (D) of paragraph
(10), and shall be entitled to the rights and privileges
provided in section 1823(f) of this title.
(F) Amendments to charter
Following the consummation of a transaction described in
subparagraph (A), (B), (C), or (D) of paragraph (10), the
charter of the resulting institution shall be amended to
reflect the termination of bridge depository institution
status, if appropriate.
(12) Dissolution of bridge depository institution
(A) In general
Notwithstanding any other provision of State or Federal law,
if the bridge depository institution's status as such has not
previously been terminated by the occurrence of an event
specified in subparagraph (A), (B), (C), or (D) of paragraph
(10) -
(i) the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, dissolve
a bridge depository institution in accordance with this
paragraph at any time; and
(ii) the Board of Directors shall promptly commence
dissolution proceedings in accordance with this paragraph
upon the expiration of the 2-year period following the date
the bridge depository institution was chartered, or any
extension thereof, as provided in paragraph (9).
(B) Procedures
The Comptroller of the Currency or the Director of the Office
of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate, shall appoint the
Corporation receiver for a bridge depository institution upon
certification by the Board of Directors to the Comptroller of
the Currency or the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, as appropriate, of its determination to dissolve
the bridge depository institution. The Corporation as such
receiver shall wind up the affairs of the bridge depository
institution in conformity with the provisions of law relating
to the liquidation of closed national banks or Federal savings
associations, as appropriate. With respect to any such bridge
depository institution, the Corporation as such receiver shall
have all the rights, powers, and privileges and shall perform
the duties related to the exercise of such rights, powers, or
privileges granted by law to a receiver of any insured
depository institution and notwithstanding any other provision
of law in the exercise of such rights, powers, and privileges
the Corporation shall not be subject to the direction or
supervision of any State agency or other Federal agency.
(13) Multiple bridge depository institutions
Subject to paragraph (1)(B)(i), the Corporation may, in the
Corporation's discretion, organize 2 or more bridge depository
institutions under this subsection to assume any deposits of,
assume any other liabilities of, and purchase any assets of a
single depository institution in default.
(o) Supervisory records
In addition to the requirements of section 1817(a)(2) of this
title to provide to the Corporation copies of reports of
examination and reports of condition, whenever the Corporation has
been appointed as receiver for an insured depository institution,
the appropriate Federal banking agency shall make available all
supervisory records to the receiver which may be used by the
receiver in any manner the receiver determines to be appropriate.
(p) Certain sales of assets prohibited
(1) Persons who engaged in improper conduct with, or caused
losses to, depository institutions
The Corporation shall prescribe regulations which, at a
minimum, shall prohibit the sale of assets of a failed
institution by the Corporation to -
(A) any person who -
(i) has defaulted, or was a member of a partnership or an
officer or director of a corporation that has defaulted, on 1
or more obligations the aggregate amount of which exceed
$1,000,000, to such failed institution;
(ii) has been found to have engaged in fraudulent activity
in connection with any obligation referred to in clause (i);
and
(iii) proposes to purchase any such asset in whole or in
part through the use of the proceeds of a loan or advance of
credit from the Corporation or from any institution for which
the Corporation has been appointed as conservator or
receiver;

(B) any person who participated, as an officer or director of
such failed institution or of any affiliate of such
institution, in a material way in transactions that resulted in
a substantial loss to such failed institution;
(C) any person who has been removed from, or prohibited from
participating in the affairs of, such failed institution
pursuant to any final enforcement action by an appropriate
Federal banking agency; or
(D) any person who has demonstrated a pattern or practice of
defalcation regarding obligations to such failed institution.
(2) Convicted debtors
Except as provided in paragraph (3), any person who -
(A) has been convicted of an offense under section 215, 656,
657, 1005, 1006, 1007, 1008,(!2) 1014, 1032, 1341, 1343, or
1344 of title 18 or of conspiring to commit such an offense,
affecting any insured depository institution for which any
conservator or receiver has been appointed; and
(B) is in default on any loan or other extension of credit
from such insured depository institution which, if not paid,
will cause substantial loss to the institution, the Deposit
Insurance Fund, the Corporation, the FSLIC Resolution Fund, or
the Resolution Trust Corporation,

may not purchase any asset of such institution from the
conservator or receiver.
(3) Settlement of claims
Paragraphs (1) and (2) shall not apply to the sale or transfer
by the Corporation of any asset of any insured depository
institution to any person if the sale or transfer of the asset
resolves or settles, or is part of the resolution or settlement,
of -
(A) 1 or more claims that have been, or could have been,
asserted by the Corporation against the person; or
(B) obligations owed by the person to any insured depository
institution, the FSLIC Resolution Fund, the Resolution Trust
Corporation, or the Corporation.
(4) "Default" defined
For purposes of this subsection, the term "default" means a
failure to comply with the terms of a loan or other obligation to
such an extent that the property securing the obligation is
foreclosed upon.
(q) Expedited procedures for certain claims
(1) Time for filing notice of appeal
The notice of appeal of any order, whether interlocutory or
final, entered in any case brought by the Corporation against an
insured depository institution's director, officer, employee,
agent, attorney, accountant, or appraiser or any other person
employed by or providing services to an insured depository
institution shall be filed not later than 30 days after the date
of entry of the order. The hearing of the appeal shall be held
not later than 120 days after the date of the notice of appeal.
The appeal shall be decided not later than 180 days after the
date of the notice of appeal.
(2) Scheduling
Consistent with section 1657 of title 18,(!9) a court of the
United States shall expedite the consideration of any case
brought by the Corporation against an insured depository
institution's director, officer, employee, agent, attorney,
accountant, or appraiser or any other person employed by or
providing services to an insured depository institution. As far
as practicable the court shall give such case priority on its
docket.

(3) Judicial discretion
The court may modify the schedule and limitations stated in
paragraphs (1) and (2) in a particular case, based on a specific
finding that the ends of justice that would be served by making
such a modification would outweigh the best interest of the
public in having the case resolved expeditiously.
(r) Foreign investigations
The Corporation and the Resolution Trust Corporation, as
conservator or receiver of any insured depository institution and
for purposes of carrying out any power, authority, or duty with
respect to an insured depository institution -
(1) may request the assistance of any foreign banking authority
and provide assistance to any foreign banking authority in
accordance with section 1818(v) of this title; and
(2) may each maintain an office to coordinate foreign
investigations or investigations on behalf of foreign banking
authorities.
(s) Prohibition on entering secrecy agreements and protective
orders
The Corporation may not enter into any agreement or approve any
protective order which prohibits the Corporation from disclosing
the terms of any settlement of an administrative or other action
for damages or restitution brought by the Corporation in its
capacity as conservator or receiver for an insured depository
institution.
(t) Agencies may share information without waiving privilege
(1) In general
A covered agency, in any capacity, shall not be deemed to have
waived any privilege applicable to any information by
transferring that information to or permitting that information
to be used by -
(A) any other covered agency, in any capacity; or
(B) any other agency of the Federal Government (as defined in
section 6 of title 18).
(2) Definitions
For purposes of this subsection:
(A) Covered agency
The term "covered agency" means any of the following:
(i) Any Federal banking agency.
(ii) The Farm Credit Administration.
(iii) The Farm Credit System Insurance Corporation.
(iv) The National Credit Union Administration.
(v) The Government Accountability Office.
(vii) (!10) Federal (!11) Housing Finance Agency.


(B) Privilege
The term "privilege" includes any work-product, attorney-
client, or other privilege recognized under Federal or State
law.
(3) Rule of construction
Paragraph (1) shall not be construed as implying that any
person waives any privilege applicable to any information because
paragraph (1) does not apply to the transfer or use of that
information.
(u) Purchase rights of tenants
(1) Notice
Except as provided in paragraph (3), the Corporation may make
available for sale a 1- to 4-family residence (including a
manufactured home) to which the Corporation acquires title only
after the Corporation has provided the household residing in the
property notice (in writing and mailed to the property) of the
availability of such property and the preference afforded such
household under paragraph (2).
(2) Preference
In selling such a property, the Corporation shall give
preference to any bona fide offer made by the household residing
in the property, if -
(A) such offer is substantially similar in amount to other
offers made within such period (or expected by the Corporation
to be made within such period);
(B) such offer is made during the period beginning upon the
Corporation making such property available and of a reasonable
duration, as determined by the Corporation based on the normal
period for sale of such properties; and
(C) the household making the offer complies with any other
requirements applicable to purchasers of such property,
including any downpayment and credit requirements.
(3) Exceptions
Paragraphs (1) and (2) shall not apply to -
(A) any residence transferred in connection with the transfer
of substantially all of the assets of an insured depository
institution for which the Corporation has been appointed
conservator or receiver;
(B) any eligible single family property (as such term is
defined in section 1831q(p) of this title; or
(C) any residence for which the household occupying the
residence was the mortgagor under a mortgage on such residence
and to which the Corporation acquired title pursuant to default
on such mortgage.
(v) Preference for sales for homeless families
Subject to subsection (u) of this section, in selling any real
property (other than eligible residential property and eligible
condominium property, as such terms are defined in section 1831q(p)
of this title) to which the Corporation acquires title, the
Corporation shall give preference among offers to purchase the
property that will result in the same net present value proceeds,
to any offer that would provide for the property to be used, during
the remaining useful life of the property, to provide housing or
shelter for homeless persons (as such term is defined in section
11302 of title 42) or homeless families.
(w) Preferences for sales of certain commercial real properties
(1) Authority
In selling any eligible commercial real properties of the
Corporation, the Corporation shall give preference, among offers
to purchase the property that will result in the same net present
value proceeds, to any offer -
(A) that is made by a public agency or nonprofit
organization; and
(B) under which the purchaser agrees that the property shall
be used, during the remaining useful life of the property, for
offices and administrative purposes of the purchaser to carry
out a program to acquire residential properties to provide (i)
homeownership and rental housing opportunities for very-low-,
low-, and moderate-income families, or (ii) housing or shelter
for homeless persons (as such term is defined in section 11302
of title 42) or homeless families.
(2) Definitions
For purposes of this subsection, the following definitions
shall apply:
(A) Eligible commercial real property
The term "eligible commercial real property" means any
property (i) to which the Corporation acquires title, and (ii)
that the Corporation, in the discretion of the Corporation,
determines is suitable for use for the location of offices or
other administrative functions involved with carrying out a
program referred to in paragraph (1)(B).
(B) Nonprofit organization and public agency
The terms "nonprofit organization" and "public agency" have
the same meanings as in section 1831q(p) of this title.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[11], 64 Stat. 884; Pub. L. 89-695,
title III, Sec. 301(c), (d), Oct. 16, 1966, 80 Stat. 1055; Pub. L.
91-151, title I, Sec. 7(a)(3), (4), Dec. 23, 1969, 83 Stat. 375;
Pub. L. 93-495, title I, Secs. 101(a)(3), 102(a)(3), (4), Oct. 28,
1974, 88 Stat. 1500, 1502; Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(17)-(22),
Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 619; Pub. L. 95-630, title XIV, Sec.
1401(a), Nov. 10, 1978, 92 Stat. 3712; Pub. L. 96-153, title III,
Sec. 323(a), Dec. 21, 1979, 93 Stat. 1120; Pub. L. 96-221, title
III, Sec. 308(a)(1)(C), (D), Mar. 31, 1980, 94 Stat. 147; Pub. L.
97-110, title I, Sec. 103(c), Dec. 26, 1981, 95 Stat. 1514; Pub. L.
97-320, title I, Sec. 113(j), (k), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1474;
Pub. L. 99-514, Sec. 2, Oct. 22, 1986, 100 Stat. 2095; Pub. L. 100-
86, title V, Secs. 503(a), 507, Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 629, 634;
Pub. L. 101-73, title II, Secs. 201(a), 211-214, title IX, Sec.
909, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 218-246, 477; Pub. L. 101-647,
title XXV, Secs. 2521(a)(1), 2526(a), 2527(a), 2528(a), 2532(b),
2534(a), Nov. 29, 1990, 104 Stat. 4863, 4875, 4877, 4880, 4882;
Pub. L. 102-233, title I, Sec. 102, title II, Sec. 202(a), (b),
title III, Sec. 302(a), Dec. 12, 1991, 105 Stat. 1761, 1766, 1767;
Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Secs. 123(a), 133(a), (e), 141(b), (d),
161(a), (e), title II, Sec. 241(c)(1), title III, Sec. 311(a)(1),
(b)(1), (2), (5)(B), (C), title IV, Secs. 416, 426, 446, Dec. 19,
1991, 105 Stat. 2252, 2270, 2272, 2277, 2285, 2286, 2331, 2363,
2364, 2366, 2376, 2378, 2382; Pub. L. 102-550, title XV, Secs.
1501(a), 1544, title XVI, Secs. 1603(e)(1), 1604(c)(2), 1606(c),
1611(b), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4044, 4069, 4081, 4083, 4088,
4090; Pub. L. 103-66, title III, Sec. 3001(a), (b), Aug. 10, 1993,
107 Stat. 336; Pub. L. 103-204, Secs. 3(d), 4(b), 8(a)-(f), (i),
11, 15(b), 16(b), 17(b), 20, 27(b), 38(b), Dec. 17, 1993, 107 Stat.
2379, 2380, 2384-2389, 2399-2401, 2404, 2410, 2416; Pub. L. 103-
325, title III, Sec. 325, title IV, Sec. 411(c)(2)(A), title VI,
Sec. 602(a)(21)-(33), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat. 2228, 2253, 2289;
Pub. L. 103-328, title II, Sec. 201(a), Sept. 29, 1994, 108 Stat.
2368; Pub. L. 103-394, title V, Sec. 501(c)(2), Oct. 22, 1994, 108
Stat. 4143; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Secs. 2602,
2704(d)(1)-(4), (6)(C), (14)(H), (I), 2705, Sept. 30, 1996, 110
Stat. 3009-469, 3009-487, 3009-488, 3009-492, 3009-495; Pub. L. 104-
316, title I, Sec. 106(i), Oct. 19, 1996, 110 Stat. 3831; Pub. L.
106-102, title I, Sec. 117, title VII, Sec. 736(a), (b)(2), Nov.
12, 1999, 113 Stat. 1372, 1479; Pub. L. 106-400, Sec. 2, Oct. 30,
2000, 114 Stat. 1675; Pub. L. 106-569, title XII, Sec. 1222, Dec.
27, 2000, 114 Stat. 3036; Pub. L. 108-271, Sec. 8(b), July 7, 2004,
118 Stat. 814; Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(4), Oct. 30, 2004, 118
Stat. 2231; Pub. L. 109-8, title IX, Secs. 901(a)(1), (b)(1),
(c)(1), (d)(1), (e)(1), (f)(1), (g)(1), (h)(1), (i)(1), 902(a),
903(a), 904(a), 905(a), 908(a), Apr. 20, 2005, 119 Stat. 146, 147,
149, 151, 152, 155, 157-160, 165, 166, 183; Pub. L. 109-171, title
II, Secs. 2102(b), 2103(a)-(c), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9, 11; Pub.
L. 109-173, Secs. 2(a), (c)(1), 8(a)(11)-(14), Feb. 15, 2006, 119
Stat. 3601, 3602, 3611, 3612; Pub. L. 109-351, title VII, Secs.
701(b), 718(a), 721(a), 722(a), 724, Oct. 13, 2006, 120 Stat. 1985,
1997-1999, 2001; Pub. L. 109-390, Secs. 2(a)(1), (b)(1), (c)(1),
3(a), 6(a), Dec. 12, 2006, 120 Stat. 2692-2694, 2698; Pub. L. 110-
289, div. A, title I, Sec. 1161(i), title VI, Sec. 1604(a), (c),
(d), July 30, 2008, 122 Stat. 2781, 2826, 2829; Pub. L. 111-203,
title III, Secs. 335(a), 343(a)(1), (3), 363(5), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1540, 1544, 1552; Pub. L. 111-343, Sec. 1(a), Dec. 29, 2010,
124 Stat. 3609.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SECTION
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(5), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1552, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
this section is amended:
(1) in subsection (c) -
(A) in paragraph (2)(A)(ii), by striking out "(other than section
1441a of this title)";
(B) in paragraph (4), by substituting "Notwithstanding" for
"Except as otherwise provided in section 1441a of this title and
notwithstanding";
(C) in paragraph (6) -
(i) in the heading, by substituting "Comptroller of the Currency"
for "Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision";
(ii) in subparagraph (A) -
(I) by striking out "or the Resolution Trust Corporation"; and
(II) by substituting "Comptroller of the Currency" for "Director
of the Office of Thrift Supervision"; and
(iii) by amending subparagraph (B) to read as follows:
"(B) Receiver
"The Corporation may, at the discretion of the Comptroller of
the Currency, be appointed receiver and the Corporation may
accept any such appointment."; and

(D) in paragraph (12)(A), by striking out "or the Resolution
Trust Corporation";
(2) in subsection (d), in paragraphs (17)(A) and (18)(B), by
striking out "or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision";
(3) in subsection (m) -
(A) in paragraph (9), by striking out "or the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate"; and
(B) in paragraphs (16) and (18), by striking out "or the Director
of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate" wherever
appearing;
(4) in subsection (n) -
(A) in paragraph (1)(A), by substituting "or" for ", or the
Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, with respect to" and
"applicable," for "applicable,,";
(B) in paragraph (2)(A), by striking out "or the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision";
(C) in paragraph (4), in subparagraphs (D) and (G), by striking
out "and the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as
appropriate,"; and
(D) in paragraph (12)(B), by inserting "as" after "shall appoint
the Corporation" and striking out "or the Director of the Office of
Thrift Supervision, as appropriate," wherever appearing;
(5) in subsection (p) -
(i) in paragraph (2)(B), by substituting "or the Corporation,"
for "the Corporation, the FSLIC Resolution Fund, or the Resolution
Trust Corporation,"; and
(ii) in paragraph (3)(B), by striking out ", the FSLIC Resolution
Fund, the Resolution Trust Corporation,"; and
(6) in subsection (r), by striking out "and the Resolution Trust
Corporation".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 343(a)(3), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1544, provided that, effective Jan. 1, 2013, subsection
(a)(1) of this section is amended:
(1) in subparagraph (B) -
(A) by substituting "deposit. -
"The net amount"

for "deposit. - " and all that follows through "clause (ii), the
net amount"; and
(B) by striking out clauses (ii) and (iii); and
(2) in subparagraph (C), by substituting "subparagraph (B)" for
"subparagraph (B)(i)".
See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
Section 1441a(b)(4) of this title, referred to in subsec.
(d)(2)(I)(ii), was in the original "section 21A(b)(4)", which has
been translated as reading "section 21A(b)(4) of the Federal Home
Loan Bank Act", to reflect the probable intent of Congress.
Section 1823(e)(2) of this title, referred to in subsec.
(d)(9)(B), was redesignated section 1823(e)(1)(B) of this title by
Pub. L. 103-325, title III, Sec. 317(1), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat.
2223.
The Federal Rules of Civil Procedure, referred to in subsec.
(d)(18), (19), are set out in the Appendix to Title 28, Judiciary
and Judicial Procedure.
The Securities Exchange Act of 1934, referred to in subsec.
(e)(8)(D)(v)(I), is act June 6, 1934, ch. 404, 48 Stat. 881, as
amended, which is classified principally to chapter 2B (Sec. 78a et
seq.) of Title 15, Commerce and Trade. For complete classification
of this Act to the Code, see section 78a of Title 15 and Tables.
The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, referred to in subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi),
(17), is Pub. L. 106-102, Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat. 1338, as
amended. For complete classification of this Act to the Code, see
Short Title of 1999 Amendment note set out under section 1811 of
this title and Tables.
The Legal Certainty for Bank Products Act of 2000, referred to in
subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi), (17), is title IV of H.R. 5660, as enacted
by Pub. L. 106-554, Sec. 1(a)(5), Dec. 21, 2000, 114 Stat. 2763,
2763A-457, which is classified to sections 27 to 27f of Title 7,
Agriculture. For complete classification of this Act to the Code,
see Short Title of 2000 Amendment note set out under section 1 of
Title 7 and Tables.
The Commodity Exchange Act, referred to in subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi),
(17), is act Sept. 21, 1922, ch. 369, 42 Stat. 998, as amended,
which is classified generally to chapter 1 (Sec. 1 et seq.) of
Title 7, Agriculture. For complete classification of this Act to
the Code, see section 1 of Title 7 and Tables.
The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of
1991, referred to in subsec. (e)(13)(C)(ii), is Pub. L. 102-242,
Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2236, as amended. Subtitle A of title IV
of the Act is classified generally to subchapter I (Sec. 4401 et
seq.) of chapter 45 of this title. For complete classification of
this Act to the Code, see Short Title of 1991 Amendment note set
out under section 1811 of this title and Tables.
Section 1008 of title 18, referred to in subsec. (p)(2)(A), was
repealed by Pub. L. 101-73, title IX, Sec. 961(g)(1), Aug. 9, 1989,
103 Stat. 500.

-COD-
CODIFICATION
Amendments to subsec. (m) of this section by section
1604(a)(4)(J)(ii) of Pub. L. 110-289 were executed before
amendments by section 1604(a)(4)(E) of Pub. L. 110-289, to reflect
the probable intent of Congress.
Amendments to subsec. (n) of this section by section
1604(a)(5)(I) of Pub. L. 110-289 were executed before amendments by
section 1604(a)(5)(E) and (G) of Pub. L. 110-289, to reflect the
probable intent of Congress.
Amendments to subsec. (n) of this section by section
1604(a)(5)(O)(iv) and (P)(ii) of Pub. L. 110-289 were executed
before amendments by section 1604(a)(5)(D) of Pub. L. 110-289, to
reflect the probable intent of Congress.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (l) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (a)(1)(B). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 343(a)(1)(A),
designated existing provisions as cl. (i), inserted heading,
substituted "Subject to clause (ii), the net amount" for "The net
amount", and added cls. (ii) and (iii).
Subsec. (a)(1)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 111-343 substituted "means - "
for "means a deposit" in introductory provisions, inserted "(I) a
deposit" before "or account maintained", redesignated former
subcls. (I) to (III) as items (aa) to (cc) of subcl. (I), and added
subcl. (II).
Subsec. (a)(1)(C). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 343(a)(1)(B),
substituted "subparagraph (B)(i)" for "subparagraph (B)".
Subsec. (a)(1)(E). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 335(a), substituted
"$250,000," for "$100,000," and inserted at the end
"Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the increase in the
standard maximum deposit insurance amount to $250,000 shall apply
to depositors in any institution for which the Corporation was
appointed as receiver or conservator on or after January 1, 2008,
and before October 3, 2008. The Corporation shall take such actions
as are necessary to carry out the requirements of this section with
respect to such depositors, without regard to any time limitations
under this chapter. In implementing this and the preceding 2
sentences, any payment on a deposit claim made by the Corporation
as receiver or conservator to a depositor above the standard
maximum deposit insurance amount in effect at the time of the
appointment of the Corporation as receiver or conservator shall be
deemed to be part of the net amount due to the depositor under
subparagraph (B)."
2008 - Subsec. (d)(2)(F). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(1)(A),
substituted "as receiver, with respect to any insured depository
institution, organize a new depository institution under subsection
(m) or a bridge depository institution under subsection (n)." for
"as receiver -
"(i) with respect to savings associations and by application to
the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, organize a new
Federal savings association to take over such assets or such
liabilities as the Corporation may determine to be appropriate;
and
"(ii) with respect to any insured bank, organize a new national
bank under subsection (m) of this section or a bridge bank under
subsection (n) of this section."
Subsec. (d)(2)(G)(ii). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(1)(B),
substituted "new depository institution or a bridge depository
institution" for "new bank or a bridge bank".
Subsec. (e)(10)(C). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(2), substituted
"bridge depository institutions" for "bridge banks" in heading.
Subsec. (e)(10)(C)(i). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(3),
substituted "bridge depository institution" for "bridge bank".
Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(A)-(E), substituted
"depository institutions" for "banks" in heading, "the insured
depository institution in default to" for "the bank in default to"
in par. (1), "the insured depository institution in default, and"
for "the bank in default, and" in par. (11), "insured depository
institution" for "insured bank" wherever appearing in pars. (1),
(11)(A), (13), and (15)(B), and "new depository institution" for
"new bank" and "such depository institution" for "such bank"
wherever appearing in text. See Codification note above.
Subsec. (m)(1). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(F), inserted "or
Federal savings association" after "national bank".
Subsec. (m)(6). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(G), substituted
"only depository institution" for "only bank".
Subsec. (m)(9). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(H), inserted "or
the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate"
after "Comptroller of the Currency".
Subsec. (m)(15)(A). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(I), struck
out ", but in no event less than that required by section 51 of
this title for the organization of a national bank in the place
where such new bank is located" before period at end.
Subsec. (m)(16). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(j)(iii)-(v),
inserted "or Federal savings association" after "national bank"
wherever appearing and "or Federal savings associations" after
"national banks" and substituted "Such depository institution" for
"Such bank".
Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(J)(ii), substituted "the
depository institution" for "the bank" in two places. See
Codification note above.
Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(J)(i), inserted "or the Director
of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate," after
"Comptroller of the Currency" in two places.
Subsec. (m)(18). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(4)(K), inserted
"or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as
appropriate," after "Comptroller of the Currency" in two places.
Subsec. (n). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(A)-(I), in heading
substituted "depository institutions" for "banks" and in text
substituted, wherever appearing, "bridge depository institution"
for "bridge bank", "bridge depository institutions" for "bridge
banks" except in par. (1)(A), "bridge depository institution's" for
"bridge bank's", "insured depository institution" for "insured
bank" in pars. (2), (3), (4)(I), (7), and (8)(B), "insured
depository institutions" for "insured banks", "such depository
institution" for "such bank" except in par. (4)(J), "the depository
institution" for "the bank", and "depository institution or
institutions" for "bank or banks". See Codification note above.
Subsec. (n)(1)(A). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(J), inserted
", with respect to 1 or more insured banks, or the Director of the
Office of Thrift Supervision, with respect to 1 or more insured
savings associations," after "Comptroller of the Currency", "or
Federal savings associations, as appropriate," after "national
banks", and "or Federal savings associations, as applicable," after
"banking associations", and substituted "as 'bridge depository
institutions' " for "as bridge banks".
Subsec. (n)(1)(B)(i). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(c), struck out
", except that if any insured deposits are assumed, all insured
deposits shall be assumed by the bridge bank or another insured
depository institution" before semicolon at end.
Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(K), struck out "of a bank" after
"any insured deposits" and "of that bank" after "all insured
deposits".
Subsec. (n)(1)(E). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(L), (M),
inserted "or Federal savings association" after "National bank" in
heading and ", in the case of 1 or more insured banks, and as a
Federal savings association, in the case of 1 or more insured
savings associations" after "national bank" in text.
Subsec. (n)(2)(A). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(N)(i), (ii),
inserted "or Federal savings association" after "national bank" and
"or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision" after
"Comptroller of the Currency" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (n)(2)(B). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(N)(i), (iii),
inserted "or Federal savings association" after "national bank" in
heading and introductory provisions.
Subsec. (n)(4). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(i), inserted
"or Federal savings association, as appropriate" after "national
bank" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (n)(4)(C). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(ii),
substituted "under any" for "under section 51 of this title or any
other".
Subsec. (n)(4)(D). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(iv),
substituted "depository institution's" for "bank's". See
Codification note above.
Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(iii), inserted "and the
Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as appropriate,"
after "Comptroller of the Currency".
Subsec. (n)(4)(G). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(iii),
inserted "and the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as
appropriate," after "Comptroller of the Currency".
Subsec. (n)(4)(H). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(O)(v),
substituted "a depository institution in default" for "a bank in
default".
Subsec. (n)(5)(D). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(d), added subpar.
(D).
Subsec. (n)(8)(A). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(P)(i),
substituted "the depository institutions" for "the banks".
Subsec. (n)(8)(B). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(P)(ii),
substituted "depository institution's" for "bank's". See
Codification note above.
Subsec. (n)(9), (10). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(Q),
substituted "bridge depository institution" for "bridge bank" in
heading.
Subsec. (n)(11)(A) to (C). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(R),
inserted "or a Federal savings association, as the case may be,"
after "national bank".
Subsec. (n)(12). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(Q), substituted
"bridge depository institution" for "bridge bank" in heading.
Subsec. (n)(12)(B). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(S), inserted
"or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision, as
appropriate," after "Comptroller of the Currency" in two places and
"or Federal savings associations, as appropriate" after "national
banks".
Subsec. (n)(13). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1604(a)(5)(Q), (T),
substituted "bridge depository institutions" for "bridge banks" in
heading and "single depository institution" for "single bank" in
text.
Subsec. (t)(2)(A)(vii). Pub. L. 110-289, Sec. 1161(i), added cl.
(vii).
2006 - Subsec. (a)(1)(B). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2103(a)(1), added
subpar. (B) and struck out heading and text of former subpar. (B).
Text read as follows: "The net amount due to any depositor at an
insured depository institution shall not exceed $100,000 as
determined in accordance with subparagraphs (C) and (D)."
Subsec. (a)(1)(D). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2103(b), amended heading
and text of subpar. (D) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (D)
provided that for the purpose of determining the amount of
insurance due under subpar. (B), the Corporation was to provide
deposit insurance coverage with respect to deposits accepted by any
insured depository institution on a pro rata or "pass-through"
basis to a participant in or beneficiary of an employee benefit
plan, including any eligible deferred compensation plan described
in section 457 of title 26.
Subsec. (a)(1)(E), (F). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2103(a)(2), added
subpars. (E) and (F).
Subsec. (a)(2). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 2(a), inserted par. (2)
heading and substituted subpar. (A) and heading and introductory
provisions of subpar. (B) for introductory provisions of former
subpar. (A) which related to exception to limitation relating to
the amount of deposit insurance available for the account of any
one depositor, struck out concluding provisions of former subpar.
(A) which related to the status of certain depositors under former
provisions, redesignated former subpar. (B) as (C), inserted
heading, and substituted "government depositor" for "depositor
referred to in subparagraph (A) of this paragraph" in two places.
Subsec. (a)(3)(A). Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2103(c), in concluding
provisions substituted "$250,000 (which amount shall be subject to
inflation adjustments as provided in paragraph (1)(F), except that
$250,000 shall be substituted for $100,000 wherever such term
appears in such paragraph)" for "$100,000".
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(B), added par. (4)
and struck out former par. (4) which set out general provisions
relating to the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings Association
Insurance Fund.
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(1)-(3). See 1996 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (a)(5) to (8). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(C), (D),
redesignated par. (8) as (5) and struck out former pars. (5) to
(7), which related to the establishment and operations of the Bank
Insurance Fund and Savings Association Insurance Fund and
provisions applicable to maintenance of accounts.
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(6)(C). See 1996 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (c)(5)(H)(iii). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(A),
substituted "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund".
Subsec. (c)(7). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 701(b), reenacted heading
without change and amended text generally. Prior to amendment, text
read as follows: "If the Corporation appoints itself as conservator
or receiver under paragraph (4), the insured State depository
institution may, within 30 days thereafter, bring an action in the
United States district court for the judicial district in which the
home office of such institution is located, or in the United States
District Court for the District of Columbia, for an order requiring
the Corporation to remove itself as such conservator or receiver,
and the court shall, upon the merits, dismiss such action or direct
the Corporation to remove itself as such conservator or receiver."
Subsec. (c)(10). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(A), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund" in heading
and cls. (i) and (ii) of subpar. (B).
Subsec. (d)(15)(D). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 722(a), designated
existing provisions as cl. (i), inserted heading, substituted
"Except as provided in clause (ii), after the end of the 6-year
period" for "After the end of the 6-year period", and added cl.
(ii).
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii)(I). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(a)(1)(A),
substituted "a mortgage loan," for "a mortgage loan, or" after
"certificate of deposit," and inserted before semicolon at end
"(whether or not such repurchase or reverse repurchase transaction
is a 'repurchase agreement', as defined in clause (v))".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii)(IV). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(a)(1)(B),
inserted "(including by novation)" after "the guarantee" and
"(whether or not such settlement is in connection with any
agreement or transaction referred to in subclauses (I) through
(XII) (other than subclause (II))" before semicolon at end.
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii)(VI) to (VIII). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec.
2(a)(1)(D), (E), added subcls. (VI) and (VII) and redesignated
former subcl. (VI) as (VIII). Former subcls. (VII) and (VIII)
redesignated (IX) and (X), respectively.
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii)(IX). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(a)(1)(D),
redesignated subcl. (VII) as (IX). Former subcl. (IX) redesignated
(XI).
Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(a)(1)(C), substituted "(VIII), (IX), or
(X)" for "or (VIII)" in two places.
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii)(X) to (XII). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec.
2(a)(1)(D), redesignated subcls. (VIII) to (X) as (X) to (XII),
respectively.
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(iv)(I). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(b)(1),
substituted "or reverse repurchase transaction (whether or not such
repurchase or reverse repurchase transaction is a 'repurchase
agreement', as defined in clause (v))" for "transaction, reverse
repurchase transaction".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(c)(1)(C),
substituted in concluding provisions "the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act,
the Legal Certainty for Bank Products Act of 2000, the securities
laws (as such term is defined in section 3(a)(47) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934) and the Commodity Exchange Act" for "the
Securities Act of 1933, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the
Public Utility Holding Company Act of 1935, the Trust Indenture Act
of 1939, the Investment Company Act of 1940, the Investment
Advisers Act of 1940, the Securities Investor Protection Act of
1970, the Commodity Exchange Act, the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, and
the Legal Certainty for Bank Products Act of 2000".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi)(I). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(c)(1)(A),
substituted ", precious metals, or other commodity" for "or
precious metals" and "weather swap, option, future, or forward
agreement; an emissions swap, option, future, or forward agreement;
or an inflation swap, option, future, or forward agreement" for "or
a weather swap, weather derivative, or weather option".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi)(II). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 2(c)(1)(B),
inserted "or other derivatives" after "dealings in the swap" and
substituted "future, option, or spot transaction" for "future, or
option".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ix). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 3(a), added cl.
(ix).
Subsec. (e)(8)(G)(ii), (iii). Pub. L. 109-390, Sec. 6(a), added
cls. (ii) and (iii) and struck out former cl. (ii) which defined
walkaway clause.
Subsec. (e)(13)(C). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 718(a), added subpar.
(C).
Subsec. (e)(15)(B)(i). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(A),
substituted "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund".
Subsec. (f)(1). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(12), substituted
period at end for ", except that -
"(A) all payments made pursuant to this section on account of a
closed Bank Insurance Fund member shall be made only from the
Bank Insurance Fund, and
"(B) all payments made pursuant to this section on account of a
closed Savings Association Insurance Fund member shall be made
only from the Savings Association Insurance Fund."
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(H). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (f)(3) to (5). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 721(a), added pars.
(3) to (5) and struck out former pars. (3) to (5) which related to
resolution of disputes, review of Corporation's determination, and
statute of limitations, respectively.
Subsec. (i)(3)(B), (C). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(13),
redesignated subpar. (C) as (B), substituted "subparagraph (A)" for
"subparagraphs (A) and (B)", and struck out heading and text of
former subpar. (B). Text read as follows: "If the depository
institution in default is a Bank Insurance Fund member, the
Corporation may only make such payments out of funds held in the
Bank Insurance Fund. If the depository institution in default is a
Savings Association Insurance Fund member, the Corporation may only
make such payments out of funds held in the Savings Association
Insurance Fund."
Pub. L. 109-171, Sec. 2102(b), repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(I). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (m)(6). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 2(c)(1), substituted "an
amount equal to the standard maximum deposit insurance amount" for
"$100,000".
Subsec. (p)(2)(B). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(11)(A), (14),
substituted "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "any deposit insurance
fund".
Subsec. (t)(1). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 724(1), inserted ", in any
capacity," after "A covered agency" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (t)(2)(A)(i). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 724(2)(A), struck out
"appropriate" before "Federal banking agency".
Subsec. (t)(2)(A)(ii) to (vi). Pub. L. 109-351, Sec. 724(2)(B),
(C), redesignated cls. (iii) to (vi) as (ii) to (v), respectively,
and struck out former cl. (ii) which read as follows: "The
Resolution Trust Corporation."
2005 - Subsec. (e)(8)(A). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(h)(1)(A),
substituted "paragraphs (9) and (10)" for "paragraph (10)" in
introductory provisions and "such person has to cause the
termination, liquidation, or acceleration" for "to cause the
termination or liquidation" in cl. (i), added cl. (ii), and struck
out former cl. (ii) which read as follows: "any right under any
security arrangement relating to any contract or agreement
described in clause (i); or".
Subsec. (e)(8)(C)(i). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(i)(1), inserted
"section 91 of this title or any other Federal or State law
relating to the avoidance of preferential or fraudulent transfers,"
before "the Corporation".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(a)(1)(A), substituted
"subsection, the following definitions shall apply:" for
"subsection - " in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(i). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(a)(1)(B), inserted
", resolution, or order" after "any similar agreement that the
Corporation determines by regulation".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(ii). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(b)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'securities contract' -
"(I) has the meaning given to such term in section 741 of title
11, except that the term 'security' (as used in such section)
shall be deemed to include any mortgage loan, any mortgage-
related security (as defined in section 78c(a)(41) of title 15),
and any interest in any mortgage loan or mortgage-related
security; and
"(II) does not include any participation in a commercial
mortgage loan unless the Corporation determines by regulation,
resolution, or order to include any such participation within the
meaning of such term."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(iii). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(c)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'commodity contract' has
the meaning given to such term in section 761 of title 11."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(iv). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(d)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'forward contract' has
the meaning given to such term in section 101 of title 11."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(v). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(e)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'repurchase agreement' -

"(I) has the meaning given to such term in section 101 of title
11, except that the items (as described in such section) which
may be subject to any such agreement shall be deemed to include
mortgage-related securities (as such term is defined in section
78c(a)(41) of title 15), any mortgage loan, and any interest in
any mortgage loan; and
"(II) does not include any participation in a commercial
mortgage loan unless the Corporation determines by regulation,
resolution, or order to include any such participation within the
meaning of such term."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vi). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(f)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'swap agreement' -
"(I) means any agreement, including the terms and conditions
incorporated by reference in any such agreement, which is a rate
swap agreement, basis swap, commodity swap, forward rate
agreement, interest rate future, interest rate option purchased,
forward foreign exchange agreement, rate cap agreement, rate
floor agreement, rate collar agreement, currency swap agreement,
cross-currency rate swap agreement, currency future, or currency
option purchased or any other similar agreement, and
"(II) includes any combination of such agreements and any
option to enter into any such agreement."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(vii). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 905(a), amended
heading and text of cl. (vii) generally. Prior to amendment, text
read as follows: "Any master agreement for any agreements described
in clause (vi)(I) together with all supplements to such master
agreement shall be treated as 1 swap agreement."
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(viii). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(g)(1), reenacted
heading without change and amended text generally. Prior to
amendment, text read as follows: "The term 'transfer' has the
meaning given to such term in section 101 of title 11."
Subsec. (e)(8)(E). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 902(a)(1)(A), substituted
"other than subsections (d)(9) and (e)(10)" for "other than
paragraph (12) of this subsection, subsection (d)(9)" in
introductory provisions.
Subsec. (e)(8)(E)(ii). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 901(h)(1)(B), added
cl. (ii) and struck out former cl. (ii) which read as follows: "any
right under any security arrangement relating to such qualified
financial contracts; or".
Subsec. (e)(8)(F), (G). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 902(a)(1)(B), added
subpars. (F) and (G).
Subsec. (e)(8)(H). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 908(a), added subpar. (H).
Subsec. (e)(9). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 903(a)(1), reenacted heading
without change and amended text generally. Prior to amendment, text
related to transfer of qualified financial contracts, claims, and
property of a depository institution in default.
Subsec. (e)(10)(A). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 903(a)(2), substituted
concluding provisions for former concluding provisions which read
as follows: "the conservator or receiver shall use such
conservator's or receiver's best efforts to notify any person who
is a party to any such contract of such transfer by 12:00, noon
(local time) on the business day following such transfer."
Subsec. (e)(10)(B) to (D). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 903(a)(3), added
subpars. (B) and (C) and redesignated former subpar. (B) as (D).
Subsec. (e)(11). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 904(a)(2), added par. (11).
Former par. (11) redesignated (12).
Subsec. (e)(12). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 904(a)(1), redesignated par.
(11) as (12). Former par. (12) redesignated (13).
Subsec. (e)(12)(A). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 902(a)(2), inserted "or
the exercise of rights or powers by" after "the appointment of".
Subsec. (e)(13) to (16). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 904(a)(1),
redesignated pars. (12) to (15) as (13) to (16), respectively.
Subsec. (e)(17). Pub. L. 109-8, Sec. 904(a)(3), added par. (17).
2004 - Subsec. (c)(2)(A)(i). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(4)(A),
struck out "or District bank" after "Federal depository
institution".
Subsec. (c)(2)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(4)(B), struck
out "or District bank" after "Federal depository institution" and
"or the code of law for the District of Columbia" before period at
end.
Subsec. (c)(3)(A). Pub. L. 108-386, Sec. 8(a)(4)(C), struck out
"(other than a District depository institution)" after "State
depository institution".
Subsec. (t)(2)(A)(vi). Pub. L. 108-271 substituted "Government
Accountability Office" for "General Accounting Office".
2000 - Subsec. (d)(10)(C). Pub. L. 106-569 added subpar. (C).
Subsecs. (v), (w)(1)(B)(ii). Pub. L. 106-400 made technical
amendment to references in original act which appear in text as
references to section 11302 of title 42.
1999 - Subsec. (a)(4)(B). Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 117, substituted
"to benefit any shareholder or affiliate (other than an insured
depository institution that receives assistance in accordance with
the provisions of this chapter) of" for "to benefit any shareholder
of" in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2), amended Pub. L.
104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(4), (6)(C). See 1996 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (a)(6). Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2)(B), amended Pub.
L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(C)(i). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (a)(6)(L). Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(a), struck out
heading and text of subpar. (L). Text read as follows:
"(i) Establishment. - If, on January 1, 1999, the reserve ratio
of the Savings Association Insurance Fund exceeds the designated
reserve ratio, there is established a Special Reserve of the
Savings Association Insurance Fund, which shall be administered by
the Corporation and shall be invested in accordance with section
1823(a) of this title.
"(ii) Amounts in special reserve. - If, on January 1, 1999, the
reserve ratio of the Savings Association Insurance Fund exceeds the
designated reserve ratio, the amount by which the reserve ratio
exceeds the designated reserve ratio shall be placed in the Special
Reserve of the Savings Association Insurance Fund established by
clause (i).
"(iii) Limitation. - The Corporation shall not provide any
assessment credit, refund, or other payment from any amount in the
Special Reserve of the Savings Association Insurance Fund.
"(iv) Emergency use of special reserve. - Notwithstanding clause
(iii), the Corporation may, in its sole discretion, transfer
amounts from the Special Reserve of the Savings Association
Insurance Fund to the Savings Association Insurance Fund for the
purposes set forth in paragraph (4), only if -
"(I) the reserve ratio of the Savings Association Insurance
Fund is less than 50 percent of the designated reserve ratio; and
"(II) the Corporation expects the reserve ratio of the Savings
Association Insurance Fund to remain at less than 50 percent of
the designated reserve ratio for each of the next 4 calendar
quarters.
"(v) Exclusion of special reserve in calculating reserve ratio. -
Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any amounts in the
Special Reserve of the Savings Association Insurance Fund shall be
excluded in calculating the reserve ratio of the Savings
Association Insurance Fund."
Subsec. (a)(7), (8). Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2)(B), (C),
amended Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(C). See 1996 Amendment
notes below.
1996 - Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(1)(C), which
directed substitution of "Establishment of the Deposit Insurance
Fund" for "General provisions relating to funds" in heading, was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (a)(4)(A) to (C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(1)(A),
(B), (2), which directed striking out subpar. (A), redesignating
subpar. (B) as (C) and substituting "Deposit Insurance Fund" for
"Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund" in
introductory provisions, and adding new subpars. (A) and (B), was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (a)(4)(D). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(3), which
directed adding subpar. (D), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See
Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note
above.
Subsec. (a)(5). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(C), as amended
by Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2)(B), (C), which directed striking
out par. (5) and redesignating par. (8) as (5), was repealed by
Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below
and 2006 Amendment note above.
Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(4), which directed general
amendment of par. (5), was repealed by Pub. L. 106-102, Sec.
736(b)(2)(A).
Subsec. (a)(6). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(C)(i), as
amended by Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2)(B), which directed
striking out par. (6), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See
Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note
above.
Subsec. (a)(6)(L). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2705, added subpar. (L).
Subsec. (a)(7), (8). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(6)(C), as
amended by Pub. L. 106-102, Sec. 736(b)(2)(B), (C), which directed
striking out par. (7) and redesignating par. (8) as (5), was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (d)(20). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2602, added par. (20).
Subsec. (f)(1). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(H), which
directed substitution of a period for ", except that - " and
subpars. (A) and (B), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See
Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note
above.
Subsec. (i)(3)(B), (C). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(I),
which directed striking out subpar. (B) and redesignating subpar.
(C) as (B) and substituting "subparagraph (A)" for "subparagraphs
(A) and (B)", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date
of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (t)(2)(A)(vi). Pub. L. 104-316 added cl. (vi).
1994 - Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(21),
substituted "provisions" for "Provisions" in heading.
Subsec. (c)(5)(M). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 411(c)(2)(A),
substituted "section 5322 or 5324 of title 31" for "section 5322 of
title 31".
Subsec. (d)(2)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(22),
substituted "are consistent" for "is consistent".
Subsec. (d)(8)(B)(ii). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(23), inserted
"provide" before "a statement".
Subsec. (d)(14)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(24), substituted
"statute of limitations" for "statute of limitation".
Subsec. (d)(14)(C). Pub. L. 103-328 added subpar. (C).
Subsec. (d)(16)(B)(iv). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(25),
substituted "disposition" for "dispositions".
Subsec. (e)(8)(D). Pub. L. 103-394 substituted "section 741" for
"section 741(7)" in cl. (ii)(I), "section 761" for "section 761(4)"
in cl. (iii), "section 101" for "section 101(24)" in cl. (iv),
"section 101" for "section 101(41)" in cl. (v)(I), and "section
101" for "section 101(50)" in cl. (viii).
Subsec. (e)(8)(D)(v)(I). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(26),
substituted "title 15)," for "title 15,".
Subsec. (e)(12)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(27), substituted
"director's or officer's" for "directors or officers".
Subsec. (e)(14), (15). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 325, added pars.
(14) and (15).
Subsec. (f)(3)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(28), substituted
"with" for "to" in heading.
Subsec. (i)(3)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(29), substituted
"other claimant or category of claimants" for "other claimant or
category or claimants" in second sentence.
Subsec. (n)(4)(E)(i). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(30), inserted
"and" at end.
Subsec. (n)(12)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(31), substituted
"subparagraph" for "subparagraphs".
Subsec. (q)(1). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(32), substituted
"held" for "decided" in second sentence.
Subsec. (u)(3)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(33), substituted
"section 1831q(p) of this title" for "subsection (c)(9)".
1993 - Subsec. (a)(1)(C). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 38(b),
substituted "paragraph (1) or (2) of section 1817(i) of this title
or any funds described in section 1817(i)(3) of this title" for
"section 1817(i)(1) of this title".
Subsec. (a)(4). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 11, substituted
"Provisions" for "provision" in heading, and amended text
generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "The Bank
Insurance Fund established under paragraph (5) and the Savings
Association Insurance Fund established under paragraph (6) shall
each be -
"(A) maintained and administered by the Corporation;
"(B) maintained separately and not commingled; and
"(C) used by the Corporation to carry out its insurance
purposes in the manner provided in this subsection."
Subsec. (a)(6)(D) to (F). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(a)-(c), amended
subpars. (D) to (F) generally. Prior to amendment, subpars. (D) to
(F) related to the availability of funds for administrative
expenses, Treasury payments to the Fund, and Treasury payments to
maintain the net worth of the Fund, respectively.
Subsec. (a)(6)(G). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(i), substituted
"subparagraph (D)" for "subparagraphs (E) and (F)" in heading and
text.
Subsec. (a)(6)(H). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(d), amended subpar.
(H) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (H) read as follows:
"Discretionary rtc payments. - If amounts available to the Savings
Association Insurance Fund for purposes other than the payment of
administrative expenses are insufficient for the Savings
Association Insurance Fund to carry out the purposes of this
chapter, the Corporation may request the Resolution Trust
Corporation to provide, and the Thrift Depositor Protection
Oversight Board of the Resolution Trust Corporation (in the
discretion of the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board) may
pay, such amount as may be needed for such purposes."
Subsec. (a)(6)(J). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(e), substituted
"Subject to subparagraph (E), there are" for "There are" and "of
subparagraph (D) for fiscal years 1994 through 1998, except that
the aggregate amount appropriated pursuant to this authorization
may not exceed $8,000,000,000." for "of this paragraph, except that
-
"(i) the annual amount appropriated under subparagraph (F)
shall not exceed $2,000,000,000 in either fiscal year 1992 or
fiscal year 1993; and
"(ii) the cumulative amount appropriated under subparagraph (F)
for fiscal years 1992 through 2000 shall not exceed
$16,000,000,000."
Subsec. (a)(6)(K). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 8(f), added subpar. (K).
Subsec. (c)(6)(B)(i). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 27(b)(1), substituted
"such date as is determined by the Chairperson of the Thrift
Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title" for "October 1, 1993".
Subsec. (c)(6)(B)(ii). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 27(b)(2), (3),
substituted "on or after the date determined by the Chairperson of
the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title" for "after September 30, 1993"
and "before such date" for "on or before such date".
Subsec. (c)(6)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 27(b)(2),
substituted "on or after the date determined by the Chairperson of
the Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board under section
1441a(b)(3)(A)(ii) of this title" for "after September 30, 1993".
Subsec. (c)(13). Pub. L. 103-66, Sec. 3001(b)(1), in subpar. (A)
struck out "subject to subparagraph (B)," before "this section
shall" and inserted "and" at end, redesignated subpar. (C) as (B),
and struck out former subpar. (B) which read as follows: "the
Corporation shall apply the law of the State in which the
institution is chartered insofar as that law gives the claims of
depositors priority over those of other creditors or claimants;
and".
Subsec. (d)(2)(K). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 3(d), inserted "legal,"
after "auction marketing," and substituted "only if" for "if" and
"the most practicable" for "practicable".
Subsec. (d)(11). Pub. L. 103-66, Sec. 3001(a), amended par. (11)
generally, substituting present provisions for former provisions
relating to distribution of assets, which consisted of a subpar.
(A) relating to subrogated claims and claims of uninsured
depositors and other creditors and a subpar. (B) relating to
distribution to shareholders of amounts remaining after payment of
all other claims and expenses.
Subsec. (d)(14)(A)(ii). Pub. L. 103-204, 4(b), inserted "(other
than a claim which is subject to section 1441a(b)(14) of this
title)" after "any tort claim".
Subsec. (g)(4). Pub. L. 103-66, Sec. 3001(b)(2), substituted
"Subject to subsection (d)(11) of this section, if" for "If".
Subsec. (p). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 20, in heading, substituted
"Certain sales of assets prohibited" for "Certain convicted debtors
prohibited from purchasing assets", added par. (1), redesignated
former pars. (1) and (2) as pars. (2) and (3), respectively, in
par. (2) substituted "paragraph (3)" for "paragraph (2)" and
"person" for "individual", in par. (3) substituted "Paragraphs (1)
and (2)" for "Paragraph (1)" and "person" for "individual",
wherever appearing, and added par. (4).
Subsec. (u). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 15(b), added subsec. (u).
Subsec. (v). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 16(b), added subsec. (v).
Subsec. (w). Pub. L. 103-204, Sec. 17(b), added subsec. (w).
1992 - Subsec. (c)(5)(M). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1501(a), added
subpar. (M).
Subsec. (c)(6)(B). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1611(b)(2), substituted
"subparagraph (A) or (C) of section 1464(d)(2) of this title" for
"subparagraph (C) or (F) of section 1464(d)(2) of this title".
Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1611(b)(1), substituted "subparagraph (C)
or (F) of section 1464(d)(2) of this title" for "section
1464(d)(2)(C) of this title".
Subsec. (d)(2)(B), (E). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1604(c)(2), made
technical amendment to reference to section 1831q of this title to
reflect change in reference to corresponding section of original
act.
Subsec. (d)(4)(A). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1606(c), substituted
"determination" for "determinations" after "administrative".
Subsec. (d)(5)(D)(iii)(I). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1603(e)(1),
substituted "insured depository institution" for "institution
described in paragraph (3)(A)".
Subsec. (t). Pub. L. 102-550, Sec. 1544, added subsec. (t).
1991 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(1), added
par. (1) and struck out former par. (1) which read as follows: "The
Corporation shall insure the deposits of all insured depository
institutions as provided in this chapter. The maximum amount of the
insured deposit of any depositor shall be $100,000."
Subsec. (a)(2)(A). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(5)(B), in closing
provisions, substituted "such depositor shall, for the purpose of
determining the amount of insured deposits under this subsection,
be deemed a depositor in such custodial capacity separate and
distinct from any other officer, employee, or agent of the United
States or any public unit referred to in clause (ii), (iii), (iv),
or (v) and the deposit of any such depositor shall be insured in an
amount not to exceed $100,000 per account" for "his deposit shall
be insured" before "in an amount not to exceed $100,000 per
account."
Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(5)(C),
substituted "(B)" for "(b)" as subpar. designation.
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(b)(2), amended par. (3)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (3) read as follows:
"Notwithstanding any limitation in this chapter or in any other
provision of law relating to the amount of deposit insurance
available for the account of any one depositor, time and savings
deposits in an insured depository institution made pursuant to a
pension or profit-sharing plan described in section 401(d) of title
26, or made in the form of individual retirement accounts as
described in section 408(a) of title 26, shall be insured in the
amount of $100,000 per account. As to any plan qualifying under
section 401(d) or section 408(a) of title 26, the term 'per
account' means the present vested and ascertainable interest of
each beneficiary under the plan, excluding any remainder interest
created by, or as a result of, the plan."
Subsec. (a)(6)(E). Pub. L. 102-233, Sec. 202(a), substituted
"1993" for "1992" and "2000" for "1999".
Subsec. (a)(6)(J). Pub. L. 102-233, Sec. 202(b), substituted
"1992" for "1991" and "1993" for "1992" in cl. (i), and "1992" for
"1991" and "2000" for "1999" in cl. (ii).
Subsec. (a)(8). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 311(a)(1), added par. (8).
Subsec. (c)(5). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 133(a), amended par. (5)
generally, revising and restating as subpars. (A) to (L) provisions
of former subpars. (A) to (H).
Subsec. (c)(6)(B). Pub. L. 102-233, Sec. 102, amended subpar. (B)
generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (B) read as follows:
"Whenever the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision appoints
a receiver under the provisions of section 1464(d)(2)(C) of this
title for the purpose of liquidation or winding up any savings
association's affairs -
"(i) during the 3-year period beginning on August 9, 1989, the
Resolution Trust Corporation shall be appointed; and
"(ii) after the end of the 3-year period referred to in clause
(i), the Corporation shall be appointed."
Subsec. (c)(9). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 133(e), amended par. (9)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (9) read as follows: "In any
case in which the Corporation is appointed conservator or receiver
pursuant to paragraph (4) or (6) -
"(A) the provisions of this section shall be applicable to the
Corporation, as conservator or receiver of any insured State
depository institution in the same manner and to the same extent
as if such institution were a Federal depository institution for
which the Corporation had been appointed conservator or receiver;
and
"(B) the Corporation as receiver of any insured State
depository institution may -
"(i) liquidate such institution in an orderly manner; and
"(ii) make such other disposition of any matter concerning
such institution as the Corporation determines is in the best
interests of the institution, the depositors of such
institution, and the Corporation."
Subsec. (c)(10) to (13). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 133(e), added
pars. (10) to (13).
Subsec. (d)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 241(c)(1)(A), inserted
"(subject to the provisions of section 1831q of this title)" before
comma in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (d)(2)(E). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 241(c)(1)(B), inserted
"(subject to the provisions of section 1831q of this title)" before
first comma.
Subsec. (d)(2)(K). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 426, added subpar. (K).
Subsec. (d)(3)(A). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(a)(1), substituted
"paragraph (4)" for "paragraph (4)(A)".
Subsec. (d)(4). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 416, amended par. (4)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (4) read as follows: "The
Corporation may prescribe regulations regarding the allowance or
disallowance of claims by the receiver and providing for
administrative determination of claims and review of such
determination."
Subsec. (d)(5)(D). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(b), amended subpar.
(D) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (D) read as follows:
"The receiver may disallow any portion of any claim by a creditor
or claim of security, preference, or priority which is not proved
to the satisfaction of the receiver."
Subsec. (d)(11)(B). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(a)(2), substituted
"paragraph (15)(B)" for "paragraph (14)(C)".
Subsec. (d)(13)(E). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 123(a), added subpar.
(E).
Subsec. (e)(3)(C)(ii), (4)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec.
161(a)(3), (4), substituted "subsection (i)" for "subsection (k)".
Subsec. (e)(8)(A), (E). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(a)(5),
substituted "subsection (d)(9) of this section" for "subsections
(d)(9) and (i)(4)(I) of this section".
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(d)(2), substituted
"resolution" for "liquidation" in heading.
Subsec. (h)(4). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(d)(1), added par. (4).
Subsec. (i)(3)(A). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(e), substituted
"Notwithstanding any other provision of Federal or State law, or
the constitution of any State, the" for "The".
Subsec. (n)(9). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(a)(6), substituted
"paragraphs (11) and (12)" for "paragraphs (11) and (13)".
Subsec. (n)(11)(D). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 161(a)(7), substituted
"paragraph (9)" for "paragraph (8)".
Subsec. (s). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 446, added subsec. (s).
1990 - Subsec. (d)(2)(I), (J). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2534(a),
added subpar. (I) and redesignated former subpar. (I) as (J).
Subsec. (d)(17). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2528(a), added par. (17).
Subsec. (d)(18), (19). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2521(a)(1), added
pars. (18) and (19).
Subsec. (p). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2526(a), added subsec. (p).
Subsec. (q). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2527, added subsec. (q).
Subsec. (r). Pub. L. 101-647, Sec. 2532(b), added subsec. (r).
1989 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 211(1), added par.
(1) and struck out former par. (1) which read as follows: "The
Temporary Federal Deposit Insurance Fund and the Fund for Mutuals
heretofore created pursuant to the provisions of section 12B of the
Federal Reserve Act, as amended, are consolidated into a Permanent
Insurance Fund for insuring deposits, and the assets therein shall
be held by the Corporation for the uses and purposes of the
Corporation: Provided, That the obligations to and rights of the
Corporation, depositors, banks, and other persons arising out of
any event or transaction prior to September 21, 1950, shall remain
unimpaired. On and after August 23, 1935, the Corporation shall
insure the deposits of all insured banks as provided in this
chapter: Provided further, That the insurance shall apply only to
deposits of insured banks which have been made available since
March 10, 1933, for withdrawal in the usual course of the banking
business: Provided further, That if any insured bank shall, without
the consent of the Corporation, release or modify restrictions on
or deferments of deposits which had not been made available for
withdrawal in the usual course of the banking business on or before
August 23, 1935, such deposits shall not be insured. Except as
provided in paragraph (2), the maximum amount of the insured
deposit of any depositor shall be $100,000."
Subsec. (a)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted
"insured depository institution" for "insured bank" wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 211(2), struck out "time
and savings" after "deposited in".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institution" for "insured bank".
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured
depository institution" for "insured bank".
Subsec. (a)(4) to (7). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 211(3), added pars.
(4) to (7).
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured
depository institution" for "insured bank".
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (c) and
struck out former subsec. (c) which related to Corporation as
receiver.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (d) and
struck out former subsec. (d) which related to powers and duties of
Corporation as receiver.
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (e) and
struck out former subsec. (e) which related to Corporation as
receiver of State banks.
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (f) and
struck out former subsec. (f) which related to payment of insured
deposits of closed insured bank or insured branch of a foreign
bank.
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (g) and
struck out former subsec. (g) which related to subrogation rights
of Corporation in the case of a closed national bank, insured
branch of a foreign bank, District bank, or closed insured Federal
savings bank.
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (h) and
struck out former subsec. (h) which related to organization, etc.,
of new national banks upon closing of insured banks. See subsec.
(m) of this section.
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (i) and
struck out former subsec. (i) which related to establishment, etc.,
of bridge banks. See subsec. (n) of this section.
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsec. (j) and
struck out former subsec. (j) which related to conditions
applicable to liquidation proceedings.
Subsecs. (k), (l). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 212(a), added subsecs.
(k) and (l).
Subsec. (m). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 213, added subsec. (m).
Subsec. (n). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 214, added subsec. (n).
Subsec. (o). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 909, added subsec. (o).
1987 - Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 503(a)(1), (2),
designated existing provisions as par. (1) and redesignated former
subsecs. (i) to (l) as pars. (2) to (5), respectively.
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 503(a)(2), (3), added subsec.
(i). Former subsec. (i) redesignated subsec. (h)(2) of this
section.
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 100-86, Secs. 503(a)(2), 507, added subsec.
(j). Former subsec. (j) redesignated subsec. (h)(3) of this
section.
Subsecs. (k), (l). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 503(a)(2), redesignated
subsecs. (k) and (l) as pars. (4) and (5), respectively, of subsec.
(h).
1986 - Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 99-514 substituted "Internal
Revenue Code of 1986" for "Internal Revenue Code of 1954" wherever
appearing, which for purposes of codification was translated as
"title 26" thus requiring no change in text.
1982 - Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(j), inserted
provision relating to appointment of Corporation as receiver for an
insured Federal savings bank by Federal Home Loan Bank Board.
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(k), inserted "or closed
insured Federal savings bank," after "foreign bank, or District
bank,".
1981 - Subsec. (a)(2)(A)(iv). Pub. L. 97-110 inserted "the Trust
Territory of the Pacific Islands," after "Virgin Islands, American
Samoa," and "of the Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands," after
"of American Samoa,".
1980 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 96-221, Sec. 308(a)(1)(C),
substituted "$100,000" for "$40,000".
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 96-221, Sec. 308(a)(1)(D), substituted
"$100,000" for "$40,000".
1979 - Subsec. (a)(2)(A)(v). Pub. L. 96-153 added cl. (v).
1978 - Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 95-630 added par. (3).
Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(17), inserted "insured
Federal branch of a foreign bank" after "any insured national
bank".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(18), (19), inserted "or
any insured branch (other than a Federal branch) of a foreign bank"
after "(except a District bank)", and substituted "such insured
State bank or insured branch of a foreign bank" for "such insured
State bank".
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(20), inserted "or insured
branch of a foreign bank" after "Whenever an insured bank".
Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 95-369, Sec. 6(c)(21), (22), inserted
"insured branch of a foreign bank" after "In the case of a closed
national bank", and substituted "In the case of any closed insured
bank or closed insured branch of a foreign bank, such subrogation"
for "In the case of any closed insured bank, such subrogation".
1974 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 93-495, Secs. 101(a)(3), 102(a)(3),
redesignated existing provisions as par. (1), inserted exception
relating to applicability of par. (2), substituted "$40,000" for
"$20,000', and added par. (2).
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 93-495, Sec. 102(a)(4), substituted
"$40,000" for "$20,000".
1969 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 91-151, Sec. 7(a)(3), substituted
$20,000 for $15,000 in last sentence.
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 91-151, Sec. 7(a)(4), substituted $20,000
for $15,000 in fifth sentence.
1966 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 301(c), substituted in
last sentence "$15,000" for "$10,000" and struck out ": And
provided further, That in the case of banks closing prior to
September 21, 1950, the maximum amount of the insured deposit of
any depositor shall be $5,000".
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 89-695, Sec. 301(d), substituted "$15,000"
for "$10,000" in fifth sentence.

-CHANGE-
CHANGE OF NAME
Committee on Banking, Finance and Urban Affairs of House of
Representatives treated as referring to Committee on Banking and
Financial Services of House of Representatives by section 1(a) of
Pub. L. 104-14, set out as a note preceding section 21 of Title 2,
The Congress. Committee on Banking and Financial Services of House
of Representatives abolished and replaced by Committee on Financial
Services of House of Representatives, and jurisdiction over matters
relating to securities and exchanges and insurance generally
transferred from Committee on Energy and Commerce of House of
Representatives by House Resolution No. 5, One Hundred Seventh
Congress, Jan. 3, 2001.
Oversight Board redesignated Thrift Depositor Protection
Oversight Board, effective Feb. 1, 1992, see section 302(a) of Pub.
L. 102-233, set out as a note under section 1441a of this title.
Thrift Depositor Protection Oversight Board abolished, see section
14(a)-(d) of Pub. L. 105-216, set out as a note under section 1441a
of this title.


-MISC2-
EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 111-343, Sec. 1(b), Dec. 29, 2010, 124 Stat. 3609,
provided that: "The amendments made by subsection (a) [amending
this section] shall take effect on December 31, 2010."
Amendment by section 335(a) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 1 day
after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided, see section 4 of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note under section
5301 of this title.
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 343(a)(2), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1544, provided that: "The amendments made by paragraph (1)
[amending this section] shall take effect on December 31, 2010."
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 343(a)(3), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1544, provided that the amendment made by section 343(a)(3)
is effective Jan. 1, 2013.
Amendment by section 363(5) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-390 not applicable to any cases
commenced under Title 11, Bankruptcy, or to appointments made under
any Federal or State law, before Dec. 12, 2006, see section 7 of
Pub. L. 109-390, set out as a note under section 101 of Title 11.
Amendment by subsection 701(b) of Pub. L. 109-351 applicable with
respect to conservators or receivers appointed on or after Oct. 13,
2006, see section 701(c) of Pub. L. 109-351, set out as a note
under section 191 of this title.
Amendment by section 2(a), (c)(1) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective
Apr. 1, 2006, see section 2(e) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a
note under section 1785 of this title.
Amendment by section 8(a)(11)-(14) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective
Mar. 31, 2006, see section 8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a
note under section 1813 of this title.
Amendment by section 2102(b) of Pub. L. 109-171 effective no
later than the first day of the first calendar quarter that begins
after the end of the 90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see
section 2102(c) of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and
SAIF note below.
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2103(d), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat.
12, provided that: "This section [amending this section] and the
amendments made by this section shall take effect on the date the
final regulations required under section 9(a)(2) [probably means
section 2109(a)(2) of Pub. L. 109-171, set out as a Regulations
note under section 1817 of this title] take effect [Apr. 1, 2006,
see 71 F.R. 14629]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2005 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-8 effective 180 days after Apr. 20,
2005, and not applicable with respect to cases commenced under
Title 11, Bankruptcy, before such effective date, except as
otherwise provided, see section 1501 of Pub. L. 109-8, set out as a
note under section 101 of Title 11.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2004 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 108-386 effective Oct. 30, 2004, and, except
as otherwise provided, applicable with respect to fiscal year 2005
and each succeeding fiscal year, see sections 8(i) and 9 of Pub. L.
108-386, set out as notes under section 321 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1999 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 117 of Pub. L. 106-102 effective 120 days
after Nov. 12, 1999, see section 161 of Pub. L. 106-102, set out as
a note under section 24 of this title.
Pub. L. 106-102, title VII, Sec. 736(c), Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat.
1479, provided that: "This section [amending this section and
provisions set out as a note under this section] and the amendments
made by this section shall become effective on the date of the
enactment of this Act [Nov. 12, 1999]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2704(c), Sept. 30, 1996,
110 Stat. 3009-487, which provided that section 2704 of div. A of
Pub. L. 104-208 (amending this section, sections 24, 338a, 347b,
1431, 1441a, 1441b, 1464, 1467a, 1723i, 1735f-14, 1813, 1815 to
1817, 1821a, 1823 to 1825, 1827, 1828, 1831a, 1831e, 1831m, 1831o,
1833a, 1834, 1841, and 3341 of this title, and section 905 of Title
2, The Congress, repealing section 1831h of this title, and
enacting provisions set out as notes under this section) was to
become effective on Jan. 1, 1999, if no insured depository
institution was a savings association on that date, was repealed by
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2102(b), (c), Feb. 8, 2006, 120
Stat. 9, eff. no later than the first day of the first calendar
quarter that begins after the end of the 90-day period beginning
Feb. 8, 2006.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1994 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 103-394 effective Oct. 22, 1994, and not
applicable with respect to cases commenced under Title 11,
Bankruptcy, before Oct. 22, 1994, see section 702 of Pub. L. 103-
394, set out as a note under section 101 of Title 11.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1993 AMENDMENT
Section 3001(c) of Pub. L. 103-66 provided that: "The amendments
made by this section [amending this section] shall apply with
respect to insured depository institutions for which a receiver is
appointed after the date of the enactment of this Act [Aug. 10,
1993]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1992 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 1501(a) of Pub. L. 102-550 effective Dec.
20, 1992, see section 1501(c) of Pub. L. 102-550, set out as a note
under section 1786 of this title.
Amendment by sections 1603(e)(1), 1604(c)(2), and 1606(c) of Pub.
L. 102-550 effective as if included in the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, Pub. L. 102-242, as
of Dec. 19, 1991, except that where amendment is to any provision
of law added or amended by Pub. L. 102-242 effective after Dec. 19,
1992, then amendment by Pub. L. 102-550 effective on effective date
of amendment by Pub. L. 102-242, see section 1609 of Pub. L. 102-
550, set out as a note under section 191 of this title.
Section 1611(b)(2) of Pub. L. 102-550 provided that the amendment
made by that section is effective one year after Dec. 19, 1991.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1991 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 133(a), (e) of Pub. L. 102-242 effective 1
year after Dec. 19, 1991, see section 133(g) of Pub. L. 102-242,
set out as a note under section 191 of this title.
Section 311(c) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that:
"(1) In general. - Except as provided in paragraph (2), the
amendments made by subsection (a) and paragraphs (2) and (3) of
subsection (b) [amending this section and section 1817 of this
title] shall take effect at the end of the 2-year period beginning
on the date of the enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991].
"(2) Application to time deposits. -
"(A) Certain deposits excluded. - Except with respect to the
amendment referred to in paragraph (3), the amendments made by
subsections (a) and (b) [amending this section and sections 1813
and 1817 of this title] shall not apply to any time deposit which
-
"(i) was made before the date of enactment of this Act [Dec.
19, 1991]; and
"(ii) matures after the end of the 2-year period referred to
in paragraph (1).
"(B) Rollovers and renewals treated as new deposit. - Any
renewal or rollover of a time deposit described in subparagraph
(A) after the date of the enactment of this Act shall be treated
as a new deposit which is not described in such subparagraph.
"(3) Effective date for amendment relating to certain employee
plans. -
"(A) Section 11(a)(1)(B) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act
[12 U.S.C. 1821(a)(1)(B)] (as amended by subsection (b)(1) of
this section) shall take effect on the earlier of -
"(i) the date of the enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991];
or
"(ii) January 1, 1992.
"(B) Section 11(a)(3)(A) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act
(as amended by subsection (b)(2) of this section) shall take
effect on the earlier of the dates described in clauses (i) and
(ii) of subparagraph (A) with respect to plans described in
clause (ii) of such section."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1980 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 96-221 effective Mar. 31, 1980, see section
308(e) of Pub. L. 96-221, set out as a note under section 1817 of
this title.
Amendment by section 308(a)(1) of Pub. L. 96-221 not applicable
to any claim arising out of the closing of a bank prior to the
effective date of section 308 of Pub L. 96-221, see section
308(a)(2) of Pub. L. 96-221, set out as a note under section 1813
of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1979 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 96-153 applicable only to claims arising
after Dec. 21, 1979, with respect to a closing of a bank, etc., see
section 323(e) of Pub. L. 96-153, set out as an Effective and
Termination Dates of 1979 Amendment note under section 1757 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1978 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 95-630 effective Nov. 10, 1978, see section
1402 of Pub. L. 95-630, set out as a note under section 1787 of
this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1974 AMENDMENT
Amendment by sections 101(a)(3) and 102(a)(3), (4) of Pub. L. 93-
495 effective on thirtieth day beginning after Oct. 28, 1974, and
amendment by section 102(a)(3), (4) of Pub. L. 93-495 not
applicable to any claim arising out of the closing of any bank
prior to such effective date, see sections 101(g) and 102(a)(3),
(4) of Pub. L. 93-495, set out as a note under section 1813 of this
title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1969 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 91-151 not applicable to any claim arising
out of the closing of a bank where such closing took place prior to
Dec. 23, 1969, see section 7(b) of Pub. L. 91-151, set out as a
note under section 1813 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1966 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 89-695 not applicable to any claim arising
out of the closing of a bank where such closing is prior to Oct.
16, 1966, see section 301(e) of Pub. L. 89-695, set out as a note
under section 1813 of this title.

REGULATIONS
Section 311(b)(4) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that:
"(A) Review of coverage. - For the purpose of prescribing
regulations, during the 1-year period beginning on the date of the
enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991], the Board of Directors shall
review the capacities and rights in which deposit accounts are
maintained and for which deposit insurance coverage is provided by
the Corporation.
"(B) Regulations. - After the end of the 1-year period referred
to in subparagraph (A), the Board of Directors may prescribe
regulations that provide for separate insurance coverage for the
different capacities and rights in which deposit accounts are
maintained if a determination is made by the Board of Directors
that such separate insurance coverage is consistent with -
"(i) the purpose of protecting small depositors and limiting
the undue expansion of deposit insurance coverage; and
"(ii) the insurance provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Act [12 U.S.C. 1811 et seq.].
"(C) Delayed effective date for regulations. - No regulation
prescribed under subparagraph (B) may take effect before the 2-year
period beginning on the date of the enactment of this Act [Dec. 19,
1991]."


-TRANS-
TERMINATION OF TRUST TERRITORY OF THE PACIFIC ISLANDS
For termination of Trust Territory of the Pacific Islands, see
note set out preceding section 1681 of Title 48, Territories and
Insular Possessions.


-MISC3-
TEMPORARY ADJUSTMENT IN STANDARD MAXIMUM DEPOSIT INSURANCE AMOUNT
Subsec. (a)(1)(E) of this section to apply with "$250,000"
substituted for "$100,000" during period beginning on Oct. 3, 2008,
and ending on Dec. 31, 2009, see section 5241(a)(1) of this title.

MERGER OF BIF AND SAIF
Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2102, Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9,
provided that:
"(a) In General. -
"(1) Merger. - The Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings
Association Insurance Fund shall be merged into the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
"(2) Disposition of assets and liabilities. - All assets and
liabilities of the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings
Association Insurance Fund shall be transferred to the Deposit
Insurance Fund.
"(3) No separate existence. - The separate existence of the
Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund
shall cease on the effective date of the merger thereof under
this section.
"(b) Repeal of Outdated Merger Provision. - Section 2704 of the
Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996 (12 U.S.C. 1821 note) [section
2704 of Pub. L. 104-208, which amended this section, sections 24,
338a, 347b, 1431, 1441a, 1441b, 1464, 1467a, 1723i, 1735f-14, 1813,
1815 to 1817, 1821a, 1823 to 1825, 1827, 1828, 1831a, 1831e, 1831m,
1831o, 1833a, 1834, 1841, and 3341 of this title, and section 905
of Title 2, The Congress, repealed section 1831h of this title, and
enacted provisions set out as notes under this section] is
repealed.
"(c) Effective Date. - This section shall take effect no later
than the first day of the first calendar quarter that begins after
the end of the 90-day period beginning on the date of the enactment
of this Act [Feb. 8, 2006]."
Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2704(a), (b), Sept. 30,
1996, 110 Stat. 3009-486, as amended by Pub. L. 106-102, title VII,
Sec. 736(b)(1), Nov. 12, 1999, 113 Stat. 1479, which provided that
the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund
were to be merged into the Deposit Insurance Fund, that all assets
and liabilities of the Bank Insurance Fund and the Savings
Association Insurance Fund were to be transferred to the Deposit
Insurance Fund, and that the separate existence of the Bank
Insurance Fund and the Savings Association Insurance Fund was to
cease, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec. 2102(b),
(c), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9, eff. no later than the first day of
the first calendar quarter that begins after the end of the 90-day
period beginning Feb. 8, 2006. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note and note above.

GAO REPORT
Section 8(g) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that: "Not later than 60
days after receipt of any certification submitted pursuant to
subparagraph (E) or (F) of section 11(a)(6) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [former 12 U.S.C. 1821(a)(6)], the Comptroller
General shall transmit a report to the Congress evaluating any such
certification."

SINGLE AGENCY FOR REAL PROPERTY DISPOSITION
Section 26(b) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that:
"(1) Study. - The Comptroller General of the United States shall
conduct a study to determine the feasibility and effectiveness of
establishing a single Federal agency responsible for selling and
otherwise disposing of real property owned or held by the
Department of Housing and Urban Development, the Farmers Home
Administration of the Department of Agriculture, the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation, and the Resolution Trust
Corporation. The study shall examine the real property disposition
procedures of such agencies and corporations, analyze the
feasibility of consolidating such procedures through such single
agency, and determine the characteristics and authority necessary
for any such single agency to efficiently carry out such
disposition activities.
"(2) Report. - Not later than 12 months after the date of
enactment of this Act [Dec. 17, 1993], the Comptroller General
shall submit a report to the Congress on the study required under
paragraph (1), which shall describe any findings under the study
and contain any recommendations of the Comptroller General for the
establishment of such single agency."

EXEMPTIONS FOR CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS
Section 37 of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that:
"(a) Transactions Involving Certain Institutions. - Section
11(a)(4)(B) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1821(a)(4)(B)] shall not prohibit assistance from the Bank
Insurance Fund that otherwise meets all the criteria established in
section 13(c) of such Act [12 U.S.C. 1823(c)] from being provided
to an insured depository institution that became wholly-owned,
either directly or through a wholly-owned subsidiary, by an entity
or instrumentality of a State government during the period
beginning on January 1, 1992, and ending on the date of enactment
of this Act [Dec. 17, 1993].
"(b) Transactions Involving the FDIC as Receiver. -
Notwithstanding the extension, pursuant to section 27 [12 U.S.C.
1831d], of the Resolution Trust Corporation's jurisdiction to be
appointed conservator or receiver of certain savings associations
after September 30, 1993, no provision of this Act [see Short Title
of 1993 Amendment note set out under section 1421 of this title] or
any amendment made by this Act shall invalidate or otherwise affect
-
"(1) any appointment of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation as receiver for any savings association that became
effective before the date of enactment of this Act; or
"(2) any action taken by the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation as such receiver before, on, or after such date of
enactment."

INFORMATIONAL STUDY
Section 311(d) of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that:
"(1) In general. - The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, in
conjunction with such consultants and technical experts as the
Corporation determines to be appropriate, shall conduct a study of
the cost and feasibility of tracking the insured and uninsured
deposits of any individual and the exposure, under any Act of
Congress or any regulation of any appropriate Federal banking
agency, of the Federal Government with respect to all insured
depository institutions.
"(2) Analysis of costs and benefits. - The study under paragraph
(1) shall include detailed, technical analysis of the costs and
benefits associated with the least expensive way to implement the
system.
"(3) Specific factors to be studied. - As part of the study under
paragraph (1), the Corporation shall investigate, review, and
evaluate -
"(A) the data systems that would be required to track deposits
in all insured depository institutions;
"(B) the reporting burdens of such tracking on individual
depository institutions;
"(C) the systems which exist or which would be required to be
developed to aggregate such data on an accurate basis;
"(D) the implications such tracking would have for individual
privacy; and
"(E) the manner in which systems would be administered and
enforced.
"(4) Federal reserve board survey. - As part of the informational
study required under paragraph (1), the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System shall conduct, in conjunction with other
Federal departments and agencies as necessary, a survey of the
ownership of deposits held by individuals including the dollar
amount of deposits held, the type of deposit accounts held, and the
type of financial institutions in which the deposit accounts are
held.
"(5) Analysis by fdic. - The results of the survey under
paragraph (4) shall be provided to the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation before the end of the 1-year period beginning on the
date of the enactment of this Act [Dec. 19, 1991] for analysis and
inclusion in the informational study.
"(6) Report to congress. - Before the end of the 18-month period
beginning on the date of the enactment of this Act, the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation shall submit to the Congress a report
containing a detailed statement of findings made and conclusions
drawn from the study conducted under this section, including such
recommendations for administrative and legislative action as the
Corporation determines to be appropriate."

CONTINUATION OF HEALTH PLAN COVERAGE IN CASES OF FAILED FINANCIAL
INSTITUTIONS
Section 451 of Pub. L. 102-242, as amended by Pub. L. 102-550,
title XVI, Sec. 1606(g)(1), Oct. 28, 1992, 106 Stat. 4088, provided
that:
"(a) Continuation Coverage. - The Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation -
"(1) shall, in its capacity as a successor of a failed
depository institution (whether acting directly or through any
bridge bank), have the same obligation to provide a group health
plan meeting the requirements of section 602 of the Employee
Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 [29 U.S.C. 1162] (relating
to continuation coverage requirements of group health plans) with
respect to former employees of such institution as such
institution would have had but for its failure, and
"(2) shall require that any successor described in subsection
(b)(1)(B)(iii) provide a group health plan with respect to former
employees of such institution in the same manner as the failed
depository institution would have been required to provide but
for its failure.
"(b) Definitions. - For purposes of this section -
"(1) Successor. - An entity is a successor of a failed
depository institution during any period if -
"(A) such entity holds substantially all of the assets or
liabilities of such institution, and
"(B) such entity is -
"(i) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation,
"(ii) any bridge bank, or
"(iii) an entity that acquires such assets or liabilities
from the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or a bridge
bank.
"(2) Failed depository institution. - The term 'failed
depository institution' means any depository institution (as
defined in section 3(c) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12
U.S.C. 1813(c)]) for which a receiver has been appointed.
"(3) Bridge bank. - The term 'bridge bank' has the meaning
given such term by section 3(i)(2) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1813(i)(2)].
"(c) No premium costs imposed on fdic. - Subsection (a) shall not
be construed as requiring the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
to incur, by reason of this section, any obligation for any premium
under any group health plan referred to in such subsection.
"(d) Effective Date. - This section shall apply to plan years
beginning on or after the date of the enactment of this Act [Dec.
19, 1991], regardless of whether the qualifying event under section
603 of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 [29
U.S.C. 1163] occurred before, on, or after such date."

-CROSS-
DEFINITIONS
Section 2710 of div. A of Pub. L. 104-208 provided that: "For
purposes of this subtitle [subtitle G (Secs. 2701-2711) of title II
of div. A of Pub. L. 104-208, see Short Title of 1996 Amendment
note set out under section 1811 of this title], the following
definitions shall apply:
"(1) Bank insurance fund. - The term 'Bank Insurance Fund'
means the fund established pursuant to section (11)(a)(5)(A) of
the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [former 12 U.S.C.
1821(a)(5)(A)], as that section existed on the day before the
date of enactment of this Act [Sept. 30, 1996].
"(2) BIF member, saif member. - The terms 'Bank Insurance Fund
member' and 'Savings Association Insurance Fund member' have the
same meanings as in section 7(l) of the Federal Deposit Insurance
Act [12 U.S.C. 1817(l)].
"(3) Various banking terms. - The terms 'bank', 'Board of
Directors', 'Corporation', 'deposit', 'insured depository
institution', 'Federal savings association', 'savings
association', 'State savings bank', and 'State depository
institution' have the same meanings as in section 3 of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1813].
"(4) Deposit insurance fund. - The term 'Deposit Insurance
Fund' means the fund established under section 11(a)(4) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [former 12 U.S.C. 1821(a)(4)] (as
amended by section 2704(d) of this subtitle).
"(5) Depository institution holding company. - The term
'depository institution holding company' has the same meaning as
in section 3 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C.
1813].
"(6) Designated reserve ratio. - The term 'designated reserve
ratio' has the same meaning as in section 7(b)(2)(A)(iv) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [former 12 U.S.C.
1817(b)(2)(A)(iv), see 12 U.S.C. 1817(b)(3)].
"(7) SAIF. - The term 'Savings Association Insurance Fund'
means the fund established pursuant to section 11(a)(6)(A) of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [former 12 U.S.C. 1821(a)(6)(A)],
as that section existed on the day before the date of enactment
of this Act [Sept. 30, 1996].
"(8) SAIF-assessable deposit. - The term 'SAIF-assessable
deposit' -
"(A) means a deposit that is subject to assessment for
purposes of the Savings Association Insurance Fund under the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1811 et seq.]
(including a deposit that is treated as insured by the Savings
Association Insurance Fund under section 5(d)(3) of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1815(d)(3)]); and
"(B) includes any deposit described in subparagraph (A) which
is assumed after March 31, 1995, if the insured depository
institution, the deposits of which are assumed, is not an
insured depository institution when the special assessment is
imposed under section 2702(a) [former 12 U.S.C. 1817 note]."

-FOOTNOTE-
(!1) So in original. Probably should be "depository institution".

(!2) See References in Text note below.



(!3) So in original. Probably should be followed by "or".



(!4) So in original. The semicolon probably should be preceded
by an additional closing parenthesis.

(!5) So in original. The comma probably should not appear.

(!6) So in original.

(!7) So in original. Probably should be "Bridge depository
institution".



(!8) So in original. Probably should be "bridge depository
institution".

(!9) So in original. Probably should be "title 28,".

(!10) So in original. There is no cl. (vi).

(!11) So in original. Probably should be preceded by "The".


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1821a 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1821a. FSLIC Resolution Fund

-STATUTE-
(a) Established
(1) In general
There is established a separate fund to be designated as the
FSLIC Resolution Fund which shall be managed by the Corporation
and separately maintained and not commingled.
(2) Transfer of FSLIC assets and liabilities
Except as provided in section 1441a of this title, all assets
and liabilities of the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance
Corporation on the day before August 9, 1989, shall be
transferred to the FSLIC Resolution Fund.
(3) Separate holding
Assets and liabilities transferred to the FSLIC Resolution Fund
shall be the assets and liabilities of the Fund and not of the
Corporation and shall not be consolidated with the assets and
liabilities of the Deposit Insurance Fund or the Corporation for
accounting, reporting, or any other purpose.
(4) Rights, powers, and duties
Effective August 10, 1989, the Corporation shall have all
rights, powers, and duties to carry out the Corporation's duties
with respect to the assets and liabilities of the FSLIC
Resolution Fund that the Corporation otherwise has under this
chapter.
(5) Corporation as conservator or receiver
(A) In general
Effective August 10, 1989, the Corporation shall succeed the
Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation as conservator
or receiver with respect to any depository institution -
(i) the accounts of which were insured before August 10,
1989 by the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation;
and
(ii) for which a conservator or receiver was appointed
before January 1, 1989.
(B) Rights, powers, and duties
When acting as conservator or receiver with respect to any
depository institution described in subparagraph (A), the
Corporation shall have all rights, powers, and duties that the
Corporation otherwise has as conservator or receiver under this
chapter.
(b) Source of funds
The FSLIC Resolution Fund shall be funded from the following
sources to the extent funds are needed in the listed priority:
(1) Income earned on assets of the FSLIC Resolution Fund.
(2) Liquidating dividends and payments made on claims received
by the FSLIC Resolution Fund from receiverships to the extent
such funds are not required by the Resolution Funding Corporation
pursuant to section 1441b of this title or the Financing
Corporation pursuant to section 1441 of this title.
(3) Amounts borrowed by the Financing Corporation pursuant to
section 1441 of this title.
(c) Treasury backup
(1) In general
If the funds described in subsections (a) and (b) of this
section are insufficient to satisfy the liabilities of the FSLIC
Resolution Fund, the Secretary of the Treasury shall pay to the
Fund such amounts as may be necessary, as determined by the
Corporation and the Secretary, for FSLIC Resolution Fund
purposes.
(2) Authorization of appropriations
There are authorized to be appropriated to the Secretary of the
Treasury, without fiscal year limitation, such sums as may be
necessary to carry out this section.
(d) Legal proceedings
Any judgment resulting from a proceeding to which the Federal
Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation was a party prior to its
dissolution or which is initiated against the Corporation with
respect to the Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation or
with respect to the FSLIC Resolution Fund shall be limited to the
assets of the FSLIC Resolution Fund.
(e) Transfer of net proceeds from sale of RTC assets
The FSLIC Resolution Fund shall transfer to the Resolution
Funding Corporation any net proceeds from the sale of assets
acquired from the Resolution Trust Corporation upon the termination
of such Corporation pursuant to section 1441a of this title.
(f) Dissolution
The FSLIC Resolution Fund shall be dissolved upon satisfaction of
all debts and liabilities and sale of all assets. Upon dissolution
any remaining funds shall be paid into the Treasury. Any
administrative facilities and supplies, including offices and
office supplies, shall be transferred to the Corporation for use by
and to be held as assets of the Deposit Insurance Fund.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[11A], as added Pub. L. 101-73,
title II, Sec. 215, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 252; amended Pub. L.
102-233, title II, Sec. 202(c), (d), Dec. 12, 1991, 105 Stat. 1767;
Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Sec. 161(b), Dec. 19, 1991, 105 Stat.
2285; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(J)-(L),
Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-492; Pub. L. 109-171, title II, Sec.
2102(b), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9; Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(15)-
(17), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3612, 3613.)


-MISC1-
AMENDMENTS
2006 - Subsec. (a)(2). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(15)(A), (B),
struck out subpar. (A) designation and heading before "Except as"
and struck out heading and text of subpar. (B). Text read as
follows: "The FSLIC Resolution Fund shall pay to the Savings
Association Insurance Fund such amounts as are needed for
administrative and supervisory expenses from August 9, 1989,
through September 30, 1992."
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(J)(i),
(ii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(15)(C), substituted
"the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "the Bank Insurance Fund, the
Savings Association Insurance Fund,".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(J)(iii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(16), struck out par.
(4) which read as follows: "During the period beginning on August
9, 1989, and ending on December 31, 1992, amounts assessed against
Savings Association Insurance Fund members by the Corporation
pursuant to section 1817 of this title which are not required by
the Financing Corporation pursuant to section 1441 of this title or
by the Resolution Funding Corporation pursuant to section 1441b of
this title."
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(K).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(17), substituted "Deposit
Insurance Fund" for "Savings Association Insurance Fund".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(L).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
1996 - Subsec. (a)(2). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(J)(i),
(ii), which directed striking out subpar. (A) heading and subpar.
(B) and redesignating subpar. (A) as par. (2), was repealed by Pub.
L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and
2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (a)(3). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(J)(iii), which
directed substitution of "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "the Bank
Insurance Fund, the Savings Association Insurance Fund,", was
repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment
note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(K), which
directed striking out par. (4), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171.
See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment
note above.
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(L), which directed
substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Savings Association
Insurance Fund", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective
Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
1991 - Subsec. (a)(2)(B). Pub. L. 102-233, Sec. 202(c),
substituted "1992" for "1991".
Subsec. (a)(4), (5). Pub. L. 102-242 added pars. (4) and (5).
Subsec. (b)(4). Pub. L. 102-233, Sec. 202(d), substituted "1992"
for "1991".

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar. 31, 2006, see section
8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under section 1813 of
this title.
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-171 effective no later than the first
day of the first calendar quarter that begins after the end of the
90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see section 2102(c) of Pub.
L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and SAIF note under section
1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 104-208 effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no
insured depository institution is a savings association on that
date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L. 104-208, formerly set out as a
note under section 1821 of this title.

PAYMENT OF JUDGMENTS AND SETTLEMENTS OF CLAIMS AGAINST UNITED
STATES
Pub. L. 106-113, div. B, Sec. 1000(a)(1) [title I, Sec. 110],
Nov. 29, 1999, 113 Stat. 1535, 1501A-20, provided that: "Hereafter,
for payments of judgments against the United States and compromise
settlements of claims in suits against the United States arising
from the Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement
Act [Pub. L. 101-73, see Tables for classification] and its
implementation, such sums as may be necessary, to remain available
until expended: Provided, That the foregoing authority is available
solely for payment of judgments and compromise settlements:
Provided further, That payment of litigation expenses is available
under existing authority and will continue to be made available as
set forth in the Memorandum of Understanding between the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation and the Department of Justice, dated
October 2, 1998."
Similar provisions were contained in Pub. L. 105-277, div. A,
Sec. 101(b) [title I, Sec. 130], Oct. 21, 1998, 112 Stat. 2681-50,
2681-77.

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1822 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1822. Corporation as receiver

-STATUTE-
(a) Bond not required; agents; fee
The Corporation as receiver of an insured depository institution
or branch of a foreign bank shall not be required to furnish bond
and may appoint an agent or agents to assist it in its duties as
such receiver. All fees, compensation, and expenses of liquidation
and administration shall be fixed by the Corporation, and may be
paid by it out of funds coming into its possession as such
receiver.
(b) Payment of insured deposit as discharge from liability
Payment of an insured deposit to any person by the Corporation
shall discharge the Corporation, and payment of a transferred
deposit to any person by the new depository institution or by an
insured depository institution in which a transferred deposit has
been made available shall discharge the Corporation and such new
depository institution or other insured depository institution, to
the same extent that payment to such person by the depository
institution in default would have discharged it from liability for
the insured deposit.
(c) Recognition of claimant not on depository institution records
Except as otherwise prescribed by the Board of Directors, neither
the Corporation nor such new depository institution or other
insured depository institution shall be required to recognize as
the owner of any portion of a deposit appearing on the records of
the depository institution in default under a name other than that
of the claimant, any person whose name or interest as such owner is
not disclosed on the records of such depository institution in
default as part owner of said deposit, if such recognition would
increase the aggregate amount of the insured deposits in such
depository institution in default.
(d) Withholding payments to meet liability to depository
institution
The Corporation may withhold payment of such portion of the
insured deposit of any depositor in a depository institution in
default as may be required to provide for the payment of any
liability of such depositor to the depository institution in
default or its receiver, which is not offset against a claim due
from such depository institution, pending the determination and
payment of such liability by such depositor or any other person
liable therefor.
(e) Disposition of unclaimed deposits
(1) Notices
(A) First notice
Within 30 days after the initiation of the payment of insured
deposits under section 1821(f) of this title, the Corporation
shall provide written notice to all insured depositors that
they must claim their deposit from the Corporation, or if the
deposit has been transferred to another institution, from the
transferee institution.
(B) Second notice
A second notice containing this information shall be mailed
by the Corporation to all insured depositors who have not
responded to the first notice, 15 months after the Corporation
initiates such payment of insured depositors.
(C) Address
The notices shall be mailed to the last known address of the
depositor appearing on the records of the insured depository
institution in default.
(2) Transfer to appropriate State
If an insured depositor fails to make a claim for his, her, or
its insured or transferred deposit within 18 months after the
Corporation initiates the payment of insured deposits under
section 1821(f) of this title -
(A) any transferee institution shall refund the deposit to
the Corporation, and all rights of the depositor against the
transferee institution shall be barred; and
(B) with the exception of United States deposits, the
Corporation shall deliver the deposit to the custody of the
appropriate State as unclaimed property, unless the appropriate
State declines to accept custody. Upon delivery to the
appropriate State, all rights of the depositor against the
Corporation with respect to the deposit shall be barred and the
Corporation shall be deemed to have made payment to the
depositor for purposes of section 1821(g)(1) of this title.
(3) Refusal of appropriate State to accept custody
If the appropriate State declines to accept custody of the
deposit tendered pursuant to paragraph (2)(B), the deposit shall
not be delivered to any State, and the insured depositor shall
claim the deposit from the Corporation before the receivership is
terminated, or all rights of the depositor with respect to such
deposit shall be barred.
(4) Treatment of United States deposits
If the deposit is a United States deposit it shall be delivered
to the Secretary of the Treasury for deposit in the general fund
of the Treasury. Upon delivery to the Secretary of the Treasury,
all rights of the depositor against the Corporation with respect
to the deposit shall be barred and the Corporation shall be
deemed to have made payment to the depositor for purposes of
section 1821(g)(1) of this title.
(5) Reversion
If a depositor does not claim the deposit delivered to the
custody of the appropriate State pursuant to paragraph (2)(B)
within 10 years of the date of delivery, the deposit shall be
immediately refunded to the Corporation and become its property.
All rights of the depositor against the appropriate State with
respect to such deposit shall be barred as of the date of the
refund to the Corporation.
(6) Definitions
For purposes of this subsection -
(A) the term "transferee institution" means the insured
depository institution in which the Corporation has made
available a transferred deposit pursuant to section 1821(f)(1)
of this title;
(B) the term "appropriate State" means the State to which
notice was mailed under paragraph (1)(C), except that if the
notice was not mailed to an address that is within a State it
shall mean the State in which the depository institution in
default has its main office; and
(C) the term "United States deposit" means an insured or
transferred deposit for which the deposit records of the
depository institution in default disclose that title to the
deposit is held by the United States, any department, agency,
or instrumentality of the Federal Government, or any officer or
employee thereof in such person's official capacity.
(f) Conflict of interest
(1) Applicability of other provisions
(A) Clarification of status of Corporation
The Corporation is, and has been since its creation, an
agency for purposes of title 18.
(B) Treatment of contractors
Any individual who, pursuant to a contract or any other
arrangement, performs functions or activities of the
Corporation, under the direct supervision of an officer or
employee of the Corporation, shall be deemed to be an employee
of the Corporation for purposes of title 18 and this chapter.
Any individual who, pursuant to a contract or any other
agreement, acts for or on behalf of the Corporation, and who is
not otherwise treated as an officer or employee of the United
States for purposes of title 18 shall be deemed to be a public
official for purposes of section 201 of title 18.
(2) Regulations concerning employee conduct
The officers and employees of the Corporation and those
individuals under contract to the Corporation who are deemed,
under paragraph (1)(B), to be employees of the Corporation for
purposes of title 18 shall be subject to the ethics and conflict
of interest rules and regulations issued by the Office of
Government Ethics, including those concerning employee conduct,
financial disclosure, and post-employment activities. The Board
of Directors may prescribe regulations that supplement such rules
and regulations only with the concurrence of that Office.
(3) Regulations concerning independent contractors
The Board of Directors shall prescribe regulations applicable
to those independent contractors who are not deemed, under
paragraph (1)(B), to be employees of the Corporation for purposes
of title 18 governing conflicts of interest, ethical
responsibilities, and the use of confidential information
consistent with the goals and purposes of titles 18 and 41. Any
such regulations shall be in addition to, and not in lieu of, any
other statute or regulation which may apply to the conduct of
such independent contractors.
(4) Disapproval of contractors
(A) In general
The Board of Directors shall prescribe regulations
establishing procedures for ensuring that any individual who is
performing, directly or indirectly, any function or service on
behalf of the Corporation meets minimum standards of
competence, experience, integrity, and fitness.
(B) Prohibition from service on behalf of Corporation
The procedures established under subparagraph (A) shall
provide that the Corporation shall prohibit any person who does
not meet the minimum standards of competence, experience,
integrity, and fitness from -
(i) entering into any contract with the Corporation; or
(ii) becoming employed by the Corporation or otherwise
performing any service for or on behalf of the Corporation.
(C) Information required to be submitted
The procedures established under subparagraph (A) shall
require that any offer submitted to the Corporation by any
person under this section and any employment application
submitted to the Corporation by any person shall include -
(i) a list and description of any instance during the 5
years preceding the submission of such application in which
the person or a company under such person's control defaulted
on a material obligation to an insured depository
institution; and
(ii) such other information as the Board may prescribe by
regulation.
(D) Subsequent submissions
(i) In general
No offer submitted to the Corporation may be accepted
unless the offeror agrees that no person will be employed,
directly or indirectly, by the offeror under any contract
with the Corporation unless -
(I) all applicable information described in subparagraph
(C) with respect to any such person is submitted to the
Corporation; and
(II) the Corporation does not disapprove of the direct or
indirect employment of such person.
(ii) Finality of determination
Any determination made by the Corporation pursuant to this
paragraph shall be in the Corporation's sole discretion and
shall not be subject to review.
(E) Prohibition required in certain cases
The standards established under subparagraph (A) shall
require the Corporation to prohibit any person who has -
(i) been convicted of any felony;
(ii) been removed from, or prohibited from participating in
the affairs of, any insured depository institution pursuant
to any final enforcement action by any appropriate Federal
banking agency;
(iii) demonstrated a pattern or practice of defalcation
regarding obligations to insured depository institutions; or
(iv) caused a substantial loss to the Deposit Insurance
Fund (or any predecessor deposit insurance fund);

from performing any service on behalf of the Corporation.
(5) Abrogation of contracts
The Corporation may rescind any contract with a person who -
(A) fails to disclose a material fact to the Corporation;
(B) would be prohibited under paragraph (6) from providing
services to, receiving fees from, or contracting with the
Corporation; or
(C) has been subject to a final enforcement action by any
Federal banking agency.
(6) Priority of FDIC rules
To the extent that the regulations under this subsection
conflict with rules of other agencies or Government corporations,
officers, directors, employees, and independent contractors of
the Corporation who are also subject to the conflict of interest
or ethical rules of another agency or Government corporation,
shall be governed by the regulations prescribed by the Board of
Directors under this subsection when acting for or on behalf of
the Corporation. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, the
rules of the Corporation shall not take priority over the ethics
and conflict of interest rules and regulations promulgated by the
Office of Government Ethics unless specifically authorized by
that Office.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[12], 64 Stat. 887; Pub. L. 95-369,
Sec. 6(c)(23), Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 619; Pub. L. 97-320, title
I, Sec. 113(l), Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1474; Pub. L. 101-73, title
II, Secs. 201(a), 216, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187, 254; Pub. L.
103-44, Sec. 1, June 28, 1993, 107 Stat. 220; Pub. L. 103-204, Sec.
19(a), Dec. 17, 1993, 107 Stat. 2402; Pub. L. 104-179, Sec.
4(b)(1), Aug. 6, 1996, 110 Stat. 1567; Pub. L. 109-173, Sec.
8(a)(18), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3613; Pub. L. 110-289, div. A,
title VI, Sec. 1604(b)(1)(C), July 30, 2008, 122 Stat. 2829.)


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (m) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2008 - Subsecs. (b), (c). Pub. L. 110-289 substituted "new
depository institution" for "new bank" wherever appearing.
2006 - Subsec. (f)(4)(E)(iv). Pub. L. 109-173 substituted "the
Deposit Insurance Fund (or any predecessor deposit insurance fund)"
for "Federal deposit insurance funds".
1996 - Subsec. (f)(3). Pub. L. 104-179 struck out ", with the
concurrence of the Office of Government Ethics," after "The Board
of Directors".
1993 - Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 103-44 inserted heading and amended
text generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "If,
after the Corporation shall have given at least three months'
notice to the depositor by mailing a copy thereof to his last-known
address appearing on the records of the depository institution in
default, any depositor in the depository institution in default
shall fail to claim his insured deposit from the Corporation within
eighteen months after the appointment of the receiver for the
depository institution in default, or shall fail within such period
to claim or arrange to continue the transferred deposit with the
new bank or with the other insured depository institution which
assumes liability therefor, all rights of the depositor against the
Corporation with respect to the insured deposit, and against the
new bank and such other insured depository institution with respect
to the transferred deposit, shall be barred, and all rights of the
depositor against the depository institution in default and its
shareholders, or the receivership estate to which the Corporation
may have become subrogated, shall thereupon revert to the
depositor. The amount of any transferred deposits not claimed
within such eighteen months' period, shall be refunded to the
Corporation."
Subsec. (f). Pub. L. 103-204 added subsec. (f).
1989 - Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to
insured depository institutions for references to insured banks
wherever appearing in this section.
Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 216(2), inserted heading and
text of subsec. (a), and struck out former subsec. (a) which read
as follows: "Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the
Corporation as receiver of a closed national bank, branch of a
foreign bank, insured Federal savings bank, or District bank shall
not be required to furnish bond and shall have the right to appoint
an agent or agents to assist it in its duties as such receiver, and
all fees, compensation, and expenses of liquidation and
administration thereof shall be fixed by the Corporation, and may
be paid by it out of funds coming into its possession as such
receiver."
Subsecs. (b), (c). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 216(1), substituted
"depository institution in default" for "closed bank" wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 216(1), (3), substituted
"depository institution in default" for "closed bank" in three
places, struck out "as a stockholder of the depository institution
in default, or of any liability of such depositor" after "payment
of any liability of such depositor", and substituted "such
depository institution" for "such bank".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 216(1), substituted "depository
institution in default" for "closed bank" wherever appearing.
1982 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 97-320 inserted "insured Federal
savings bank," after "foreign bank,".
1978 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 95-369 inserted ", branch of a
foreign bank," after "a closed national bank".

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar. 31, 2006, see section
8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under section 1813 of
this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1993 AMENDMENTS
Section 19(c) of Pub. L. 103-204 provided that: "The amendment
made by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall apply after
the end of the 6-month period beginning on the date of enactment of
this Act [Dec. 17, 1993]."
Section 2 of Pub. L. 103-44 provided that:
"(a) In General. - The amendments made by section 1 of this Act
[amending this section] shall only apply with respect to
institutions for which the Corporation has initiated the payment of
insured deposits under section 11(f) of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1821(f)] after the date of enactment of
this Act [June 28, 1993].
"(b) Special Rule for Receiverships in Progress. - Section 12(e)
of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1822(e)] as in
effect on the day before the date of enactment of this Act [June
28, 1993] shall apply with respect to insured deposits in
depository institutions for which the Corporation was first
appointed receiver during the period between January 1, 1989 and
the date of enactment of this Act, except that such section 12(e)
shall not bar any claim made against the Corporation by an insured
depositor for an insured or transferred deposit, so long as such
claim is made prior to the termination of the receivership.
"(c) Information to States. - Within 120 days after the date of
enactment of this Act [June 28, 1993], the Corporation shall
provide, at the request of and for the sole use of any State, the
name and last known address of any insured depositor (as shown on
the records of the institution in default) eligible to make a claim
against the Corporation solely due to the operation of subsection
(b) of this section.
"(d) Definition. - For purposes of this section, the term
'Corporation' means the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the
Resolution Trust Corporation, or the Federal Savings and Loan
Insurance Corporation, as appropriate."

-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1823 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1823. Corporation monies

-STATUTE-
(a) Investment of Corporation's funds
(1) Authority
Funds held in the Deposit Insurance Fund or the FSLIC
Resolution Fund, that are not otherwise employed shall be
invested in obligations of the United States or in obligations
guaranteed as to principal and interest by the United States.
(2) Limitation
The Corporation shall not sell or purchase any obligations
described in paragraph (1) for its own account, at any one time
aggregating in excess of $100,000, without the approval of the
Secretary of the Treasury. The Secretary may approve a
transaction or class of transactions subject to the provisions of
this paragraph under such conditions as the Secretary may
determine.
(b) Depository accounts
The depository accounts of the Corporation shall be kept with the
Treasurer of the United States, or, with the approval of the
Secretary of the Treasury, with a Federal Reserve bank, or with a
depository institution designated as a depository or fiscal agent
of the United States: Provided, That the Secretary of the Treasury
may waive the requirements of this subsection under such conditions
as he may determine: And provided further, That this subsection
shall not apply to the establishment and maintenance in any
depository institution for temporary purposes of depository
accounts not in excess of $50,000 in any one depository
institution, or to the establishment and maintenance in any
depository institution of any depository accounts to facilitate the
payment of insured deposits, or the making of loans to, or the
purchase of assets of, insured depository institutions. When
designated for that purpose by the Secretary of the Treasury, the
Corporation shall be a depositary of public moneys, except receipts
from customs, under such regulations as may be prescribed by the
said Secretary, and may also be employed as a financial agent of
the Government. It shall perform all such reasonable duties as
depositary of public moneys and financial agent of the Government
as may be required of it.
(c) Assistance to insured depository institutions
(1) The Corporation is authorized, in its sole discretion and
upon such terms and conditions as the Board of Directors may
prescribe, to make loans to, to make deposits in, to purchase the
assets or securities of, to assume the liabilities of, or to make
contributions to, any insured depository institution -
(A) if such action is taken to prevent the default of such
insured depository institution;
(B) if, with respect to an insured bank in default, such action
is taken to restore such insured bank to normal operation; or
(C) if, when severe financial conditions exist which threaten
the stability of a significant number of insured depository
institutions or of insured depository institutions possessing
significant financial resources, such action is taken in order to
lessen the risk to the Corporation posed by such insured
depository institution under such threat of instability.

(2)(A) In order to facilitate a merger or consolidation of
another (!1) insured depository institution described in
subparagraph (B) with another insured depository institution or the
sale of any or all of the assets of such insured depository
institution or the assumption of any or all of such insured
depository institution's liabilities by another insured depository
institution, or the acquisition of the stock of such insured
depository institution, the Corporation is authorized, in its sole
discretion and upon such terms and conditions as the Board of
Directors may prescribe -

(i) to purchase any such assets or assume any such liabilities;
(ii) to make loans or contributions to, or deposits in, or
purchase the securities of, such other insured depository
institution or the company which controls or will acquire control
of such other insured depository institution;
(iii) to guarantee such other insured depository institution or
the company which controls or will acquire control of such other
insured depository institution against loss by reason of such
insured institution's merging or consolidating with or assuming
the liabilities and purchasing the assets of such insured
depository institution or by reason of such company acquiring
control of such insured depository institution; or
(iv) to take any combination of the actions referred to in
subparagraphs (i) through (iii).

(B) For the purpose of subparagraph (A), the insured depository
institution must be an insured depository institution -
(i) which is in default;
(ii) which, in the judgment of the Board of Directors, is in
danger of default; or
(iii) which, when severe financial conditions exist which
threaten the stability of a significant number of insured
depository institutions or of insured depository institutions
possessing significant financial resources, is determined by the
Corporation, in its sole discretion, to require assistance under
subparagraph (A) in order to lessen the risk to the Corporation
posed by such insured depository institution under such threat of
instability.

(C) Any action to which the Corporation is or becomes a party by
acquiring any asset or exercising any other authority set forth in
this section shall be stayed for a period of 60 days at the request
of the Corporation.
(3) The Corporation may provide any person acquiring control of,
merging with, consolidating with or acquiring the assets of an
insured depository institution under subsection (f) or (k) of this
section with such financial assistance as it could provide an
insured institution under this subsection.
(4) Least-cost resolution required. -
(A) In general. - Notwithstanding any other provision of this
chapter, the Corporation may not exercise any authority under
this subsection or subsection (d), (f), (h), (i), or (k) of this
section with respect to any insured depository institution unless
-
(i) the Corporation determines that the exercise of such
authority is necessary to meet the obligation of the
Corporation to provide insurance coverage for the insured
deposits in such institution; and
(ii) the total amount of the expenditures by the Corporation
and obligations incurred by the Corporation (including any
immediate and long-term obligation of the Corporation and any
direct or contingent liability for future payment by the
Corporation) in connection with the exercise of any such
authority with respect to such institution is the least costly
to the Deposit Insurance Fund of all possible methods for
meeting the Corporation's obligation under this section.

(B) Determining least costly approach. - In determining how to
satisfy the Corporation's obligations to an institution's insured
depositors at the least possible cost to the Deposit Insurance
Fund, the Corporation shall comply with the following provisions:
(i) Present-value analysis; documentation required. - The
Corporation shall -
(I) evaluate alternatives on a present-value basis, using a
realistic discount rate;
(II) document that evaluation and the assumptions on which
the evaluation is based, including any assumptions with
regard to interest rates, asset recovery rates, asset holding
costs, and payment of contingent liabilities; and
(III) retain the documentation for not less than 5 years.

(ii) Foregone tax revenues. - Federal tax revenues that the
Government would forego as the result of a proposed
transaction, to the extent reasonably ascertainable, shall be
treated as if they were revenues foregone by the Deposit
Insurance Fund.

(C) Time of determination. -
(i) General rule. - For purposes of this subsection, the
determination of the costs of providing any assistance under
paragraph (1) or (2) or any other provision of this section
with respect to any depository institution shall be made as of
the date on which the Corporation makes the determination to
provide such assistance to the institution under this section.
(ii) Rule for liquidations. - For purposes of this
subsection, the determination of the costs of liquidation of
any depository institution shall be made as of the earliest of -

(I) the date on which a conservator is appointed for such
institution;
(II) the date on which a receiver is appointed for such
institution; or
(III) the date on which the Corporation makes any
determination to provide any assistance under this section
with respect to such institution.

(D) Liquidation costs. - In determining the cost of liquidating
any depository institution for the purpose of comparing the costs
under subparagraph (A) (with respect to such institution), the
amount of such cost may not exceed the amount which is equal to
the sum of the insured deposits of such institution as of the
earliest of the dates described in subparagraph (C), minus the
present value of the total net amount the Corporation reasonably
expects to receive from the disposition of the assets of such
institution in connection with such liquidation.
(E) Deposit insurance fund available for intended purpose only.
-
(i) In general. - After December 31, 1994, or at such earlier
time as the Corporation determines to be appropriate, the
Corporation may not take any action, directly or indirectly,
with respect to any insured depository institution that would
have the effect of increasing losses to the Deposit Insurance
Fund by protecting -
(I) depositors for more than the insured portion of
deposits (determined without regard to whether such
institution is liquidated); or
(II) creditors other than depositors.

(ii) Deadline for regulations. - The Corporation shall
prescribe regulations to implement clause (i) not later than
January 1, 1994, and the regulations shall take effect not
later than January 1, 1995.
(iii) Purchase and assumption transactions. - No provision of
this subparagraph shall be construed as prohibiting the
Corporation from allowing any person who acquires any assets or
assumes any liabilities of any insured depository institution
for which the Corporation has been appointed conservator or
receiver to acquire uninsured deposit liabilities of such
institution so long as the insurance fund does not incur any
loss with respect to such deposit liabilities in an amount
greater than the loss which would have been incurred with
respect to such liabilities if the institution had been
liquidated.

(F) Discretionary determinations. - Any determination which the
Corporation may make under this paragraph shall be made in the
sole discretion of the Corporation.
(G) Systemic risk. -
(i) Emergency determination by secretary of the treasury. -
Notwithstanding subparagraphs (A) and (E), if, upon the written
recommendation of the Board of Directors (upon a vote of not
less than two-thirds of the members of the Board of Directors)
and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (upon
a vote of not less than two-thirds of the members of such
Board), the Secretary of the Treasury (in consultation with the
President) determines that -
(I) the Corporation's compliance with subparagraphs (A) and
(E) with respect to an insured depository institution for
which the Corporation has been appointed receiver would have
serious adverse effects on economic conditions or financial
stability; and
(II) any action or assistance under this subparagraph would
avoid or mitigate such adverse effects,

the Corporation may take other action or provide assistance
under this section for the purpose of winding up the insured
depository institution for which the Corporation has been
appointed receiver as necessary to avoid or mitigate such
effects.
(ii) Repayment of loss. -
(I) In general. - The Corporation shall recover the loss to
the Deposit Insurance Fund arising from any action taken or
assistance provided with respect to an insured depository
institution under clause (i) from 1 or more special
assessments on insured depository institutions, depository
institution holding companies (with the concurrence of the
Secretary of the Treasury with respect to holding companies),
or both, as the Corporation determines to be appropriate.
(II) Treatment of depository institution holding companies.
- For purposes of this clause, sections 1817(c)(2) and
1828(h) of this title shall apply to depository institution
holding companies as if they were insured depository
institutions.
(III) Regulations. - The Corporation shall prescribe such
regulations as it deems necessary to implement this clause.
In prescribing such regulations, defining terms, and setting
the appropriate assessment rate or rates, the Corporation
shall establish rates sufficient to cover the losses incurred
as a result of the actions of the Corporation under clause
(i) and shall consider: the types of entities that benefit
from any action taken or assistance provided under this
subparagraph; economic conditions, the effects on the
industry, and such other factors as the Corporation deems
appropriate and relevant to the action taken or the
assistance provided. Any funds so collected that exceed
actual losses shall be placed in the Deposit Insurance Fund.

(iii) Documentation required. - The Secretary of the Treasury
shall -
(I) document any determination under clause (i); and
(II) retain the documentation for review under clause (iv).

(iv) GAO review. - The Comptroller General of the United
States shall review and report to the Congress on any
determination under clause (i), including -
(I) the basis for the determination;
(II) the purpose for which any action was taken pursuant to
such clause; and
(III) the likely effect of the determination and such
action on the incentives and conduct of insured depository
institutions and uninsured depositors.

(v) Notice. -
(I) In general. - Not later than 3 days after making a
determination under clause (i), the Secretary of the Treasury
shall provide written notice of any determination under
clause (i) to the Committee on Banking, Housing, and Urban
Affairs of the Senate and the Committee on Banking, Finance
and Urban Affairs of the House of Representatives.
(II) Description of basis of determination. - The notice
under subclause (I) shall include a description of the basis
for any determination under clause (i).

(H) Rule of construction. - No provision of law shall be
construed as permitting the Corporation to take any action
prohibited by paragraph (4) unless such provision expressly
provides, by direct reference to this paragraph, that this
paragraph shall not apply with respect to such action.

(5) The Corporation may not use its authority under this
subsection to purchase the voting or common stock of an insured
depository institution. Nothing in the preceding sentence shall be
construed to limit the ability of the Corporation to enter into and
enforce covenants and agreements that it determines to be necessary
to protect its financial interest.
(6)(A) During any period in which an insured depository
institution has received assistance under this subsection and such
assistance is still outstanding, such insured depository
institution may defer the payment of any State or local tax which
is determined on the basis of the deposits held by such insured
depository institution or of the interest or dividends paid on such
deposits.
(B) When such insured depository institution no longer has any
outstanding assistance, such insured depository institution shall
pay all taxes which were deferred under subparagraph (A). Such
payments shall be made in accordance with a payment plan
established by the Corporation, after consultation with the
applicable State and local taxing authorities.
(7) The transfer of any assets or liabilities associated with any
trust business of an insured depository institution in default
under subparagraph (2)(A) shall be effective without any State or
Federal approval, assignment, or consent with respect thereto.
(8) Assistance before appointment of conservator or receiver. -
(A) In general. - Subject to the least-cost provisions of
paragraph (4), the Corporation shall consider providing direct
financial assistance under this section for depository
institutions before the appointment of a conservator or receiver
for such institution only under the following circumstances:
(i) Troubled condition criteria. - The Corporation determines
-
(I) grounds for the appointment of a conservator or
receiver exist or likely will exist in the future unless the
depository institution's capital levels are increased; and
(II) it is unlikely that the institution can meet all
currently applicable capital standards without assistance.

(ii) Other criteria. - The depository institution meets the
following criteria:
(I) The appropriate Federal banking agency and the
Corporation have determined that, during such period of time
preceding the date of such determination as the agency or the
Corporation considers to be relevant, the institution's
management has been competent and has complied with
applicable laws, rules, and supervisory directives and
orders.
(II) The institution's management did not engage in any
insider dealing, speculative practice, or other abusive
activity.

(B) Public disclosure. - Any determination under this paragraph
to provide assistance under this section shall be made in writing
and published in the Federal Register.

(9) Any assistance provided under this subsection may be in
subordination to the rights of depositors and other creditors.
(10) In its annual report to the Congress, the Corporation shall
report the total amount it has saved, or estimates it has saved, by
exercising the authority provided in this subsection.
(11) Unenforceability of certain agreements. - No provision
contained in any existing or future standstill, confidentiality, or
other agreement that, directly or indirectly -
(A) affects, restricts, or limits the ability of any person to
offer to acquire or acquire,
(B) prohibits any person from offering to acquire or acquiring,
or
(C) prohibits any person from using any previously disclosed
information in connection with any such offer to acquire or
acquisition of,

all or part of any insured depository institution, including any
liabilities, assets, or interest therein, in connection with any
transaction in which the Corporation exercises its authority under
section 1821 of this title or this section, shall be enforceable
against or impose any liability on such person, as such enforcement
or liability shall be contrary to public policy.
(d) Sale of assets to Corporation
(1) In general
Any conservator, receiver, or liquidator appointed for any
insured depository institution in default, including the
Corporation acting in such capacity, shall be entitled to offer
the assets of such depository institutions for sale to the
Corporation or as security for loans from the Corporation.
(2) Proceeds
The proceeds of every sale or loan of assets to the Corporation
shall be utilized for the same purposes and in the same manner as
other funds realized from the liquidation of the assets of such
depository institutions.
(3) Rights and powers of Corporation
(A) In general
With respect to any asset acquired or liability assumed
pursuant to this section, the Corporation shall have all of the
rights, powers, privileges, and authorities of the Corporation
as receiver under sections 1821 and 1825(b) of this title.
(B) Rule of construction
Such rights, powers, privileges, and authorities shall be in
addition to and not in derogation of any rights, powers,
privileges, and authorities otherwise applicable to the
Corporation.
(C) Fiduciary responsibility
In exercising any right, power, privilege, or authority
described in subparagraph (A), the Corporation shall continue
to be subject to the fiduciary duties and obligations of the
Corporation as receiver to claimants against the insured
depository institution in receivership.
(D) Disposition of assets
In exercising any right, power, privilege, or authority
described in subparagraph (A) regarding the sale or disposition
of assets sold to the Corporation pursuant to paragraph (1),
the Corporation shall conduct its operations in a manner which -

(i) maximizes the net present value return from the sale or
disposition of such assets;
(ii) minimizes the amount of any loss realized in the
resolution of cases;
(iii) ensures adequate competition and fair and consistent
treatment of offerors;
(iv) prohibits discrimination on the basis of race, sex, or
ethnic groups in the solicitation and consideration of
offers; and
(v) maximizes the preservation of the availability and
affordability of residential real property for low- and
moderate-income individuals.
(4) Loans
The Corporation, in its discretion, may make loans on the
security of or may purchase and liquidate or sell any part of the
assets of an insured depository institution which is now or may
hereafter be in default.
(e) Agreements against interests of Corporation
(1) In general
No agreement which tends to diminish or defeat the interest of
the Corporation in any asset acquired by it under this section or
section 1821 of this title, either as security for a loan or by
purchase or as receiver of any insured depository institution,
shall be valid against the Corporation unless such agreement -
(A) is in writing,
(B) was executed by the depository institution and any person
claiming an adverse interest thereunder, including the obligor,
contemporaneously with the acquisition of the asset by the
depository institution,
(C) was approved by the board of directors of the depository
institution or its loan committee, which approval shall be
reflected in the minutes of said board or committee, and
(D) has been, continuously, from the time of its execution,
an official record of the depository institution.
(2) Exemptions from contemporaneous execution requirement
An agreement to provide for the lawful collateralization of -
(A) deposits of, or other credit extension by, a Federal,
State, or local governmental entity, or of any depositor
referred to in section 1821(a)(2) of this title, including an
agreement to provide collateral in lieu of a surety bond;
(B) bankruptcy estate funds pursuant to section 345(b)(2) of
title 11;
(C) extensions of credit, including any overdraft, from a
Federal reserve bank or Federal home loan bank; or
(D) one or more qualified financial contracts, as defined in
section 1821(e)(8)(D) of this title,

shall not be deemed invalid pursuant to paragraph (1)(B) solely
because such agreement was not executed contemporaneously with
the acquisition of the collateral or because of pledges,
delivery, or substitution of the collateral made in accordance
with such agreement.
(f) Assisted emergency interstate acquisitions
(1) This subsection shall apply only to an acquisition of an
insured bank or a holding company by an out-of-State bank (!2)
savings association or out-of-State holding company for which the
Corporation provides assistance under subsection (c) of this
section.

(2)(A) Whenever an insured bank with total assets of $500,000,000
or more (as determined from its most recent report of condition) is
in default, the Corporation, as receiver, may, in its discretion
and upon such terms and conditions as the Corporation may
determine, arrange the sale of assets of the bank in default and
the assumption of the liabilities of the bank in default, including
the sale of such assets to and the assumption of such liabilities
by an insured depository institution located in the State where the
bank in default was chartered but established by an out-of-State
bank or holding company. Where otherwise lawfully required, a
transaction under this subsection must be approved by the primary
Federal or State supervisor of all parties thereto.
(B)(i) Before making a determination to take any action under
subparagraph (A), the Corporation shall consult the State bank
supervisor of the State in which the insured bank in default was
chartered.
(ii) The State bank supervisor shall be given a reasonable
opportunity, and in no event less than forty-eight hours, to object
to the use of the provisions of this paragraph. Such notice may be
provided by the Corporation prior to its appointment as receiver,
but in anticipation of an impending appointment.
(iii) If the State supervisor objects during such period, the
Corporation may use the authority of this paragraph only by a vote
of 75 percent of the Board of Directors. The Board of Directors
shall provide to the State supervisor, as soon as practicable, a
written certification of its determination.
(3) Emergency Interstate Acquisitions of Insured Banks in Danger
of Default. -
(A) Acquisition of insured banks in danger of default. - One or
more out-of-State banks or out-of-State holding companies may
acquire and retain all or part of the shares or assets of, or
otherwise acquire and retain -
(i) an insured bank in danger of default which has total
assets of $500,000,000 or more; or
(ii) 2 or more affiliated insured banks in danger of default
which have aggregate total assets of $500,000,000 or more, if
the aggregate total assets of such banks is equal to or greater
than 33 percent of the aggregate total assets of all affiliated
insured banks.

(B) Acquisition of a holding company or other bank affiliate. -
If one or more out-of-State banks or out-of-State holding
companies acquire 1 or more affiliated insured banks under
subparagraph (A) the aggregate total assets of which is equal to
or greater than 33 percent of the aggregate total assets of all
affiliated insured banks, any such out-of-State bank or out-of-
State holding company may also, as part of the same transaction,
acquire and retain the shares or assets of, or otherwise acquire
and retain -
(i) the holding company which controls the affiliated insured
banks so acquired; or
(ii) any other affiliated insured bank.

(C) Request for assistance by corporate board of directors. -
The Corporation may assist an acquisition or merger authorized
under subparagraph (A) only if the board of directors or trustees
of each insured bank in danger of default which is being acquired
has requested in writing that the Corporation assist the
acquisition or merger.
(D) Certain acquisitions authorized after assistance is
provided. - Notwithstanding paragraph (1), if -
(i) at any time after August 10, 1987, the Corporation
provides any assistance under subsection (c) of this section to
an insured bank; and
(ii) at the time such assistance is granted, the insured
bank, the holding company which controls the insured bank (if
any), or any affiliated insured bank is eligible to be acquired
by an out-of-State bank or out-of-State holding company under
this paragraph,

the insured bank, the holding company, and such other affiliated
insured bank shall remain eligible, subject to such terms and
conditions as the Corporation (in the Corporation's discretion)
may impose, to be acquired by an out-of-State bank or out-of-
State holding company under this paragraph as long as any
portion of such assistance remains outstanding.
(E) State bank supervisor approval. - The Corporation may take
no final action in connection with any acquisition under this
paragraph unless the State bank supervisor of the State in which
the bank in danger of default is located approves the
acquisition.
(F) Other requirements not affected. - This paragraph does not
affect any other requirement under Federal or State law for
regulatory approval of an acquisition under this paragraph.
(G) Acquisition may be conditioned on receipt of consideration
for corporation's assistance. - Any acquisition described in
subparagraph (D) may be conditioned on the receipt of such
consideration for the Corporation's assistance as the Board of
Directors deems appropriate.

(4)(A) Acquisitions Not Subject to Certain Other Laws. - Section
1842(d) of this title, any provision of State law, and section
1730a(e)(3) (!3) of this title shall not apply to prohibit any
acquisition under paragraph (2) or (3), except that an out-of-State
bank may make such an acquisition only if such ownership is
otherwise specifically authorized.

(B) Any subsidiary created by operation of this subsection may
retain and operate any existing branch or branches of the
institution merged with or acquired under paragraph (2) or (3), but
otherwise shall be subject to the conditions upon which a national
bank may establish and operate branches in the State in which such
insured institution is located.
(C) No insured institution acquired under this subsection shall
after it is acquired move its principal office or any branch office
which it would be prohibited from moving if the institution were a
national bank.
(D) Subsequent Nonemergency Interstate Acquisitions Subject to
State Law. -
(i) In general. - Any out-of-State bank holding company which
acquires control of an insured bank in any State under paragraph
(2) or (3) may acquire any other insured bank and establish
branches in such State to the same extent as a bank holding
company whose insured bank subsidiaries' operations are
principally conducted in such State may acquire any other insured
bank or establish branches.
(ii) Delayed date of applicability. - Clause (i) shall not
apply with respect to any out-of-State bank holding company
referred to in such clause before the earlier of -
(I) the end of the 2-year period beginning on the date the
acquisition referred to in such clause with respect to such
company is consummated; or
(II) the end of any period established under State law during
which such out-of-State bank holding company may not be treated
as a bank holding company whose insured bank subsidiaries'
operations are principally conducted in such State for purposes
of acquiring other insured banks or establishing bank branches.

(iii) Determination of principally conducted. - For purposes of
this subparagraph, the State in which the operations of a holding
company's insured bank subsidiaries are principally conducted is
the State determined under section 1842(d) of this title with
respect to such holding company.

(E) Certain State Interstate Banking Laws Inapplicable. - Any
holding company which acquires control of any insured bank or
holding company under paragraph (2) or (3) or subparagraph (D) of
this paragraph shall not, by reason of such acquisition, be
required under the law of any State to divest any other insured
bank or be prevented from acquiring any other bank or holding
company.
(5) In determining whether to arrange a sale of assets and
assumption of liabilities or an acquisition or a merger under the
authority of paragraph (2) or (3), the Corporation may solicit such
offers or proposals as are practicable from any prospective
purchasers or merger partners it determines, in its sole
discretion, are both qualified and capable of acquiring the assets
and liabilities of the bank in default or the bank in danger of
default.
(6)(A) If, after receiving offers, the offer presenting the
lowest expense to the Corporation, that is in a form and with
conditions acceptable to the Corporation (hereinafter referred to
as the "lowest acceptable offer"), is from an offeror that is not
an existing in-State bank of the same type as the bank that is in
default or is in danger of default (or, where the bank is an
insured bank other than a mutual savings bank, the lowest
acceptable offer is not from an in-State holding company), the
Corporation shall permit the offeror which made the initial lowest
acceptable offer and each offeror who made an offer the estimated
cost of which to the Corporation was within 15 per centum or
$15,000,000, whichever is less, of the initial lowest acceptable
offer to submit a new offer.
(B) In considering authorizations under this subsection, the
Corporation shall give consideration to the need to minimize the
cost of financial assistance and to the maintenance of specialized
depository institutions. The Corporation shall authorize
transactions under this subsection considering the following
priorities:
(i) First, between depository institutions of the same type
within the same State.
(ii) Second, between depository institutions of the same type -

(I) in different States which by statute specifically
authorize such acquisitions; or
(II) in the absence of such statutes, in different States
which are contiguous.

(iii) Third, between depository institutions of the same type
in different States other than the States described in clause
(ii).
(iv) Fourth, between depository institutions of different types
in the same State.
(v) Fifth, between depository institutions of different types -

(I) in different States which by statute specifically
authorize such acquisitions; or
(II) in the absence of such statutes, in different States
which are contiguous.

(vi) Sixth, between depository institutions of different types
in different States other than the States described in clause
(v).

(C) Minority Bank Priority. - In the case of a minority-
controlled bank, the Corporation shall seek an offer from other
minority-controlled banks before proceeding with the bidding
priorities set forth in subparagraph (B).
(D) In determining the cost of offers and reoffers, the
Corporation's calculations and estimations shall be determinative.
The Corporation may set reasonable time limits on offers and
reoffers.
(7) No sale may be made under the provisions of paragraph (2) or
(3) -
(A) which would result in a monopoly, or which would be in
furtherance of any combination or conspiracy to monopolize or to
attempt to monopolize the business of banking in any part of the
United States;
(B) whose effect in any section of the country may be
substantially to lessen competition, or to tend to create a
monopoly, or which in any other manner would be in restraint of
trade, unless the Corporation finds that the anticompetitive
effects of the proposed transactions are clearly outweighed in
the public interest by the probable effect of the transaction in
meeting the convenience and needs of the community to be served;
or
(C) if in the opinion of the Corporation the acquisition
threatens the safety and soundness of the acquirer or does not
result in the future viability of the resulting depository
institution.

(8) As used in this subsection -
(A) the term "in-State depository institution or in-State
holding company" means an existing insured depository institution
currently operating in the State in which the bank in default or
the bank in danger of default is chartered or a company that is
operating an insured depository institution subsidiary in the
State in which the bank in default or the bank in danger of
default is chartered;
(B) the term "acquire" means to acquire, directly or
indirectly, ownership or control through -
(i) an acquisition of shares;
(ii) an acquisition of assets or assumption of liabilities;
(iii) a merger or consolidation; or
(iv) any similar transaction;

(C) the term "affiliated insured bank" means -
(i) when used in connection with a reference to a holding
company, an insured bank which is a subsidiary of such holding
company; and
(ii) when used in connection with a reference to 2 or more
insured banks, insured banks which are subsidiaries of the same
holding company; and

(D) the term "subsidiary" has the meaning given to such term in
section 1841(d) of this title.

(9) No Assistance Authorized for Certain Subsidiaries of Holding
Companies. -
(A) In general. - The Corporation shall not provide any
assistance to a subsidiary, other than a subsidiary that is an
insured depository institution, of a holding company in
connection with any acquisition under this subsection.
(B) Intermediate holding company permitted. - This paragraph
does not prohibit an intermediate holding company or an affiliate
of an insured depository institution from being a conduit for
assistance ultimately intended for an insured bank.

(10) Annual Report. -
(A) Required. - In its annual report to Congress the
Corporation shall include a report on the acquisitions under this
subsection during the preceding year.
(B) Contents. - The report required under subparagraph (A)
shall contain the following information:
(i) The number of acquisitions under this subsection.
(ii) A brief description of each such acquisition and the
circumstances under which such acquisition occurred.

(11) Determination of Total Assets. - For purposes of this
subsection, the total assets of any insured bank shall be
determined on the basis of the most recent report of condition of
such bank which is available at the time of such determination.
(12) Acquisition of minority bank by minority bank holding
company without regard to asset size. -
(A) In general. - For the purpose of ensuring continued
minority control of a minority-controlled bank, paragraphs (2)
and (3) shall apply with respect to the acquisition of a minority-
controlled bank by an out-of-State minority-controlled
depository institution or depository institution holding company
without regard to the fact that the total assets of such minority-
controlled bank are less than $500,000,000.
(B) Definitions. - For purposes of this paragraph:
(i) Minority bank. - The term "minority bank" means any
depository institution described in clause (i), (ii), or (iii)
of section 461(b)(1)(A) of this title -
(I) more than 50 percent of the ownership or control of
which is held by one or more minority individuals; and
(II) more than 50 percent of the net profit or loss of
which accrues to minority individuals.

(ii) Minority. - The term "minority" means any Black
American, Native American, Hispanic American, or Asian
American.
(g) Payment of interest on stock subscriptions
Prior to July 1, 1951, the Corporation shall pay out of its
capital account to the Secretary of the Treasury an amount equal to
2 per centum simple interest per annum on amounts advanced to the
Corporation on stock subscriptions by the Secretary of the Treasury
and the Federal Reserve banks, from the time of such advances until
the amounts thereof were repaid. The amount payable hereunder shall
be paid in two equal installments, the first installment to be paid
prior to December 31, 1950.
(h) Reopening or aversion of closing of insured branch of foreign
bank
The powers conferred on the Board of Directors and the
Corporation by this section to take action to reopen an insured
depository institution in default or to avert the default of an
insured depository institution may be used with respect to an
insured branch of a foreign bank if, in the judgment of the Board
of Directors, the public interest in avoiding the default of such
branch substantially outweighs any additional risk of loss to the
Deposit Insurance Fund which the exercise of such powers would
entail.
(i) Repealed. Pub. L. 97-320, title II, Sec. 206, Oct. 15, 1982, 96
Stat. 1496
(j) Loan loss amortization for certain banks
(1) Eligibility
The appropriate Federal banking agency shall permit an
agricultural bank to take the actions referred to in paragraph
(2) if it finds that -
(A) there is no evidence that fraud or criminal abuse on the
part of the bank led to the losses referred to in paragraph
(2); and
(B) the agricultural bank has a plan to restore its capital,
not later than the close of the amortization period established
under paragraph (2), to a level prescribed by the appropriate
Federal banking agency.
(2) Seven-year loss amortization
(A) Any loss on any qualified agricultural loan that an
agricultural bank would otherwise be required to show on its
annual financial statement for any year between December 31,
1983, and January 1, 1992, may be amortized on its financial
statements over a period of not to exceed 7 years, as provided in
regulations issued by the appropriate Federal banking agency.
(B) An agricultural bank may reappraise any real estate or
other property, real or personal, that it acquired coincident to
the making of a qualified agricultural loan and that it owned on
January 1, 1983, and any such additional property that it
acquires prior to January 1, 1992. Any loss that such bank would
otherwise be required to show on its annual financial statements
as the result of any such reappraisal may be amortized on its
financial statements over a period of not to exceed 7 years, as
provided in regulations issued by the appropriate Federal banking
agency.
(3) Regulations
Not later than 90 days after August 10, 1987, the appropriate
Federal banking agency shall issue regulations implementing this
subsection with respect to banks that it supervises, including
regulations implementing the capital restoration requirement of
paragraph (1)(B).
(4) Definitions
As used in this subsection -
(A) the term "agricultural bank" means a bank -
(i) the deposits of which are insured by the Federal
Deposit Insurance Corporation;
(ii) which is located in an area the economy of which is
dependent on agriculture;
(iii) which has assets of $100,000,000 or less; and
(iv) which has -
(I) at least 25 percent of its total loans in qualified
agricultural loans; or
(II) fewer than 25 percent of its total loans in
qualified agricultural loans but which the appropriate
Federal banking agency or State bank commissioner
recommends to the Corporation for eligibility under this
section, or which the Corporation, on its motion, deems
eligible; and

(B) the term "qualified agricultural loan" means a loan made
to finance the production of agricultural products or livestock
in the United States, a loan secured by farmland or farm
machinery, or such other category of loans as the appropriate
Federal banking agency may deem eligible.
(5) Maintenance of portfolio
As a condition of eligibility under this subsection, the
agricultural bank must agree to maintain in its loan portfolio a
percentage of agricultural loans which is not lower than the
percentage of such loans in its loan portfolio on January 1,
1986.
(k) Emergency acquisitions
(1) In general
(A) Acquisitions authorized
(i) Transactions described
Notwithstanding any provision of State law, upon
determining that severe financial conditions threaten the
stability of a significant number of savings associations, or
of savings associations possessing significant financial
resources, the Corporation, in its discretion and if it
determines such authorization would lessen the risk to the
Corporation, may authorize -
(I) a savings association that is eligible for assistance
pursuant to subsection (c) of this section to merge or
consolidate with, or to transfer its assets and liabilities
to, any other savings association or any insured bank,
(II) any other savings association to acquire control of
such savings association, or
(III) any company to acquire control of such savings
association or to acquire the assets or assume the
liabilities thereof.

The Corporation may not authorize any transaction under this
subsection unless the Corporation determines that the
authorization will not present a substantial risk to the
safety or soundness of the savings association to be acquired
or any acquiring entity.
(ii) Terms of transactions
Mergers, consolidations, transfers, and acquisitions under
this subsection shall be on such terms as the Corporation
shall provide.
(iii) Approval by appropriate agency
Where otherwise required by law, transactions under this
subsection must be approved by the appropriate Federal
banking agency of every party thereto.
(iv) Acquisitions by savings associations
Any Federal savings association that acquires another
savings association pursuant to clause (i) may, with the
concurrence of the Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision, hold that savings association as a subsidiary
notwithstanding the percentage limitations of section
1464(c)(4)(B) of this title.
(v) Dual service
Dual service by a management official that would otherwise
be prohibited under the Depository Institution Management
Interlocks Act [12 U.S.C. 3201 et seq.] may, with the
approval of the Corporation, continue for up to 10 years.
(vi) Continued applicability of certain State restrictions
Nothing in this subsection overrides or supersedes State
laws restricting or limiting the activities of a savings
association on behalf of another entity.
(B) Consultation with State official
(i) Consultation required
Before making a determination to take any action under
subparagraph (A), the Corporation shall consult the State
official having jurisdiction of the acquired institution.
(ii) Period for State response
The official shall be given a reasonable opportunity, and
in no event less than 48 hours, to object to the use of the
provisions of this paragraph. Such notice may be provided by
the Corporation prior to its appointment as receiver, but in
anticipation of an impending appointment.
(iii) Approval over objection of State official
If the official objects during such period, the Corporation
may use the authority of this paragraph only by a vote of 75
percent or more of the voting members of the Board of
Directors. The Corporation shall provide to the official, as
soon as practicable, a written certification of its
determination.
(2) Solicitation of offers
(A) In general
In considering authorizations under this subsection, the
Corporation may solicit such offers or proposals as are
practicable from any prospective purchasers or merger partners
it determines, in its sole discretion, are both qualified and
capable of acquiring the assets and liabilities of the savings
association.
(B) Minority-controlled institutions
In the case of a minority-controlled depository institution,
the Corporation shall seek an offer from other minority-
controlled depository institutions before seeking an offer
from other persons or entities.
(3) Determination of costs
In determining the cost of offers under this subsection, the
Corporation's calculations and estimations shall be
determinative. The Corporation may set reasonable time limits on
offers.
(4) Branching provisions
(A) In general
If a merger, consolidation, transfer, or acquisition under
this subsection involves a savings association eligible for
assistance and a bank or bank holding company, a savings
association may retain and operate any existing branch or
branches or any other existing facilities. If the savings
association continues to exist as a separate entity, it may
establish and operate new branches to the same extent as any
savings association that is not affiliated with a bank holding
company and the home office of which is located in the same
State.
(B) Restrictions
(i) In general
Notwithstanding subparagraph (A), if -
(I) a savings association described in such subparagraph
does not have its home office in the State of the bank
holding company bank subsidiary, and
(II) such association does not qualify as a domestic
building and loan association under section 7701(a)(19) of
title 26, or does not meet the asset composition test
imposed by subparagraph (C) of that section on institutions
seeking so to qualify,

such savings association shall be subject to the conditions
upon which a bank may retain, operate, and establish branches
in the State in which the savings association is located.
(ii) Transition period
The Corporation, for good cause shown, may allow a savings
association up to 2 years to comply with the requirements of
clause (i).
(5) Assistance before appointment of conservator or receiver
(A) Assistance proposals
The Corporation shall consider proposals by savings
associations for assistance pursuant to subsection (c) of this
section before grounds exist for appointment of a conservator
or receiver for such member under the following circumstances:
(i) Troubled condition criteria
The Corporation determines -
(I) that grounds for appointment of a conservator or
receiver exist or likely will exist in the future unless
the member's tangible capital is increased;
(II) that it is unlikely that the member can achieve
positive tangible capital without assistance; and
(III) that providing assistance pursuant to the member's
proposal would be likely to lessen the risk to the
Corporation.
(ii) Other criteria
The member meets the following criteria:
(I) Before August 9, 1989, the member was solvent under
applicable regulatory accounting principles but had
negative tangible capital.
(II) The member's negative tangible capital position is
substantially attributable to its participation in
acquisition and merger transactions that were instituted by
the Federal Home Loan Bank Board or the Federal Savings and
Loan Insurance Corporation for supervisory reasons.
(III) The member is a qualified thrift lender (as defined
in section 1467a(m) of this title) or would be a qualified
thrift lender if commercial real estate owned and
nonperforming commercial loans acquired in acquisition and
merger transactions that were instituted by the Federal
Home Loan Bank Board or the Federal Savings and Loan
Insurance Corporation for supervisory reasons were excluded
from the member's total assets.
(IV) The appropriate Federal banking agency has
determined that the member's management is competent and
has complied with applicable laws, rules, and supervisory
directives and orders.
(V) The member's management did not engage in insider
dealing or speculative practices or other activities that
jeopardized the member's safety and soundness or
contributed to its impaired capital position.
(VI) The member's offices are located in an economically
depressed region.
(B) Corporation consideration of assistance proposal
If a member meets the requirements of clauses (i) and (ii) of
subparagraph (A), the Corporation shall consider providing
direct financial assistance.
(C) "Economically depressed region" defined
For purposes of this paragraph, the term "economically
depressed region" means any geographical region which the
Corporation determines by regulation to be a region within
which real estate values have suffered serious decline due to
severe economic conditions, such as a decline in energy or
agricultural values or prices.

-SOURCE-
(Sept. 21, 1950, ch. 967, Sec. 2[13], 64 Stat. 888; Pub. L. 95-369,
Sec. 6(c)(24), Sept. 17, 1978, 92 Stat. 619; Pub. L. 97-320, title
I, Secs. 111, 113(m), 116, 141(a)(1), (3), title II, Secs. 203,
206, Oct. 15, 1982, 96 Stat. 1469, 1474, 1476, 1488, 1489, 1492,
1496; Pub. L. 97-457, Secs. 1(a), 4, 10(a), Jan. 12, 1983, 96 Stat.
2507, 2508; Pub. L. 98-29, Sec. 1(a), May 16, 1983, 97 Stat. 189;
Pub. L. 100-86, title V, Secs. 502(a)-(g), (i), 509(a), title VIII,
Sec. 801, Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 623-627, 629, 635, 656; Pub. L.
101-73, title II, Secs. 201(a), 217, Aug. 9, 1989, 103 Stat. 187,
254; Pub. L. 102-242, title I, Secs. 123(b), 141(a)(1), (e), Dec.
19, 1991, 105 Stat. 2252, 2273, 2278; Pub. L. 103-325, title III,
Sec. 317, title VI, Sec. 602(a)(34)-(42), Sept. 23, 1994, 108 Stat.
2223, 2289, 2290; Pub. L. 104-208, div. A, title II, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M), Sept. 30, 1996, 110 Stat. 3009-492; Pub. L. 109-8,
title IX, Sec. 909, Apr. 20, 2005, 119 Stat. 183; Pub. L. 109-171,
title II, Sec. 2102(b), Feb. 8, 2006, 120 Stat. 9; Pub. L. 109-173,
Secs. 3(a)(8), 8(a)(19), Feb. 15, 2006, 119 Stat. 3606, 3613; Pub.
L. 110-343, div. A, title I, Sec. 126(c), Oct. 3, 2008, 122 Stat.
3795; Pub. L. 111-22, div. A, title II, Sec. 204(d), May 20, 2009,
123 Stat. 1650; Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Sec. 363(6), title XI,
Sec. 1106(b), July 21, 2010, 124 Stat. 1553, 2125.)


-STATAMEND-
AMENDMENT OF SUBSECTION (K)(1)(A)(IV)
Pub. L. 111-203, title III, Secs. 351, 363(6), July 21, 2010, 124
Stat. 1546, 1553, provided that, effective on the transfer date,
subsection (k)(1)(A)(iv) of this section is amended by substituting
"Comptroller of the Currency" for "Director of the Office of Thrift
Supervision". See Effective Date of 2010 Amendment note below.

-REFTEXT-
REFERENCES IN TEXT
Section 1730a of this title, referred to in subsec. (f)(4)(A),
was repealed by Pub. L. 101-73, title IV, Sec. 407, Aug. 9, 1989,
103 Stat. 363.
The Depository Institution Management Interlocks Act, referred to
in subsec. (k)(1)(A)(v), is title II of Pub. L. 95-630, Nov. 10,
1978, 92 Stat. 3672, as amended, which is classified principally to
chapter 33 (Sec. 3201 et seq.) of this title. For complete
classification of this Act to the Code, see Short Title note set
out under section 3201 of this title and Tables.


-MISC1-
PRIOR PROVISIONS
Section is derived from subsec. (n) of former section 264 of this
title. See Codification note set out under section 1811 of this
title.

AMENDMENTS
2010 - Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(i). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 1106(b)(1)(B),
inserted "for the purpose of winding up the insured depository
institution for which the Corporation has been appointed receiver"
after "provide assistance under this section" in concluding
provisions.
Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(i)(I). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 1106(b)(1)(A),
inserted "for which the Corporation has been appointed receiver"
before "would have serious".
Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(v)(I). Pub. L. 111-203, Sec. 1106(b)(2),
substituted "Not later than 3 days after making a determination
under clause (i), the" for "The".
2009 - Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(ii). Pub. L. 111-22 amended cl. (ii)
generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "The
Corporation shall recover the loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund
arising from any action taken or assistance provided with respect
to an insured depository institution under clause (i) expeditiously
from 1 or more emergency special assessments on insured depository
institutions equal to the product of -
"(I) an assessment rate established by the Corporation; and
"(II) the amount of each insured depository institution's
average total assets during the assessment period, minus the sum
of the amount of the institution's average total tangible equity
and the amount of the institution's average total subordinated
debt."
2008 - Subsec. (c)(11). Pub. L. 110-343 added par. (11).
2006 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(B),
substituted "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank Insurance Fund, the
Savings Association Insurance Fund,".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(i).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (c)(4)(A)(ii), (B). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(A),
substituted "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "deposit insurance fund"
wherever appearing.
Subsec. (c)(4)(E). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(C)(i),
substituted "fund" for "funds" in heading.
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M)(ii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (c)(4)(E)(i). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(C)(ii),
substituted "the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "any insurance fund"
in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(ii). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(D)(i),
(ii), in introductory provisions, substituted "Deposit Insurance
Fund" for "appropriate insurance fund" and "insured depository
institutions" for "the members of the insurance fund (of which such
institution is a member)".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M)(iii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(ii)(II). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec.
8(a)(19)(D)(iii), (iv), substituted "the institution's" for "the
member's" in two places and substituted "each insured depository
institution's" for "each member's".
Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 3(a)(8), substituted "assessment period"
for "semiannual period".
Subsec. (c)(11). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(E), struck out
par. (11) which read as follows: "Payments made under this
subsection shall be made -
"(A) from the Bank Insurance Fund in the case of payments to or
on behalf of a member of such Fund; or
"(B) from the Savings Association Insurance Fund or from funds
made available by the Resolution Trust Corporation in the case of
payments to or on behalf of any Savings Association Insurance
Fund member."
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M)(iv). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(F), substituted
"Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank Insurance Fund".
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(v).
See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (k)(4)(B)(i). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(G),
substituted "savings association is" for "Savings Association
Insurance Fund member is" in concluding provisions.
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M)(vi). See 1996 Amendment note below.
Subsec. (k)(5)(A). Pub. L. 109-173, Sec. 8(a)(19)(H), substituted
"savings associations" for "Savings Association Insurance Fund
members" in introductory provisions.
Pub. L. 109-171 repealed Pub. L. 104-208, Sec.
2704(d)(14)(M)(vii). See 1996 Amendment note below.
2005 - Subsec. (e)(2). Pub. L. 109-8 amended heading and text of
par. (2) generally. Prior to amendment, text read as follows: "An
agreement to provide for the lawful collateralization of deposits
of a Federal, State, or local governmental entity or of any
depositor referred to in section 1821(a)(2) of this title shall not
be deemed to be invalid pursuant to paragraph (1)(B) solely because
such agreement was not executed contemporaneously with the
acquisition of the collateral or with any changes in the collateral
made in accordance with such agreement."
1996 - Subsec. (a)(1). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(i),
which directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund, the Special
Reserve of the Deposit Insurance Fund," for "Bank Insurance Fund,
the Savings Association Insurance Fund,", was repealed by Pub. L.
109-171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
Subsec. (c)(4)(E). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(ii),
which directed substitution of "fund" for "funds" in heading and
"the Deposit Insurance Fund" for "any insurance fund" in cl. (i),
was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (c)(4)(G)(ii). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(iii),
which directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for
"appropriate insurance fund", "insured depository institutions" for
"the members of the insurance fund (of which such institution is a
member)", "each insured depository institution's" for "each
member's", and "the institution's" for "the member's" in two
places, was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective Date of 1996
Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (c)(11). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(iv), which
directed striking out par. (11), was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171.
See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment
note above.
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(v), which
directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for "Bank
Insurance Fund", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-171. See Effective
Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006 Amendment note above.
Subsec. (k)(4)(B)(i). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(vi),
which directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for
"Savings Association Insurance Fund", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-
171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
Subsec. (k)(5)(A). Pub. L. 104-208, Sec. 2704(d)(14)(M)(vii),
which directed substitution of "Deposit Insurance Fund" for
"Savings Association Insurance Fund", was repealed by Pub. L. 109-
171. See Effective Date of 1996 Amendment note below and 2006
Amendment note above.
1994 - Subsec. (c)(1)(B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(34),
substituted "an insured bank in default" for "a in default insured
bank" and "such insured bank" for "such in default insured bank".
Subsec. (c)(2)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(35), substituted
"with another insured depository institution" for "with an insured
institution" and "by another depository institution" for "by an
insured institution".
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 317, designated existing
provisions as par. (1) and inserted heading, redesignated former
pars. (1) to (4) as subpars. (A) to (D) of par. (1), respectively,
and added par. (2).
Subsec. (f)(2)(B)(i). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(36),
substituted "the insured bank in default" for "the in default
insured bank".
Subsec. (f)(2)(B)(iii). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(37),
substituted "of" for "of of" after "percent".
Subsec. (f)(3). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(38), substituted
"default" for "closing" in heading.
Subsec. (f)(6)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(39), substituted
"bank that is in default" for "bank that has in default".
Subsec. (f)(6)(B)(i). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(40), inserted
period for semicolon at end.
Subsec. (f)(7)(A), (B). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(41), struck
out "or" at end of subpar. (A) and substituted "; or" for period at
end of subpar. (B).
Subsec. (f)(12)(A). Pub. L. 103-325, Sec. 602(a)(42), substituted
"are" for "is".
1991 - Subsec. (c)(4) to (10). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 141(a)(1),
(e), redesignated former pars. (5) to (9) as (6) to (10),
respectively, redesignated subpar. (B) of par. (4) as par. (5),
amended par. (4)(A) generally and redesignated it as par. (4),
further redesignated pars. (8) to (10) as (9) to (11),
respectively, and added par. (8). Prior to amendment, par. (4)(A)
read as follows: "No assistance shall be provided under this
subsection in an amount in excess of that amount which the
Corporation determines to be reasonably necessary to save the cost
of liquidating, including paying the insured accounts of, such
insured depository institution, except that such restriction shall
not apply in any case in which the Corporation determines that the
continued operation of such insured depository institution is
essential to provide adequate depository services in its community.
In calculating the cost of assistance, the Corporation shall
include (i) the immediate and long-term obligations of the
Corporation with respect to such assistance, including contingent
liabilities, and (ii) the Federal tax revenues foregone by the
Government, to the extent reasonably ascertainable."
Subsec. (d)(3)(D). Pub. L. 102-242, Sec. 123(b), added subpar.
(D).
1989 - Subsec. (a). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(1), added heading
and text of subsec. (a) and struck out former subsec. (a) which
read as follows: "Money of the Corporation not otherwise employed
shall be invested in obligations of the United States or in
obligations guaranteed as to principal and interest by the United
States: Provided, That the Corporation shall not sell or purchase
any such obligations for its own account and in its own right and
interest, at any one time aggregating in excess of $100,000,
without the approval of the Secretary of the Treasury: And provided
further, That the Secretary of the Treasury may waive the
requirement of his approval with respect to any transaction or
classes of transactions subject to the provisions of this
subsection for such period of time and under such conditions as he
may determine."
Subsec. (b). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(2), substituted "depository
accounts of the Corporation", "temporary purposes of depository
accounts", and "depository accounts to facilitate" for "banking or
checking accounts of the Corporation", "temporary purposes of
banking and checking accounts", and "banking and checking accounts
to facilitate", respectively, and substituted "depository
institution" for "bank" in four places.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institutions" for "insured banks".
Subsec. (c)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted
reference to insured depository institution for reference to
insured bank in introductory provisions.
Subsec. (c)(1)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(A), substituted
"default" for "closing".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted reference to insured
depository institution for reference to insured bank.
Subsec. (c)(1)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(C), which directed
the amendment of subsec. (c) by substituting "insured depository
institution in default" for "in default insured depository
institution" wherever appearing, could not be executed because
phrase "in default insured depository institution" did not appear
in text.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(B), which directed the amendment of
subsec. (c) by substituting "a" for "an" wherever appearing before
"closed insured bank", could not be executed because "an" did not
appear before "closed insured bank" in text.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(A), substituted "in default" for
"closed" in two places.
Subsec. (c)(1)(C). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted
references to insured depository institutions for references to
insured banks wherever appearing.
Subsec. (c)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(D)(i), substituted
"such other insured depository institution" for "such insured
institution" wherever appearing in cls. (ii) and (iii) and "another
insured depository institution" for "an insured depository
institution" in introductory provisions.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(D)(ii), (iii), in introductory
provisions, substituted "the sale of any or all of the assets" for
"the sale of assets" and "or the assumption of any or all" for "and
the assumption".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institution" and "insured depository institution's" for "insured
bank" and "insured bank's" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (c)(2)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(A), substituted
"in default" for "closed" in cl. (i) and "default" for "closing" in
cl. (ii).
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to insured
depository institutions for references to insured banks wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (c)(2)(C). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(E), added subpar.
(C).
Subsec. (c)(3). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(F), substituted
"subsection (f) or (k) of this section" for "subsection (f) of this
section".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted reference to insured
depository institution for reference to insured bank.
Subsec. (c)(4)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(G), substituted
"depository services" for "banking services" and inserted sentence
at end relating to calculation of the cost of assistance.
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted references to insured
depository institutions for references to insured banks wherever
appearing.
Subsec. (c)(4)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted
reference to insured depository institution for reference to
insured bank.
Subsec. (c)(5). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted
references to insured depository institutions for references to
insured banks wherever appearing.
Subsec. (c)(6). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(J), added par. (6).
Former par. (6) redesignated (7).
Subsec. (c)(7). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(I), redesignated par.
(6) as (7). Former par. (7) redesignated (8).
Subsec. (c)(8). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(H), (I), redesignated
par. (7) as (8) and struck out former par. (8) which read as
follows: "For purposes of this subsection, the term 'insured
institution' means an insured bank as defined in section 1813 of
this title or an insured institution as defined in section 1724 of
this title."
Subsec. (c)(9). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(3)(K), added par. (9).
Subsec. (d). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(4), added subsec. (d) and
struck out former subsec. (d), changing the structure of the
subsection from a single unnumbered paragraph to one consisting of
four numbered paragraphs.
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(4), added subsec. (e) and
struck out former subsec. (e) which read as follows: "No agreement
which tends to diminish or defeat the right, title or interest of
the Corporation in any asset acquired by it under this section,
either as security for a loan or by purchase, shall be valid
against the Corporation unless such agreement (1) shall be in
writing, (2) shall have been executed by the bank and the person or
persons claiming an adverse interest thereunder, including the
obligor, contemporaneously with the acquisition of the asset by the
bank, (3) shall have been approved by the board of directors of the
bank or its loan committee, which approval shall be reflected in
the minutes of said board or committee, and (4) shall have been,
continuously, from the time of its execution, an official record of
the bank."
Subsec. (f)(1). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(C), inserted "savings
association" after "out-of-State bank".
Subsec. (f)(2)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(A), (B),
substituted "is in default" for "is closed", and "bank in default"
for "closed bank" in three places.
Subsec. (f)(2)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(A), (D),
substituted "in default insured bank" for "closed insured bank" in
cl. (i), and "a vote of 75 percent of" for "a unanimous vote" in
cl. (iii).
Subsec. (f)(3)(A)(i), (ii), (C), (E). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec.
217(5)(A), substituted "danger of default" for "danger of closing".
Subsec. (f)(4)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(E), struck out
"the constitution of any State," after "State law,".
Subsec. (f)(5). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(A), (B), substituted
"danger of default" for "danger of closing" and "bank in default"
for "closed bank".
Subsec. (f)(6)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(A), (F),
substituted "the bank that has in default or is in danger of
default" for "the bank that has closed or is in danger of closing"
and "the Corporation shall permit the offeror which made the
initial lowest acceptable offer and" for "the Corporation shall
permit".
Subsec. (f)(7)(C). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(G), added subpar.
(C).
Subsec. (f)(8)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(H), redesignated
subpar. (C) as (A) and struck out former subpar. (A) which read as
follows: "the term 'receiver' means the Corporation when it has
been appointed the receiver of a closed insured bank;".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(A), (B), substituted "danger of
default" for "danger of closing" in two places and "bank in
default" for "closed bank" in two places.
Subsec. (f)(8)(B). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(H), redesignated
subpar. (E) as (B) and struck out former subpar. (B) which read as
follows: "the term 'insured depository institution' means an
insured bank or an association or savings bank insured by the
Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation;".
Subsec. (f)(8)(C). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(H), redesignated
subpar. (F) as (C). Former subpar. (C) redesignated (A).
Subsec. (f)(8)(D). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(H), redesignated
subpar. (G) as (D) and struck out former subpar. (D) which read as
follows: "the term 'bank in danger of closing' means an insured
bank with respect to which the appropriate Federal or State
chartering authority certifies in writing that -
"(i)(I) the bank is not likely to be able to meet the demands
of such bank's depositors or pay the obligations of the bank in
the normal course of business, and
"(II) there is no reasonable prospect that the bank will be
able to meet such demands or pay such obligations without Federal
assistance; or
"(ii)(I) the bank has incurred or is likely to incur losses
that will deplete all or substantially all of the capital of the
bank, and
"(II) there is no reasonable prospect for the replenishment of
the bank's capital without Federal assistance;".
Subsec. (f)(8)(E) to (G). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(H),
redesignated subpars. (E) to (G) as (B) to (D), respectively.
Subsec. (f)(9). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(I), substituted
"certain subsidiaries" for "nonbank subsidiaries" in heading,
"subsidiary, other than a subsidiary that is an insured depository
institution," for "subsidiary" and "holding company" for "holding
company which is not an insured bank" in subpar. (A), and
"intermediate holding company or an affiliate of an insured
depository institution" for "intermediate holding company" in
subpar. (B).
Subsec. (f)(12). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(5)(J), added par. (12).
Subsec. (h). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(6), substituted "an insured
depository institution in default" for "a closed insured depository
institution", "default" for "closing", and "Bank Insurance Fund"
for "insurance fund".
Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 201(a), substituted "insured depository
institution" for "insured bank" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (i)(1)(A). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), inserted
"depository" before "institution" in three places.
Subsec. (i)(1)(C). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(B), substituted
"Corporation" for "corporation" where first appearing, "chartered
depository institution" for "chartered bank", "State member bank, a
savings association," for "State member bank", and "Federal Reserve
System or the Director of the Office of Thrift Supervision" for
"Federal Reserve System".
Subsec. (i)(1)(D). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), inserted
"depository" before "institution" in two places.
Subsec. (i)(2). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), (C), inserted
"depository" before "institution" in two places, and struck out "or
insured or guaranteed under State law" after "insured under this
chapter".
Subsec. (i)(3) to (9). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), inserted
"depository" before "institution" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (i)(10). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(D), struck out par.
(10) which read as follows: "Notwithstanding any other Federal or
State law, net worth certificates purchased by the Corporation
under this subsection shall be deemed to be net worth for statutory
and regulatory purposes."
Subsec. (i)(11). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), inserted
"depository" before "institution".
Subsec. (i)(12). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(D), struck out par.
(12) which read as follows: "The Corporation may provide assistance
to a qualified institution which is not an insured institution only
if the State fund which insures or guarantees the deposits of such
qualified institution enters into an agreement with the Corporation
which provides that -
"(A) the State fund will indemnify the Corporation for any
losses which the Corporation may incur as a result of providing
assistance under this subsection to such qualified institution;
and
"(B) during any period when such qualified institution has
outstanding capital instruments issued in accordance with this
subsection, the State insurance fund maintains a level of
assessments on its members which results in costs to its members
which are at least equivalent to the premium assessments paid to
the Corporation by insured institutions during such period."
Subsec. (i)(13). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(7)(A), inserted
"depository" before "institution" in two places.
Subsec. (k). Pub. L. 101-73, Sec. 217(8), added subsec. (k).
1987 - Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 509(a), repealed Pub. L. 97-320, Sec.
141. See 1982 Amendment notes below.
Subsec. (f)(1). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(a), amended par. (1)
generally. Prior to amendment, par. (1) read as follows: "Nothing
contained in paragraph (2) or (3) shall be construed to limit the
Corporation's powers in subsection (c) of this section to assist a
transaction under paragraph (2) or (3)."
Subsec. (f)(3). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(b), amended par. (3)
generally, substituting subpars. (A) to (G) relating to emergency
interstate acquisitions of insured banks in danger of closing for
former subpars. (A) to (C) which authorized merger, purchase of
assets, or assumption of liabilities of insured bank organized in
mutual form with total assets of $500,000,000 or more upon
Corporation's determination it was in danger of closing.
Subsec. (f)(4). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(c)(1), redesignated cls.
(i) to (iii) as subpars. (A) to (C), amended subpar. (A) generally,
and added subpars. (D) and (E). Prior to amendment, subpar. (A), as
so redesignated, read as follows: "Notwithstanding section 1842(d)
of this title or any other provision of law, State or Federal, or
the constitution of any State, an institution that merges with or
acquires an insured bank under paragraph (2) or (3) is authorized
to be and shall be operated as a subsidiary of an out-of-State bank
or bank holding company, except that an out-of-State bank may
operate the resulting institution as a subsidiary only if such
ownership is otherwise specifically authorized."
Subsec. (f)(5). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(i)(1), struck out "to
permit" before "an acquisition".
Subsec. (f)(6)(A). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(i)(2), substituted
"where the bank" for "where the closed bank" and "in-State holding
company" for "in-State bank holding company".
Subsec. (f)(6)(B). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(c)(2)(A), added cls.
(ii) to (vi) and struck out former cls. (ii) to (iv) which read as
follows:
"(ii) Second, between depository institutions of the same type in
different States;
"(iii) Third, between depository institutions of different types
in the same State; and
"(iv) Fourth, between depository institutions of different types
in different States."
Subsec. (f)(6)(C). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(c)(2)(B), amended
subpar. (C) generally. Prior to amendment, subpar. (C) read as
follows: "In considering offers from different States, the
Corporation shall give a priority to offers from adjoining States."
Subsec. (f)(8)(D) to (G). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(d)-(g), added
subpars. (D) to (G).
Subsec. (f)(9) to (11). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 502(c)(3)-(5), added
pars. (9) to (11).
Subsec. (j). Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 801, added subsec. (j).
1983 - Subsec. (i)(1)(D). Pub. L. 98-29 inserted provision that
issuance of net worth certificates in accordance with this
subsection shall not constitute a default under the terms of any
debt obligations subordinated to the claims of general creditors
which were outstanding when such net worth certificates were
issued.
1983 - Subsec. (c)(5)(A). Pub. L. 97-457, Sec. 1(a), inserted "or
dividends" after "interest".
Subsec. (f)(1). Pub. L. 97-457, Sec. 4, substituted "paragraph"
for "paragraphs" wherever appearing.
Subsec. (i)(9). Pub. L. 97-457, Sec. 10, inserted "or dividends"
after "interest".
1982 - Subsec. (c). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 111, substituted
provisions contained in numbered pars. (1) through (8) relating to
the Corporation's authority to assist insured banks for prior
provisions contained in a single undesignated paragraph authorizing
the Corporation, in order to reopen a closed insured bank or, when
the Corporation had determined that an insured bank was in danger
of closing, in order to prevent such closing, in the discretion of
its Board of Directors, to make loans to, or purchase the assets
of, or make deposits in, such insured bank, upon such terms and
conditions as the Board of Directors might prescribe, when in the
opinion of the Board of Directors the continued operation of such
bank was essential to provide adequate banking service in the
community, with such loans and deposits to be in subordination to
the rights of depositors and other creditors.
Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 141(a)(1), which directed the repeal of par.
(5) effective Oct. 13, 1986, was repealed by Pub. L. 100-86, Sec.
509(a). See Effective and Termination Dates of 1982 Amendment note
and Extension of Emergency Acquisition and Net Worth Guarantee
Provisions of Pub. L. 97-320 note set out under section 1464 of
this title.
Subsec. (e). Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 113(m)(2), inserted "(e)"
before "No agreement" and struck out provision authorizing the
Board of Directors, for the purpose of averting loss to the
Corporation and facilitating a merger of an insured bank or
facilitating the sale of an insured bank's assets and assumption of
its liabilities by another insured bank, to make secured loans or
to purchase the insured bank's assets or to guarantee another
insured bank against loss by reason of its assuming the liabilities
and purchasing the assets of an insured bank, and authorizing
national or District banks or the Corporation as receiver thereof
to contract for such sales or loans and to pledge assets to secure
such loans.
Subsecs. (f) to (h). Pub. L. 97-320, Secs. 113(m)(1), 116, added
subsec. (f) and redesignated former subsecs. (f) and (g) as (g) and
(h), respectively.
Pub. L. 97-320, Sec. 141(a)(3), which directed that, effective
Oct. 13, 1986, the provisions of law amended by section 116 of Pub.
L. 97-320 shall be amended to read as they would without such
amendment, was repealed by Pub. L. 100-86, Sec. 509(a). See
Effective and Termination Dates of 1982 Amendment note and
Extension of Emergency Acquisition and Net Worth Guarantee
Provisions of Pub. L. 97-320 note set out under section 1464 of
this title.
Subsec. (i). Pub. L. 97-320, Secs. 203, 206, added subsec. (i),
relating to net worth certificates, and provided for its
prospective repeal. See Effective Date of 1982 Amendment note
below.
1978 - Subsec. (g). Pub. L. 95-369 added subsec. (g).

-CHANGE-
CHANGE OF NAME
Committee on Banking, Finance and Urban Affairs of House of
Representatives treated as referring to Committee on Banking and
Financial Services of House of Representatives by section 1(a) of
Pub. L. 104-14, set out as a note preceding section 21 of Title 2,
The Congress. Committee on Banking and Financial Services of House
of Representatives abolished and replaced by Committee on Financial
Services of House of Representatives, and jurisdiction over matters
relating to securities and exchanges and insurance generally
transferred from Committee on Energy and Commerce of House of
Representatives by House Resolution No. 5, One Hundred Seventh
Congress, Jan. 3, 2001.


-MISC2-
EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2010 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 363(6) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective on the
transfer date, see section 351 of Pub. L. 111-203, set out as a
note under section 906 of Title 2, The Congress.
Amendment by section 1106(b) of Pub. L. 111-203 effective 1 day
after July 21, 2010, except as otherwise provided, see section 4 of
Pub. L. 111-203, set out as an Effective Date note under section
5301 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2006 AMENDMENT
Amendment by section 3(a)(8) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective Jan. 1,
2007, see section 3(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note under
section 1817 of this title.
Amendment by section 8(a)(19) of Pub. L. 109-173 effective Mar.
31, 2006, see section 8(b) of Pub. L. 109-173, set out as a note
under section 1813 of this title.
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-171 effective no later than the first
day of the first calendar quarter that begins after the end of the
90-day period beginning Feb. 8, 2006, see section 2102(c) of Pub.
L. 109-171, set out as a Merger of BIF and SAIF note under section
1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 2005 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 109-8 effective 180 days after Apr. 20,
2005, and not applicable with respect to cases commenced under
Title 11, Bankruptcy, before such effective date, except as
otherwise provided, see section 1501 of Pub. L. 109-8, set out as a
note under section 101 of Title 11.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1996 AMENDMENT
Amendment by Pub. L. 104-208 effective Jan. 1, 1999, if no
insured depository institution is a savings association on that
date, see section 2704(c) of Pub. L. 104-208, formerly set out as a
note under section 1821 of this title.

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1983 AMENDMENTS
Section 1(b) of Pub. L. 98-29 provided that: "The amendment made
by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall be deemed to have
taken effect on the date of enactment of the Garn-St Germain
Depository Institutions Act of 1982 [Oct. 15, 1982]."
Section 1(b) of Pub. L. 97-457 provided that: "The amendment made
by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall be deemed to have
taken effect upon the enactment of Public Law 97-320 [Oct. 15,
1982]."
Section 10(b) of Pub. L. 97-457 provided that: "The amendment
made by subsection (a) [amending this section] shall be deemed to
have taken effect upon the enactment of Public Law 97-320 [Oct. 15,
1982]."

EFFECTIVE DATE OF 1982 AMENDMENT
Section 206 of Pub. L. 97-320, as amended by Pub. L. 97-457, Sec.
11, Jan. 12, 1983, 96 Stat. 2508; Pub. L. 99-120, Sec. 6(b), Oct.
8, 1985, 99 Stat. 504; Pub. L. 99-278, Sec. 1(b), Apr. 24, 1986,
100 Stat. 397; Pub. L. 99-400, Sec. 1(b), Aug. 27, 1986, 100 Stat.
902; Pub. L. 99-452, Sec. 1(b), Oct. 8, 1986, 100 Stat. 1140; Pub.
L. 100-86, title V, Sec. 509(b), Aug. 10, 1987, 101 Stat. 635,
provided that:
"(a) On October 13, 1991, section 406(f)(5) of the National
Housing Act [12 U.S.C. 1729(f)(5)] and section 13(i) of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1823(i)] are repealed.
"(b) The repeal by subsection (a) shall have no effect on any
action taken or authorized pursuant to the amendments made by this
title [see Short Title of 1982 Amendments note set out under
section 1811 of this title] by or for a qualified institution while
such amendments were in effect and while net worth certificates
issued pursuant to these amendments are outstanding."

GAO COMPLIANCE AUDIT
Section 141(a)(2) of Pub. L. 102-242, as amended by Pub. L. 104-
316, title I, Sec. 106(b), Oct. 19, 1996, 110 Stat. 3830, provided
that: "The Comptroller General of the United States shall audit,
under such conditions as the Comptroller General determines to be
appropriate, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and the
Resolution Trust Corporation to determine the extent to which such
corporations are complying with section 13(c)(4) of the Federal
Deposit Insurance Act [12 U.S.C. 1823(c)(4)]."

EARLY RESOLUTION OF TROUBLED INSURED DEPOSITORY INSTITUTIONS
Section 143 of Pub. L. 102-242 provided that:
"(a) In General. - It is the sense of the Congress that the
Federal banking agencies should facilitate early resolution of
troubled insured depository institutions whenever feasible if early
resolution would have the least possible long-term cost to the
deposit insurance fund, consistent with the least-cost and prompt
corrective action provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act
[12 U.S.C. 1811 et seq.].
"(b) General Principles. - In encouraging the Federal banking
agencies to pursue early resolution strategies, the Congress
contemplates that any resolution transaction under section 13(c) of
that Act [12 U.S.C. 1823(c)] would observe the following general
principles:
"(1) Competitive negotiation. - The transaction should be
negotiated competitively, taking into account the value of
expediting the process.
"(2) Resulting institution adequately capitalized. - Any
insured depository institution created or assisted in the
transaction (hereafter the 'resulting institution') and any
institution acquiring the troubled institution should meet all
applicable minimum capital standards.
"(3) Substantial private investment. - The transaction should
involve substantial private investment.
"(4) Concessions. - Preexisting owners and debtholders of any
troubled institution or its holding company should make
substantial concessions.
"(5) Qualified management. - Directors and senior management of
the resulting institution should be qualified to perform their
duties, and should not include individuals substantially
responsible for the troubled institution's problems.
"(6) FDIC's participation. - The transaction should give the
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation an opportunity to
participate in the success of the resulting institution.
"(7) Structure of transaction. - The transaction should,
insofar as practical, be structured so that -
"(A) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation -
"(i) does not acquire a significant proportion of the
troubled institution's problem assets;
"(ii) succeeds to the interests of the troubled
institution's preexisting owners and debtholders in
proportion to the assistance the Corporation provides; and
"(iii) limits the Corporation's assistance in term and
amount; and
"(B) new investors share risk with the Corporation.
"(c) Report. - Two years after the date of enactment of this Act
[Dec. 19, 1991], the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation shall
submit a report to Congress analyzing the effect of early
resolution on the deposit insurance funds."

EXTENSION OF EMERGENCY ACQUISITION AND NET WORTH GUARANTEE
PROVISIONS OF PUB. L. 97-320
No amendment made by section 141(a) of Pub. L. 97-320, set out as
a note under section 1464 of this title, or section 206(a) of Pub.
L. 97-320, set out as a note above, as in effect before Aug. 10,
1987, to any other provision of law to be deemed to have taken
effect before such date and any such provision of law to be in
effect as if no such amendment had been made before such date, see
section 509(c) of Pub. L. 100-86, set out as a note under section
1464 of this title.
No amendment made by section 141(a) or section 206(a) of Pub. L.
97-320, set out as notes under sections 1464 and 1729 of this
title, respectively, as in effect on the day before Oct. 8, 1986,
to any other provision of law to be deemed to have taken effect
before such date and any such provision of law to be in effect as
if no such amendment had taken effect before such date, see section
1(c) of Pub. L. 99-452, set out as a note under section 1464 of
this title.
Sections 141(a) and 206(a) of Pub. L. 97-320, which are set out
as notes under sections 1464 and 1729 of this title, as such
sections were in effect on the day after Aug. 27, 1986, applicable
as if such sections had been included in Pub. L. 97-320 on Oct. 15,
1982, with no amendment made by any such section to any other
provision of law to be deemed to have taken effect before Aug. 27,
1986, and any such provision of law to be in effect as if no such
amendment had taken effect before Aug. 27, 1986, see section 1(c)
of Pub. L. 99-400, set out as a note under section 1464 of this
title.

ANNUAL REPORTS TO CONGRESS BY FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK BOARD AND
FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION ON PURCHASES OF NET WORTH
CERTIFICATES
Section 204 of Pub. L. 97-320 provided that: "The Federal Home
Loan Bank Board and the Board of Directors of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation shall each transmit an annual report to each
House of the Congress specifying the types and amounts of net worth
certificates purchased from each depository institution and the
conditions imposed on each such depository institution."
[For termination, effective May 15, 2000, of reporting provisions
relating to the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation in section
204 of Pub. L. 97-320, set out above, see section 3003 of Pub. L.
104-66, as amended, set out as a note under section 1113 of Title
31, Money and Finance, and page 167 of House Document No. 103-7.]

SEMIANNUAL AUDIT BY COMPTROLLER GENERAL OF NET WORTH CERTIFICATE
PROGRAMS OF FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION AND FEDERAL HOME
LOAN BANK BOARD
Section 205 of Pub. L. 97-320 provided that: "The Comptroller
General of the United States shall conduct on a semiannual basis an
audit of the net worth certificate programs of the Federal Deposit
Insurance Corporation and the Federal Home Loan Bank Board. A
report on each such audit shall be transmitted to each House of the
Congress."
[For termination, effective May 15, 2000, of reporting provisions
in section 205 of Pub. L. 97-320, set out above, see section 3003
of Pub. L. 104-66, as amended, set out as a note under section 1113
of Title 31, Money and Finance, and page 3 of House Document No.
103-7.]

-FOOTNOTE-
(!1) So in original. Probably should be "an".

(!2) So in original. Probably should be followed by "or".

(!3) See References in Text note below.


-End-



-CITE-
12 USC Sec. 1824 01/07/2011

-EXPCITE-
TITLE 12 - BANKS AND BANKING
CHAPTER 16 - FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION

-HEAD-
Sec. 1824. Borrowing authority

-STATUTE-
(a) Borrowing from Treasury
(1) In general
The Corporation is authorized to borrow from the Treasury, and
the Secretary of the Treasury is authorized and directed to loan
to the Corporation on such terms as may be fixed by the
Corporation and the Secretary, such funds as in the judgment of
the Board of Directors of the Corporation are from time to time
required for insurance purposes, not exceeding in the aggregate
$100,000,000,000 outstanding at any one time, subject to the
approval of the Secretary of the Treasury: Provided, That the
rate of interest to be charged in connection with any loan made
pursuant to this subsection shall not be less than an amount
determined by the Secretary of the Treasury, taking into
consideration current market yields on outstanding marketable
obligations of the United States of comparable maturities. For
such purpose the Secretary of the Treasury is authorized to use
as a public-debt transaction the proceeds of the sale of any
securities hereafter issued under chapter 31 of title 31, and the
purposes for which securities may be issued under chapter 31 of
title 31